Implement TARGET_WAITKIND_NO_RESUMED in the remote protocol
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661
2662 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2663 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2664 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2665 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2666 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2667 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex add-inferior
2671 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2672 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2673 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2674 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2675 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2676 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2677
2678 @kindex clone-inferior
2679 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2681 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2682 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2683 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2684
2685 @smallexample
2686 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2687 Num Description Executable
2688 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2689 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2690 Added inferior 2.
2691 1 inferiors added.
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 2 <null> helloworld
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 @end smallexample
2697
2698 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2699
2700 @kindex remove-inferiors
2701 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2702 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2703 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2704 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2705
2706 @end table
2707
2708 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2709 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2710 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2711 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2716 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2717 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2718 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2719 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2720
2721 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2724 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2725 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2726 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2730 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2731 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2732 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2733
2734
2735 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2736 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2737
2738 @table @code
2739 @kindex set print inferior-events
2740 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2741 @item set print inferior-events
2742 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2743 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2744 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2745 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2746 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2747 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2748
2749 @kindex show print inferior-events
2750 @item show print inferior-events
2751 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2752 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2753 @end table
2754
2755 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2756 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2757 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2758
2759
2760 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2761 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2762 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2763 info program-spaces}} command.
2764
2765 @table @code
2766 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2767 @item maint info program-spaces
2768 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2769 @value{GDBN}.
2770
2771 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2772
2773 @enumerate
2774 @item
2775 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2776
2777 @item
2778 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2779 the @code{file} command.
2780
2781 @end enumerate
2782
2783 @noindent
2784 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2785 indicates the current program space.
2786
2787 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2788 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2789 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2790
2791 @smallexample
2792 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2793 Id Executable
2794 * 1 hello
2795 2 goodbye
2796 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2797 @end smallexample
2798
2799 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2800 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2801 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2802 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2803 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2807 Id Executable
2808 * 1 vfork-test
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2813 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2814 @end table
2815
2816 @node Threads
2817 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2818
2819 @cindex threads of execution
2820 @cindex multiple threads
2821 @cindex switching threads
2822 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2823 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2824 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2825 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2826 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2827 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2828 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2829
2830 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2831 programs:
2832
2833 @itemize @bullet
2834 @item automatic notification of new threads
2835 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2836 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2837 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2838 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2839 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2840 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2841 messages on thread start and exit.
2842 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2843 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2844 isn't compatible with the program.
2845 @end itemize
2846
2847 @quotation
2848 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2849 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2850 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2851 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2852 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2853 like this:
2854
2855 @smallexample
2856 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2857 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2858 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2859 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2860 @end smallexample
2861 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2862 @c doesn't support threads"?
2863 @end quotation
2864
2865 @cindex focus of debugging
2866 @cindex current thread
2867 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2868 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2869 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2870 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2871 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2872
2873 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2874 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2875 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2876 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2877 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2878 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2879 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2880 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2881 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2882 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2883
2884 @smallexample
2885 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2886 @end smallexample
2887
2888 @noindent
2889 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2890 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2891 further qualifier.
2892
2893 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2894 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2895 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2896 @c program?
2897 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2898 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2899 @c threads ab initio?
2900
2901 @cindex thread number
2902 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2903 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2904 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2905
2906 @table @code
2907 @kindex info threads
2908 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2909 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2910 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2911 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2912 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2913
2914 @enumerate
2915 @item
2916 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2917
2918 @item
2919 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2920
2921 @item
2922 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2923 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2924 program itself.
2925
2926 @item
2927 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2928 @end enumerate
2929
2930 @noindent
2931 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2932 indicates the current thread.
2933
2934 For example,
2935 @end table
2936 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2937
2938 @smallexample
2939 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2940 Id Target Id Frame
2941 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2942 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2943 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2944 at threadtest.c:68
2945 @end smallexample
2946
2947 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2948 Solaris-specific command:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item maint info sol-threads
2952 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2953 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2954 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2955 @end table
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2959 @item thread @var{threadno}
2960 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2961 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2962 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2963 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2964 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2965
2966 @smallexample
2967 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2968 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2969 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2970 8 printf ("hello\n");
2971 @end smallexample
2972
2973 @noindent
2974 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2975 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2976 threads.
2977
2978 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2979 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2980 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2981 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2982 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2983 information on convenience variables.
2984
2985 @kindex thread apply
2986 @cindex apply command to several threads
2987 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2988 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2989 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2990 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2991 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2992 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2993 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
2994 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
2995 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
2996 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
2997
2998
2999 @kindex thread name
3000 @cindex name a thread
3001 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3002 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3003 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3004 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3005
3006 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3007 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3008 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3009 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3010 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3011
3012 @kindex thread find
3013 @cindex search for a thread
3014 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3015 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3016 matches the supplied regular expression.
3017
3018 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3019 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3020 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3021 is the LWP id.
3022
3023 @smallexample
3024 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3025 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3026 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3027 Id Target Id Frame
3028 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 @kindex set print thread-events
3032 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3033 @item set print thread-events
3034 @itemx set print thread-events on
3035 @itemx set print thread-events off
3036 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3037 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3038 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3039 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3040 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3041
3042 @kindex show print thread-events
3043 @item show print thread-events
3044 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3045 have started and exited.
3046 @end table
3047
3048 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3049 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3050 programs with multiple threads.
3051
3052 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3053 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3054
3055 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3056 @table @code
3057 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3058 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3059 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3060 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3061 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3062 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3063 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3064 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3065 macro.
3066
3067 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3068 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3069 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3070 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3071 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3072 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3073
3074 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3075 refers to the default system directories that are
3076 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3077 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3078 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3079
3080 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3081 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3082 was loaded in the inferior process.
3083
3084 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3085 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3086 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3087 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3088 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3089 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3090 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3091
3092 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3093 only on some platforms.
3094
3095 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3096 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3097 Display current libthread_db search path.
3098
3099 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3100 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3101 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3102 @item set debug libthread-db
3103 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3104 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3105 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3106 @end table
3107
3108 @node Forks
3109 @section Debugging Forks
3110
3111 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3112 @cindex multiple processes
3113 @cindex processes, multiple
3114 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3115 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3116 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3117 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3118 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3119 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3120 will cause it to terminate.
3121
3122 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3123 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3124 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3125 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3126 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3127 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3128 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3129 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3130 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3131 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3132
3133 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3134 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3135 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3136 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3137
3138 The fork debugging commands are supported in both native mode and when
3139 connected to @code{gdbserver} using @kbd{target extended-remote}.
3140
3141 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3142 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3143
3144 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3145 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3146
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3149 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3150 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3151 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3152 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3153
3154 @table @code
3155 @item parent
3156 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3157 unimpeded. This is the default.
3158
3159 @item child
3160 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3161 unimpeded.
3162
3163 @end table
3164
3165 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3166 @item show follow-fork-mode
3167 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3168 @end table
3169
3170 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3171 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3172 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3173
3174 @table @code
3175 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3176 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3177 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3178 retain debugger control over them both.
3179
3180 @table @code
3181 @item on
3182 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3183 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3184 independently. This is the default.
3185
3186 @item off
3187 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3188 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3189 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3190 is held suspended.
3191
3192 @end table
3193
3194 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3195 @item show detach-on-fork
3196 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3197 @end table
3198
3199 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3200 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3201 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3202 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3203 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3204 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3205
3206 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3207 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3208 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3209 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3210 and Programs}.
3211
3212 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3213 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3214 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3215 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3216 the child process's @code{main}.
3217
3218 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3219 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3220
3221 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3222 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3223 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3224 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3225 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3226 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3227 command.
3228
3229 @table @code
3230 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3231 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3232
3233 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3234 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3235
3236 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3237
3238 @table @code
3239 @item new
3240 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3241 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3242 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3243 original inferior.
3244
3245 For example:
3246
3247 @smallexample
3248 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3249 (gdb) info inferior
3250 Id Description Executable
3251 * 1 <null> prog1
3252 (@value{GDBP}) run
3253 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3254 Program exited normally.
3255 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3256 Id Description Executable
3257 1 <null> prog1
3258 * 2 <null> prog2
3259 @end smallexample
3260
3261 @item same
3262 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3263 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3264 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3265 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3266 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3267
3268 For example:
3269
3270 @smallexample
3271 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3272 Id Description Executable
3273 * 1 <null> prog1
3274 (@value{GDBP}) run
3275 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3276 Program exited normally.
3277 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3278 Id Description Executable
3279 * 1 <null> prog2
3280 @end smallexample
3281
3282 @end table
3283 @end table
3284
3285 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3286 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3287 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3288
3289 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3290 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3291
3292 @cindex checkpoint
3293 @cindex restart
3294 @cindex bookmark
3295 @cindex snapshot of a process
3296 @cindex rewind program state
3297
3298 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3299 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3300 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3301 later.
3302
3303 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3304 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3305 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3306 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3307 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3308
3309 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3310 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3311 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3312 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3313 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3314 start again from there.
3315
3316 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3317 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3318
3319 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3320
3321 @table @code
3322 @kindex checkpoint
3323 @item checkpoint
3324 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3325 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3326 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3327
3328 @kindex info checkpoints
3329 @item info checkpoints
3330 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3331 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3332 listed:
3333
3334 @table @code
3335 @item Checkpoint ID
3336 @item Process ID
3337 @item Code Address
3338 @item Source line, or label
3339 @end table
3340
3341 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3342 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3343 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3344 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3345 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3346 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3347 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3348
3349 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3350 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3351 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3352 the debugger.
3353
3354 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3355 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3356 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3357
3358 @end table
3359
3360 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3361 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3362 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3363 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3364 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3365 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3366 previously read data can be read again.
3367
3368 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3369 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3370 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3371 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3372 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3373 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3374
3375 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3376 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3377 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3378 different execution path this time.
3379
3380 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3381 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3382 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3383 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3384 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3385 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3386 potentially pose a problem.
3387
3388 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3389
3390 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3391 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3392 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3393 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3394 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3395 next.
3396
3397 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3398 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3399 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3400 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3401 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3402
3403 @node Stopping
3404 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3405
3406 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3407 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3408 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3409
3410 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3411 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3412 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3413 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3414 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3415 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3416 explicitly request this information at any time.
3417
3418 @table @code
3419 @kindex info program
3420 @item info program
3421 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3422 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3423 @end table
3424
3425 @menu
3426 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3427 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3428 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3429 Skipping over functions and files
3430 * Signals:: Signals
3431 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3432 @end menu
3433
3434 @node Breakpoints
3435 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3436
3437 @cindex breakpoints
3438 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3439 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3440 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3441 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3442 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3443 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3444 program.
3445
3446 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3447 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3448 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3449 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3450 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3451 call).
3452
3453 @cindex watchpoints
3454 @cindex data breakpoints
3455 @cindex memory tracing
3456 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3457 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3458 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3459 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3460 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3461 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3462 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3463 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3464 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3465 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3466 same commands.
3467
3468 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3469 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3470 Automatic Display}.
3471
3472 @cindex catchpoints
3473 @cindex breakpoint on events
3474 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3475 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3476 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3477 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3478 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3479 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3480 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3481
3482 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3483 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3484 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3485 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3486 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3487 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3488 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3489 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3490 enable it again.
3491
3492 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3493 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3494 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3495 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3496 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3497 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3498 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3499
3500 @menu
3501 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3502 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3503 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3504 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3505 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3506 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3507 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3508 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3509 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3510 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3511 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3512 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3513 @end menu
3514
3515 @node Set Breaks
3516 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3517
3518 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3519 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3520 @c
3521 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3522
3523 @kindex break
3524 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3525 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3526 @cindex latest breakpoint
3527 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3528 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3529 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3530 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3531 convenience variables.
3532
3533 @table @code
3534 @item break @var{location}
3535 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3536 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3537 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3538 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3539 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3540
3541 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3542 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3543 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3544 that situation.
3545
3546 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3547 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3548 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3549
3550 @item break
3551 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3552 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3553 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3554 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3555 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3556 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3557 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3558 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3559 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3560 inside loops.
3561
3562 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3563 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3564 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3565 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3566 existed when your program stopped.
3567
3568 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3569 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3570 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3571 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3572 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3573 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3574 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3575
3576 @kindex tbreak
3577 @item tbreak @var{args}
3578 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3579 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3580 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3581 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3582
3583 @kindex hbreak
3584 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3585 @item hbreak @var{args}
3586 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3587 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3588 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3589 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3590 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3591 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3592 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3593 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3594 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3595 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3596 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3597 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3598 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3599 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3600 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3601 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3602 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3603 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3604
3605 @kindex thbreak
3606 @item thbreak @var{args}
3607 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3608 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3609 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3610 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3611 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3612 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3613 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3614 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3615
3616 @kindex rbreak
3617 @cindex regular expression
3618 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3619 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3620 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3621 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3622 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3623 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3624 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3625 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3626 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3627
3628 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3629 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3630 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3631 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3632 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3633 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3634
3635 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3636 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3637 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3638 classes.
3639
3640 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3641 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3642 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3643
3644 @smallexample
3645 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3646 @end smallexample
3647
3648 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3649 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3650 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3651 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3652 every function in a given file:
3653
3654 @smallexample
3655 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3656 @end smallexample
3657
3658 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3659 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3660
3661 @kindex info breakpoints
3662 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3663 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3664 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3665 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3666 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3667 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3668 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3669
3670 @table @emph
3671 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3672 @item Type
3673 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3674 @item Disposition
3675 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3676 @item Enabled or Disabled
3677 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3678 that are not enabled.
3679 @item Address
3680 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3681 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3682 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3683 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3684 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3685 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3686 @item What
3687 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3688 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3689 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3690 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3691 @end table
3692
3693 @noindent
3694 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3695 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3696 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3697 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3698 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3699 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3700
3701 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3702 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3703 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3704 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3705
3706 @noindent
3707 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3708 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3709 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3710 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3711 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3712
3713 @noindent
3714 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3715 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3716 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3717 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3718 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3719 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3720
3721 @noindent
3722 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3723 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3724
3725 @end table
3726
3727 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3728 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3729 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3730 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3731
3732 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3733 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3734 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3735 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3736
3737 @itemize @bullet
3738 @item
3739 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3740
3741 @item
3742 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3743 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3744
3745 @item
3746 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3747 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3748
3749 @item
3750 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3751 several places where that function is inlined.
3752 @end itemize
3753
3754 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3755 the relevant locations.
3756
3757 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3758 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3759 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3760 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3761 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3762 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3763 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3764
3765 For example:
3766
3767 @smallexample
3768 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3769 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3770 stop only if i==1
3771 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3772 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3773 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3774 @end smallexample
3775
3776 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3777 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3778 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3779 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3780 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3781 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3782 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3783 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3784 that belong to that breakpoint.
3785
3786 @cindex pending breakpoints
3787 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3788 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3789 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3790 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3791 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3792 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3793 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3794 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3795 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3796 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3797 is not yet resolved.
3798
3799 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3800 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3801 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3802 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3803 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3804 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3805
3806 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3807 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3808 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3809 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3810
3811 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3812 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3813 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3814
3815 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3816 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3817 address specification to an address:
3818
3819 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3820 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3821 @table @code
3822 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3823 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3824 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3825
3826 @item set breakpoint pending on
3827 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3828 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3829
3830 @item set breakpoint pending off
3831 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3832 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3833 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3834
3835 @item show breakpoint pending
3836 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3837 @end table
3838
3839 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3840 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3841 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3842
3843 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3844 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3845 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3846 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3847 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3848 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3849 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3850 breakpoints.
3851
3852 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3853
3854 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3855 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3856 @table @code
3857 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3858 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3859 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3860 breakpoint must be used.
3861
3862 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3863 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3864 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3865 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3866 @end table
3867
3868 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3869 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3870 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3871 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3872 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3873 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3874 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3875 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3876 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3877
3878 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3879 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3880 @table @code
3881 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3882 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3883 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3884 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3885
3886 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3887 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3888 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3889 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3890 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3894 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3895 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3896
3897 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3898 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3899
3900 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3901
3902 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3903 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3904 @table @code
3905 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3906 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3907 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3908 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3909 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3910
3911 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3912 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3913 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3914 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3915 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3916 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3917 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3918 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3919 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3920 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3921 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3922 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3923 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3924
3925 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3926 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3927 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3928 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3929 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3930 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3931 @end table
3932
3933
3934 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3935 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3936 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3937 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3938 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3939 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3940 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3941 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3942
3943
3944 @node Set Watchpoints
3945 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3946
3947 @cindex setting watchpoints
3948 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3949 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3950 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3951 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3952 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3953
3954 @itemize @bullet
3955 @item
3956 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3957
3958 @item
3959 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3960 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3961 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3962
3963 @item
3964 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3965 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3966 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3967 @end itemize
3968
3969 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3970 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3971 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3972 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3973 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3974 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3975 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3976 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3977 the expression changes.
3978
3979 @cindex software watchpoints
3980 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3981 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3982 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3983 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3984 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3985 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3986 culprit.)
3987
3988 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3989 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3990 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3991
3992 @table @code
3993 @kindex watch
3994 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3995 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3996 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3997 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3998 to watch the value of a single variable:
3999
4000 @smallexample
4001 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4002 @end smallexample
4003
4004 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
4005 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4006 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4007 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4008 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4009 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4010
4011 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4012 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4013 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4014 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4015 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4016 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4017 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4018 error.
4019
4020 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4021 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4022 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4023 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4024 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4025 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4026 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4027 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4028 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4029 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4030 Examples:
4031
4032 @smallexample
4033 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4034 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4035 @end smallexample
4036
4037 @kindex rwatch
4038 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4039 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4040 by the program.
4041
4042 @kindex awatch
4043 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4044 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4045 or written into by the program.
4046
4047 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4048 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4049 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4050 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4051 @end table
4052
4053 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4054 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4055 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4056 a never-changing value:
4057
4058 @smallexample
4059 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4060 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4061 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4062 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4063 @end smallexample
4064
4065 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4066 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4067 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4068 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4069 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4070 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4071
4072 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4073 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4074 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4075 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4076 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4077 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4078 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4079 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4080
4081 @table @code
4082 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4083 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4084 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4085
4086 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4087 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4088 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4089 @end table
4090
4091 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4092 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4093 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4094
4095 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4096
4097 @smallexample
4098 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4099 @end smallexample
4100
4101 @noindent
4102 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4103
4104 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4105 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4106 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4107 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4108 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4109 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4110 will print a message like this:
4111
4112 @smallexample
4113 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4114 @end smallexample
4115
4116 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4117 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4118 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4119 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4120 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4121 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4122 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4123 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4124
4125 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4126 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4127 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4128 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4129 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4130 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4131
4132 @smallexample
4133 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136 @noindent
4137 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4138
4139 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4140 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4141 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4142 expression with separately allocated resources.
4143
4144 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4145 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4146 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4147
4148 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4149 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4150 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4151 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4152 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4153 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4154 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4155 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4156 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4157
4158 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4159 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4160 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4161 watched expression from every thread.
4162
4163 @quotation
4164 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4165 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4166 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4167 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4168 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4169 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4170 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4171 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4172 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4173 @end quotation
4174
4175 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4176
4177 @node Set Catchpoints
4178 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4179 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4180 @cindex exception handlers
4181 @cindex event handling
4182
4183 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4184 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4185 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4186
4187 @table @code
4188 @kindex catch
4189 @item catch @var{event}
4190 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4191
4192 @table @code
4193 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4194 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4195 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4196 @kindex catch throw
4197 @kindex catch rethrow
4198 @kindex catch catch
4199 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4200 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4201
4202 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4203 regular expression will be caught.
4204
4205 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4206 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4207 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4208 exception being thrown.
4209
4210 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4211 @value{GDBN}:
4212
4213 @itemize @bullet
4214 @item
4215 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4216 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4217 supported.
4218
4219 @item
4220 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4221 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4222 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4223 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4224 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4225 built.
4226
4227 @item
4228 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4229 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4230
4231 @item
4232 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4233 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4234 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4235 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4236
4237 @item
4238 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4239 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4240 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4241 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4242 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4243 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4244 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4245 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4246 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4247
4248 @item
4249 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4250
4251 @item
4252 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4253 @end itemize
4254
4255 @item exception
4256 @kindex catch exception
4257 @cindex Ada exception catching
4258 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4259 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4260 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4261 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4262 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4263
4264 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4265 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4266 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4267 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4268 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4269 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4270 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4271 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4272
4273 @item exception unhandled
4274 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4275 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4276
4277 @item assert
4278 @kindex catch assert
4279 A failed Ada assertion.
4280
4281 @item exec
4282 @kindex catch exec
4283 @cindex break on fork/exec
4284 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4285 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4286
4287 @item syscall
4288 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4289 @kindex catch syscall
4290 @cindex break on a system call.
4291 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4292 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4293 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4294 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4295 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4296 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4297 will be caught.
4298
4299 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4300 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4301 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4302 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4303
4304 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4305 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4306 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4307 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4308
4309 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4310 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4311 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4312 available choices.
4313
4314 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4315 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4316 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4317 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4318 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4319 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4320 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4321 behind the OS upgrades).
4322
4323 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4324 arguments to it:
4325
4326 @smallexample
4327 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4328 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4329 (@value{GDBP}) r
4330 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4331
4332 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4333 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4334 (@value{GDBP}) c
4335 Continuing.
4336
4337 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4338 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4339 (@value{GDBP})
4340 @end smallexample
4341
4342 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4343
4344 @smallexample
4345 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4346 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4347 (@value{GDBP}) r
4348 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4349
4350 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4351 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4352 (@value{GDBP}) c
4353 Continuing.
4354
4355 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4356 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4357 (@value{GDBP})
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4361 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4362 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4363
4364 @smallexample
4365 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4366 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4367 (@value{GDBP}) r
4368 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4369
4370 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4371 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4372 (@value{GDBP}) c
4373 Continuing.
4374
4375 Program exited normally.
4376 (@value{GDBP})
4377 @end smallexample
4378
4379 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4380 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4381 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4382 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4383
4384 @smallexample
4385 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4386 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4387 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4388 (@value{GDBP})
4389 @end smallexample
4390
4391 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4392 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4393 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4394 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4395 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4396 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4397
4398 @smallexample
4399 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4400 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4401 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4402 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4403 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4404 (@value{GDBP})
4405 @end smallexample
4406
4407 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4408
4409 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4410 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4411
4412 @smallexample
4413 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4414 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4415 @end smallexample
4416
4417 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4418
4419 @item fork
4420 @kindex catch fork
4421 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4422 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4423
4424 @item vfork
4425 @kindex catch vfork
4426 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4427 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4428
4429 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4430 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4431 @kindex catch load
4432 @kindex catch unload
4433 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4434 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4435 matches one of the affected libraries.
4436
4437 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4438 @kindex catch signal
4439 The delivery of a signal.
4440
4441 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4442 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4443 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4444
4445 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4446 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4447 signal names.
4448
4449 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4450 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4451 will be caught.
4452
4453 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4454 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4455 catchpoint.
4456
4457 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4458 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4459 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4460 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4461 commands.
4462
4463 @end table
4464
4465 @item tcatch @var{event}
4466 @kindex tcatch
4467 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4468 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4469
4470 @end table
4471
4472 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4473
4474
4475 @node Delete Breaks
4476 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4477
4478 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4479 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4480 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4481 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4482 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4483 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4484
4485 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4486 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4487 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4488 their breakpoint numbers.
4489
4490 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4491 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4492 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4493
4494 @table @code
4495 @kindex clear
4496 @item clear
4497 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4498 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4499 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4500 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4501
4502 @item clear @var{location}
4503 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4504 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4505 most useful ones are listed below:
4506
4507 @table @code
4508 @item clear @var{function}
4509 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4510 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4511
4512 @item clear @var{linenum}
4513 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4514 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4515 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4516 @end table
4517
4518 @cindex delete breakpoints
4519 @kindex delete
4520 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4521 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4522 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4523 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4524 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4525 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4526 @end table
4527
4528 @node Disabling
4529 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4530
4531 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4532 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4533 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4534 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4535 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4536
4537 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4538 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4539 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4540 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4541 do not know which numbers to use.
4542
4543 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4544 affects all of its locations.
4545
4546 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4547 different states of enablement:
4548
4549 @itemize @bullet
4550 @item
4551 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4552 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4553 @item
4554 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4555 @item
4556 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4557 disabled.
4558 @item
4559 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4560 N times, then becomes disabled.
4561 @item
4562 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4563 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4564 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4565 @end itemize
4566
4567 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4568 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4569
4570 @table @code
4571 @kindex disable
4572 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4573 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4574 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4575 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4576 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4577 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4578 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4579
4580 @kindex enable
4581 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4582 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4583 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4584
4585 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4586 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4587 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4588
4589 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4590 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4591 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4592 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4593 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4594 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4595 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4596
4597 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4598 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4599 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4600 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4601 @end table
4602
4603 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4604 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4605 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4606 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4607 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4608 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4609 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4610 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4611 Stepping}.)
4612
4613 @node Conditions
4614 @subsection Break Conditions
4615 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4616 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4617
4618 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4619 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4620 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4621 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4622 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4623 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4624 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4625 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4626
4627 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4628 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4629 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4630 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4631 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4632
4633 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4634 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4635 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4636 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4637 one.
4638
4639 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4640 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4641 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4642 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4643 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4644 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4645 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4646 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4647 conditions for the
4648 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4649 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4650
4651 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4652 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4653 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4654 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4655 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4656 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4657
4658 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4659 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4660 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4661 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4662 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4663
4664 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4665 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4666 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4667 with the @code{condition} command.
4668
4669 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4670 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4671 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4672 catchpoint.
4673
4674 @table @code
4675 @kindex condition
4676 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4677 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4678 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4679 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4680 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4681 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4682 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4683 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4684 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4685 prints an error message:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4689 @end smallexample
4690
4691 @noindent
4692 @value{GDBN} does
4693 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4694 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4695 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4696
4697 @item condition @var{bnum}
4698 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4699 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4700 @end table
4701
4702 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4703 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4704 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4705 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4706 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4707 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4708 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4709 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4710 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4711 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4712 your program reaches it.
4713
4714 @table @code
4715 @kindex ignore
4716 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4717 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4718 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4719 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4720 takes no action.
4721
4722 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4723 a count of zero.
4724
4725 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4726 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4727 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4728 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4729
4730 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4731 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4732 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4733
4734 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4735 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4736 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4737 Variables}.
4738 @end table
4739
4740 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4741
4742
4743 @node Break Commands
4744 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4745
4746 @cindex breakpoint commands
4747 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4748 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4749 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4750 enable other breakpoints.
4751
4752 @table @code
4753 @kindex commands
4754 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4755 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4756 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4757 @itemx end
4758 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4759 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4760 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4761
4762 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4763 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4764
4765 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4766 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4767 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4768 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4769 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4770 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4771 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4772 Expressions}).
4773 @end table
4774
4775 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4776 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4777
4778 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4779 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4780 that resumes execution.
4781
4782 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4783 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4784 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4785 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4786 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4787
4788 @kindex silent
4789 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4790 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4791 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4792 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4793 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4794 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4795
4796 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4797 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4798 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4799
4800 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4801 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4802
4803 @smallexample
4804 break foo if x>0
4805 commands
4806 silent
4807 printf "x is %d\n",x
4808 cont
4809 end
4810 @end smallexample
4811
4812 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4813 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4814 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4815 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4816 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4817 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4818 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4819
4820 @smallexample
4821 break 403
4822 commands
4823 silent
4824 set x = y + 4
4825 cont
4826 end
4827 @end smallexample
4828
4829 @node Dynamic Printf
4830 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4831
4832 @cindex dynamic printf
4833 @cindex dprintf
4834 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4835 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4836 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4837 having to recompile it.
4838
4839 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4840 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4841 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4842 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4843 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4844 redirects to files and so forth.
4845
4846 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4847 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4848 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4849 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4850 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4851 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4852 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4853
4854 @table @code
4855 @kindex dprintf
4856 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4857 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4858 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4859 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4860
4861 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4862 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4863 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4864 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4865 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4866 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4867
4868 @item gdb
4869 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4870 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4871
4872 @item call
4873 @kindex dprintf-style call
4874 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4875 @code{printf}).
4876
4877 @item agent
4878 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4879 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4880 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4881 support running commands on the target.
4882
4883 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4884 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4885 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4886 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4887 command.
4888
4889 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4890 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4891 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4892 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4893 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4894 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4895
4896 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4897 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4898 you could do the following:
4899
4900 @example
4901 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4902 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4903 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4904 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4905 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4906 (gdb) info break
4907 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4908 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4909 continue
4910 (gdb)
4911 @end example
4912
4913 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4914 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4915 the variable settings.
4916
4917 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4918 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4919 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4920 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4921 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4922 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4923
4924 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4925 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4926 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4927
4928 @end table
4929
4930 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4931 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4932 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4933 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4934 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4935 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4936
4937 @node Save Breakpoints
4938 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4939
4940 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4941 breakpoints}} command.
4942
4943 @table @code
4944 @kindex save breakpoints
4945 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4946 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4947 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4948 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4949 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4950 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4951 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4952 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4953 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4954 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4955 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4956 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4957 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4958 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4959 that can no longer be recreated.
4960 @end table
4961
4962 @node Static Probe Points
4963 @subsection Static Probe Points
4964
4965 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4966 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
4967 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4968 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4969 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
4970
4971 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
4972 ELF-compatible systems:
4973
4974 @itemize @bullet
4975
4976 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4977 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
4978 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4979 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
4980 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
4981 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
4982 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4983 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
4984
4985 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
4986 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
4987 C@t{++} languages.
4988 @end itemize
4989
4990 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4991 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
4992 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
4993 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
4994 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
4995 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
4996 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
4997 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
4998 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
4999
5000 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5001 probes}, with optional arguments:
5002
5003 @table @code
5004 @kindex info probes
5005 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5006 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5007 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5008 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5009
5010 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5011 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5012 probes from all providers are listed.
5013
5014 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5015 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5016 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5017
5018 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5019 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5020 given, all object files are considered.
5021
5022 @item info probes all
5023 List the available static probes, from all types.
5024 @end table
5025
5026 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5027 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5028 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5029 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5030 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5031
5032 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5033 commands, with optional arguments:
5034
5035 @table @code
5036 @kindex enable probes
5037 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5038 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5039 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5040 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5041
5042 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5043 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5044 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5045
5046 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5047 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5048 given, all object files are considered.
5049
5050 @kindex disable probes
5051 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5052 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5053 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5054 @end table
5055
5056 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5057 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5058 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5059 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5060 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5061 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5062 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5063 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5064 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5065 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5066 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5067 at the current probe point.
5068
5069 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5070 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5071 an error message.
5072
5073
5074 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5075 @node Error in Breakpoints
5076 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5077
5078 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5079 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5080
5081 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5082 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5083 @smallexample
5084 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5085 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5086 @end smallexample
5087
5088 @noindent
5089 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5090 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5091 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5092
5093 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5094 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5095
5096 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5097 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5098 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5099
5100 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5101 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5102 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5103 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5104
5105 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5106 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5107 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5108 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5109 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5110 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5111 first in the bundle.
5112
5113 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5114 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5115 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5116 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5117 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5118 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5119 is hit.
5120
5121 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5122 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5123
5124 @smallexample
5125 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5126 @end smallexample
5127
5128 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5129 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5130 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5131 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5132 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5133 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5134 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5135 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5136
5137 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5138 adjusted breakpoints:
5139
5140 @smallexample
5141 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5142 to 0x00010410.
5143 @end smallexample
5144
5145 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5146 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5147 frequently than expected.
5148
5149 @node Continuing and Stepping
5150 @section Continuing and Stepping
5151
5152 @cindex stepping
5153 @cindex continuing
5154 @cindex resuming execution
5155 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5156 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5157 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5158 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5159 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5160 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5161 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5162 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5163 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5164 handlers}).)
5165
5166 @table @code
5167 @kindex continue
5168 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5169 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5170 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5171 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5172 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5173 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5174 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5175 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5176 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5177 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5178
5179 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5180 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5181 @code{continue} is ignored.
5182
5183 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5184 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5185 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5186 @code{continue}.
5187 @end table
5188
5189 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5190 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5191 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5192 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5193
5194 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5195 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5196 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5197 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5198 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5199 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5200
5201 @table @code
5202 @kindex step
5203 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5204 @item step
5205 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5206 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5207 abbreviated @code{s}.
5208
5209 @quotation
5210 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5211 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5212 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5213 @c distinction here.
5214 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5215 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5216 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5217 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5218 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5219 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5220 below.
5221 @end quotation
5222
5223 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5224 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5225 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5226 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5227 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5228 called within the line.
5229
5230 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5231 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5232 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5233 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5234 was any debugging information about the routine.
5235
5236 @item step @var{count}
5237 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5238 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5239 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5240
5241 @kindex next
5242 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5243 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5244 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5245 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5246 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5247 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5248 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5249 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5250
5251 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5252
5253
5254 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5255 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5256 @c
5257 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5258 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5259 @c function are executed without stopping.
5260
5261 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5262 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5263 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5264
5265 @kindex set step-mode
5266 @item set step-mode
5267 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5268 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5269 @itemx set step-mode on
5270 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5271 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5272 information rather than stepping over it.
5273
5274 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5275 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5276 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5277
5278 @item set step-mode off
5279 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5280 debug information. This is the default.
5281
5282 @item show step-mode
5283 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5284 source line debug information.
5285
5286 @kindex finish
5287 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5288 @item finish
5289 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5290 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5291 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5292
5293 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5294 ,Returning from a Function}).
5295
5296 @kindex until
5297 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5298 @cindex run until specified location
5299 @item until
5300 @itemx u
5301 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5302 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5303 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5304 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5305 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5306 than the address of the jump.
5307
5308 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5309 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5310 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5311 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5312 through the next iteration.
5313
5314 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5315 stack frame.
5316
5317 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5318 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5319 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5320 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5321 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5322
5323 @smallexample
5324 (@value{GDBP}) f
5325 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5326 206 expand_input();
5327 (@value{GDBP}) until
5328 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5329 @end smallexample
5330
5331 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5332 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5333 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5334 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5335 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5336 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5337 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5338
5339 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5340 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5341 argument.
5342
5343 @item until @var{location}
5344 @itemx u @var{location}
5345 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5346 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5347 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5348 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5349 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5350 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5351 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5352 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5353 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5354 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5355 invocations have returned.
5356
5357 @smallexample
5358 94 int factorial (int value)
5359 95 @{
5360 96 if (value > 1) @{
5361 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5362 98 @}
5363 99 return (value);
5364 100 @}
5365 @end smallexample
5366
5367
5368 @kindex advance @var{location}
5369 @item advance @var{location}
5370 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5371 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5372 @ref{Specify Location}.
5373 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5374 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5375 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5376 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5377
5378
5379 @kindex stepi
5380 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5381 @item stepi
5382 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5383 @itemx si
5384 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5385
5386 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5387 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5388 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5389 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5390
5391 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5392
5393 @need 750
5394 @kindex nexti
5395 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5396 @item nexti
5397 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5398 @itemx ni
5399 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5400 proceed until the function returns.
5401
5402 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5403
5404 @end table
5405
5406 @anchor{range stepping}
5407 @cindex range stepping
5408 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5409 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5410 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5411 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5412 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5413 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5414 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5415 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5416 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5417 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5418 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5419 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5420 if necessary:
5421
5422 @table @code
5423 @kindex set range-stepping
5424 @kindex show range-stepping
5425 @item set range-stepping
5426 @itemx show range-stepping
5427 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5428
5429 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5430 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5431 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5432 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5433 default is @code{on}.
5434
5435 @end table
5436
5437 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5438 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5439 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5440
5441 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5442 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5443 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5444
5445 For example, consider the following C function:
5446
5447 @smallexample
5448 101 int func()
5449 102 @{
5450 103 foo(boring());
5451 104 bar(boring());
5452 105 @}
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455 @noindent
5456 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5457 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5458 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5459 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5460
5461 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5462 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5463 is called from many places.
5464
5465 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5466 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5467 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5468 @code{foo}.
5469
5470 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5471 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5472
5473 @table @code
5474 @kindex skip function
5475 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5476 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5477 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5478 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5479 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5480
5481 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5482 will be skipped.
5483
5484 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5485 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5486
5487 @kindex skip file
5488 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5489 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5490 will be skipped over when stepping.
5491
5492 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5493 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5494 @end table
5495
5496 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5497 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5498
5499 @table @code
5500 @kindex info skip
5501 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5502 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5503 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5504 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5505
5506 @table @emph
5507 @item Identifier
5508 A number identifying this skip.
5509 @item Type
5510 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5511 @item Enabled or Disabled
5512 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5513 @item Address
5514 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5515 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5516 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5517 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5518 address here.
5519 @item What
5520 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5521 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5522 where it is defined.
5523 @end table
5524
5525 @kindex skip delete
5526 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5527 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5528 skips.
5529
5530 @kindex skip enable
5531 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5532 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5533 skips.
5534
5535 @kindex skip disable
5536 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5537 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5538 skips.
5539
5540 @end table
5541
5542 @node Signals
5543 @section Signals
5544 @cindex signals
5545
5546 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5547 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5548 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5549 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5550 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5551 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5552 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5553 requested an alarm).
5554
5555 @cindex fatal signals
5556 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5557 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5558 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5559 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5560 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5561 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5562
5563 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5564 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5565 signal.
5566
5567 @cindex handling signals
5568 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5569 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5570 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5571 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5572 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5573
5574 @table @code
5575 @kindex info signals
5576 @kindex info handle
5577 @item info signals
5578 @itemx info handle
5579 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5580 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5581 the defined types of signals.
5582
5583 @item info signals @var{sig}
5584 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5585
5586 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5587
5588 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5589 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5590 for details about this command.
5591
5592 @kindex handle
5593 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5594 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5595 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5596 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5597 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5598 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5599 say what change to make.
5600 @end table
5601
5602 @c @group
5603 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5604 Their full names are:
5605
5606 @table @code
5607 @item nostop
5608 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5609 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5610
5611 @item stop
5612 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5613 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5614
5615 @item print
5616 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5617
5618 @item noprint
5619 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5620 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5621
5622 @item pass
5623 @itemx noignore
5624 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5625 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5626 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5627
5628 @item nopass
5629 @itemx ignore
5630 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5631 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5632 @end table
5633 @c @end group
5634
5635 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5636 program until you
5637 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5638 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5639 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5640 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5641 program sees that signal when you continue.
5642
5643 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5644 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5645 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5646 erroneous signals.
5647
5648 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5649 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5650 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5651 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5652 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5653 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5654 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5655 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5656 Program a Signal}.
5657
5658 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5659 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5660
5661 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5662 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5663 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5664 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5665 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5666 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5667 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5668 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5669 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5670 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5671 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5672 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5673 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5674
5675 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5676
5677 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5678 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5679 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5680 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5681
5682 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5683 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5684 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5685 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5686
5687 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5688 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5689
5690 @smallexample
5691 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5692 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5693 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5694 (@value{GDBP}) c
5695 Continuing.
5696
5697 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5698 main () sigusr1.c:28
5699 28 p = 0;
5700 (@value{GDBP}) si
5701 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5702 9 @{
5703 @end smallexample
5704
5705 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5706 program to receive the signal first:
5707
5708 @smallexample
5709 (@value{GDBP}) n
5710 28 p = 0;
5711 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5712 (@value{GDBP}) si
5713 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5714 9 @{
5715 (@value{GDBP})
5716 @end smallexample
5717
5718 @cindex extra signal information
5719 @anchor{extra signal information}
5720
5721 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5722 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5723 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5724 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5725 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5726 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5727 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5728 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5729 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5730 system header.
5731
5732 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5733 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5734
5735 @smallexample
5736 @group
5737 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5738 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5739 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5740 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5741 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5742 type = struct @{
5743 int si_signo;
5744 int si_errno;
5745 int si_code;
5746 union @{
5747 int _pad[28];
5748 struct @{...@} _kill;
5749 struct @{...@} _timer;
5750 struct @{...@} _rt;
5751 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5752 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5753 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5754 @} _sifields;
5755 @}
5756 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5757 type = struct @{
5758 void *si_addr;
5759 @}
5760 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5761 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5762 @end group
5763 @end smallexample
5764
5765 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5766
5767 @node Thread Stops
5768 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5769
5770 @cindex stopped threads
5771 @cindex threads, stopped
5772
5773 @cindex continuing threads
5774 @cindex threads, continuing
5775
5776 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5777 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5778 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5779 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5780 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5781 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5782 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5783 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5784 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5785
5786 @menu
5787 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5788 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5789 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5790 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5791 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5792 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5793 @end menu
5794
5795 @node All-Stop Mode
5796 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5797
5798 @cindex all-stop mode
5799
5800 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5801 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5802 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5803 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5804 underfoot.
5805
5806 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5807 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5808 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5809
5810 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5811 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5812 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5813 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5814 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5815 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5816 stops.
5817
5818 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5819 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5820 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5821 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5822
5823 @cindex automatic thread selection
5824 @cindex switching threads automatically
5825 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5826 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5827 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5828 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5829 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5830 thread.
5831
5832 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5833 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5834
5835 @table @code
5836 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5837 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5838 @cindex lock scheduler
5839 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
5840 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5841 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
5842 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
5843 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
5844 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
5845 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
5846 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5847 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
5848 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
5849 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
5850 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
5851 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
5852 @code{on} in replay mode.
5853
5854 @item show scheduler-locking
5855 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5856 @end table
5857
5858 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5859 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5860 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5861 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5862 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5863 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5864 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5865 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5866 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5867 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5868 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5869 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5870 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5871 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5872
5873 @table @code
5874 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5875 @item set schedule-multiple
5876 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5877 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5878 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5879 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5880 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5881 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5882
5883 @item show schedule-multiple
5884 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5885 multiple processes.
5886 @end table
5887
5888 @node Non-Stop Mode
5889 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5890
5891 @cindex non-stop mode
5892
5893 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5894 @c with more details.
5895
5896 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5897 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5898 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5899 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5900 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5901 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5902
5903 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5904 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5905 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5906 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5907 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5908 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5909 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5910 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5911 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5912 independently and simultaneously.
5913
5914 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5915 or attach to your program:
5916
5917 @smallexample
5918 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5919 set pagination off
5920
5921 # Finally, turn it on!
5922 set non-stop on
5923 @end smallexample
5924
5925 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5926
5927 @table @code
5928 @kindex set non-stop
5929 @item set non-stop on
5930 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5931 @item set non-stop off
5932 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5933 @kindex show non-stop
5934 @item show non-stop
5935 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5936 @end table
5937
5938 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5939 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5940 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5941 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5942 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5943 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5944 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5945 default.
5946
5947 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5948 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5949 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5950
5951 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5952 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5953 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5954 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5955 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5956
5957 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5958 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5959 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5960 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5961 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5962
5963 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5964
5965 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5966 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5967 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5968 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5969 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5970 previously current thread.
5971
5972 @node Background Execution
5973 @subsection Background Execution
5974
5975 @cindex foreground execution
5976 @cindex background execution
5977 @cindex asynchronous execution
5978 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5979
5980 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5981 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5982 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5983 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5984 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5985 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5986
5987 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5988 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5989
5990 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5991 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5992 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5993 are:
5994
5995 @table @code
5996 @kindex run&
5997 @item run
5998 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5999
6000 @item attach
6001 @kindex attach&
6002 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6003
6004 @item step
6005 @kindex step&
6006 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6007
6008 @item stepi
6009 @kindex stepi&
6010 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6011
6012 @item next
6013 @kindex next&
6014 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6015
6016 @item nexti
6017 @kindex nexti&
6018 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6019
6020 @item continue
6021 @kindex continue&
6022 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6023
6024 @item finish
6025 @kindex finish&
6026 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6027
6028 @item until
6029 @kindex until&
6030 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6031
6032 @end table
6033
6034 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6035 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6036 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6037 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6038 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6039 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6040
6041 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6042 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6043
6044 @table @code
6045 @kindex interrupt
6046 @item interrupt
6047 @itemx interrupt -a
6048
6049 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6050 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6051 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6052 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6053 @end table
6054
6055 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6056 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6057
6058 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6059 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6060 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6061
6062 @table @code
6063 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6064 @cindex thread breakpoints
6065 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6066 @item break @var{location} thread @var{threadno}
6067 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6068 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6069 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6070 specify some source line.
6071
6072 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6073 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6074 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6075 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6076 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6077
6078 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6079 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6080 program.
6081
6082 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6083 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6084 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6085
6086 @smallexample
6087 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 @end table
6091
6092 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6093 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6094 thread list. For example:
6095
6096 @smallexample
6097 (@value{GDBP}) c
6098 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6099 @end smallexample
6100
6101 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6102 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6103 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6104 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6105 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6106 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6107 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6108 command.
6109
6110 @node Interrupted System Calls
6111 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6112
6113 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6114 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6115 @cindex premature return from system calls
6116 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6117 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6118 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6119 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6120 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6121 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6122 stop execution.
6123
6124 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6125 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6126 style anyways.
6127
6128 For example, do not write code like this:
6129
6130 @smallexample
6131 sleep (10);
6132 @end smallexample
6133
6134 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6135 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6136
6137 Instead, write this:
6138
6139 @smallexample
6140 int unslept = 10;
6141 while (unslept > 0)
6142 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6143 @end smallexample
6144
6145 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6146 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6147 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6148 @value{GDBN}.
6149
6150 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6151 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6152 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6153 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6154
6155 @node Observer Mode
6156 @subsection Observer Mode
6157
6158 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6159 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6160 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6161 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6162 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6163
6164 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6165 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6166 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6167 mode.
6168
6169 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6170 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6171 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6172 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6173 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6174
6175 @table @code
6176
6177 @kindex observer
6178 @item set observer on
6179 @itemx set observer off
6180 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6181 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6182 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6183 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6184
6185 @item show observer
6186 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6187
6188 @kindex may-write-registers
6189 @item set may-write-registers on
6190 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6191 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6192 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6193 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6194
6195 @item show may-write-registers
6196 Show the current permission to write registers.
6197
6198 @kindex may-write-memory
6199 @item set may-write-memory on
6200 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6201 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6202 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6203 defaults to @code{on}.
6204
6205 @item show may-write-memory
6206 Show the current permission to write memory.
6207
6208 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6209 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6210 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6211 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6212 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6213 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6214
6215 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6216 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6217
6218 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6219 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6220 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6221 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6222 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6223 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6224 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6225
6226 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6227 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6228
6229 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6230 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6231 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6232 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6233 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6234 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6235 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6236
6237 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6238 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6239
6240 @kindex may-interrupt
6241 @item set may-interrupt on
6242 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6243 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6244 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6245 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6246 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6247
6248 @item show may-interrupt
6249 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6250
6251 @end table
6252
6253 @node Reverse Execution
6254 @chapter Running programs backward
6255 @cindex reverse execution
6256 @cindex running programs backward
6257
6258 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6259 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6260 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6261 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6262
6263 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6264 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6265 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6266 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6267 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6268 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6269
6270 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6271 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6272 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6273 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6274 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6275 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6276 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6277 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6278 prior values@footnote{
6279 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6280 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6281 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6282
6283 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6284 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6285 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6286 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6287 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6288 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6289 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6290 }.
6291
6292 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6293 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6294
6295 @table @code
6296 @kindex reverse-continue
6297 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6298 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6299 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6300 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6301 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6302 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6303 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6304
6305 @kindex reverse-step
6306 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6307 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6308 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6309 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6310
6311 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6312 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6313 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6314 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6315 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6316 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6317
6318 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6319 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6320
6321 @kindex reverse-stepi
6322 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6323 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6324 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6325 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6326 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6327 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6328 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6329
6330 @kindex reverse-next
6331 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6332 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6333 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6334 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6335 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6336 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6337 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6338 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6339 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6340 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6341
6342 @kindex reverse-nexti
6343 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6344 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6345 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6346 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6347 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6348 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6349 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6350 frame) is reached.
6351
6352 @kindex reverse-finish
6353 @item reverse-finish
6354 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6355 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6356 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6357 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6358
6359 @kindex set exec-direction
6360 @item set exec-direction
6361 Set the direction of target execution.
6362 @item set exec-direction reverse
6363 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6364 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6365 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6366 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6367 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6368 @item set exec-direction forward
6369 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6370 This is the default.
6371 @end table
6372
6373
6374 @node Process Record and Replay
6375 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6376 @cindex process record and replay
6377 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6378
6379 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6380 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6381 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6382
6383 @cindex replay mode
6384 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6385 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6386 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6387 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6388 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6389 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6390 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6391 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6392 execution log.
6393
6394 @cindex record mode
6395 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6396 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6397 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6398 for future replay.
6399
6400 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6401 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6402 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6403 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6404 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6405 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6406
6407 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6408 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6409 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6410 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6411
6412 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6413 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6414
6415 @table @code
6416 @kindex target record
6417 @kindex target record-full
6418 @kindex target record-btrace
6419 @kindex record
6420 @kindex record full
6421 @kindex record btrace
6422 @kindex record btrace bts
6423 @kindex record btrace pt
6424 @kindex record bts
6425 @kindex record pt
6426 @kindex rec
6427 @kindex rec full
6428 @kindex rec btrace
6429 @kindex rec btrace bts
6430 @kindex rec btrace pt
6431 @kindex rec bts
6432 @kindex rec pt
6433 @item record @var{method}
6434 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6435 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6436 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6437 recording methods are available:
6438
6439 @table @code
6440 @item full
6441 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6442 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6443 execution.
6444
6445 @item btrace @var{format}
6446 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6447 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6448 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6449 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6450 execution.
6451
6452 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6453 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6454 formats are available:
6455
6456 @table @code
6457 @item bts
6458 @cindex branch trace store
6459 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6460 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6461 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6462
6463 @item pt
6464 @cindex Intel(R) Processor Trace
6465 Use the @dfn{Intel(R) Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6466 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6467 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6468
6469 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6470 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6471 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6472
6473 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6474 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6475 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6476 buffer-size with care.
6477 @end table
6478
6479 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6480 @end table
6481
6482 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6483 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6484 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6485 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6486
6487 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6488 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6489 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6490 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6491 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6492
6493 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6494 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6495 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6496 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6497 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6498 does not support these two modes.
6499
6500 @kindex record stop
6501 @kindex rec s
6502 @item record stop
6503 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6504 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6505 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6506
6507 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6508 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6509 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6510 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6511 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6512
6513 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6514 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6515 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6516 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6517 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6518
6519 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6520 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6521
6522 @kindex record goto
6523 @item record goto
6524 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6525 ways to specify the location to go to:
6526
6527 @table @code
6528 @item record goto begin
6529 @itemx record goto start
6530 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6531
6532 @item record goto end
6533 Go to the end of the execution log.
6534
6535 @item record goto @var{n}
6536 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6537 @end table
6538
6539 @kindex record save
6540 @item record save @var{filename}
6541 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6542 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6543 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6544
6545 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6546
6547 @kindex record restore
6548 @item record restore @var{filename}
6549 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6550 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6551
6552 @kindex set record full
6553 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6554 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6555 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6556 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6557
6558 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6559 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6560 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6561 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6562 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6563 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6564 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6565 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6566
6567 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6568 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6569 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6570
6571 @kindex show record full
6572 @item show record full insn-number-max
6573 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6574 recording method.
6575
6576 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6577 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6578 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6579 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6580 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6581 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6582 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6583 oldest one to be deleted.
6584
6585 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6586 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6587
6588 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6589 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6590
6591 @item set record full memory-query
6592 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6593 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6594 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6595 case.
6596
6597 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6598 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6599 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6600 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6601 results.
6602
6603 @item show record full memory-query
6604 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6605
6606 @kindex set record btrace
6607 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6608 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6609 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6610 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6611 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6612 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6613 You can use the following command for that:
6614
6615 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6616 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6617 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6618 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6619 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6620 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6621 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6622 position.
6623
6624 @kindex show record btrace
6625 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6626 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6627
6628 @kindex set record btrace bts
6629 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6630 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6631 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6632 format. Default is 64KB.
6633
6634 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6635 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6636 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6637 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6638 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6639 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6640 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6641
6642 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6643 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6644
6645 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6646 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6647
6648 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6649 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6650 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6651
6652 @kindex set record btrace pt
6653 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6654 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6655 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel(R)
6656 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6657
6658 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6659 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6660 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel(R) Processor Trace
6661 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6662 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6663 actual buffer size for each thread.
6664
6665 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6666 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6667
6668 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6669 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6670
6671 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6672 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6673 tracing in Intel(R) Processor Trace format.
6674
6675 @kindex info record
6676 @item info record
6677 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6678 method:
6679
6680 @table @code
6681 @item full
6682 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6683 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6684
6685 @itemize @bullet
6686 @item
6687 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6688 @item
6689 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6690 @item
6691 Highest recorded instruction number.
6692 @item
6693 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6694 @item
6695 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6696 @item
6697 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6698 @end itemize
6699
6700 @item btrace
6701 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6702
6703 @itemize @bullet
6704 @item
6705 Recording format.
6706 @item
6707 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6708 @item
6709 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6710 instructions.
6711 @item
6712 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6713 @end itemize
6714
6715 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6716 @itemize @bullet
6717 @item
6718 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6719 @end itemize
6720
6721 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6722 @itemize @bullet
6723 @item
6724 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6725 @end itemize
6726 @end table
6727
6728 @kindex record delete
6729 @kindex rec del
6730 @item record delete
6731 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6732 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6733 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6734 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6735
6736 @kindex record instruction-history
6737 @kindex rec instruction-history
6738 @item record instruction-history
6739 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6740 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6741 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6742 are printed in execution order.
6743
6744 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6745 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6746 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6747
6748 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6749 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6750 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6751 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6752 @code{/p} modifier.
6753
6754 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6755 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6756 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6757
6758 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6759 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6760
6761 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6762 disassemble:
6763
6764 @table @code
6765 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6766 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6767 @var{insn}.
6768
6769 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6770 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6771 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6772 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6773 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6774 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6775
6776 @item record instruction-history
6777 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6778
6779 @item record instruction-history -
6780 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6781
6782 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6783 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6784 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6785 number @var{end} is included.
6786 @end table
6787
6788 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6789
6790 @kindex set record
6791 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6792 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6793 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6794 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6795 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6796
6797 @kindex show record
6798 @item show record instruction-history-size
6799 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6800 instruction-history} command.
6801
6802 @kindex record function-call-history
6803 @kindex rec function-call-history
6804 @item record function-call-history
6805 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6806 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6807 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6808 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6809 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6810 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6811 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6812 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6813 given together.
6814
6815 @smallexample
6816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6817 1 void foo (void)
6818 2 @{
6819 3 @}
6820 4
6821 5 void bar (void)
6822 6 @{
6823 7 ...
6824 8 foo ();
6825 9 ...
6826 10 @}
6827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6828 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6829 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6830 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6831 @end smallexample
6832
6833 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6834 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6835 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6836 to print:
6837
6838 @table @code
6839 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6840 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6841
6842 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6843 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6844 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6845 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6846 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6847
6848 @item record function-call-history
6849 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6850
6851 @item record function-call-history -
6852 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6853
6854 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6855 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6856 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6857 @end table
6858
6859 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6860
6861 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6862 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6863 Define how many lines to print in the
6864 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6865 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6866
6867 @item show record function-call-history-size
6868 Show how many lines to print in the
6869 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6870 @end table
6871
6872
6873 @node Stack
6874 @chapter Examining the Stack
6875
6876 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6877 stopped and how it got there.
6878
6879 @cindex call stack
6880 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6881 is generated.
6882 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6883 the arguments of the call,
6884 and the local variables of the function being called.
6885 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6886 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6887 stack}.
6888
6889 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6890 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6891
6892 @cindex selected frame
6893 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6894 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6895 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6896 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6897 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6898 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6899
6900 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6901 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6902 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6903
6904 @menu
6905 * Frames:: Stack frames
6906 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6907 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6908 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6909 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6910
6911 @end menu
6912
6913 @node Frames
6914 @section Stack Frames
6915
6916 @cindex frame, definition
6917 @cindex stack frame
6918 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6919 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6920 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6921 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6922 which the function is executing.
6923
6924 @cindex initial frame
6925 @cindex outermost frame
6926 @cindex innermost frame
6927 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6928 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6929 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6930 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6931 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6932 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6933 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6934 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6935
6936 @cindex frame pointer
6937 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6938 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6939 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6940 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6941 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6942 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6943
6944 @cindex frame number
6945 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6946 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6947 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6948 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6949 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6950
6951 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6952 @c underflow problems.
6953 @cindex frameless execution
6954 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6955 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6956 @smallexample
6957 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6958 @end smallexample
6959 generates functions without a frame.)
6960 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6961 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6962 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6963 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6964 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6965 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6966 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6967
6968 @node Backtrace
6969 @section Backtraces
6970
6971 @cindex traceback
6972 @cindex call stack traces
6973 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6974 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6975 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6976 stack.
6977
6978 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6979 @table @code
6980 @kindex backtrace
6981 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6982 @item backtrace
6983 @itemx bt
6984 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6985 frames in the stack.
6986
6987 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6988 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6989
6990 @item backtrace @var{n}
6991 @itemx bt @var{n}
6992 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6993
6994 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6995 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6996 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6997
6998 @item backtrace full
6999 @itemx bt full
7000 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7001 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7002 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7003 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7004
7005 @item backtrace no-filters
7006 @itemx bt no-filters
7007 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7008 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7009 @itemx bt no-filters full
7010 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7011 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7012 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7013 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7014 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7015 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7016 support.
7017 @end table
7018
7019 @kindex where
7020 @kindex info stack
7021 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7022 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7023
7024 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7025 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7026 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7027 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7028 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7029 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7030 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7031 multi-threaded program.
7032
7033 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7034 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7035 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7036 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7037 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7038 line number.
7039
7040 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7041 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7042
7043 @smallexample
7044 @group
7045 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7046 at builtin.c:993
7047 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7048 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7049 at macro.c:71
7050 (More stack frames follow...)
7051 @end group
7052 @end smallexample
7053
7054 @noindent
7055 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7056 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7057 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7058
7059 @noindent
7060 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7061 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7062 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7063 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7064 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7065
7066 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7067 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7068 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7069 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7070 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7071 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7072 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7073 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7074 such a backtrace might look like:
7075
7076 @smallexample
7077 @group
7078 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7079 at builtin.c:993
7080 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7081 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7082 at macro.c:71
7083 (More stack frames follow...)
7084 @end group
7085 @end smallexample
7086
7087 @noindent
7088 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7089 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7090
7091 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7092 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7093 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7094
7095 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7096 @cindex program entry point
7097 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7098 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7099 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7100 @code{main}@footnote{
7101 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7102 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7103 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7104 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7105 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7106 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7107
7108 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7109 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7110
7111 @table @code
7112 @item set backtrace past-main
7113 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7114 @kindex set backtrace
7115 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7116
7117 @item set backtrace past-main off
7118 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7119 default.
7120
7121 @item show backtrace past-main
7122 @kindex show backtrace
7123 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7124
7125 @item set backtrace past-entry
7126 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7127 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7128 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7129 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7130
7131 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7132 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7133 application. This is the default.
7134
7135 @item show backtrace past-entry
7136 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7137
7138 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7139 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7140 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7141 @cindex backtrace limit
7142 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7143 or zero means unlimited levels.
7144
7145 @item show backtrace limit
7146 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7147 @end table
7148
7149 You can control how file names are displayed.
7150
7151 @table @code
7152 @item set filename-display
7153 @itemx set filename-display relative
7154 @cindex filename-display
7155 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7156
7157 @item set filename-display basename
7158 Display only basename of a filename.
7159
7160 @item set filename-display absolute
7161 Display an absolute filename.
7162
7163 @item show filename-display
7164 Show the current way to display filenames.
7165 @end table
7166
7167 @node Selection
7168 @section Selecting a Frame
7169
7170 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7171 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7172 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7173 of the stack frame just selected.
7174
7175 @table @code
7176 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7177 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7178 @item frame @var{n}
7179 @itemx f @var{n}
7180 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7181 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7182 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7183 @code{main}.
7184
7185 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7186 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7187 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7188 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7189 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7190 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7191 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7192 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7193
7194 @kindex up
7195 @item up @var{n}
7196 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7197 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7198 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7199
7200 @kindex down
7201 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7202 @item down @var{n}
7203 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7204 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7205 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7206 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7207 @end table
7208
7209 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7210 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7211 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7212 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7213
7214 @need 1000
7215 For example:
7216
7217 @smallexample
7218 @group
7219 (@value{GDBP}) up
7220 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7221 at env.c:10
7222 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7223 @end group
7224 @end smallexample
7225
7226 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7227 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7228 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7229 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7230 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7231 for details.
7232
7233 @table @code
7234 @kindex select-frame
7235 @item select-frame
7236 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7237 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7238 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7239 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7240
7241 @kindex down-silently
7242 @kindex up-silently
7243 @item up-silently @var{n}
7244 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7245 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7246 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7247 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7248 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7249 distracting.
7250 @end table
7251
7252 @node Frame Info
7253 @section Information About a Frame
7254
7255 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7256 stack frame.
7257
7258 @table @code
7259 @item frame
7260 @itemx f
7261 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7262 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7263 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7264 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7265 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7266
7267 @kindex info frame
7268 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7269 @item info frame
7270 @itemx info f
7271 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7272 including:
7273
7274 @itemize @bullet
7275 @item
7276 the address of the frame
7277 @item
7278 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7279 @item
7280 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7281 @item
7282 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7283 @item
7284 the address of the frame's arguments
7285 @item
7286 the address of the frame's local variables
7287 @item
7288 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7289 @item
7290 which registers were saved in the frame
7291 @end itemize
7292
7293 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7294 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7295 the usual conventions.
7296
7297 @item info frame @var{addr}
7298 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7299 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7300 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7301 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7302 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7303 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7304
7305 @kindex info args
7306 @item info args
7307 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7308
7309 @item info locals
7310 @kindex info locals
7311 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7312 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7313 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7314
7315 @end table
7316
7317 @node Frame Filter Management
7318 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7319 @cindex managing frame filters
7320
7321 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7322 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7323
7324 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7325 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7326
7327 @table @code
7328 @kindex info frame-filter
7329 @item info frame-filter
7330 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7331 their name, priority and enabled status.
7332
7333 @kindex disable frame-filter
7334 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7335 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7336 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7337 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7338 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7339 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7340 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7341 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7342 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7343 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7344 may be enabled again later.
7345
7346 @kindex enable frame-filter
7347 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7348 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7349 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7350 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7351 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7352 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7353 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7354 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7355 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7356
7357 Example:
7358
7359 @smallexample
7360 (gdb) info frame-filter
7361
7362 global frame-filters:
7363 Priority Enabled Name
7364 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7365 100 Yes Reverse
7366
7367 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7368 Priority Enabled Name
7369 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7370
7371 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7372 Priority Enabled Name
7373 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7374
7375 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7376 (gdb) info frame-filter
7377
7378 global frame-filters:
7379 Priority Enabled Name
7380 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7381 100 Yes Reverse
7382
7383 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7384 Priority Enabled Name
7385 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7386
7387 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7388 Priority Enabled Name
7389 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7390
7391 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7392 (gdb) info frame-filter
7393
7394 global frame-filters:
7395 Priority Enabled Name
7396 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7397 100 Yes Reverse
7398
7399 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7400 Priority Enabled Name
7401 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7402
7403 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7404 Priority Enabled Name
7405 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7406 @end smallexample
7407
7408 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7409 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7410 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7411 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7412 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7413 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7414 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7415
7416 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7417 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7418 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7419 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7420 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7421 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7422 dictionary resides.
7423
7424 Example:
7425
7426 @smallexample
7427 (gdb) info frame-filter
7428
7429 global frame-filters:
7430 Priority Enabled Name
7431 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7432 100 Yes Reverse
7433
7434 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7435 Priority Enabled Name
7436 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7437
7438 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7439 Priority Enabled Name
7440 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7441
7442 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7443 (gdb) info frame-filter
7444
7445 global frame-filters:
7446 Priority Enabled Name
7447 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7448 50 Yes Reverse
7449
7450 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7451 Priority Enabled Name
7452 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7453
7454 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7455 Priority Enabled Name
7456 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7457 @end smallexample
7458 @end table
7459
7460 @node Source
7461 @chapter Examining Source Files
7462
7463 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7464 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7465 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7466 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7467 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7468 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7469 source files by explicit command.
7470
7471 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7472 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7473 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7474
7475 @menu
7476 * List:: Printing source lines
7477 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7478 * Edit:: Editing source files
7479 * Search:: Searching source files
7480 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7481 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7482 @end menu
7483
7484 @node List
7485 @section Printing Source Lines
7486
7487 @kindex list
7488 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7489 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7490 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7491 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7492 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7493
7494 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7495
7496 @table @code
7497 @item list @var{linenum}
7498 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7499 current source file.
7500
7501 @item list @var{function}
7502 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7503 @var{function}.
7504
7505 @item list
7506 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7507 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7508 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7509 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7510 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7511
7512 @item list -
7513 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7514 @end table
7515
7516 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7517 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7518 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7519
7520 @table @code
7521 @kindex set listsize
7522 @item set listsize @var{count}
7523 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7524 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7525 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7526 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7527
7528 @kindex show listsize
7529 @item show listsize
7530 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7531 @end table
7532
7533 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7534 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7535 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7536 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7537 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7538
7539 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7540 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7541 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7542 to specify some source line.
7543
7544 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7545
7546 @table @code
7547 @item list @var{location}
7548 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7549
7550 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7551 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7552 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7553 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7554 the same source file as the first location.
7555
7556 @item list ,@var{last}
7557 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7558
7559 @item list @var{first},
7560 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7561
7562 @item list +
7563 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7564
7565 @item list -
7566 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7567
7568 @item list
7569 As described in the preceding table.
7570 @end table
7571
7572 @node Specify Location
7573 @section Specifying a Location
7574 @cindex specifying location
7575 @cindex location
7576 @cindex source location
7577
7578 @menu
7579 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7580 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7581 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7582 @end menu
7583
7584 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7585 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7586 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7587 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7588 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7589
7590 @node Linespec Locations
7591 @subsection Linespec Locations
7592 @cindex linespec locations
7593
7594 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7595 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7596 specifying a linespec:
7597
7598 @table @code
7599 @item @var{linenum}
7600 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7601
7602 @item -@var{offset}
7603 @itemx +@var{offset}
7604 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7605 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7606 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7607 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7608 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7609 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7610 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7611 linespec.
7612
7613 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7614 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7615 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7616 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7617 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7618 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7619 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7620
7621 @item @var{function}
7622 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7623 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7624
7625 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7626 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7627
7628 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7629 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7630 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7631 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7632 functions in different source files.
7633
7634 @item @var{label}
7635 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7636 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7637 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7638 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7639
7640 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7641 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7642 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7643 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7644 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7645 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7646
7647 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7648 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7649 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7650 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7651 each one of those probes.
7652 @end table
7653
7654 @node Explicit Locations
7655 @subsection Explicit Locations
7656 @cindex explicit locations
7657
7658 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7659 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7660
7661 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7662 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7663 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7664 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7665 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7666
7667 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7668 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7669 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7670 the symbol table to know.
7671
7672 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7673 following table:
7674
7675 @table @code
7676 @item -source @var{filename}
7677 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7678 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7679 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7680 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7681 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7682
7683 @item -function @var{function}
7684 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7685 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7686 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7687 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7688
7689 @item -label @var{label}
7690 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7691 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7692 selected stack frame.
7693
7694 @item -line @var{number}
7695 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7696 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7697 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7698 relative to the current line.
7699 @end table
7700
7701 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7702 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7703
7704 @node Address Locations
7705 @subsection Address Locations
7706 @cindex address locations
7707
7708 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7709 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7710
7711 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7712 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7713 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7714 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7715 source files.
7716
7717 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7718 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7719 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7720 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7721 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7722 of @var{address}:
7723
7724 @table @code
7725 @item @var{expression}
7726 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7727
7728 @item @var{funcaddr}
7729 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7730 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7731 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7732 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7733 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7734 (although the Pascal form also works).
7735
7736 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7737 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7738
7739 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7740 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7741 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7742 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7743 functions with identical names in different source files.
7744 @end table
7745
7746 @node Edit
7747 @section Editing Source Files
7748 @cindex editing source files
7749
7750 @kindex edit
7751 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7752 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7753 The editing program of your choice
7754 is invoked with the current line set to
7755 the active line in the program.
7756 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7757 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7758
7759 @table @code
7760 @item edit @var{location}
7761 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7762 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7763 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7764 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7765 command most commonly used:
7766
7767 @table @code
7768 @item edit @var{number}
7769 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7770
7771 @item edit @var{function}
7772 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7773 @end table
7774
7775 @end table
7776
7777 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7778 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7779 @footnote{
7780 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7781 following command-line syntax:
7782 @smallexample
7783 ex +@var{number} file
7784 @end smallexample
7785 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7786 the file where to start editing.}.
7787 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7788 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7789 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7790 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7791 @smallexample
7792 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7793 export EDITOR
7794 gdb @dots{}
7795 @end smallexample
7796 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7797 @smallexample
7798 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7799 gdb @dots{}
7800 @end smallexample
7801
7802 @node Search
7803 @section Searching Source Files
7804 @cindex searching source files
7805
7806 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7807 regular expression.
7808
7809 @table @code
7810 @kindex search
7811 @kindex forward-search
7812 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7813 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7814 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7815 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7816 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7817 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7818 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7819 @code{fo}.
7820
7821 @kindex reverse-search
7822 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7823 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7824 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7825 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7826 this command as @code{rev}.
7827 @end table
7828
7829 @node Source Path
7830 @section Specifying Source Directories
7831
7832 @cindex source path
7833 @cindex directories for source files
7834 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7835 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7836 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7837 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7838 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7839 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7840 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7841
7842 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7843 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7844 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7845 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7846 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7847 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7848 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7849 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7850 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7851 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7852 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7853
7854 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7855 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7856 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7857 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7858 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7859 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7860
7861 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7862 source files.
7863
7864 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7865 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7866 each line is in the file.
7867
7868 @kindex directory
7869 @kindex dir
7870 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7871 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7872 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7873
7874 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7875 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7876
7877 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7878 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7879 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7880 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7881 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7882 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7883 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7884 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7885 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7886 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7887 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7888 name to look up the sources.
7889
7890 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7891 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7892 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7893 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7894 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7895 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7896 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7897 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7898
7899 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7900 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7901 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7902 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7903 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7904 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7905 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7906
7907 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7908 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7909 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7910 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7911 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7912 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7913 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7914 command.
7915
7916 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7917 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7918 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7919 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7920 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7921 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7922 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7923
7924 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7925 @cindex default source path substitution
7926 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7927 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7928 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7929 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7930 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7931 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7932 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7933 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7934 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7935 together.
7936
7937 @table @code
7938 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7939 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7940 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7941 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7942 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7943 part of absolute file names) or
7944 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7945 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7946
7947 @kindex cdir
7948 @kindex cwd
7949 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7950 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7951 @cindex compilation directory
7952 @cindex current directory
7953 @cindex working directory
7954 @cindex directory, current
7955 @cindex directory, compilation
7956 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7957 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7958 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7959 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7960 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7961 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7962
7963 @item directory
7964 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7965
7966 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7967 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7968
7969 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7970 @kindex set directories
7971 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7972 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7973
7974 @item show directories
7975 @kindex show directories
7976 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7977
7978 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7979 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7980 @kindex set substitute-path
7981 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7982 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7983 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7984
7985 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7986 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7987
7988 @smallexample
7989 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
7990 @end smallexample
7991
7992 @noindent
7993 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
7994 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7995 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7996
7997 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7998 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7999 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8000 the substitution.
8001
8002 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8003
8004 @smallexample
8005 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8006 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8007 @end smallexample
8008
8009 @noindent
8010 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8011 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8012 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8013 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8014
8015
8016 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8017 @kindex unset substitute-path
8018 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8019 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8020 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8021
8022 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8023
8024 @item show substitute-path [path]
8025 @kindex show substitute-path
8026 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8027 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8028
8029 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8030 rules.
8031
8032 @end table
8033
8034 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8035 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8036 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8037
8038 @enumerate
8039 @item
8040 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8041
8042 @item
8043 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8044 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8045 directories in one command.
8046 @end enumerate
8047
8048 @node Machine Code
8049 @section Source and Machine Code
8050 @cindex source line and its code address
8051
8052 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8053 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8054 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8055 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8056 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8057 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8058 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8059 well as hex.
8060
8061 @table @code
8062 @kindex info line
8063 @item info line @var{location}
8064 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8065 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8066 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8067 @end table
8068
8069 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8070 the object code for the first line of function
8071 @code{m4_changequote}:
8072
8073 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8074 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8075 @smallexample
8076 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8077 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8078 @end smallexample
8079
8080 @noindent
8081 @cindex code address and its source line
8082 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8083 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8084 @smallexample
8085 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8086 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8087 @end smallexample
8088
8089 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8090 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8091 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8092 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8093 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8094 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8095 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8096 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8097 Variables}).
8098
8099 @table @code
8100 @kindex disassemble
8101 @cindex assembly instructions
8102 @cindex instructions, assembly
8103 @cindex machine instructions
8104 @cindex listing machine instructions
8105 @item disassemble
8106 @itemx disassemble /m
8107 @itemx disassemble /s
8108 @itemx disassemble /r
8109 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8110 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8111 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8112 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8113 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8114 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8115 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8116 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8117 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8118 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8119
8120 @table @code
8121 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8122 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8123 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8124 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8125 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8126 @end table
8127
8128 @noindent
8129 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8130 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8131
8132 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8133 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8134
8135 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8136 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8137 @end table
8138
8139 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8140 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8141
8142 @smallexample
8143 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8144 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8145 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8146 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8147 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8148 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8149 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8150 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8151 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8152 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8153 End of assembler dump.
8154 @end smallexample
8155
8156 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8157 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8158 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8159
8160 @smallexample
8161 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8162 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8163 5 @{
8164 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8165 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8166 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8167 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8168 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8169
8170 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8171 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8172 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8173
8174 7 return 0;
8175 8 @}
8176 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8177 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8178 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8179
8180 End of assembler dump.
8181 @end smallexample
8182
8183 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8184 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8185 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8186 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8187 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8188 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8189 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8190 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8191 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8192
8193 @file{foo.h}:
8194
8195 @smallexample
8196 int
8197 foo (int a)
8198 @{
8199 if (a < 0)
8200 return a * 2;
8201 if (a == 0)
8202 return 1;
8203 return a + 10;
8204 @}
8205 @end smallexample
8206
8207 @file{foo.c}:
8208
8209 @smallexample
8210 #include "foo.h"
8211 volatile int x, y;
8212 int
8213 main ()
8214 @{
8215 x = foo (y);
8216 return 0;
8217 @}
8218 @end smallexample
8219
8220 @smallexample
8221 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8222 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8223 5 @{
8224
8225 6 x = foo (y);
8226 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8227 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8228
8229 7 return 0;
8230 8 @}
8231 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8232 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8233 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8234 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8235
8236 End of assembler dump.
8237 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8238 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8239 foo.c:
8240 5 @{
8241 6 x = foo (y);
8242 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8243
8244 foo.h:
8245 4 if (a < 0)
8246 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8247 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8248
8249 6 if (a == 0)
8250 7 return 1;
8251 8 return a + 10;
8252 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8253 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8254 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8255 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8256
8257 foo.c:
8258 6 x = foo (y);
8259 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8260
8261 7 return 0;
8262 8 @}
8263 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8264 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8265
8266 foo.h:
8267 5 return a * 2;
8268 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8269 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8270 End of assembler dump.
8271 @end smallexample
8272
8273 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8274
8275 @smallexample
8276 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8277 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8278 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8279 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8280 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8281 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8282 End of assembler dump.
8283 @end smallexample
8284
8285 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8286 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8287 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8288 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8289
8290 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8291 mnemonics or other syntax.
8292
8293 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8294 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8295 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8296 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8297 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8298
8299 @table @code
8300 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8301 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8302 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8303 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8304 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8305 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8306
8307 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8308 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8309 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8310 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8311
8312 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8313 @item show disassembly-flavor
8314 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8315 @end table
8316
8317 @table @code
8318 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8319 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8320 @item set disassemble-next-line
8321 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8322 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8323 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8324 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8325 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8326 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8327 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8328 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8329 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8330 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8331 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8332 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8333 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8334 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8335 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8336 instruction.
8337 @end table
8338
8339
8340 @node Data
8341 @chapter Examining Data
8342
8343 @cindex printing data
8344 @cindex examining data
8345 @kindex print
8346 @kindex inspect
8347 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8348 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8349 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8350 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8351 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8352 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8353
8354 @table @code
8355 @item print @var{expr}
8356 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8357 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8358 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8359 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8360 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8361 Formats}.
8362
8363 @item print
8364 @itemx print /@var{f}
8365 @cindex reprint the last value
8366 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8367 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8368 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8369 @end table
8370
8371 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8372 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8373 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8374
8375 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8376 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8377 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8378 Table}.
8379
8380 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8381 @kindex explore
8382 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8383 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8384 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8385 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8386 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8387 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8388 embedded in the higher level data types.
8389
8390 @table @code
8391 @item explore @var{arg}
8392 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8393 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8394 @end table
8395
8396 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8397 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8398 C program as
8399
8400 @smallexample
8401 struct SimpleStruct
8402 @{
8403 int i;
8404 double d;
8405 @};
8406
8407 struct ComplexStruct
8408 @{
8409 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8410 int arr[10];
8411 @};
8412 @end smallexample
8413
8414 @noindent
8415 followed by variable declarations as
8416
8417 @smallexample
8418 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8419 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8420 @end smallexample
8421
8422 @noindent
8423 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8424 @code{explore} command as follows.
8425
8426 @smallexample
8427 (gdb) explore cs
8428 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8429 the following fields:
8430
8431 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8432 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8433
8434 Enter the field number of choice:
8435 @end smallexample
8436
8437 @noindent
8438 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8439 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8440 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8441 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8442 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8443 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8444 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8445 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8446
8447 @smallexample
8448 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8449 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8450 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8451 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8452
8453 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8454 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8455
8456 Press enter to return to parent value:
8457 @end smallexample
8458
8459 @noindent
8460 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8461 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8462 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8463 to explore.
8464
8465 @smallexample
8466 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8467 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8468
8469 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8470
8471 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8472
8473 Press enter to return to parent value:
8474 @end smallexample
8475
8476 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8477 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8478 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8479 level data structure).
8480
8481 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8482 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8483 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8484 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8485 same example as above, your can explore the type
8486 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8487 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8488
8489 @smallexample
8490 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8491 @end smallexample
8492
8493 @noindent
8494 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8495 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8496 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8497 example.
8498
8499 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8500 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8501 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8502 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8503 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8504
8505 @table @code
8506 @item explore value @var{expr}
8507 @cindex explore value
8508 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8509 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8510 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8511 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8512 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8513
8514 @item explore type @var{arg}
8515 @cindex explore type
8516 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8517 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8518 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8519 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8520 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8521 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8522 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8523 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8524 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8525 @end table
8526
8527 @menu
8528 * Expressions:: Expressions
8529 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8530 * Variables:: Program variables
8531 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8532 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8533 * Memory:: Examining memory
8534 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8535 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8536 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8537 * Value History:: Value history
8538 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8539 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8540 * Registers:: Registers
8541 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8542 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8543 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8544 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8545 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8546 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8547 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8548 character set than GDB does
8549 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8550 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8551 @end menu
8552
8553 @node Expressions
8554 @section Expressions
8555
8556 @cindex expressions
8557 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8558 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8559 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8560 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8561 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8562 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8563 @ref{Compilation}.
8564
8565 @cindex arrays in expressions
8566 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8567 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8568 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8569 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8570 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8571 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8572
8573 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8574 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8575 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8576 languages.
8577
8578 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8579 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8580
8581 @cindex casts, in expressions
8582 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8583 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8584 at that address in memory.
8585 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8586
8587 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8588 to programming languages:
8589
8590 @table @code
8591 @item @@
8592 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8593 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8594
8595 @item ::
8596 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8597 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8598
8599 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8600 @cindex type casting memory
8601 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8602 @cindex casts, to view memory
8603 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8604 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8605 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8606 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8607 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8608 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8609 @end table
8610
8611 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8612 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8613 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8614
8615 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8616 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8617 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8618 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8619 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8620 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8621 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8622
8623 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8624 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8625 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8626 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8627 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8628 as well.
8629
8630 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8631 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8632 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8633 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8634 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8635 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8636 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8637 choices.
8638
8639 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8640 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8641 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8642
8643 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8644 @smallexample
8645 @group
8646 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8647 [0] cancel
8648 [1] all
8649 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8650 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8651 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8652 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8653 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8654 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8655 > 2 4 6
8656 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8657 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8658 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8659 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8660 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8661 breakpoints.
8662 (@value{GDBP})
8663 @end group
8664 @end smallexample
8665
8666 @table @code
8667 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8668 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8669 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8670
8671 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8672 is ambiguous.
8673
8674 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8675 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8676 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8677 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8678 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8679 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8680 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8681 in the use of the menu.
8682
8683 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8684 when an ambiguity is detected.
8685
8686 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8687 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8688
8689 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8690 @item show multiple-symbols
8691 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8692 @end table
8693
8694 @node Variables
8695 @section Program Variables
8696
8697 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8698 in your program.
8699
8700 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8701 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8702
8703 @itemize @bullet
8704 @item
8705 global (or file-static)
8706 @end itemize
8707
8708 @noindent or
8709
8710 @itemize @bullet
8711 @item
8712 visible according to the scope rules of the
8713 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8714 @end itemize
8715
8716 @noindent This means that in the function
8717
8718 @smallexample
8719 foo (a)
8720 int a;
8721 @{
8722 bar (a);
8723 @{
8724 int b = test ();
8725 bar (b);
8726 @}
8727 @}
8728 @end smallexample
8729
8730 @noindent
8731 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8732 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8733 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8734 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8735
8736 @cindex variable name conflict
8737 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8738 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8739 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8740 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8741 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8742 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8743 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8744
8745 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8746 @ifnotinfo
8747 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8748 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8749 @end ifnotinfo
8750 @smallexample
8751 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8752 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8753 @end smallexample
8754
8755 @noindent
8756 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8757 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8758 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8759 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8760
8761 @smallexample
8762 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8763 @end smallexample
8764
8765 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8766 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8767 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8768 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8769 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8770
8771 @smallexample
8772 void
8773 foo (int a)
8774 @{
8775 if (a < 10)
8776 bar (a);
8777 else
8778 process (a); /* Stop here */
8779 @}
8780
8781 int
8782 bar (int a)
8783 @{
8784 foo (a + 5);
8785 @}
8786 @end smallexample
8787
8788 @noindent
8789 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8790 here is what you might see
8791 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8792
8793 @smallexample
8794 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8795 $1 = 10
8796 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8797 $2 = 5
8798 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8799 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8800 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8801 $3 = 5
8802 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8803 $4 = 0
8804 @end smallexample
8805
8806 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8807 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8808 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8809 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8810 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8811
8812 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8813 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8814 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8815 @code{some_global}.
8816
8817 @smallexample
8818 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8819 $1 = 23
8820 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8821 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8822 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8823 $2 = 27
8824 @end smallexample
8825
8826 @cindex wrong values
8827 @cindex variable values, wrong
8828 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8829 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8830 @quotation
8831 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8832 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8833 scope, and just before exit.
8834 @end quotation
8835 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8836 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8837 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8838 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8839 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8840 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8841 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8842 variable definitions may be gone.
8843
8844 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8845 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8846 when compiling.
8847
8848 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8849 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8850 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8851 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8852 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8853 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8854 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8855
8856 @smallexample
8857 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8858 @end smallexample
8859
8860 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8861 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8862 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8863 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8864 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8865
8866 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8867 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8868 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8869 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8870
8871 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8872 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8873 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8874 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8875 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8876
8877 @smallexample
8878 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8879 29 i++;
8880 (gdb) next
8881 30 e (i);
8882 (gdb) print i
8883 $1 = 31
8884 (gdb) print i@@entry
8885 $2 = 30
8886 @end smallexample
8887
8888 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8889 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8890 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8891 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8892 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8893 For program code
8894
8895 @smallexample
8896 char var0[] = "A";
8897 signed char var1[] = "A";
8898 @end smallexample
8899
8900 You get during debugging
8901 @smallexample
8902 (gdb) print var0
8903 $1 = "A"
8904 (gdb) print var1
8905 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8906 @end smallexample
8907
8908 @node Arrays
8909 @section Artificial Arrays
8910
8911 @cindex artificial array
8912 @cindex arrays
8913 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8914 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8915 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8916 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8917 program.
8918
8919 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8920 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8921 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8922 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8923 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8924 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8925 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8926 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8927 example. If a program says
8928
8929 @smallexample
8930 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8931 @end smallexample
8932
8933 @noindent
8934 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8935
8936 @smallexample
8937 p *array@@len
8938 @end smallexample
8939
8940 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8941 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8942 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8943 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8944 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8945
8946 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8947 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8948 The value need not be in memory:
8949 @smallexample
8950 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8951 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8952 @end smallexample
8953
8954 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8955 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8956 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8957 @smallexample
8958 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8959 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8960 @end smallexample
8961
8962 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8963 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8964 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8965 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8966 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8967 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8968 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8969 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8970 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8971 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8972
8973 @smallexample
8974 set $i = 0
8975 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8976 @key{RET}
8977 @key{RET}
8978 @dots{}
8979 @end smallexample
8980
8981 @node Output Formats
8982 @section Output Formats
8983
8984 @cindex formatted output
8985 @cindex output formats
8986 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8987 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8988 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8989 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8990 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8991
8992 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8993 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8994 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8995 letters supported are:
8996
8997 @table @code
8998 @item x
8999 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9000 hexadecimal.
9001
9002 @item d
9003 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9004
9005 @item u
9006 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9007
9008 @item o
9009 Print as integer in octal.
9010
9011 @item t
9012 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9013 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9014 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9015 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9016
9017 @item a
9018 @cindex unknown address, locating
9019 @cindex locate address
9020 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9021 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9022 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9023
9024 @smallexample
9025 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9026 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9027 @end smallexample
9028
9029 @noindent
9030 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9031 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9032
9033 @item c
9034 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9035 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9036 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9037 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9038
9039 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9040 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9041 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9042 data.
9043
9044 @item f
9045 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9046 using typical floating point syntax.
9047
9048 @item s
9049 @cindex printing strings
9050 @cindex printing byte arrays
9051 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9052 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9053 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9054 natural types.
9055
9056 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9057 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9058 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9059 array.
9060
9061 @item z
9062 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9063 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9064 to the size of the integer type.
9065
9066 @item r
9067 @cindex raw printing
9068 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9069 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9070 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9071 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9072 pretty-printer which might exist.
9073 @end table
9074
9075 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9076
9077 @smallexample
9078 p/x $pc
9079 @end smallexample
9080
9081 @noindent
9082 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9083 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9084
9085 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9086 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9087 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9088
9089 @node Memory
9090 @section Examining Memory
9091
9092 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9093 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9094
9095 @cindex examining memory
9096 @table @code
9097 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9098 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9099 @itemx x @var{addr}
9100 @itemx x
9101 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9102 @end table
9103
9104 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9105 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9106 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9107 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9108 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9109
9110 @table @r
9111 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9112 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9113 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
9114 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9115 @c 4.1.2.
9116
9117 @item @var{f}, the display format
9118 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9119 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9120 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9121 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9122 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9123
9124 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9125 The unit size is any of
9126
9127 @table @code
9128 @item b
9129 Bytes.
9130 @item h
9131 Halfwords (two bytes).
9132 @item w
9133 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9134 @item g
9135 Giant words (eight bytes).
9136 @end table
9137
9138 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9139 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9140 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9141 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9142 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9143 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9144 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9145 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9146 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9147 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9148 be altered.
9149
9150 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9151 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9152 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9153 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9154 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9155 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9156 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9157 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9158 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9159 a value from memory).
9160 @end table
9161
9162 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9163 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9164 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9165 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9166 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9167
9168 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9169 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9170 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9171 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9172 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9173
9174 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9175 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9176 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9177 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9178 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9179 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9180 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9181 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9182 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9183
9184 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9185 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9186 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9187 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9188 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9189 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9190 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9191
9192 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9193 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9194
9195 @smallexample
9196 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9197 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9198 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9199 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9200 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9201 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9202 @end smallexample
9203
9204 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9205 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9206 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9207 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9208 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9209 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9210 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9211 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9212 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9213
9214 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9215 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9216 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9217
9218 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9219 @cindex addressable memory unit
9220 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9221 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9222 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9223 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9224 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9225 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9226 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9227 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9228 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9229
9230 @cindex remote memory comparison
9231 @cindex target memory comparison
9232 @cindex verify remote memory image
9233 @cindex verify target memory image
9234 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9235 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9236 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9237 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9238 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9239 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9240
9241 @table @code
9242 @kindex compare-sections
9243 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9244 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9245 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9246 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9247 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9248 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9249
9250 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9251 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9252 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9253 @end table
9254
9255 @node Auto Display
9256 @section Automatic Display
9257 @cindex automatic display
9258 @cindex display of expressions
9259
9260 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9261 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9262 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9263 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9264 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9265 The automatic display looks like this:
9266
9267 @smallexample
9268 2: foo = 38
9269 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9270 @end smallexample
9271
9272 @noindent
9273 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9274 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9275 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9276 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9277 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9278 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9279
9280 @table @code
9281 @kindex display
9282 @item display @var{expr}
9283 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9284 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9285
9286 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9287
9288 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9289 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9290 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9291 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9292 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9293
9294 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9295 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9296 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9297 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9298 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9299 @end table
9300
9301 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9302 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9303 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9304
9305 @table @code
9306 @kindex delete display
9307 @kindex undisplay
9308 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9309 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9310 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9311 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9312 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9313 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9314 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9315
9316 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9317 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9318
9319 @kindex disable display
9320 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9321 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9322 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9323 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9324 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9325 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9326 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9327 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9328
9329 @kindex enable display
9330 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9331 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9332 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9333 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9334 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9335 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9336 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9337
9338 @item display
9339 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9340 done when your program stops.
9341
9342 @kindex info display
9343 @item info display
9344 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9345 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9346 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9347 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9348 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9349 @end table
9350
9351 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9352 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9353 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9354 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9355 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9356 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9357 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9358 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9359 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9360 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9361 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9362
9363 @node Print Settings
9364 @section Print Settings
9365
9366 @cindex format options
9367 @cindex print settings
9368 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9369 and symbols are printed.
9370
9371 @noindent
9372 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9373
9374 @table @code
9375 @kindex set print
9376 @item set print address
9377 @itemx set print address on
9378 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9379 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9380 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9381 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9382 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9383 @code{set print address on}:
9384
9385 @smallexample
9386 @group
9387 (@value{GDBP}) f
9388 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9389 at input.c:530
9390 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9391 @end group
9392 @end smallexample
9393
9394 @item set print address off
9395 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9396 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9397
9398 @smallexample
9399 @group
9400 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9401 (@value{GDBP}) f
9402 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9403 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9404 @end group
9405 @end smallexample
9406
9407 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9408 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9409 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9410 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9411
9412 @kindex show print
9413 @item show print address
9414 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9415 @end table
9416
9417 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9418 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9419 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9420 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9421 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9422 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9423 it prints a symbolic address:
9424
9425 @table @code
9426 @item set print symbol-filename on
9427 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9428 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9429 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9430 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9431
9432 @item set print symbol-filename off
9433 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9434 default.
9435
9436 @item show print symbol-filename
9437 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9438 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9439 @end table
9440
9441 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9442 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9443 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9444
9445 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9446 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9447
9448 @table @code
9449 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9450 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9451 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9452 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9453 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9454 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9455 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9456 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9457
9458 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9459 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9460 symbolic address.
9461 @end table
9462
9463 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9464 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9465 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9466 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9467 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9468 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9469 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9470 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9471
9472 @smallexample
9473 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9474 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9475 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9476 @end smallexample
9477
9478 @quotation
9479 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9480 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9481 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9482 @end quotation
9483
9484 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9485 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9486
9487 @table @code
9488 @item set print symbol on
9489 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9490 one exists.
9491
9492 @item set print symbol off
9493 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9494 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9495 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9496
9497 @item show print symbol
9498 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9499 address.
9500 @end table
9501
9502 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9503
9504 @table @code
9505 @item set print array
9506 @itemx set print array on
9507 @cindex pretty print arrays
9508 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9509 but uses more space. The default is off.
9510
9511 @item set print array off
9512 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9513
9514 @item show print array
9515 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9516 arrays.
9517
9518 @cindex print array indexes
9519 @item set print array-indexes
9520 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9521 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9522 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9523 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9524
9525 @item set print array-indexes off
9526 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9527
9528 @item show print array-indexes
9529 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9530 arrays.
9531
9532 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9533 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9534 @cindex number of array elements to print
9535 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9536 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9537 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9538 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9539 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9540 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9541 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9542 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9543
9544 @item show print elements
9545 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9546 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9547
9548 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9549 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9550 @cindex printing frame argument values
9551 @cindex print all frame argument values
9552 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9553 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9554 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9555 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9556 values are:
9557
9558 @table @code
9559 @item all
9560 The values of all arguments are printed.
9561
9562 @item scalars
9563 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9564 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9565 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9566 only scalar arguments are shown:
9567
9568 @smallexample
9569 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9570 at frame-args.c:23
9571 @end smallexample
9572
9573 @item none
9574 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9575 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9576
9577 @smallexample
9578 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9579 at frame-args.c:23
9580 @end smallexample
9581 @end table
9582
9583 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9584 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9585 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9586 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9587 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9588 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9589 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9590 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9591 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9592 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9593
9594 @item show print frame-arguments
9595 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9596
9597 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9598 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9599
9600 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9601 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9602 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9603 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9604 This is the default.
9605
9606 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9607 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9608
9609 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9610 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9611 @kindex set print entry-values
9612 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9613 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9614 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9615 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9616 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9617
9618 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9619 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9620 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9621 @code{no} setting.
9622
9623 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9624 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9625 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9626 this information.
9627
9628 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9629
9630 @table @code
9631 @item no
9632 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9633 point.
9634 @smallexample
9635 #0 equal (val=5)
9636 #0 different (val=6)
9637 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9638 #0 born (val=10)
9639 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9640 @end smallexample
9641
9642 @item only
9643 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9644 values are never printed.
9645 @smallexample
9646 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9647 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9648 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9649 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9650 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9651 @end smallexample
9652
9653 @item preferred
9654 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9655 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9656 value for such parameter.
9657 @smallexample
9658 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9659 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9660 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9661 #0 born (val=10)
9662 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9663 @end smallexample
9664
9665 @item if-needed
9666 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9667 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9668 parameter.
9669 @smallexample
9670 #0 equal (val=5)
9671 #0 different (val=6)
9672 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9673 #0 born (val=10)
9674 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9675 @end smallexample
9676
9677 @item both
9678 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9679 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9680 optimizations.
9681 @smallexample
9682 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9683 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9684 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9685 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9686 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9687 @end smallexample
9688
9689 @item compact
9690 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9691 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9692 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9693 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9694 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9695 @smallexample
9696 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9697 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9698 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9699 #0 born (val=10)
9700 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9701 @end smallexample
9702
9703 @item default
9704 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9705 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9706 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9707 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9708 @smallexample
9709 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9710 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9711 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9712 #0 born (val=10)
9713 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9714 @end smallexample
9715 @end table
9716
9717 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9718 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9719
9720 @item show print entry-values
9721 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9722 entry.
9723
9724 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9725 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9726 @cindex repeated array elements
9727 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9728 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9729 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9730 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9731 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9732 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9733 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9734 is 10.
9735
9736 @item show print repeats
9737 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9738 elements.
9739
9740 @item set print null-stop
9741 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9742 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9743 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9744 contain only short strings.
9745 The default is off.
9746
9747 @item show print null-stop
9748 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9749 @sc{null} character.
9750
9751 @item set print pretty on
9752 @cindex print structures in indented form
9753 @cindex indentation in structure display
9754 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9755 per line, like this:
9756
9757 @smallexample
9758 @group
9759 $1 = @{
9760 next = 0x0,
9761 flags = @{
9762 sweet = 1,
9763 sour = 1
9764 @},
9765 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9766 @}
9767 @end group
9768 @end smallexample
9769
9770 @item set print pretty off
9771 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9772
9773 @smallexample
9774 @group
9775 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9776 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9777 @end group
9778 @end smallexample
9779
9780 @noindent
9781 This is the default format.
9782
9783 @item show print pretty
9784 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9785
9786 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9787 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9788 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9789 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9790 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9791 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9792 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9793 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9794
9795 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9796 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9797 international character sets, and is the default.
9798
9799 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9800 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9801
9802 @item set print union on
9803 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9804 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9805 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9806
9807 @item set print union off
9808 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9809 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9810 instead.
9811
9812 @item show print union
9813 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9814 structures and other unions.
9815
9816 For example, given the declarations
9817
9818 @smallexample
9819 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9820 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9821 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9822 Bug_forms;
9823
9824 struct thing @{
9825 Species it;
9826 union @{
9827 Tree_forms tree;
9828 Bug_forms bug;
9829 @} form;
9830 @};
9831
9832 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9833 @end smallexample
9834
9835 @noindent
9836 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9837
9838 @smallexample
9839 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9840 @end smallexample
9841
9842 @noindent
9843 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9844
9845 @smallexample
9846 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9847 @end smallexample
9848
9849 @noindent
9850 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9851 and in Pascal.
9852 @end table
9853
9854 @need 1000
9855 @noindent
9856 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9857
9858 @table @code
9859 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9860 @item set print demangle
9861 @itemx set print demangle on
9862 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9863 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9864 linkage. The default is on.
9865
9866 @item show print demangle
9867 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9868
9869 @item set print asm-demangle
9870 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9871 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9872 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9873 The default is off.
9874
9875 @item show print asm-demangle
9876 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9877 or demangled form.
9878
9879 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9880 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9881 @kindex set demangle-style
9882 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9883 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9884 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9885
9886 @table @code
9887 @item auto
9888 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9889 This is the default.
9890
9891 @item gnu
9892 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9893
9894 @item hp
9895 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9896
9897 @item lucid
9898 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9899
9900 @item arm
9901 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9902 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9903 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9904 require further enhancement to permit that.
9905
9906 @end table
9907 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9908
9909 @item show demangle-style
9910 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9911
9912 @item set print object
9913 @itemx set print object on
9914 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9915 @cindex display derived types
9916 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9917 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9918 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9919 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9920 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9921 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9922 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9923
9924 @item set print object off
9925 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9926 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9927
9928 @item show print object
9929 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9930
9931 @item set print static-members
9932 @itemx set print static-members on
9933 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9934 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9935
9936 @item set print static-members off
9937 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9938
9939 @item show print static-members
9940 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9941
9942 @item set print pascal_static-members
9943 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9944 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9945 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9946 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9947
9948 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9949 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9950
9951 @item show print pascal_static-members
9952 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9953
9954 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9955 @item set print vtbl
9956 @itemx set print vtbl on
9957 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9958 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9959 @cindex VTBL display
9960 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9961 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9962 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9963
9964 @item set print vtbl off
9965 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9966
9967 @item show print vtbl
9968 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9969 @end table
9970
9971 @node Pretty Printing
9972 @section Pretty Printing
9973
9974 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9975 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9976 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9977
9978 @menu
9979 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9980 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9981 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9982 @end menu
9983
9984 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9985 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9986
9987 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9988 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9989 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9990
9991 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9992 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9993 pretty-printers with their names.
9994 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9995 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9996 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9997 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9998
9999 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10000 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10001 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10002 do anything special.
10003
10004 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10005
10006 @itemize @bullet
10007 @item
10008 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10009 all inferiors.
10010
10011 @item
10012 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10013 when debugging that program.
10014 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10015
10016 @item
10017 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10018 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10019 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10020 @end itemize
10021
10022 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10023 pretty-printers are selected,
10024
10025 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10026 for new types.
10027
10028 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10029 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10030
10031 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10032
10033 @smallexample
10034 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10035 $1 = @{
10036 static npos = 4294967295,
10037 _M_dataplus = @{
10038 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10039 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10040 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10041 @},
10042 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10043 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10044 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10045 @}
10046 @}
10047 @end smallexample
10048
10049 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10050
10051 @smallexample
10052 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10053 $2 = "abcd"
10054 @end smallexample
10055
10056 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10057 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10058 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10059
10060 @table @code
10061 @kindex info pretty-printer
10062 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10063 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10064 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10065
10066 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10067 whose pretty-printers to list.
10068 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10069 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10070 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10071 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10072 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10073
10074 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10075 to list.
10076
10077 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10078 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10079 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10080 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10081
10082 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10083 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10084 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10085 @end table
10086
10087 Example:
10088
10089 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10090 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10091 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10092 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10093
10094 @smallexample
10095 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10096 library1.so:
10097 foo
10098 library2.so:
10099 bar
10100 bar1
10101 bar2
10102 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10103 library2.so:
10104 bar
10105 bar1
10106 bar2
10107 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10108 1 printer disabled
10109 2 of 3 printers enabled
10110 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10111 library1.so:
10112 foo [disabled]
10113 library2.so:
10114 bar
10115 bar1
10116 bar2
10117 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10118 1 printer disabled
10119 1 of 3 printers enabled
10120 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10121 library1.so:
10122 foo [disabled]
10123 library2.so:
10124 bar
10125 bar1 [disabled]
10126 bar2
10127 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10128 1 printer disabled
10129 0 of 3 printers enabled
10130 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10131 library1.so:
10132 foo [disabled]
10133 library2.so:
10134 bar [disabled]
10135 bar1 [disabled]
10136 bar2
10137 @end smallexample
10138
10139 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10140 as can each individual subprinter.
10141
10142 @node Value History
10143 @section Value History
10144
10145 @cindex value history
10146 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10147 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10148 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10149 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10150 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10151 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10152 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10153 symbol table.
10154
10155 @cindex @code{$}
10156 @cindex @code{$$}
10157 @cindex history number
10158 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10159 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10160 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10161 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10162 history number.
10163
10164 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10165 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10166 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10167 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10168 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10169 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10170 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10171
10172 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10173 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10174
10175 @smallexample
10176 p *$
10177 @end smallexample
10178
10179 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10180 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10181
10182 @smallexample
10183 p *$.next
10184 @end smallexample
10185
10186 @noindent
10187 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10188 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10189
10190 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10191 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10192
10193 @smallexample
10194 print x
10195 set x=5
10196 @end smallexample
10197
10198 @noindent
10199 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10200 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10201
10202 @table @code
10203 @kindex show values
10204 @item show values
10205 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10206 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10207 values} does not change the history.
10208
10209 @item show values @var{n}
10210 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10211
10212 @item show values +
10213 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10214 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10215 @end table
10216
10217 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10218 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10219
10220 @node Convenience Vars
10221 @section Convenience Variables
10222
10223 @cindex convenience variables
10224 @cindex user-defined variables
10225 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10226 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10227 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10228 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10229 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10230
10231 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10232 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10233 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10234 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10235 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10236
10237 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10238 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10239 For example:
10240
10241 @smallexample
10242 set $foo = *object_ptr
10243 @end smallexample
10244
10245 @noindent
10246 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10247 @code{object_ptr}.
10248
10249 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10250 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10251 value with another assignment at any time.
10252
10253 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10254 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10255 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10256 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10257
10258 @table @code
10259 @kindex show convenience
10260 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10261 @item show convenience
10262 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10263 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10264 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10265
10266 @kindex init-if-undefined
10267 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10268 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10269 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10270 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10271 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10272 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10273 override default values used in a command script.
10274
10275 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10276 any side-effects do not occur.
10277 @end table
10278
10279 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10280 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10281 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10282
10283 @smallexample
10284 set $i = 0
10285 print bar[$i++]->contents
10286 @end smallexample
10287
10288 @noindent
10289 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10290
10291 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10292 values likely to be useful.
10293
10294 @table @code
10295 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10296 @item $_
10297 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10298 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10299 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10300 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10301 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10302 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10303 to the type of @code{$__}.
10304
10305 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10306 @item $__
10307 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10308 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10309 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10310
10311 @item $_exitcode
10312 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10313 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10314 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10315 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10316
10317 @item $_exitsignal
10318 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10319 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10320 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10321 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10322
10323 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10324 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10325 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10326 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10327 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10328
10329 @smallexample
10330 #include <signal.h>
10331
10332 int
10333 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10334 @{
10335 raise (SIGALRM);
10336 return 0;
10337 @}
10338 @end smallexample
10339
10340 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10341 or signalled would be:
10342
10343 @smallexample
10344 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10345 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10346 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10347 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10348 >echo The program has exited\n
10349 >else
10350 >echo The program has signalled\n
10351 >end
10352 >end
10353 (@value{GDBP}) run
10354 Starting program:
10355
10356 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10357 The program no longer exists.
10358 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10359 The program has signalled
10360 @end smallexample
10361
10362 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10363 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10364 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10365 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10366
10367 @smallexample
10368 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10369 The program has exited
10370 @end smallexample
10371
10372 @item $_exception
10373 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10374 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10375
10376 @item $_probe_argc
10377 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10378 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10379
10380 @item $_sdata
10381 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10382 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10383 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10384 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10385 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10386
10387 @item $_siginfo
10388 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10389 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10390 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10391 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10392 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10393
10394 @item $_tlb
10395 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10396 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10397 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10398 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10399 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10400 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10401
10402 @end table
10403
10404 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10405 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10406 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10407
10408 @node Convenience Funs
10409 @section Convenience Functions
10410
10411 @cindex convenience functions
10412 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10413 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10414 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10415 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10416 @value{GDBN}.
10417
10418 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10419 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10420
10421 @table @code
10422
10423 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10424 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10425 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10426 returns zero.
10427
10428 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10429 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10430 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10431 it is @code{void}:
10432
10433 @smallexample
10434 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10435 $1 = void
10436 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10437 $2 = 1
10438 (@value{GDBP}) run
10439 Starting program: ./a.out
10440 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10441 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10442 $3 = 0
10443 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10444 $4 = 0
10445 @end smallexample
10446
10447 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10448 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10449 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10450 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10451 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10452 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10453 anymore.
10454
10455 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10456 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10457
10458 @smallexample
10459 void
10460 foo (void)
10461 @{
10462 @}
10463 @end smallexample
10464
10465 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10466
10467 @smallexample
10468 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10469 $1 = void
10470 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10471 $2 = 1
10472 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10473 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10474 $3 = void
10475 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10476 $4 = 1
10477 @end smallexample
10478
10479 @end table
10480
10481 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10482 @code{Python} support.
10483
10484 @table @code
10485
10486 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10487 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10488 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10489 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10490 Otherwise it returns zero.
10491
10492 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10493 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10494 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10495 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10496 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10497 regular expression support.
10498
10499 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10500 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10501 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10502 Otherwise it returns zero.
10503
10504 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10505 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10506 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10507
10508 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10509 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10510 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10511 Otherwise it returns zero.
10512
10513 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10514 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10515 The default is 1.
10516
10517 Example:
10518
10519 @smallexample
10520 (gdb) backtrace
10521 #0 bottom_func ()
10522 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10523 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10524 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10525 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10526 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10527 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10528 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10529 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10530 $1 = 1
10531 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10532 $1 = 1
10533 @end smallexample
10534
10535 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10536 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10537 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10538 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10539
10540 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10541 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10542 The default is 1.
10543
10544 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10545 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10546 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10547 Otherwise it returns zero.
10548
10549 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10550 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10551 The default is 1.
10552
10553 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10554 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10555 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10556 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10557
10558 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10559 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10560 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10561 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10562
10563 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10564 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10565 The default is 1.
10566
10567 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10568 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10569 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10570 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10571
10572 @end table
10573
10574 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10575 convenience functions.
10576
10577 @table @code
10578 @item help function
10579 @kindex help function
10580 @cindex show all convenience functions
10581 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10582 @end table
10583
10584 @node Registers
10585 @section Registers
10586
10587 @cindex registers
10588 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10589 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10590 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10591 your machine.
10592
10593 @table @code
10594 @kindex info registers
10595 @item info registers
10596 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10597 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10598
10599 @kindex info all-registers
10600 @cindex floating point registers
10601 @item info all-registers
10602 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10603 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10604
10605 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10606 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10607 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10608 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10609 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10610 @end table
10611
10612 @anchor{standard registers}
10613 @cindex stack pointer register
10614 @cindex program counter register
10615 @cindex process status register
10616 @cindex frame pointer register
10617 @cindex standard registers
10618 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10619 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10620 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10621 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10622 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10623 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10624 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10625 you could print the program counter in hex with
10626
10627 @smallexample
10628 p/x $pc
10629 @end smallexample
10630
10631 @noindent
10632 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10633
10634 @smallexample
10635 x/i $pc
10636 @end smallexample
10637
10638 @noindent
10639 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10640 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10641 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10642 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10643 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10644 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10645 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10646
10647 @smallexample
10648 set $sp += 4
10649 @end smallexample
10650
10651 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10652 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10653 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10654 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10655 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10656 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10657 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10658
10659 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10660 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10661 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10662 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10663 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10664 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10665 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10666
10667 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10668 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10669 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10670 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10671 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10672 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10673 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10674 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10675 prints the data in both formats.
10676
10677 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10678 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10679 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10680 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10681 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10682 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10683 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10684
10685 @smallexample
10686 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10687 $1 = @{
10688 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10689 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10690 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10691 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10692 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10693 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10694 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10695 @}
10696 @end smallexample
10697
10698 @noindent
10699 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10700 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10701 value to a @code{struct} member:
10702
10703 @smallexample
10704 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10705 @end smallexample
10706
10707 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10708 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10709 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10710 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10711 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10712 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10713
10714 @cindex caller-saved registers
10715 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10716 @cindex volatile registers
10717 @cindex <not saved> values
10718 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10719 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10720 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10721 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10722 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10723 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10724 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10725 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10726 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10727 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10728 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10729 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10730 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10731 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10732 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10733 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10734 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10735 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10736 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10737 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10738 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10739 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10740 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10741
10742 @node Floating Point Hardware
10743 @section Floating Point Hardware
10744 @cindex floating point
10745
10746 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10747 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10748
10749 @table @code
10750 @kindex info float
10751 @item info float
10752 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10753 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10754 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10755 the ARM and x86 machines.
10756 @end table
10757
10758 @node Vector Unit
10759 @section Vector Unit
10760 @cindex vector unit
10761
10762 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10763 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10764
10765 @table @code
10766 @kindex info vector
10767 @item info vector
10768 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10769 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10770 @end table
10771
10772 @node OS Information
10773 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10774 @cindex OS information
10775
10776 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10777 you debug your program.
10778
10779 @cindex auxiliary vector
10780 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10781 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10782 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10783 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10784 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10785 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10786 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10787 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10788 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10789 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10790 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10791 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10792
10793 @table @code
10794 @kindex info auxv
10795 @item info auxv
10796 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10797 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10798 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10799 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10800 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10801 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10802 an unrecognized tag.
10803 @end table
10804
10805 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10806 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10807 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10808 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10809 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10810 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10811 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10812
10813 @table @code
10814 @kindex info os
10815 @item info os @var{infotype}
10816
10817 Display OS information of the requested type.
10818
10819 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10820
10821 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10822 @table @code
10823 @kindex info os cpus
10824 @item cpus
10825 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10826 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10827 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10828 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10829 kernel initialization.
10830
10831 @kindex info os files
10832 @item files
10833 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10834 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10835 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10836 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10837
10838 @kindex info os modules
10839 @item modules
10840 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10841 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10842 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10843 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10844 in memory.
10845
10846 @kindex info os msg
10847 @item msg
10848 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10849 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10850 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10851 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10852 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10853 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10854 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10855 the message queue was last changed.
10856
10857 @kindex info os processes
10858 @item processes
10859 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10860 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10861 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10862 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10863 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10864 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10865
10866 @kindex info os procgroups
10867 @item procgroups
10868 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10869 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10870 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10871 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10872 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10873 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10874 and the process group leader is listed first.
10875
10876 @kindex info os semaphores
10877 @item semaphores
10878 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10879 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10880 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10881 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10882 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10883
10884 @kindex info os shm
10885 @item shm
10886 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10887 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10888 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10889 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10890 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10891 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10892 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10893
10894 @kindex info os sockets
10895 @item sockets
10896 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10897 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10898 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10899 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10900 connection.
10901
10902 @kindex info os threads
10903 @item threads
10904 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10905 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10906 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10907 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10908 process is not listed.
10909 @end table
10910
10911 @item info os
10912 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10913 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10914 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10915 types, this command will report an error.
10916 @end table
10917
10918 @node Memory Region Attributes
10919 @section Memory Region Attributes
10920 @cindex memory region attributes
10921
10922 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10923 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10924 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10925 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10926 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10927 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10928 user can override the fetched regions.
10929
10930 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10931 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10932 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10933 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10934 all memory.
10935
10936 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10937 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10938
10939 @table @code
10940 @kindex mem
10941 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10942 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10943 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10944 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10945 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10946 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10947
10948 @item mem auto
10949 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10950 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10951
10952 @kindex delete mem
10953 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10954 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10955 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10956
10957 @kindex disable mem
10958 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10959 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10960 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10961 It may be enabled again later.
10962
10963 @kindex enable mem
10964 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10965 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10966
10967 @kindex info mem
10968 @item info mem
10969 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10970 for each region:
10971
10972 @table @emph
10973 @item Memory Region Number
10974 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10975 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10976 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10977
10978 @item Lo Address
10979 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10980
10981 @item Hi Address
10982 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10983
10984 @item Attributes
10985 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10986 @end table
10987 @end table
10988
10989
10990 @subsection Attributes
10991
10992 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10993 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10994 write accesses to a memory region.
10995
10996 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10997 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10998 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10999
11000 @table @code
11001 @item ro
11002 Memory is read only.
11003 @item wo
11004 Memory is write only.
11005 @item rw
11006 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11007 @end table
11008
11009 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11010 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11011 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11012 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11013 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11014
11015 @table @code
11016 @item 8
11017 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11018 @item 16
11019 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11020 @item 32
11021 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11022 @item 64
11023 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11024 @end table
11025
11026 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11027 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11028 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11029 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11030 @c
11031 @c @table @code
11032 @c @item hwbreak
11033 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11034 @c @item swbreak (default)
11035 @c @end table
11036
11037 @subsubsection Data Cache
11038 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11039 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11040 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11041 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11042 registers.
11043
11044 @table @code
11045 @item cache
11046 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11047 @item nocache
11048 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11049 @end table
11050
11051 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11052 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11053 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11054 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11055 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11056
11057 @table @code
11058 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11059 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11060 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11061 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11062 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11063 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11064 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11065 The default value is @code{on}.
11066 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11067 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11068 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11069 @end table
11070
11071
11072 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11073 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11074 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11075 @c
11076 @c @table @code
11077 @c @item verify
11078 @c @item noverify (default)
11079 @c @end table
11080
11081 @node Dump/Restore Files
11082 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11083 @cindex dump/restore files
11084 @cindex append data to a file
11085 @cindex dump data to a file
11086 @cindex restore data from a file
11087
11088 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11089 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11090 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11091 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11092 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11093 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11094 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11095
11096 @table @code
11097
11098 @kindex dump
11099 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11100 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11101 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11102 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11103
11104 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11105 @table @code
11106 @item binary
11107 Raw binary form.
11108 @item ihex
11109 Intel hex format.
11110 @item srec
11111 Motorola S-record format.
11112 @item tekhex
11113 Tektronix Hex format.
11114 @item verilog
11115 Verilog Hex format.
11116 @end table
11117
11118 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11119 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11120 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11121 form.
11122
11123 @kindex append
11124 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11125 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11126 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11127 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11128 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11129
11130 @kindex restore
11131 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11132 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11133 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11134 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11135 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11136
11137 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11138 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11139 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11140 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11141 from that location.
11142
11143 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11144 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11145 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11146 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11147
11148 @end table
11149
11150 @node Core File Generation
11151 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11152 @cindex dump core from inferior
11153
11154 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11155 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11156 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11157 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11158 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11159 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11160 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11161
11162 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11163 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11164 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11165
11166 @table @code
11167 @kindex gcore
11168 @kindex generate-core-file
11169 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11170 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11171 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11172 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11173 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11174 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11175
11176 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11177 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11178
11179 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11180 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11181 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11182
11183 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11184 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11185 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11186 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11187 Enable or disable the use of the file
11188 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11189 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11190 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11191 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11192
11193 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11194 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11195 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11196 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11197 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11198 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11199 about the bits that can be set in the
11200 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11201 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11202
11203 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11204 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11205 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11206 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11207 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11208 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11209 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11210 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11211 @end table
11212
11213 @node Character Sets
11214 @section Character Sets
11215 @cindex character sets
11216 @cindex charset
11217 @cindex translating between character sets
11218 @cindex host character set
11219 @cindex target character set
11220
11221 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11222 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11223 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11224 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11225 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11226 @dfn{target character set}.
11227
11228 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11229 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11230 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11231 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11232 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11233 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11234 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11235 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11236 character and string literals in expressions.
11237
11238 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11239 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11240 target-charset} command, described below.
11241
11242 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11243 support:
11244
11245 @table @code
11246 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11247 @kindex set target-charset
11248 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11249 list of supported target character sets, type
11250 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11251
11252 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11253 @kindex set host-charset
11254 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11255
11256 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11257 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11258 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11259 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11260 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11261
11262 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11263 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11264 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11265
11266 @item set charset @var{charset}
11267 @kindex set charset
11268 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11269 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11270 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11271 for both host and target.
11272
11273 @item show charset
11274 @kindex show charset
11275 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11276
11277 @item show host-charset
11278 @kindex show host-charset
11279 Show the name of the current host character set.
11280
11281 @item show target-charset
11282 @kindex show target-charset
11283 Show the name of the current target character set.
11284
11285 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11286 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11287 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11288 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11289 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11290 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11291
11292 @item show target-wide-charset
11293 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11294 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11295 @end table
11296
11297 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11298 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11299 @file{charset-test.c}:
11300
11301 @smallexample
11302 #include <stdio.h>
11303
11304 char ascii_hello[]
11305 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11306 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11307 char ibm1047_hello[]
11308 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11309 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11310
11311 main ()
11312 @{
11313 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11314 @}
11315 @end smallexample
11316
11317 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11318 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11319 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11320
11321 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11322
11323 @smallexample
11324 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11325 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11326 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11327 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11328 @dots{}
11329 (@value{GDBP})
11330 @end smallexample
11331
11332 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11333 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11334 strings:
11335
11336 @smallexample
11337 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11338 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11339 (@value{GDBP})
11340 @end smallexample
11341
11342 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11343 initial character set:
11344 @smallexample
11345 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11346 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11347 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11348 (@value{GDBP})
11349 @end smallexample
11350
11351 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11352 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11353 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11354 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11355 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11356
11357 @smallexample
11358 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11359 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11360 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11361 $2 = 72 'H'
11362 (@value{GDBP})
11363 @end smallexample
11364
11365 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11366 literals you use in expressions:
11367
11368 @smallexample
11369 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11370 $3 = 43 '+'
11371 (@value{GDBP})
11372 @end smallexample
11373
11374 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11375 character.
11376
11377 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11378 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11379 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11380
11381 @smallexample
11382 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11383 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11384 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11385 $5 = 200 '\310'
11386 (@value{GDBP})
11387 @end smallexample
11388
11389 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11390 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11391
11392 @smallexample
11393 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11394 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11395 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11396 @end smallexample
11397
11398 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11399 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11400 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11401 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11402 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11403
11404 @smallexample
11405 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11406 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11407 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11408 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11409 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11410 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11411 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11412 $7 = 72 '\110'
11413 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11414 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11415 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11416 $9 = 200 'H'
11417 (@value{GDBP})
11418 @end smallexample
11419
11420 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11421 string literals you use in expressions:
11422
11423 @smallexample
11424 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11425 $10 = 78 '+'
11426 (@value{GDBP})
11427 @end smallexample
11428
11429 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11430 character.
11431
11432 @node Caching Target Data
11433 @section Caching Data of Targets
11434 @cindex caching data of targets
11435
11436 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11437 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11438 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11439 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11440 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11441 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11442 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11443 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11444 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11445 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11446 is executing.
11447 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11448 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11449 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11450 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11451 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11452 in the code segment.
11453 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11454 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11455
11456 @table @code
11457 @kindex set remotecache
11458 @item set remotecache on
11459 @itemx set remotecache off
11460 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11461 with old scripts.
11462
11463 @kindex show remotecache
11464 @item show remotecache
11465 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11466
11467 @kindex set stack-cache
11468 @item set stack-cache on
11469 @itemx set stack-cache off
11470 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11471 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11472
11473 @kindex show stack-cache
11474 @item show stack-cache
11475 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11476
11477 @kindex set code-cache
11478 @item set code-cache on
11479 @itemx set code-cache off
11480 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11481 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11482 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11483
11484 @kindex show code-cache
11485 @item show code-cache
11486 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11487 accesses.
11488
11489 @kindex info dcache
11490 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11491 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11492 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11493 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11494 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11495 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11496
11497 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11498 printed in hex.
11499
11500 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11501 @cindex dcache size
11502 @kindex set dcache size
11503 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11504
11505 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11506 @cindex dcache line-size
11507 @kindex set dcache line-size
11508 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11509 Must be a power of 2.
11510
11511 @item show dcache size
11512 @kindex show dcache size
11513 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11514
11515 @item show dcache line-size
11516 @kindex show dcache line-size
11517 Show default size of dcache lines.
11518
11519 @end table
11520
11521 @node Searching Memory
11522 @section Search Memory
11523 @cindex searching memory
11524
11525 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11526 @code{find} command.
11527
11528 @table @code
11529 @kindex find
11530 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11531 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11532 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11533 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11534 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11535 @end table
11536
11537 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11538 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11539
11540 @table @r
11541 @item @var{s}, search query size
11542 The size of each search query value.
11543
11544 @table @code
11545 @item b
11546 bytes
11547 @item h
11548 halfwords (two bytes)
11549 @item w
11550 words (four bytes)
11551 @item g
11552 giant words (eight bytes)
11553 @end table
11554
11555 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11556 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11557 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11558
11559 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11560 value's type in the current language.
11561 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11562 pattern as a mixture of types.
11563 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11564 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11565 which is typically four bytes.
11566
11567 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11568 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11569 @end table
11570
11571 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11572 (@code{"}).
11573 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11574 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11575
11576 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11577 number of matches found.
11578
11579 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11580 @samp{$_}.
11581 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11582
11583 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11584
11585 @smallexample
11586 void
11587 hello ()
11588 @{
11589 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11590 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11591 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11592 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11593 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11594 @}
11595 @end smallexample
11596
11597 @noindent
11598 you get during debugging:
11599
11600 @smallexample
11601 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11602 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11603 1 pattern found
11604 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11605 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11606 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11607 2 patterns found
11608 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11609 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11610 1 pattern found
11611 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11612 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11613 1 pattern found
11614 (gdb) print $numfound
11615 $1 = 1
11616 (gdb) print $_
11617 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11618 @end smallexample
11619
11620 @node Optimized Code
11621 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11622 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11623 @cindex debugging optimized code
11624
11625 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11626 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11627 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11628 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11629 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11630 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11631 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11632
11633 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11634 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11635 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11636 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11637
11638 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11639 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11640 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11641 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11642 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11643 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11644
11645 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11646 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11647 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11648 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11649 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11650
11651 @menu
11652 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11653 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11654 @end menu
11655
11656 @node Inline Functions
11657 @section Inline Functions
11658 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11659
11660 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11661 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11662 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11663 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11664 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11665 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11666 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11667 @code{info frame} command.
11668
11669 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11670 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11671 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11672 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11673 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11674 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11675 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11676 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11677 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11678 local variables in the caller.
11679
11680 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11681 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11682 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11683 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11684 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11685 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11686 instructions are executed.
11687
11688 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11689 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11690 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11691 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11692
11693 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11694 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11695
11696 @itemize @bullet
11697 @item
11698 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11699 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11700 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11701 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11702 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11703 or inside the inlined function instead.
11704
11705 @item
11706 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11707 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11708 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11709 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11710
11711 @end itemize
11712
11713 @node Tail Call Frames
11714 @section Tail Call Frames
11715 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11716
11717 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11718 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11719 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11720 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11721 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11722
11723 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11724 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11725 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11726 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11727 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11728 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11729 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11730
11731 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11732 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11733 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11734 this information.
11735
11736 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11737 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11738
11739 @smallexample
11740 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11741 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11742 (gdb) info frame
11743 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11744 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11745 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11746 source language c++.
11747 Arglist at unknown address.
11748 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11749 @end smallexample
11750
11751 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11752 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11753 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11754 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11755 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11756 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11757
11758 @table @code
11759 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11760 @item set debug entry-values
11761 @kindex set debug entry-values
11762 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11763 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11764 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11765 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11766 result.
11767
11768 @item show debug entry-values
11769 @kindex show debug entry-values
11770 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11771 values at function entry and tail calls.
11772 @end table
11773
11774 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11775 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11776 reference by variable @code{x}):
11777
11778 @smallexample
11779 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11780 void (*x) (void) = c;
11781 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11782 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11783 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11784
11785 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11786 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11787 a () at t.c:3
11788 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11789 (gdb) bt
11790 #0 a () at t.c:3
11791 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11792 @end smallexample
11793
11794 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11795
11796 @smallexample
11797 int i;
11798 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11799 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11800 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11801 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11802 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11803 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11804 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11805 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11806
11807 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11808 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11809 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11810 (gdb) bt
11811 #0 f () at t.c:2
11812 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11813 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11814 @end smallexample
11815
11816 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11817 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11818
11819 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11820 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11821 @set ARROW @click{}
11822 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11823 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11824 @end ifset
11825 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11826 @set ARROW ->
11827 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11828 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11829 @end ifclear
11830
11831 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11832 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11833 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11834
11835 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11836 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11837 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11838 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11839 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11840 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11841
11842 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11843 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11844 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11845 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11846 omitted.
11847
11848 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11849 entry may fail:
11850
11851 @smallexample
11852 int v;
11853 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11854 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11855 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11856 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11857 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11858 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11859
11860 (gdb) bt
11861 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11862 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11863 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11864 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11865 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11866 @end smallexample
11867
11868 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11869 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11870 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11871 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11872 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11873
11874 @node Macros
11875 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11876
11877 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11878 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11879 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11880 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11881 where it was defined.
11882
11883 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11884 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11885 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11886 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11887
11888 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11889 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11890 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11891 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11892 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11893 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11894 see @ref{List}.
11895
11896 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11897 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11898 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11899
11900 @table @code
11901
11902 @kindex macro expand
11903 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11904 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11905 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11906 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11907 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11908 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11909 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11910 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11911 it can be any string of tokens.
11912
11913 @kindex macro exp1
11914 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11915 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11916 @cindex expand macro once
11917 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11918 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11919 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11920 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11921 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11922 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11923 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11924 can be any string of tokens.
11925
11926 @kindex info macro
11927 @cindex macro definition, showing
11928 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11929 @cindex macros, from debug info
11930 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11931 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11932 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11933 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11934 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11935 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11936
11937 @kindex info macros
11938 @item info macros @var{location}
11939 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11940 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
11941 command-line where those definitions were established.
11942
11943 @kindex macro define
11944 @cindex user-defined macros
11945 @cindex defining macros interactively
11946 @cindex macros, user-defined
11947 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11948 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11949 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11950 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11951 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11952 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11953 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11954 @var{arglist}.
11955
11956 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11957 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11958 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11959 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11960 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11961
11962 @kindex macro undef
11963 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11964 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11965 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11966 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11967 in the program being debugged.
11968
11969 @kindex macro list
11970 @item macro list
11971 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11972 @end table
11973
11974 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11975 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11976 show our source files:
11977
11978 @smallexample
11979 $ cat sample.c
11980 #include <stdio.h>
11981 #include "sample.h"
11982
11983 #define M 42
11984 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11985
11986 main ()
11987 @{
11988 #define N 28
11989 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11990 #undef N
11991 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11992 #define N 1729
11993 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11994 @}
11995 $ cat sample.h
11996 #define Q <
11997 $
11998 @end smallexample
11999
12000 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12001 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12002 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12003 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12004 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12005 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12006 information.
12007
12008 @smallexample
12009 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12010 $
12011 @end smallexample
12012
12013 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12014
12015 @smallexample
12016 $ gdb -nw sample
12017 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12018 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12019 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12020 (@value{GDBP})
12021 @end smallexample
12022
12023 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12024 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12025 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12026
12027 @smallexample
12028 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12029 3
12030 4 #define M 42
12031 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12032 6
12033 7 main ()
12034 8 @{
12035 9 #define N 28
12036 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12037 11 #undef N
12038 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12039 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12040 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12041 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12042 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12043 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12044 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12045 #define Q <
12046 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12047 expands to: (42 + 1)
12048 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12049 expands to: once (M + 1)
12050 (@value{GDBP})
12051 @end smallexample
12052
12053 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12054 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12055 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12056 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12057
12058 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12059 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12060
12061 @smallexample
12062 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12063 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12064 (@value{GDBP}) run
12065 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12066
12067 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12068 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12069 (@value{GDBP})
12070 @end smallexample
12071
12072 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12073
12074 @smallexample
12075 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12076 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12077 #define N 28
12078 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12079 expands to: 28 < 42
12080 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12081 $1 = 1
12082 (@value{GDBP})
12083 @end smallexample
12084
12085 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12086 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12087 thereof) in force at each point:
12088
12089 @smallexample
12090 (@value{GDBP}) next
12091 Hello, world!
12092 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12093 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12094 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12095 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12096 (@value{GDBP}) next
12097 We're so creative.
12098 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12099 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12100 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12101 #define N 1729
12102 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12103 expands to: 1729 < 42
12104 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12105 $2 = 0
12106 (@value{GDBP})
12107 @end smallexample
12108
12109 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12110 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12111 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12112 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12113
12114 @smallexample
12115 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12116 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12117 -D__STDC__=1
12118 (@value{GDBP})
12119 @end smallexample
12120
12121
12122 @node Tracepoints
12123 @chapter Tracepoints
12124 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12125 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12126
12127 @cindex tracepoints
12128 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12129 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12130 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12131 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12132 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12133 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12134 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12135
12136 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12137 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12138 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12139 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12140 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12141 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12142 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12143 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12144 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12145 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12146 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12147
12148 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12149 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12150 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12151 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12152 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12153 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12154 Packets}.
12155
12156 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12157 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12158 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12159
12160 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12161
12162 @menu
12163 * Set Tracepoints::
12164 * Analyze Collected Data::
12165 * Tracepoint Variables::
12166 * Trace Files::
12167 @end menu
12168
12169 @node Set Tracepoints
12170 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12171
12172 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12173 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12174 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12175 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12176 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12177 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12178 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12179
12180 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12181 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12182 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12183 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12184 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12185 tracepoint was hit.
12186
12187 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12188 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12189 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12190 either.
12191
12192 @cindex fast tracepoints
12193 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12194 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12195 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12196
12197 @cindex static tracepoints
12198 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12199 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12200 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12201 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12202 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12203 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12204 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12205 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12206 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12207 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12208 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12209 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12210 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12211 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12212 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12213 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12214 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12215 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12216 static tracepoint marker.
12217
12218 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12219 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12220
12221 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12222 conditions and actions.
12223
12224 @menu
12225 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12226 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12227 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12228 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12229 * Trace State Variables::
12230 * Tracepoint Actions::
12231 * Listing Tracepoints::
12232 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12233 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12234 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12235 @end menu
12236
12237 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12238 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12239
12240 @table @code
12241 @cindex set tracepoint
12242 @kindex trace
12243 @item trace @var{location}
12244 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12245 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12246 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12247 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12248 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12249 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12250 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12251 in tracing}).
12252 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12253 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12254 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12255 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12256 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12257 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12258 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12259 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12260 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12261 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12262 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12263 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12264
12265 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12266
12267 @smallexample
12268 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12269
12270 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12271
12272 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12273
12274 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12275
12276 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12277 @end smallexample
12278
12279 @noindent
12280 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12281
12282 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12283 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12284 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12285 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12286 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12287 information on tracepoint conditions.
12288
12289 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12290 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12291 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12292 @kindex ftrace
12293 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12294 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12295 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12296 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12297 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12298 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12299 message.
12300
12301 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12302 @code{trace}.
12303
12304 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12305 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12306 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12307 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12308 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12309 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12310 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12311 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12312
12313 @example
12314 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12315 @end example
12316
12317 @noindent
12318 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12319 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12320
12321 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12322 @cindex set static tracepoint
12323 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12324 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12325 @kindex strace
12326 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12327 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12328 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12329 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12330 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12331
12332 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12333 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12334 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12335 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12336 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12337 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12338 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12339 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12340 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12341 tracing engine:
12342
12343 @smallexample
12344 main ()
12345 @{
12346 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12347 @}
12348 @end smallexample
12349
12350 @noindent
12351 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12352 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12353
12354 @smallexample
12355 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12356 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12357 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12358 Data: "str %s"
12359 [etc...]
12360 @end smallexample
12361
12362 @noindent
12363 so you may probe the marker above with:
12364
12365 @smallexample
12366 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12367 @end smallexample
12368
12369 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12370 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12371 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12372 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12373 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12374 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12375 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12376 the @samp{Data:} field.
12377
12378 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12379 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12380 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12381
12382 @vindex $tpnum
12383 @cindex last tracepoint number
12384 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12385 @cindex tracepoint number
12386 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12387 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12388
12389 @kindex delete tracepoint
12390 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12391 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12392 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12393 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12394 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12395
12396 Examples:
12397
12398 @smallexample
12399 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12400
12401 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12402 @end smallexample
12403
12404 @noindent
12405 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12406 @end table
12407
12408 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12409 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12410
12411 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12412
12413 @table @code
12414 @kindex disable tracepoint
12415 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12416 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12417 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12418 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12419 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12420 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12421 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12422 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12423 next trace experiment.
12424
12425 @kindex enable tracepoint
12426 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12427 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12428 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12429 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12430 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12431 next time a trace experiment is run.
12432 @end table
12433
12434 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12435 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12436
12437 @table @code
12438 @kindex passcount
12439 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12440 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12441 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12442 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12443 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12444 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12445 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12446 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12447 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12448 user.
12449
12450 Examples:
12451
12452 @smallexample
12453 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12454 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12455
12456 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12457 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12458 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12459 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12460 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12461 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12462 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12463 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12464 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12465 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12466 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12467 @end smallexample
12468 @end table
12469
12470 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12471 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12472 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12473 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12474
12475 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12476 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12477 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12478 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12479 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12480 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12481 is true.
12482
12483 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12484 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12485 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12486 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12487 just as with breakpoints.
12488
12489 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12490 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12491 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12492 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12493 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12494 accesses, and so forth.
12495
12496 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12497 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12498 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12499 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12500 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12501 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12502 search through.
12503
12504 @smallexample
12505 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12506 @end smallexample
12507
12508 @node Trace State Variables
12509 @subsection Trace State Variables
12510 @cindex trace state variables
12511
12512 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12513 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12514 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12515 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12516 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12517 integers.
12518
12519 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12520 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12521 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12522 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12523
12524 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12525 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12526 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12527 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12528 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12529 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12530 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12531 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12532 variable with the same name.
12533
12534 @table @code
12535
12536 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12537 @kindex tvariable
12538 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12539 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12540 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12541 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12542 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12543 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12544 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12545 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12546 value. The default initial value is 0.
12547
12548 @item info tvariables
12549 @kindex info tvariables
12550 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12551 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12552 currently running.
12553
12554 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12555 @kindex delete tvariable
12556 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12557 are specified.
12558
12559 @end table
12560
12561 @node Tracepoint Actions
12562 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12563
12564 @table @code
12565 @kindex actions
12566 @cindex tracepoint actions
12567 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12568 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12569 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12570 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12571 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12572 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12573 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12574 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12575 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12576 @code{while-stepping}.
12577
12578 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12579 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12580 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12581
12582 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12583 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12584 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12585
12586 @smallexample
12587 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12588
12589 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12590
12591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12592 @end smallexample
12593
12594 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12595 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12596 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12597 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12598 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12599 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12600 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12601 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12602
12603 @smallexample
12604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12606 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12607 > collect bar,baz
12608 > collect $regs
12609 > while-stepping 12
12610 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12611 > end
12612 end
12613 @end smallexample
12614
12615 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12616 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12617 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12618 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12619 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12620 special arguments are supported:
12621
12622 @table @code
12623 @item $regs
12624 Collect all registers.
12625
12626 @item $args
12627 Collect all function arguments.
12628
12629 @item $locals
12630 Collect all local variables.
12631
12632 @item $_ret
12633 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12634 of a backtrace.
12635
12636 @item $_probe_argc
12637 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12638 tracepoint is located.
12639 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12640
12641 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12642 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12643 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12644 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12645
12646 @item $_sdata
12647 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12648 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12649 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12650 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12651 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12652 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12653 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12654 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12655 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12656
12657 @smallexample
12658 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12659 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12660 @end smallexample
12661
12662 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12663 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12664 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12665 @value{GDBN}.
12666 @end table
12667
12668 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12669 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12670 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12671
12672 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12673 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12674 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12675 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12676 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12677 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12678 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12679 @samp{mystr}.
12680
12681 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12682 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12683
12684 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12685 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12686 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12687 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12688 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12689 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12690 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12691 action were used.
12692
12693 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12694 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12695 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12696 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12697 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12698 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12699
12700 @smallexample
12701 > while-stepping 12
12702 > collect $regs, myglobal
12703 > end
12704 >
12705 @end smallexample
12706
12707 @noindent
12708 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12709 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12710 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12711 @code{stepping}.
12712
12713 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12714 @kindex set default-collect
12715 @cindex default collection action
12716 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12717 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12718 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12719 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12720 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12721 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12722
12723 @item show default-collect
12724 @kindex show default-collect
12725 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12726 tracepoint hit.
12727
12728 @end table
12729
12730 @node Listing Tracepoints
12731 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12732
12733 @table @code
12734 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12735 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12736 @cindex information about tracepoints
12737 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12738 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12739 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12740 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12741 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12742 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12743
12744 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12745 tracing:
12746
12747 @itemize @bullet
12748 @item
12749 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12750
12751 @item
12752 the state about installed on target of each location
12753 @end itemize
12754
12755 @smallexample
12756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12757 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12758 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12759 while-stepping 20
12760 collect globfoo, $regs
12761 end
12762 collect globfoo2
12763 end
12764 pass count 1200
12765 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12766 collect $eip
12767 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12768 installed on target
12769 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12770 installed on target
12771 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12772 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12773 not installed on target
12774 (@value{GDBP})
12775 @end smallexample
12776
12777 @noindent
12778 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12779 @end table
12780
12781 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12782 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12783
12784 @table @code
12785 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12786 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12787 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12788 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12789 program.
12790
12791 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12792
12793 @table @emph
12794 @item Count
12795 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12796 stable identifier.
12797 @item ID
12798 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12799 @item Enabled or Disabled
12800 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12801 that are not enabled.
12802 @item Address
12803 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12804 @item What
12805 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12806 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12807 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12808 will be left blank.
12809 @end table
12810
12811 @noindent
12812 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12813
12814 @table @emph
12815 @item Data
12816 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12817 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12818 marker call.
12819 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12820 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12821 @end table
12822
12823 @smallexample
12824 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12825 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12826 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12827 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12828 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12829 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12830 Data: str %s
12831 (@value{GDBP})
12832 @end smallexample
12833 @end table
12834
12835 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12836 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12837
12838 @table @code
12839 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12840 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12841 @cindex collected data discarded
12842 @item tstart
12843 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12844 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12845 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12846 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12847 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12848 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12849 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12850 information, and so forth.
12851
12852 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12853 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12854 @item tstop
12855 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12856 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12857 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12858 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12859 needs to be stopped quickly.
12860
12861 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12862 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12863 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12864
12865 @kindex tstatus
12866 @cindex status of trace data collection
12867 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12868 @item tstatus
12869 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12870 collection.
12871 @end table
12872
12873 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12874
12875 @smallexample
12876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12877 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12878 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12879 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12880 > while-stepping 11
12881 > collect $regs
12882 > end
12883 > end
12884 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12885 [time passes @dots{}]
12886 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12887 @end smallexample
12888
12889 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12890 @cindex disconnected tracing
12891 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12892 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12893 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12894 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12895 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12896 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12897 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12898 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12899
12900 @table @code
12901 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12902 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12903 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12904 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12905 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12906 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12907 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12908 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12909
12910 @item show disconnected-tracing
12911 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12912 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12913
12914 @end table
12915
12916 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12917 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12918 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12919 it will continue after reconnection.
12920
12921 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12922 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12923 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12924 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12925 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12926 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12927 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12928 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12929 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12930 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12931
12932 @cindex circular trace buffer
12933 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12934 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12935 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12936 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12937 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12938 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12939 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12940 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12941 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12942 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12943 the next run.
12944
12945 @table @code
12946 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12947 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12948 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12949 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12950 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12951 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12952 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12953
12954 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12955 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12956 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12957 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12958 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12959 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12960
12961 @end table
12962
12963 @table @code
12964 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12965 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12966 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12967 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12968 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12969 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12970 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12971 likes. This is also the default.
12972
12973 @item show trace-buffer-size
12974 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12975 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12976 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12977 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12978 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12979 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12980 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12981 @end table
12982
12983 @table @code
12984 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12985 @kindex set trace-user
12986
12987 @item show trace-user
12988 @kindex show trace-user
12989
12990 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12991 @kindex set trace-notes
12992 Set the trace run's notes.
12993
12994 @item show trace-notes
12995 @kindex show trace-notes
12996 Show the trace run's notes.
12997
12998 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12999 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13000 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13001 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13002 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13003
13004 @item show trace-stop-notes
13005 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13006 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13007
13008 @end table
13009
13010 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13011 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13012
13013 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13014 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13015 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13016 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13017 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13018 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13019 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13020 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13021 mentioned here.
13022
13023 @itemize @bullet
13024
13025 @item
13026 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13027 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13028 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13029 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13030 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13031 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13032 cannot be collected either.
13033
13034 @item
13035 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13036 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13037 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13038 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13039 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13040 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13041 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13042 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13043 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13044 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13045
13046 @item
13047 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13048 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13049 in a misleading way.
13050
13051 @item
13052 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13053 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13054 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13055 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13056 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13057 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13058 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13059 by @code{ptr}.
13060
13061 @item
13062 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13063 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13064 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13065 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13066 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13067 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13068 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13069 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13070 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13071 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13072 invalid address.
13073
13074 @item
13075 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13076 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13077 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13078 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13079 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13080 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13081 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13082 it to zero.
13083
13084 @end itemize
13085
13086 @node Analyze Collected Data
13087 @section Using the Collected Data
13088
13089 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13090 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13091 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13092 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13093 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13094 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13095 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13096 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13097 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13098 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13099 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13100 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13101 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13102 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13103 the buffer will fail.
13104
13105 @menu
13106 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13107 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13108 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13109 @end menu
13110
13111 @node tfind
13112 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13113
13114 @kindex tfind
13115 @cindex select trace snapshot
13116 @cindex find trace snapshot
13117 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13118 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13119 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13120 snapshot is selected.
13121
13122 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13123
13124 @table @code
13125 @item tfind start
13126 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13127 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13128
13129 @item tfind none
13130 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13131
13132 @item tfind end
13133 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13134
13135 @item tfind
13136 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
13137
13138 @item tfind -
13139 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13140 retracing earlier steps.
13141
13142 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13143 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13144 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13145 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13146 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13147
13148 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13149 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13150 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13151 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13152 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13153
13154 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13155 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13156 addresses (exclusive).
13157
13158 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13159 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13160 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13161
13162 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13163 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13164 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13165 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13166 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13167 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13168 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13169 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13170 @end table
13171
13172 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13173 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13174 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13175 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13176 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13177 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13178 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13179 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13180 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13181 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13182 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13183 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13184 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13185 tracepoint as the current one.
13186
13187 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13188 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13189 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13190 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13191 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13192
13193 @smallexample
13194 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13195 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13196 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13197 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13198 > tfind
13199 > end
13200
13201 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13202 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13203 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13204 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13205 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13206 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13207 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13208 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13209 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13210 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13211 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13212 @end smallexample
13213
13214 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13215 the buffer:
13216
13217 @smallexample
13218 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13219 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13220 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13221 > tfind line
13222 > end
13223
13224 Frame 0, X = 1
13225 Frame 7, X = 2
13226 Frame 13, X = 255
13227 @end smallexample
13228
13229 @node tdump
13230 @subsection @code{tdump}
13231 @kindex tdump
13232 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13233 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13234
13235 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13236 the current trace snapshot.
13237
13238 @smallexample
13239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13240 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13241 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13242 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13243 > end
13244
13245 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13246
13247 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13248 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13249 at gdb_test.c:444
13250 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13251
13252 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13253 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13254 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13255 d1 0x18 24
13256 d2 0x80 128
13257 d3 0x33 51
13258 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13259 d5 0x22 34
13260 d6 0xe0 224
13261 d7 0x380035 3670069
13262 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13263 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13264 a2 0x100 256
13265 a3 0x322000 3284992
13266 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13267 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13268 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13269 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13270 ps 0x0 0
13271 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13272 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13273 fpstatus 0x0 0
13274 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13275 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13276 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13277 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13278 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13279 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13280 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13281 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13282 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13283
13284 (@value{GDBP})
13285 @end smallexample
13286
13287 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13288 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13289 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13290 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13291
13292 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13293 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13294 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13295 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13296 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13297 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13298 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13299 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13300 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13301 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13302
13303 @node save tracepoints
13304 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13305 @kindex save tracepoints
13306 @kindex save-tracepoints
13307 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13308
13309 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13310 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13311 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13312 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13313 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13314 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13315
13316 @node Tracepoint Variables
13317 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13318 @cindex tracepoint variables
13319 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13320
13321 @table @code
13322 @vindex $trace_frame
13323 @item (int) $trace_frame
13324 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13325 snapshot is selected.
13326
13327 @vindex $tracepoint
13328 @item (int) $tracepoint
13329 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13330
13331 @vindex $trace_line
13332 @item (int) $trace_line
13333 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13334
13335 @vindex $trace_file
13336 @item (char []) $trace_file
13337 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13338
13339 @vindex $trace_func
13340 @item (char []) $trace_func
13341 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13342 @end table
13343
13344 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13345 use @code{output} instead.
13346
13347 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13348 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13349 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13350 which are managed by the target.
13351
13352 @smallexample
13353 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13354
13355 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13356 > output $trace_file
13357 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13358 > tfind
13359 > end
13360 @end smallexample
13361
13362 @node Trace Files
13363 @section Using Trace Files
13364 @cindex trace files
13365
13366 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13367 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13368 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13369 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13370 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13371
13372 @table @code
13373
13374 @kindex tsave
13375 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13376 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13377 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13378 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13379 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13380 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13381 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13382 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13383 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13384 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13385 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13386 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13387 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13388 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13389 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13390
13391 @kindex target tfile
13392 @kindex tfile
13393 @kindex target ctf
13394 @kindex ctf
13395 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13396 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13397 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13398 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13399 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13400 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13401 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13402 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13403 the host.
13404
13405 @smallexample
13406 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13407 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13408 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13409 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13410 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13411 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13412 i = 0
13413 a = 0
13414 b = 1 '\001'
13415 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13416 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13417 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13418 $1 = 1
13419 @end smallexample
13420
13421 @end table
13422
13423 @node Overlays
13424 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13425 @cindex overlays
13426
13427 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13428 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13429 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13430 use overlays.
13431
13432 @menu
13433 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13434 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13435 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13436 mapped by asking the inferior.
13437 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13438 @end menu
13439
13440 @node How Overlays Work
13441 @section How Overlays Work
13442 @cindex mapped overlays
13443 @cindex unmapped overlays
13444 @cindex load address, overlay's
13445 @cindex mapped address
13446 @cindex overlay area
13447
13448 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13449 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13450 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13451 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13452 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13453
13454 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13455 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13456 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13457 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13458 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13459 largest overlay as well.
13460
13461 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13462 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13463 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13464 there.
13465
13466 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13467 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13468 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13469
13470 @smallexample
13471 @group
13472 Data Instruction Larger
13473 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13474 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13475 | | | | | |
13476 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13477 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13478 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13479 | and heap | | | | | |
13480 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13481 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13482 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13483 | | | | | |
13484 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13485 address | | | | | |
13486 | overlay | <-' | | |
13487 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13488 | | <---. | | load address
13489 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13490 | | | |
13491 +-----------+ | |
13492 +-----------+
13493 | |
13494 +-----------+
13495
13496 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13497 @end group
13498 @end smallexample
13499
13500 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13501 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13502 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13503 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13504 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13505 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13506 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13507 program and the overlay area.
13508
13509 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13510 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13511 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13512 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13513 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13514 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13515 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13516
13517 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13518 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13519 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13520
13521 @itemize @bullet
13522
13523 @item
13524 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13525 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13526 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13527 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13528
13529 @item
13530 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13531 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13532 your program's performance.
13533
13534 @item
13535 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13536 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13537 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13538 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13539 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13540 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13541 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13542
13543 @item
13544 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13545 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13546 instruction and data spaces.
13547
13548 @end itemize
13549
13550 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13551 improved in many ways:
13552
13553 @itemize @bullet
13554
13555 @item
13556 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13557 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13558 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13559 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13560 area in the usual way.
13561
13562 @item
13563 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13564 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13565
13566 @item
13567 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13568 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13569 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13570 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13571 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13572 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13573 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13574
13575 @end itemize
13576
13577
13578 @node Overlay Commands
13579 @section Overlay Commands
13580
13581 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13582 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13583 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13584 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13585 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13586 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13587
13588 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13589 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13590
13591 @table @code
13592 @item overlay off
13593 @kindex overlay
13594 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13595 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13596 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13597 overlay support is disabled.
13598
13599 @item overlay manual
13600 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13601 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13602 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13603 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13604 commands described below.
13605
13606 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13607 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13608 @cindex map an overlay
13609 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13610 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13611 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13612 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13613 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13614 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13615
13616 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13617 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13618 @cindex unmap an overlay
13619 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13620 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13621 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13622 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13623
13624 @item overlay auto
13625 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13626 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13627 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13628 Overlay Debugging}.
13629
13630 @item overlay load-target
13631 @itemx overlay load
13632 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13633 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13634 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13635 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13636 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13637 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13638
13639 @item overlay list-overlays
13640 @itemx overlay list
13641 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13642 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13643 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13644
13645 @end table
13646
13647 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13648 of the function the address falls in:
13649
13650 @smallexample
13651 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13652 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13653 @end smallexample
13654 @noindent
13655 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13656 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13657 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13658 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13659
13660 @smallexample
13661 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13662 No sections are mapped.
13663 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13664 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13665 @end smallexample
13666 @noindent
13667 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13668 name normally:
13669
13670 @smallexample
13671 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13672 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13673 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13674 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13675 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13676 @end smallexample
13677
13678 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13679 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13680 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13681 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13682 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13683
13684 @itemize @bullet
13685 @item
13686 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13687 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13688 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13689 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13690 @item
13691 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13692 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13693 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13694 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13695 breakpoints properly.
13696 @end itemize
13697
13698
13699 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13700 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13701 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13702
13703 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13704 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13705 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13706 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13707 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13708 current state of the overlays.
13709
13710 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13711 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13712
13713 @table @asis
13714
13715 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13716 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13717
13718 @smallexample
13719 struct
13720 @{
13721 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13722 unsigned long vma;
13723
13724 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13725 unsigned long size;
13726
13727 /* The overlay's load address. */
13728 unsigned long lma;
13729
13730 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13731 zero otherwise. */
13732 unsigned long mapped;
13733 @}
13734 @end smallexample
13735
13736 @item @code{_novlys}:
13737 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13738 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13739
13740 @end table
13741
13742 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13743 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13744 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13745 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13746 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13747 currently mapped.
13748
13749 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13750 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13751 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13752 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13753 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13754 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13755 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13756 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13757 are not being executed.
13758
13759 @node Overlay Sample Program
13760 @section Overlay Sample Program
13761 @cindex overlay example program
13762
13763 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13764 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13765 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13766 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13767 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13768 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13769 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13770
13771 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13772 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13773 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13774 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13775
13776 @table @file
13777 @item overlays.c
13778 The main program file.
13779 @item ovlymgr.c
13780 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13781 @item foo.c
13782 @itemx bar.c
13783 @itemx baz.c
13784 @itemx grbx.c
13785 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13786 @item d10v.ld
13787 @itemx m32r.ld
13788 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13789 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13790 @end table
13791
13792 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13793 cross-compiler like this:
13794
13795 @smallexample
13796 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13797 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13798 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13799 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13800 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13801 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13802 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13803 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13804 @end smallexample
13805
13806 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13807 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13808 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13809
13810
13811 @node Languages
13812 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13813 @cindex languages
13814
13815 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13816 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13817 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13818 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13819 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13820 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13821
13822 @cindex working language
13823 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13824 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13825 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13826 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13827 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13828 language}.
13829
13830 @menu
13831 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13832 * Show:: Displaying the language
13833 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13834 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13835 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13836 @end menu
13837
13838 @node Setting
13839 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13840
13841 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13842 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13843 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13844 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13845 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13846 are printed, etc.
13847
13848 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13849 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13850 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13851 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13852 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13853 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13854 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13855 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13856 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13857 Displaying the Language}.
13858
13859 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13860 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13861 another language. In that case, make the
13862 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13863 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13864 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13865
13866 @menu
13867 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13868 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13869 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13870 @end menu
13871
13872 @node Filenames
13873 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13874
13875 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13876 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13877
13878 @table @file
13879 @item .ada
13880 @itemx .ads
13881 @itemx .adb
13882 @itemx .a
13883 Ada source file.
13884
13885 @item .c
13886 C source file
13887
13888 @item .C
13889 @itemx .cc
13890 @itemx .cp
13891 @itemx .cpp
13892 @itemx .cxx
13893 @itemx .c++
13894 C@t{++} source file
13895
13896 @item .d
13897 D source file
13898
13899 @item .m
13900 Objective-C source file
13901
13902 @item .f
13903 @itemx .F
13904 Fortran source file
13905
13906 @item .mod
13907 Modula-2 source file
13908
13909 @item .s
13910 @itemx .S
13911 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13912 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13913 @end table
13914
13915 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13916 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13917
13918 @node Manually
13919 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13920
13921 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13922 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13923 your program.
13924
13925 @kindex set language
13926 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13927 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13928 a language, such as
13929 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13930 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13931
13932 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13933 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13934 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13935 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13936 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13937 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13938 command such as:
13939
13940 @smallexample
13941 print a = b + c
13942 @end smallexample
13943
13944 @noindent
13945 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13946 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13947 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13948 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13949
13950 @node Automatically
13951 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13952
13953 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13954 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13955 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13956 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13957 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13958 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13959 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13960 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13961 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13962
13963 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13964 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13965 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13966 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13967 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13968
13969 @node Show
13970 @section Displaying the Language
13971
13972 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13973 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13974
13975 @table @code
13976 @item show language
13977 @anchor{show language}
13978 @kindex show language
13979 Display the current working language. This is the
13980 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13981 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13982
13983 @item info frame
13984 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13985 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13986 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13987 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13988 information listed here.
13989
13990 @item info source
13991 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13992 Display the source language of this source file.
13993 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13994 information listed here.
13995 @end table
13996
13997 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13998 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13999 with a language explicitly:
14000
14001 @table @code
14002 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14003 @kindex set extension-language
14004 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14005 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14006
14007 @item info extensions
14008 @kindex info extensions
14009 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14010 @end table
14011
14012 @node Checks
14013 @section Type and Range Checking
14014
14015 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14016 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14017 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14018 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14019 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14020 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14021 errors when your program is running.
14022
14023 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14024 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14025 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14026 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14027
14028 @menu
14029 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14030 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14031 @end menu
14032
14033 @cindex type checking
14034 @cindex checks, type
14035 @node Type Checking
14036 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14037
14038 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14039 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14040 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14041 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14042
14043 @smallexample
14044 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14045
14046 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14047 $1 = 2
14048 @exdent but
14049 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14050 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14051 @end smallexample
14052
14053 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14054 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14055
14056 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14057 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14058 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14059 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14060 expressions like the second example above.
14061
14062 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14063 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14064 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14065 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14066 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14067 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14068
14069 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14070
14071 @kindex set check type
14072 @kindex show check type
14073 @table @code
14074 @item set check type on
14075 @itemx set check type off
14076 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14077 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14078 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14079
14080 @item show check type
14081 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14082 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14083 @end table
14084
14085 @cindex range checking
14086 @cindex checks, range
14087 @node Range Checking
14088 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14089
14090 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14091 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14092 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14093 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14094 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14095
14096 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14097 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14098 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14099 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14100
14101 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14102 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14103 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14104 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14105 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14106 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14107
14108 @smallexample
14109 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14110 @end smallexample
14111
14112 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14113 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14114 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14115
14116 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14117
14118 @kindex set check range
14119 @kindex show check range
14120 @table @code
14121 @item set check range auto
14122 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14123 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14124 each language.
14125
14126 @item set check range on
14127 @itemx set check range off
14128 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14129 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14130 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14131 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14132
14133 @item set check range warn
14134 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14135 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14136 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14137 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14138 systems).
14139
14140 @item show range
14141 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14142 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14143 @end table
14144
14145 @node Supported Languages
14146 @section Supported Languages
14147
14148 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14149 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14150 @c This is false ...
14151 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14152 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14153 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14154 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14155 language.
14156
14157 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14158 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14159 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14160 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14161 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14162 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14163 language reference or tutorial.
14164
14165 @menu
14166 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14167 * D:: D
14168 * Go:: Go
14169 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14170 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14171 * Fortran:: Fortran
14172 * Pascal:: Pascal
14173 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14174 * Ada:: Ada
14175 @end menu
14176
14177 @node C
14178 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14179
14180 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14181 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14182
14183 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14184 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14185 together.
14186
14187 @cindex C@t{++}
14188 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14189 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14190 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14191 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14192 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14193 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14194 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14195
14196 @menu
14197 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14198 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14199 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14200 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14201 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14202 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14203 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14204 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14205 @end menu
14206
14207 @node C Operators
14208 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14209
14210 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14211
14212 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14213 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14214 often defined on groups of types.
14215
14216 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14217
14218 @itemize @bullet
14219
14220 @item
14221 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14222 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14223
14224 @item
14225 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14226 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14227
14228 @item
14229 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14230
14231 @item
14232 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14233
14234 @end itemize
14235
14236 @noindent
14237 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14238 in order of increasing precedence:
14239
14240 @table @code
14241 @item ,
14242 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14243 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14244 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14245
14246 @item =
14247 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14248 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14249
14250 @item @var{op}=
14251 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14252 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14253 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14254 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14255 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14256
14257 @item ?:
14258 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14259 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14260 should be of an integral type.
14261
14262 @item ||
14263 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14264
14265 @item &&
14266 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14267
14268 @item |
14269 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14270
14271 @item ^
14272 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14273
14274 @item &
14275 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14276
14277 @item ==@r{, }!=
14278 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14279 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14280
14281 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14282 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14283 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14284 and non-zero for true.
14285
14286 @item <<@r{, }>>
14287 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14288
14289 @item @@
14290 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14291
14292 @item +@r{, }-
14293 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14294 pointer types.
14295
14296 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14297 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14298 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14299 integral types.
14300
14301 @item ++@r{, }--
14302 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14303 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14304 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14305 operation takes place.
14306
14307 @item *
14308 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14309 @code{++}.
14310
14311 @item &
14312 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14313
14314 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14315 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14316 to examine the address
14317 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14318 stored.
14319
14320 @item -
14321 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14322 precedence as @code{++}.
14323
14324 @item !
14325 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14326 @code{++}.
14327
14328 @item ~
14329 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14330 @code{++}.
14331
14332
14333 @item .@r{, }->
14334 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14335 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14336 pointer based on the stored type information.
14337 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14338
14339 @item .*@r{, }->*
14340 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14341
14342 @item []
14343 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14344 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14345
14346 @item ()
14347 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14348
14349 @item ::
14350 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14351 and @code{class} types.
14352
14353 @item ::
14354 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14355 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14356 above.
14357 @end table
14358
14359 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14360 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14361 predefined meaning.
14362
14363 @node C Constants
14364 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14365
14366 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14367
14368 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14369 following ways:
14370
14371 @itemize @bullet
14372 @item
14373 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14374 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14375 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14376 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14377 @code{long} value.
14378
14379 @item
14380 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14381 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14382 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14383 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14384 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14385 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14386 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14387 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14388 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14389 constant.
14390
14391 @item
14392 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14393 integral equivalents.
14394
14395 @item
14396 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14397 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14398 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14399 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14400 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14401 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14402 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14403 @samp{\n} for newline.
14404
14405 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14406 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14407 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14408 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14409
14410 @item
14411 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14412 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14413 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14414 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14415 characters.
14416
14417 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14418 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14419 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14420
14421 @item
14422 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14423 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14424
14425 @item
14426 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14427 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14428 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14429 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14430 @end itemize
14431
14432 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14433 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14434
14435 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14436 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14437
14438 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14439 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14440 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14441 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14442 @quotation
14443 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14444 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14445 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14446 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14447 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14448 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14449 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14450 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14451 @end quotation
14452
14453 @enumerate
14454
14455 @cindex member functions
14456 @item
14457 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14458
14459 @smallexample
14460 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14461 @end smallexample
14462
14463 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14464 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14465 @item
14466 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14467 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14468 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14469 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14470 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14471
14472 @cindex call overloaded functions
14473 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14474 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14475 @item
14476 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14477 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14478 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14479 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14480 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14481 default arguments.
14482
14483 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14484 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14485 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14486 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14487 number of function arguments.
14488
14489 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14490 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14491 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14492
14493 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14494 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14495 @smallexample
14496 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14497 @end smallexample
14498
14499 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14500 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14501
14502 @cindex reference declarations
14503 @item
14504 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14505 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14506 dereferenced.
14507
14508 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14509 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14510 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14511 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14512 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14513
14514 @item
14515 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14516 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14517 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14518 necessary, for example in an expression like
14519 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14520 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14521 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14522
14523 @item
14524 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14525 specification.
14526 @end enumerate
14527
14528 @node C Defaults
14529 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14530
14531 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14532
14533 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14534 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14535 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14536 selects the working language.
14537
14538 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14539 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14540 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14541 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14542 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14543 for further details.
14544
14545 @node C Checks
14546 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14547
14548 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14549
14550 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14551 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14552 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14553 constants to pointers.
14554
14555 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14556 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14557 that is not itself an array.
14558
14559 @node Debugging C
14560 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14561
14562 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14563 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14564 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14565 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14566
14567 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14568 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14569 ,Expressions}.
14570
14571 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14572 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14573
14574 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14575
14576 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14577 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14578
14579 @table @code
14580 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14581 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14582 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14583 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14584 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14585 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14586
14587 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14588 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14589 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14590 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14591 classes.
14592 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14593
14594 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14595 @item catch throw
14596 @itemx catch rethrow
14597 @itemx catch catch
14598 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14599 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14600
14601 @cindex inheritance
14602 @item ptype @var{typename}
14603 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14604 @var{typename}.
14605 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14606
14607 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14608 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14609 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14610 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14611 multiple inheritance is in use.
14612
14613 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14614 @item demangle @var{name}
14615 Demangle @var{name}.
14616 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14617
14618 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14619 @item set print demangle
14620 @itemx show print demangle
14621 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14622 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14623 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14624 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14625 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14626
14627 @item set print object
14628 @itemx show print object
14629 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14630 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14631
14632 @item set print vtbl
14633 @itemx show print vtbl
14634 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14635 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14636 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14637 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14638
14639 @kindex set overload-resolution
14640 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14641 @item set overload-resolution on
14642 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14643 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14644 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14645 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14646 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14647 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14648
14649 @item set overload-resolution off
14650 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14651 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14652 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14653 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14654 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14655 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14656 argument types.
14657
14658 @kindex show overload-resolution
14659 @item show overload-resolution
14660 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14661
14662 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14663 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14664 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14665 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14666 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14667 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14668 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14669 @end table
14670
14671 @node Decimal Floating Point
14672 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14673 @cindex decimal floating point format
14674
14675 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14676 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14677 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14678 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14679
14680 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14681 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14682 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14683 configured target.
14684
14685 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14686 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14687 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14688
14689 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14690 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14691 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14692
14693 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14694 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14695 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14696
14697 @node D
14698 @subsection D
14699
14700 @cindex D
14701 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14702 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14703 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14704
14705 @node Go
14706 @subsection Go
14707
14708 @cindex Go (programming language)
14709 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14710 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14711
14712 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14713
14714 @table @code
14715 @cindex current Go package
14716 @item The current Go package
14717 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14718 specifying global variables and functions.
14719
14720 For example, given the program:
14721
14722 @example
14723 package main
14724 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14725 func main () @{
14726 // ...
14727 @}
14728 @end example
14729
14730 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14731
14732 @example
14733 (gdb) p myglob
14734 (gdb) p main.myglob
14735 @end example
14736
14737 @cindex builtin Go types
14738 @item Builtin Go types
14739 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14740 as a string.
14741
14742 @cindex builtin Go functions
14743 @item Builtin Go functions
14744 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14745 function and handles it internally.
14746
14747 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14748 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14749 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14750 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14751 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14752 @end table
14753
14754 @node Objective-C
14755 @subsection Objective-C
14756
14757 @cindex Objective-C
14758 This section provides information about some commands and command
14759 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14760 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14761 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14762
14763 @menu
14764 * Method Names in Commands::
14765 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14766 @end menu
14767
14768 @node Method Names in Commands
14769 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14770
14771 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14772 names as line specifications:
14773
14774 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14775 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14776 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14777 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14778 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14779 @itemize
14780 @item @code{clear}
14781 @item @code{break}
14782 @item @code{info line}
14783 @item @code{jump}
14784 @item @code{list}
14785 @end itemize
14786
14787 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14788
14789 @smallexample
14790 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14791 @end smallexample
14792
14793 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14794 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14795 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14796 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14797 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14798 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14799 debugged, enter:
14800
14801 @smallexample
14802 break -[Fruit create]
14803 @end smallexample
14804
14805 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14806 enter:
14807
14808 @smallexample
14809 list +[NSText initialize]
14810 @end smallexample
14811
14812 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14813 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14814 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14815 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14816
14817 @smallexample
14818 break create
14819 @end smallexample
14820
14821 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14822 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14823 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14824 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14825 none apply.
14826
14827 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14828 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14829
14830 @smallexample
14831 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14832 @end smallexample
14833
14834 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14835 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14836 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14837 @kindex print-object
14838 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14839
14840 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14841
14842 @smallexample
14843 print -[@var{object} hash]
14844 @end smallexample
14845
14846 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14847 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14848 @noindent
14849 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14850 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14851 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14852 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14853 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14854 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14855
14856 @node OpenCL C
14857 @subsection OpenCL C
14858
14859 @cindex OpenCL C
14860 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14861
14862 @menu
14863 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14864 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14865 * OpenCL C Operators::
14866 @end menu
14867
14868 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14869 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14870
14871 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14872 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14873 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14874 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14875 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14876
14877 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14878 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14879
14880 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14881 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14882 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14883 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14884
14885 @node OpenCL C Operators
14886 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14887
14888 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14889 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14890 vector data types.
14891
14892 @node Fortran
14893 @subsection Fortran
14894 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14895
14896 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14897 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14898
14899 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14900 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14901 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14902 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14903 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14904 underscore.
14905
14906 @menu
14907 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14908 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14909 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14910 @end menu
14911
14912 @node Fortran Operators
14913 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14914
14915 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14916
14917 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14918 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14919 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14920
14921 @table @code
14922 @item **
14923 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14924 of the second one.
14925
14926 @item :
14927 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14928 represent a section of array.
14929
14930 @item %
14931 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14932 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14933 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14934 union type.
14935 @end table
14936
14937 @node Fortran Defaults
14938 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14939
14940 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14941
14942 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14943 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14944 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14945 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14946
14947 @node Special Fortran Commands
14948 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14949
14950 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14951
14952 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14953 such as displaying common blocks.
14954
14955 @table @code
14956 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14957 @kindex info common
14958 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14959 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14960 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14961 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14962 printed.
14963 @end table
14964
14965 @node Pascal
14966 @subsection Pascal
14967
14968 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14969 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14970 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14971 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14972 syntax.
14973
14974 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14975 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14976 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14977
14978 @node Modula-2
14979 @subsection Modula-2
14980
14981 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14982
14983 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14984 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14985 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14986 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14987 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14988 table.
14989
14990 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14991 @menu
14992 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14993 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14994 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14995 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14996 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14997 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14998 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14999 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15000 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15001 @end menu
15002
15003 @node M2 Operators
15004 @subsubsection Operators
15005 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15006
15007 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15008 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15009 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15010 following definitions hold:
15011
15012 @itemize @bullet
15013
15014 @item
15015 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15016 their subranges.
15017
15018 @item
15019 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15020
15021 @item
15022 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15023
15024 @item
15025 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15026 @var{type}}.
15027
15028 @item
15029 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15030
15031 @item
15032 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15033
15034 @item
15035 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15036 @end itemize
15037
15038 @noindent
15039 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15040 increasing precedence:
15041
15042 @table @code
15043 @item ,
15044 Function argument or array index separator.
15045
15046 @item :=
15047 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15048 @var{value}.
15049
15050 @item <@r{, }>
15051 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15052 types.
15053
15054 @item <=@r{, }>=
15055 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15056 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15057 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15058
15059 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15060 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15061 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15062 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15063 comment character.
15064
15065 @item IN
15066 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15067 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15068
15069 @item OR
15070 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15071
15072 @item AND@r{, }&
15073 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15074
15075 @item @@
15076 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15077
15078 @item +@r{, }-
15079 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15080 and difference on set types.
15081
15082 @item *
15083 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15084 on set types.
15085
15086 @item /
15087 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15088 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15089
15090 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15091 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15092 precedence as @code{*}.
15093
15094 @item -
15095 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15096
15097 @item ^
15098 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15099
15100 @item NOT
15101 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15102 @code{^}.
15103
15104 @item .
15105 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15106 precedence as @code{^}.
15107
15108 @item []
15109 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15110
15111 @item ()
15112 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15113 as @code{^}.
15114
15115 @item ::@r{, }.
15116 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15117 @end table
15118
15119 @quotation
15120 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15121 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15122 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15123 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15124 @end quotation
15125
15126
15127 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15128 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15129 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15130
15131 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15132 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15133
15134 @table @var
15135
15136 @item a
15137 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15138
15139 @item c
15140 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15141
15142 @item i
15143 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15144
15145 @item m
15146 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15147 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15148 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15149
15150 @item n
15151 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15152
15153 @item r
15154 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15155
15156 @item t
15157 represents a type.
15158
15159 @item v
15160 represents a variable.
15161
15162 @item x
15163 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15164 explanation of the function for details.
15165 @end table
15166
15167 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15168
15169 @table @code
15170 @item ABS(@var{n})
15171 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15172
15173 @item CAP(@var{c})
15174 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15175 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15176
15177 @item CHR(@var{i})
15178 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15179
15180 @item DEC(@var{v})
15181 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15182
15183 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15184 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15185 new value.
15186
15187 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15188 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15189 set.
15190
15191 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15192 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15193
15194 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15195 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15196
15197 @item INC(@var{v})
15198 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15199
15200 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15201 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15202 new value.
15203
15204 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15205 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15206 there. Returns the new set.
15207
15208 @item MAX(@var{t})
15209 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15210
15211 @item MIN(@var{t})
15212 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15213
15214 @item ODD(@var{i})
15215 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15216
15217 @item ORD(@var{x})
15218 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15219 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15220 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15221 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15222
15223 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15224 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15225 variable or a type.
15226
15227 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15228 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15229
15230 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15231 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15232 variable or a type.
15233
15234 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15235 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15236 @end table
15237
15238 @quotation
15239 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15240 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15241 an error.
15242 @end quotation
15243
15244 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15245 @node M2 Constants
15246 @subsubsection Constants
15247
15248 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15249 ways:
15250
15251 @itemize @bullet
15252
15253 @item
15254 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15255 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15256 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15257 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15258
15259 @item
15260 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15261 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15262 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15263 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15264 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15265 digits.
15266
15267 @item
15268 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15269 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15270 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15271 followed by a @samp{C}.
15272
15273 @item
15274 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15275 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15276 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15277 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15278 sequences.
15279
15280 @item
15281 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15282
15283 @item
15284 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15285 @code{FALSE}.
15286
15287 @item
15288 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15289
15290 @item
15291 Set constants are not yet supported.
15292 @end itemize
15293
15294 @node M2 Types
15295 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15296 @cindex Modula-2 types
15297
15298 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15299 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15300 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15301 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15302 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15303 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15304
15305 The first example contains the following section of code:
15306
15307 @smallexample
15308 VAR
15309 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15310 r: [20..40] ;
15311 @end smallexample
15312
15313 @noindent
15314 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15315 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15316
15317 @smallexample
15318 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15319 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15320 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15321 SET OF CHAR
15322 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15323 21
15324 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15325 [20..40]
15326 @end smallexample
15327
15328 @noindent
15329 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15330
15331 @smallexample
15332 VAR
15333 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15334 @end smallexample
15335
15336 @noindent
15337 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15338
15339 @smallexample
15340 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15341 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15342 @end smallexample
15343
15344 @noindent
15345 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15346 expressions using the debugger.
15347
15348 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15349 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15350
15351 @smallexample
15352 VAR
15353 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15354 @end smallexample
15355
15356 @smallexample
15357 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15358 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15359 @end smallexample
15360
15361 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15362 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15363 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15364 above.
15365
15366 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15367
15368 @smallexample
15369 TYPE
15370 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15371 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15372 VAR
15373 s: t ;
15374 BEGIN
15375 s := blue ;
15376 @end smallexample
15377
15378 @noindent
15379 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15380 and value of a variable.
15381
15382 @smallexample
15383 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15384 $1 = blue
15385 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15386 type = [blue..yellow]
15387 @end smallexample
15388
15389 @noindent
15390 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15391 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15392 their @code{C} counterparts.
15393
15394 @smallexample
15395 VAR
15396 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15397 BEGIN
15398 s[1] := 1 ;
15399 @end smallexample
15400
15401 @smallexample
15402 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15403 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15404 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15405 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15406 @end smallexample
15407
15408 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15409 pointer types as shown in this example:
15410
15411 @smallexample
15412 VAR
15413 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15414 BEGIN
15415 NEW(s) ;
15416 s^[1] := 1 ;
15417 @end smallexample
15418
15419 @noindent
15420 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15421
15422 @smallexample
15423 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15424 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15425 @end smallexample
15426
15427 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15428 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15429 types:
15430
15431 @smallexample
15432 TYPE
15433 foo = RECORD
15434 f1: CARDINAL ;
15435 f2: CHAR ;
15436 f3: myarray ;
15437 END ;
15438
15439 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15440 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15441 VAR
15442 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15443 @end smallexample
15444
15445 @noindent
15446 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15447 below.
15448
15449 @smallexample
15450 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15451 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15452 f1 : CARDINAL;
15453 f2 : CHAR;
15454 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15455 END
15456 @end smallexample
15457
15458 @node M2 Defaults
15459 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15460 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15461
15462 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15463 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15464 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15465 selected the working language.
15466
15467 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15468 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15469 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15470 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15471
15472 @node Deviations
15473 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15474 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15475
15476 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15477 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15478
15479 @itemize @bullet
15480 @item
15481 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15482 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15483 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15484 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15485 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15486 returned a pointer.)
15487
15488 @item
15489 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15490 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15491 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15492 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15493
15494 @item
15495 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15496 argument.
15497
15498 @item
15499 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15500 @end itemize
15501
15502 @node M2 Checks
15503 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15504 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15505
15506 @quotation
15507 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15508 range checking.
15509 @end quotation
15510 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15511
15512 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15513
15514 @itemize @bullet
15515 @item
15516 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15517 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15518
15519 @item
15520 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15521 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15522 @end itemize
15523
15524 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15525 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15526
15527 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15528 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15529
15530 @node M2 Scope
15531 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15532 @cindex scope
15533 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15534 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15535 @ifinfo
15536 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15537 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15538 @end ifinfo
15539 @ifnotinfo
15540 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15541 @end ifnotinfo
15542
15543 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15544 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15545 similar syntax:
15546
15547 @smallexample
15548
15549 @var{module} . @var{id}
15550 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15551 @end smallexample
15552
15553 @noindent
15554 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15555 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15556 identifier within your program, except another module.
15557
15558 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15559 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15560 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15561 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15562
15563 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15564 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15565 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15566 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15567 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15568 @var{module}.
15569
15570 @node GDB/M2
15571 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15572
15573 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15574 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15575 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15576 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15577 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15578 analogue in Modula-2.
15579
15580 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15581 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15582 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15583 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15584 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15585 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15586
15587 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15588 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15589 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15590
15591 @node Ada
15592 @subsection Ada
15593 @cindex Ada
15594
15595 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15596 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15597 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15598 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15599 to be difficult.
15600
15601
15602 @cindex expressions in Ada
15603 @menu
15604 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15605 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15606 in @value{GDBN}.
15607 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15608 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15609 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15610 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15611 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15612 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15613 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15614 Profile
15615 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15616 @end menu
15617
15618 @node Ada Mode Intro
15619 @subsubsection Introduction
15620 @cindex Ada mode, general
15621
15622 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15623 syntax, with some extensions.
15624 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15625
15626 @itemize @bullet
15627 @item
15628 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15629 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15630 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15631 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15632
15633 @item
15634 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15635 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15636
15637 @item
15638 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15639 @end itemize
15640
15641 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15642 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15643 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15644 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15645 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15646
15647 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15648 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15649 was translated from an Ada source file.
15650
15651 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15652 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15653 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15654 middle (to allow based literals).
15655
15656 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15657 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15658 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15659 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15660 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15661 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15662
15663 @node Omissions from Ada
15664 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15665 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15666
15667 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15668
15669 @itemize @bullet
15670 @item
15671 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15672
15673 @itemize @minus
15674 @item
15675 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15676 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15677
15678 @item
15679 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15680
15681 @item
15682 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15683
15684 @item
15685 @t{'Tag}.
15686
15687 @item
15688 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15689 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15690
15691 @item
15692 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15693 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15694
15695 @item
15696 @t{'Address}.
15697 @end itemize
15698
15699 @item
15700 The names in
15701 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15702 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15703 not currently available.
15704
15705 @item
15706 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15707 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15708 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15709 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15710 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15711 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15712 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15713 indeterminate values.
15714
15715 @item
15716 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15717 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15718 are not implemented.
15719
15720 @item
15721 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15722 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15723 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15724 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15725 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15726
15727 @smallexample
15728 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15729 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15730 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15731 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15732 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15733 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15734 @end smallexample
15735
15736 Changing a
15737 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15738 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15739 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15740 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15741 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15742 declared to have a type such as:
15743
15744 @smallexample
15745 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15746 Id : Integer;
15747 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15748 end record;
15749 @end smallexample
15750
15751 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15752 assignments:
15753
15754 @smallexample
15755 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15756 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15757 @end smallexample
15758
15759 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15760 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15761 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15762 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15763 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15764 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15765 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15766 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15767
15768 @item
15769 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15770
15771 @item
15772 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15773 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15774 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15775 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15776 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15777 the proper resolution.
15778
15779 @item
15780 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15781
15782 @item
15783 Entry calls are not implemented.
15784
15785 @item
15786 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15787 formats are not supported.
15788
15789 @item
15790 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15791
15792 @item
15793 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15794 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15795 context.
15796 Should your program
15797 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15798 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15799 @end itemize
15800
15801 @node Additions to Ada
15802 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15803 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15804
15805 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15806 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15807
15808 @itemize @bullet
15809 @item
15810 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15811 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15812 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15813 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15814 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15815 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15816 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15817 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15818
15819 @item
15820 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15821 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15822 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15823
15824 @item
15825 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15826 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15827
15828 @item
15829 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15830 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15831 @end itemize
15832
15833 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15834 additions specific to Ada:
15835
15836 @itemize @bullet
15837 @item
15838 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15839 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15840
15841 @smallexample
15842 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15843 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15844 @end smallexample
15845
15846 @item
15847 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15848 the value of its right-hand operand.
15849 This allows, for example,
15850 complex conditional breaks:
15851
15852 @smallexample
15853 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15854 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15855 @end smallexample
15856
15857 @item
15858 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15859 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15860 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15861 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15862 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15863 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15864 in strings. For example,
15865 @smallexample
15866 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15867 @end smallexample
15868 @noindent
15869 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15870 after each period.
15871
15872 @item
15873 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15874 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15875 to write
15876
15877 @smallexample
15878 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15879 @end smallexample
15880
15881 @item
15882 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15883 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15884 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15885 of 3 might print as
15886
15887 @smallexample
15888 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15889 @end smallexample
15890
15891 @noindent
15892 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15893 clause.
15894
15895 @item
15896 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15897 multi-character subsequence of
15898 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15899 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15900 in place of @t{a'length}.
15901
15902 @item
15903 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15904 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15905 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15906 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15907 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15908 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15909 For example,
15910 @smallexample
15911 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15912 @end smallexample
15913
15914 @item
15915 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15916 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15917 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15918 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15919 object.
15920
15921 @end itemize
15922
15923 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15924 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15925
15926 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15927 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15928 before reaching the main procedure.
15929 As defined in the Ada Reference
15930 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15931 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15932 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15933 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15934
15935 @node Ada Exceptions
15936 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15937
15938 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15939
15940 @table @code
15941 @kindex info exceptions
15942 @item info exceptions
15943 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15944 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15945 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15946 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15947 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15948 @end table
15949
15950 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15951 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15952 argument.
15953
15954 @smallexample
15955 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15956 All defined Ada exceptions:
15957 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15958 program_error: 0x613d20
15959 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15960 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15961 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15962 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15963 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15964 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15965 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15966 @end smallexample
15967
15968 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15969 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15970
15971 @node Ada Tasks
15972 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15973 @cindex Ada, tasking
15974
15975 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15976 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15977
15978 @table @code
15979 @kindex info tasks
15980 @item info tasks
15981 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15982
15983
15984 @smallexample
15985 @iftex
15986 @leftskip=0.5cm
15987 @end iftex
15988 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15989 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15990 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15991 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15992 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15993 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15994
15995 @end smallexample
15996
15997 @noindent
15998 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15999 task currently being inspected.
16000
16001 @table @asis
16002 @item ID
16003 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16004
16005 @item TID
16006 The Ada task ID.
16007
16008 @item P-ID
16009 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16010
16011 @item Pri
16012 The base priority of the task.
16013
16014 @item State
16015 Current state of the task.
16016
16017 @table @code
16018 @item Unactivated
16019 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16020 executing.
16021
16022 @item Runnable
16023 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16024 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16025
16026 @item Terminated
16027 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16028 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16029 terminated themselves.
16030
16031 @item Child Activation Wait
16032 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16033
16034 @item Accept Statement
16035 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16036
16037 @item Waiting on entry call
16038 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16039
16040 @item Async Select Wait
16041 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16042 select statement.
16043
16044 @item Delay Sleep
16045 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16046 alternative open.
16047
16048 @item Child Termination Wait
16049 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16050 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16051 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16052
16053 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16054 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16055 finish terminating.
16056
16057 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16058 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16059 @end table
16060
16061 @item Name
16062 Name of the task in the program.
16063
16064 @end table
16065
16066 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16067 @item info task @var{taskno}
16068 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16069 the following example:
16070 @smallexample
16071 @iftex
16072 @leftskip=0.5cm
16073 @end iftex
16074 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16075 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16076 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16077 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16078 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16079 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16080 Name: task_1
16081 Thread: 0x807f378
16082 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16083 Base Priority: 15
16084 State: Runnable
16085 @end smallexample
16086
16087 @item task
16088 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16089 @cindex current Ada task ID
16090 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16091
16092 @smallexample
16093 @iftex
16094 @leftskip=0.5cm
16095 @end iftex
16096 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16097 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16098 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16099 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16100 (@value{GDBP}) task
16101 [Current task is 2]
16102 @end smallexample
16103
16104 @item task @var{taskno}
16105 @cindex Ada task switching
16106 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
16107 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16108 from the current task to the given task.
16109
16110 @smallexample
16111 @iftex
16112 @leftskip=0.5cm
16113 @end iftex
16114 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16115 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16116 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16117 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16118 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16119 [Switching to task 1]
16120 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16121 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16122 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16123 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16124 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16125 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16126 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16127 @end smallexample
16128
16129 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16130 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16131 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16132 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16133 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16134 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16135 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16136 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16137 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16138
16139 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16140 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16141 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16142 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16143 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16144
16145 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16146 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16147 program.
16148
16149 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16150 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16151 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16152
16153 For example,
16154
16155 @smallexample
16156 @iftex
16157 @leftskip=0.5cm
16158 @end iftex
16159 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16160 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16161 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16162 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16163 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16164 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16165 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16166 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16167 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16168 Continuing.
16169 task # 1 running
16170 task # 2 running
16171
16172 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16173 15 flush;
16174 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16175 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16176 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16177 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16178 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16179 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16180 @end smallexample
16181 @end table
16182
16183 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16184 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16185 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16186
16187 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16188 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16189 the platform being used.
16190 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16191 switching is not supported.
16192
16193 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16194 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16195 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16196 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16197 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16198 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16199
16200 @node Ravenscar Profile
16201 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16202 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16203
16204 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16205 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16206 requirements.
16207
16208 @table @code
16209 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16210 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16211 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16212 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16213 Profile. This is the default.
16214
16215 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16216 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16217 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16218 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16219 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16220 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16221 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16222
16223 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16224 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16225 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16226 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16227
16228 @end table
16229
16230 @node Ada Glitches
16231 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16232 @cindex Ada, problems
16233
16234 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16235 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16236 @value{GDBN},
16237 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16238 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16239
16240 @itemize @bullet
16241 @item
16242 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16243 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16244
16245 @item
16246 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16247 argument lists are treated as positional).
16248
16249 @item
16250 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16251
16252 @item
16253 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16254 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16255 the host machine.
16256
16257 @item
16258 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16259 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16260 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16261 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16262 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16263 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16264 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16265 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16266 you can usually resolve the confusion
16267 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16268 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16269 @end itemize
16270
16271 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16272 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16273 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16274 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16275 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16276 enabled.
16277
16278 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16279 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16280 @table @code
16281
16282 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16283 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16284 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16285 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16286 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16287 This is the default.
16288
16289 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16290 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16291 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16292 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16293 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16294 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16295 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16296
16297 @end table
16298
16299 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16300 @cindex GNAT encoding
16301 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16302 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16303 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16304 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16305 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16306 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16307
16308 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16309 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16310 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16311 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16312 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16313 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16314 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16315 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16316
16317 @table @code
16318
16319 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16320 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16321 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16322 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16323
16324 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16325 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16326 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16327
16328 @end table
16329
16330 @node Unsupported Languages
16331 @section Unsupported Languages
16332
16333 @cindex unsupported languages
16334 @cindex minimal language
16335 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16336 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16337 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16338 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16339 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16340 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16341
16342 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16343 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16344 language.
16345
16346 @node Symbols
16347 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16348
16349 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16350 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16351 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16352 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16353 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16354 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16355 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16356
16357 @cindex symbol names
16358 @cindex names of symbols
16359 @cindex quoting names
16360 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16361 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16362 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16363 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16364 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16365 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16366 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16367 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16368
16369 @smallexample
16370 p 'foo.c'::x
16371 @end smallexample
16372
16373 @noindent
16374 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16375
16376 @table @code
16377 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16378 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16379 @kindex set case-sensitive
16380 @item set case-sensitive on
16381 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16382 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16383 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16384 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16385 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16386 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16387 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16388 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16389 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16390 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16391 case-insensitive matches.
16392
16393 @kindex show case-sensitive
16394 @item show case-sensitive
16395 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16396 lookups.
16397
16398 @kindex set print type methods
16399 @item set print type methods
16400 @itemx set print type methods on
16401 @itemx set print type methods off
16402 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16403 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16404 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16405 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16406 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16407 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16408
16409 @kindex show print type methods
16410 @item show print type methods
16411 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16412 classes.
16413
16414 @kindex set print type typedefs
16415 @item set print type typedefs
16416 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16417 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16418
16419 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16420 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16421 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16422 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16423 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16424 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16425 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16426 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16427 types.
16428
16429 @kindex show print type typedefs
16430 @item show print type typedefs
16431 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16432 printing classes.
16433
16434 @kindex info address
16435 @cindex address of a symbol
16436 @item info address @var{symbol}
16437 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16438 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16439 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16440 is always stored.
16441
16442 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16443 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16444 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16445
16446 @kindex info symbol
16447 @cindex symbol from address
16448 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16449 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16450 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16451 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16452 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16453
16454 @smallexample
16455 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16456 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16457 @end smallexample
16458
16459 @noindent
16460 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16461 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16462
16463 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16464 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16465
16466 @smallexample
16467 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16468 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16469 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16470 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16471 @end smallexample
16472
16473 @kindex demangle
16474 @cindex demangle
16475 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16476 Demangle @var{name}.
16477 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16478 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16479
16480 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16481 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16482
16483 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16484 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16485
16486 @kindex whatis
16487 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16488 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16489 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16490 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16491
16492 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16493 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16494 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16495
16496 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16497 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16498 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16499 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16500 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16501 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16502 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16503 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16504 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16505
16506 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16507 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16508 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16509 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16510 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16511 unroll it.
16512
16513 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16514 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16515 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16516
16517 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16518 Available flags are:
16519
16520 @table @code
16521 @item r
16522 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16523 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16524 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16525
16526 @item m
16527 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16528
16529 @item M
16530 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16531 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16532
16533 @item t
16534 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16535 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16536 names are substituted when printing other types.
16537
16538 @item T
16539 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16540 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16541 @end table
16542
16543 @kindex ptype
16544 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16545 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16546 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16547 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16548
16549 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16550 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16551 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16552 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16553 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16554 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16555 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16556 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16557
16558 For example, for this variable declaration:
16559
16560 @smallexample
16561 typedef double real_t;
16562 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16563 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16564 complex_t var;
16565 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16566 @end smallexample
16567
16568 @noindent
16569 the two commands give this output:
16570
16571 @smallexample
16572 @group
16573 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16574 type = complex_t
16575 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16576 type = struct complex @{
16577 real_t real;
16578 double imag;
16579 @}
16580 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16581 type = struct complex
16582 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16583 type = struct complex
16584 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16585 type = struct complex @{
16586 real_t real;
16587 double imag;
16588 @}
16589 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16590 type = real_t *
16591 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16592 type = double *
16593 @end group
16594 @end smallexample
16595
16596 @noindent
16597 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16598 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16599
16600 @cindex incomplete type
16601 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16602 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16603 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16604 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16605 given these declarations:
16606
16607 @smallexample
16608 struct foo;
16609 struct foo *fooptr;
16610 @end smallexample
16611
16612 @noindent
16613 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16614
16615 @smallexample
16616 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16617 $1 = <incomplete type>
16618 @end smallexample
16619
16620 @noindent
16621 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16622 completely specified.
16623
16624 @kindex info types
16625 @item info types @var{regexp}
16626 @itemx info types
16627 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16628 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16629 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16630 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16631 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16632 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16633 name is @code{value}.
16634
16635 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16636 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16637 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16638
16639 @kindex info type-printers
16640 @item info type-printers
16641 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16642 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16643 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16644 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16645 type printers.
16646
16647 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16648
16649 @kindex enable type-printer
16650 @kindex disable type-printer
16651 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16652 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16653 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16654
16655 @kindex info scope
16656 @cindex local variables
16657 @item info scope @var{location}
16658 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16659 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16660 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16661 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16662 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16663
16664 @smallexample
16665 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16666 Scope for command_line_handler:
16667 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16668 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16669 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16670 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16671 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16672 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16673 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16674 @end smallexample
16675
16676 @noindent
16677 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16678 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16679 collect}.
16680
16681 @kindex info source
16682 @item info source
16683 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16684 the function containing the current point of execution:
16685 @itemize @bullet
16686 @item
16687 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16688 @item
16689 the directory it was compiled in,
16690 @item
16691 its length, in lines,
16692 @item
16693 which programming language it is written in,
16694 @item
16695 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16696 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16697 @item
16698 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16699 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16700 @item
16701 whether the debugging information includes information about
16702 preprocessor macros.
16703 @end itemize
16704
16705
16706 @kindex info sources
16707 @item info sources
16708 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16709 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16710 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16711
16712 @kindex info functions
16713 @item info functions
16714 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16715
16716 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16717 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16718 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16719 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16720 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16721 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16722 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16723 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16724
16725 @kindex info variables
16726 @item info variables
16727 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16728 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16729
16730 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16731 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16732 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16733 @var{regexp}.
16734
16735 @kindex info classes
16736 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16737 @item info classes
16738 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16739 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16740 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16741 expression.
16742
16743 @kindex info selectors
16744 @item info selectors
16745 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16746 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16747 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16748 expression.
16749
16750 @ignore
16751 This was never implemented.
16752 @kindex info methods
16753 @item info methods
16754 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16755 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16756 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16757 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16758 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16759 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16760 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16761 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16762 @end ignore
16763
16764 @cindex opaque data types
16765 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16766 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16767 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16768 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16769 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16770 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16771 another source file. The default is on.
16772
16773 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16774 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16775
16776 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16777 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16778 is printed as follows:
16779 @smallexample
16780 @{<no data fields>@}
16781 @end smallexample
16782
16783 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16784 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16785 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16786
16787 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16788 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16789 @item set print symbol-loading
16790 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16791 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16792 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16793 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16794 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16795 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16796 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16797 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16798 can be annoying.
16799 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16800 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16801 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16802 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16803
16804 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16805 @item show print symbol-loading
16806 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16807 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16808
16809 @kindex maint print symbols
16810 @cindex symbol dump
16811 @kindex maint print psymbols
16812 @cindex partial symbol dump
16813 @kindex maint print msymbols
16814 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16815 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16816 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16817 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16818 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16819 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16820 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16821 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16822 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16823 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16824 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16825 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16826 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16827 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16828 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16829 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16830 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16831 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16832
16833 @kindex maint info symtabs
16834 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16835 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16836 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16837 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16838 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16839 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16840 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16841
16842 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16843 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16844 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16845 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16846 structure in more detail. For example:
16847
16848 @smallexample
16849 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16850 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16851 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16852 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16853 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16854 readin no
16855 fullname (null)
16856 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16857 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16858 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16859 dependencies (none)
16860 @}
16861 @}
16862 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16863 (@value{GDBP})
16864 @end smallexample
16865 @noindent
16866 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16867 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16868 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16869 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16870 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16871
16872 @smallexample
16873 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16874 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16875 line 1574.
16876 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16877 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16878 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16879 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16880 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16881 dirname (null)
16882 fullname (null)
16883 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16884 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16885 debugformat DWARF 2
16886 @}
16887 @}
16888 (@value{GDBP})
16889 @end smallexample
16890
16891 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16892 @cindex symbol cache size
16893 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16894 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16895 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16896 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16897 with different sizes.
16898
16899 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16900 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16901 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16902
16903 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16904 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16905 @item maint print symbol-cache
16906 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16907 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16908
16909 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16910 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16911 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16912 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16913 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16914
16915 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16916 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16917 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16918 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16919 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16920 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16921
16922 @end table
16923
16924 @node Altering
16925 @chapter Altering Execution
16926
16927 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16928 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16929 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16930 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16931 program.
16932
16933 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16934 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16935 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16936
16937 @menu
16938 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16939 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16940 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16941 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16942 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16943 * Patching:: Patching your program
16944 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16945 @end menu
16946
16947 @node Assignment
16948 @section Assignment to Variables
16949
16950 @cindex assignment
16951 @cindex setting variables
16952 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16953 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16954
16955 @smallexample
16956 print x=4
16957 @end smallexample
16958
16959 @noindent
16960 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16961 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16962 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16963 information on operators in supported languages.
16964
16965 @kindex set variable
16966 @cindex variables, setting
16967 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16968 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16969 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16970 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16971 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16972
16973 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16974 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16975 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16976 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16977 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16978 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16979 command @code{set width}:
16980
16981 @smallexample
16982 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16983 type = double
16984 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16985 $4 = 13
16986 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16987 Invalid syntax in expression.
16988 @end smallexample
16989
16990 @noindent
16991 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16992 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16993
16994 @smallexample
16995 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16996 @end smallexample
16997
16998 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16999 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17000 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17001 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17002 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17003 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17004
17005 @smallexample
17006 @group
17007 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17008 type = double
17009 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17010 $1 = 1
17011 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17012 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17013 $2 = 1
17014 (@value{GDBP}) r
17015 The program being debugged has been started already.
17016 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17017 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17018 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17019 Invalid bfd target.
17020 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17021 The current BFD target is "=4".
17022 @end group
17023 @end smallexample
17024
17025 @noindent
17026 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17027 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17028 @code{g}, use
17029
17030 @smallexample
17031 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17032 @end smallexample
17033
17034 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17035 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17036 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17037 same length or shorter.
17038 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17039 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17040
17041 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17042 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17043 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17044 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17045 and representation in memory), and
17046
17047 @smallexample
17048 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17049 @end smallexample
17050
17051 @noindent
17052 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17053
17054 @node Jumping
17055 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17056
17057 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17058 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17059 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17060
17061 @table @code
17062 @kindex jump
17063 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17064 @item jump @var{location}
17065 @itemx j @var{location}
17066 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17067 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17068 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17069 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17070 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17071
17072 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17073 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17074 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17075 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17076 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17077 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17078 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17079 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17080 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17081 @end table
17082
17083 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
17084 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17085 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17086 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17087 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17088 example,
17089
17090 @smallexample
17091 set $pc = 0x485
17092 @end smallexample
17093
17094 @noindent
17095 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17096 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17097 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17098
17099 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17100 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17101 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17102 detail.
17103
17104 @c @group
17105 @node Signaling
17106 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17107 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17108
17109 @table @code
17110 @kindex signal
17111 @item signal @var{signal}
17112 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17113 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17114 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17115 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17116
17117 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17118 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17119 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17120 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17121 signal.
17122
17123 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17124 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17125 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17126 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17127 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17128 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17129 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17130 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17131
17132 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17133 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17134 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17135 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17136 passes the signal directly to your program.
17137
17138 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17139 after executing the command.
17140
17141 @kindex queue-signal
17142 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17143 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17144 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17145 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17146 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17147 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17148 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17149 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17150 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17151
17152 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17153 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17154 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17155 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17156 @code{continue} command.
17157
17158 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17159 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17160 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17161 (@pxref{Signals}).
17162 @end table
17163 @c @end group
17164
17165 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17166 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17167
17168 @node Returning
17169 @section Returning from a Function
17170
17171 @table @code
17172 @cindex returning from a function
17173 @kindex return
17174 @item return
17175 @itemx return @var{expression}
17176 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17177 command. If you give an
17178 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17179 value.
17180 @end table
17181
17182 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17183 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17184 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17185 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17186
17187 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17188 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17189 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17190 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17191 of functions.
17192
17193 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17194 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17195 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17196 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17197 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17198
17199 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17200 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17201 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17202 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17203 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17204 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17205 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17206 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17207 assignment into the right register(s).
17208
17209 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17210 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17211 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17212 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17213 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17214 into a @code{long long int}:
17215
17216 @smallexample
17217 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17218 29 return 31;
17219 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17220 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17221 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17222 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17223 (@value{GDBP})
17224 @end smallexample
17225
17226 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17227 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17228 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17229 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17230 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17231 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17232 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17233 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17234
17235 @smallexample
17236 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17237 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17238 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17239 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17240 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17241 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17242 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17243 (@value{GDBP})
17244 @end smallexample
17245
17246 @node Calling
17247 @section Calling Program Functions
17248
17249 @table @code
17250 @cindex calling functions
17251 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17252 @item print @var{expr}
17253 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17254 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17255 debugged.
17256
17257 @kindex call
17258 @item call @var{expr}
17259 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17260 returned values.
17261
17262 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17263 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17264 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17265 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17266 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17267 value history.
17268 @end table
17269
17270 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17271 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17272 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17273 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17274
17275 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17276 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17277 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17278 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17279 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17280 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17281 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17282 in that case is controlled by the
17283 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17284
17285 @table @code
17286 @item set unwindonsignal
17287 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17288 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17289 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17290 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17291 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17292 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17293 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17294 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17295 received.
17296
17297 @item show unwindonsignal
17298 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17299 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17300 @value{GDBN}.
17301
17302 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17303 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17304 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17305 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17306 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17307 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17308 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17309 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17310 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17311 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17312
17313 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17314 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17315 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17316 @value{GDBN}.
17317
17318 @end table
17319
17320 @cindex weak alias functions
17321 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17322 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17323 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17324 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17325 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17326 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17327 function instead.
17328
17329 @node Patching
17330 @section Patching Programs
17331
17332 @cindex patching binaries
17333 @cindex writing into executables
17334 @cindex writing into corefiles
17335
17336 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17337 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17338 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17339 patching your program's binary.
17340
17341 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17342 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17343 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17344 repairs.
17345
17346 @table @code
17347 @kindex set write
17348 @item set write on
17349 @itemx set write off
17350 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17351 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17352 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17353
17354 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17355 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17356 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17357
17358 @item show write
17359 @kindex show write
17360 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17361 as well as reading.
17362 @end table
17363
17364 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17365 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17366 @cindex injecting code
17367 @cindex writing into executables
17368 @cindex compiling code
17369
17370 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17371 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17372 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17373 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17374
17375 @table @code
17376 @kindex compile code
17377 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17378 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17379 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17380 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17381 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17382 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17383 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17384 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17385 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17386 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17387 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17388 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17389
17390 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17391 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17392 E.g.:
17393
17394 @smallexample
17395 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17396 @end smallexample
17397
17398 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17399 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17400 from actual source code. E.g.:
17401
17402 @smallexample
17403 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17404 @end smallexample
17405
17406 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17407 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17408 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17409 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17410 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17411 editor.
17412
17413 @smallexample
17414 compile code
17415 >printf ("hello\n");
17416 >printf ("world\n");
17417 >end
17418 @end smallexample
17419
17420 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17421 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17422 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17423 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17424 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17425 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17426 inferior symbols otherwise.
17427
17428 @kindex compile file
17429 @item compile file @var{filename}
17430 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17431 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17432
17433 @smallexample
17434 compile file /home/user/example.c
17435 @end smallexample
17436 @end table
17437
17438 @table @code
17439 @item compile print @var{expr}
17440 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17441 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17442 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17443 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17444 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17445 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17446 Formats}.
17447
17448 @item compile print
17449 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17450 @cindex reprint the last value
17451 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17452 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17453 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17454 multiple-line editor.
17455 @end table
17456
17457 @noindent
17458 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17459
17460 @table @code
17461 @anchor{set debug compile}
17462 @item set debug compile
17463 @cindex compile command debugging info
17464 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17465 injecting the code. The default is off.
17466
17467 @item show debug compile
17468 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17469 compiling and injecting the code.
17470 @end table
17471
17472 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17473
17474 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17475 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17476 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17477 injecting process.
17478
17479 @noindent
17480 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17481
17482 @table @asis
17483 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17484 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17485 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17486 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17487
17488 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17489 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17490 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17491 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17492 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17493 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17494 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17495 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17496
17497 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17498 @end table
17499
17500 @noindent
17501 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17502
17503 @table @code
17504 @item set compile-args
17505 @cindex compile command options override
17506 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17507 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17508 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17509 compilation.
17510
17511 @item show compile-args
17512 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17513 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17514 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17515 @end table
17516
17517 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17518
17519 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17520 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17521 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17522
17523 @table @asis
17524 @item C code examples and caveats
17525 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17526 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17527 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17528 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17529 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17530
17531 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17532 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17533 much like any other normal debugging session.
17534
17535 @smallexample
17536 void function1 (void)
17537 @{
17538 int i = 42;
17539 printf ("function 1\n");
17540 @}
17541
17542 void function2 (void)
17543 @{
17544 int j = 12;
17545 function1 ();
17546 @}
17547
17548 int main(void)
17549 @{
17550 int k = 6;
17551 int *p;
17552 function2 ();
17553 return 0;
17554 @}
17555 @end smallexample
17556
17557 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17558 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17559 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17560
17561 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17562 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17563 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17564 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17565 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17566
17567 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17568 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17569 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17570 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17571 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17572 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17573 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17574 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17575 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17576 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17577
17578 @smallexample
17579 compile code k = 3;
17580 @end smallexample
17581
17582 @noindent
17583 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17584 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17585 @code{compile} command changes it.
17586
17587 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17588 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17589 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17590 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17591 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17592
17593 @smallexample
17594 compile code j = 3;
17595 @end smallexample
17596
17597 @noindent
17598 will result in a compilation error message.
17599
17600 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17601 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17602 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17603
17604 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17605 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17606 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17607 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17608
17609 @smallexample
17610 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17611 @end smallexample
17612
17613 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17614 command has completed:
17615
17616 @smallexample
17617 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17618 @end smallexample
17619
17620 @noindent
17621 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17622 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17623 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17624 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17625 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17626
17627 @smallexample
17628 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17629 @end smallexample
17630
17631 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17632 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17633 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17634 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17635 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17636 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17637 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17638 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17639
17640 @smallexample
17641 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17642 @end smallexample
17643
17644 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17645 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17646 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17647 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17648 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17649 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17650 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17651
17652 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17653 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17654 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17655 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17656 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17657 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17658
17659 @smallexample
17660 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17661 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17662 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17663 Compilation failed.
17664 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17665 42
17666 @end smallexample
17667
17668 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17669 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17670 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17671 will print to the console.
17672 @end table
17673
17674 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17675
17676 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17677 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17678 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17679 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17680 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17681 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17682 target architecture and operating system.
17683
17684 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17685 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17686 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17687 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17688 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17689 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17690 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17691
17692 @node GDB Files
17693 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17694
17695 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17696 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17697 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17698 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17699
17700 @menu
17701 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17702 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
17703 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17704 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17705 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17706 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17707 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17708 @end menu
17709
17710 @node Files
17711 @section Commands to Specify Files
17712
17713 @cindex symbol table
17714 @cindex core dump file
17715
17716 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17717 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17718 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17719 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17720
17721 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17722 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17723 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17724 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17725 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17726 new files are useful.
17727
17728 @table @code
17729 @cindex executable file
17730 @kindex file
17731 @item file @var{filename}
17732 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17733 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17734 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17735 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17736 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17737 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17738 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17739 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17740
17741 @cindex unlinked object files
17742 @cindex patching object files
17743 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17744 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17745 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17746 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17747 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17748 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17749 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17750 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17751
17752 @item file
17753 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17754 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17755
17756 @kindex exec-file
17757 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17758 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17759 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17760 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17761 discard information on the executable file.
17762
17763 @kindex symbol-file
17764 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17765 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17766 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17767 table and program to run from the same file.
17768
17769 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17770 program's symbol table.
17771
17772 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17773 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17774 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17775 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17776 @value{GDBN}.
17777
17778 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17779 executing it once.
17780
17781 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17782 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17783 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17784 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17785 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17786 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17787 optimized code.
17788
17789 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17790 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17791 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17792 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17793 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17794
17795 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17796 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17797 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17798 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17799 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17800 Warnings and Messages}.)
17801
17802 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17803 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17804 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17805 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17806 in stabs format.
17807
17808 @kindex readnow
17809 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17810 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17811 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17812 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17813 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17814 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17815 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17816 entire symbol table available.
17817
17818 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17819 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17820 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17821 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17822 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17823 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17824 @c files.
17825
17826 @kindex core-file
17827 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17828 @itemx core
17829 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17830 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17831 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17832 executable file itself for other parts.
17833
17834 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17835 to be used.
17836
17837 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17838 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17839 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17840 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17841 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17842
17843 @kindex add-symbol-file
17844 @cindex dynamic linking
17845 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17846 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17847 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17848 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17849 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17850 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17851 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17852 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17853 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17854 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17855 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17856 @var{address} as an expression.
17857
17858 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17859 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17860 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17861 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17862
17863 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17864
17865 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17866 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17867 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17868 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17869 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17870 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17871 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17872 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17873 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17874
17875 @itemize @bullet
17876 @item
17877 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17878 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17879 @item
17880 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17881 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17882 @item
17883 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17884 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17885 @end itemize
17886
17887 @noindent
17888 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17889 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17890 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17891 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17892 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17893 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17894 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17895 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17896 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17897 way.
17898
17899 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17900
17901 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17902 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17903 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17904 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17905 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17906 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17907
17908 @smallexample
17909 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17910 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17911 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17912 (y or n) y
17913 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17914 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17915 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17916 (gdb)
17917 @end smallexample
17918
17919
17920 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17921
17922 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17923 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17924 @cindex load symbols from memory
17925 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17926 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17927 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17928 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17929 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17930 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17931 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17932 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17933 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17934
17935 @kindex section
17936 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17937 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17938 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17939 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17940 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17941 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17942 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17943 their addresses.
17944
17945 @kindex info files
17946 @kindex info target
17947 @item info files
17948 @itemx info target
17949 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17950 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17951 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17952 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17953 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17954 current ones.
17955
17956 @kindex maint info sections
17957 @item maint info sections
17958 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17959 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17960 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17961 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17962 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17963 may be arbitrarily combined):
17964
17965 @table @code
17966 @item ALLOBJ
17967 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17968 @item @var{sections}
17969 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17970 @item @var{section-flags}
17971 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17972 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17973 @table @code
17974 @item ALLOC
17975 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17976 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17977 @item LOAD
17978 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17979 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17980 @item RELOC
17981 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17982 @item READONLY
17983 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17984 @item CODE
17985 Section contains executable code only.
17986 @item DATA
17987 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17988 @item ROM
17989 Section will reside in ROM.
17990 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17991 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17992 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17993 Section is not empty.
17994 @item NEVER_LOAD
17995 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17996 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17997 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17998 COFF shared library information.
17999 @item IS_COMMON
18000 Section contains common symbols.
18001 @end table
18002 @end table
18003 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18004 @cindex read-only sections
18005 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18006 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18007 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18008 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18009 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18010 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18011 enhancement to debugging performance.
18012
18013 The default is off.
18014
18015 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18016 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18017 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18018 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18019
18020 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18021 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18022 @end table
18023
18024 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18025 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18026 name and remembers it that way.
18027
18028 @cindex shared libraries
18029 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18030 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
18031 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
18032
18033 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18034 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18035
18036 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18037 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18038 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18039 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18040 debugging a core file).
18041
18042 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
18043 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
18044
18045 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18046 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18047 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18048
18049 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18050 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18051 particularly large or there are many of them.
18052
18053 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18054 commands:
18055
18056 @table @code
18057 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18058 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18059 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18060 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18061 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18062 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18063 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18064 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18065
18066 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18067 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18068 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18069 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18070 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18071 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18072 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18073 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18074 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18075
18076 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18077 @item show auto-solib-add
18078 Display the current autoloading mode.
18079 @end table
18080
18081 @cindex load shared library
18082 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18083 command:
18084
18085 @table @code
18086 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18087 @kindex info share
18088 @item info share @var{regex}
18089 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18090 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18091 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18092 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18093
18094 @kindex info dll
18095 @item info dll @var{regex}
18096 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18097
18098 @kindex sharedlibrary
18099 @kindex share
18100 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18101 @itemx share @var{regex}
18102 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18103 Unix regular expression.
18104 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18105 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18106 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18107 loaded.
18108
18109 @item nosharedlibrary
18110 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18111 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18112 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18113 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18114 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18115 discarded.
18116 @end table
18117
18118 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18119 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18120 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18121 Catchpoints}).
18122
18123 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18124 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18125 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18126 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18127
18128 @table @code
18129 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18130 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18131 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18132 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18133 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18134 shared library.
18135
18136 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18137 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18138 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18139 library events happen.
18140 @end table
18141
18142 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18143 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18144 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18145 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18146 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18147 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18148 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18149 not.
18150
18151 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18152 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18153 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18154 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18155 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18156
18157 @table @code
18158 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18159 @cindex system root, alternate
18160 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18161 @kindex set sysroot
18162 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18163 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18164 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18165 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18166 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18167 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18168 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18169 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18170 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18171 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18172 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18173 @var{path}.
18174
18175 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18176 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18177 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18178 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18179 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18180 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18181 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18182 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18183 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18184 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18185 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18186 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18187 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18188 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18189
18190 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18191 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18192 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18193 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18194 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18195
18196 @smallexample
18197 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18198 @end smallexample
18199
18200 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18201 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18202 system:
18203
18204 @smallexample
18205 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18206 @end smallexample
18207
18208 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18209 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18210 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18211 colons:
18212
18213 @smallexample
18214 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18215 @end smallexample
18216
18217 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18218 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18219 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18220 @samp{z}):
18221
18222 @smallexample
18223 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18224 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18225 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18226 @end smallexample
18227
18228 @noindent
18229 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18230 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18231 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18232
18233 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18234 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18235
18236 @smallexample
18237 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18238 @end smallexample
18239
18240 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18241 if you don't want or need to.
18242
18243 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18244 sysroot}.
18245
18246 @cindex default system root
18247 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18248 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18249 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18250 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18251 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18252 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18253 location.
18254
18255 @kindex show sysroot
18256 @item show sysroot
18257 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18258
18259 @kindex set solib-search-path
18260 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18261 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18262 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18263 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18264 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18265 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18266 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18267 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18268 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18269 of shared library symbols.
18270
18271 @kindex show solib-search-path
18272 @item show solib-search-path
18273 Display the current shared library search path.
18274
18275 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18276 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18277 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18278 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18279 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18280
18281 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18282 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18283 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18284 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18285 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18286 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18287 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18288 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18289 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18290 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18291 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18292 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18293 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18294 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18295 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18296 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18297 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18298 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18299 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18300 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18301 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18302 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18303
18304 @table @code
18305 @item unix
18306 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18307 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18308 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18309 the forward slash.
18310
18311 @item dos-based
18312 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18313 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18314 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18315 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18316 considered directory separators.
18317
18318 @item auto
18319 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18320 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18321 This is the default.
18322 @end table
18323 @end table
18324
18325 @cindex file name canonicalization
18326 @cindex base name differences
18327 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18328 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18329 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18330 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18331 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18332 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18333 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18334 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18335 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18336 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18337 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18338 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18339 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18340 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18341 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18342
18343 @table @code
18344 @item set basenames-may-differ
18345 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18346 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18347
18348 @item show basenames-may-differ
18349 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18350 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18351 @end table
18352
18353 @node File Caching
18354 @section File Caching
18355 @cindex caching of opened files
18356 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18357
18358 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18359 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18360 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18361 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18362
18363 @table @code
18364 @kindex maint info bfds
18365 @item maint info bfds
18366 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18367 @value{GDBN}.
18368
18369 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18370 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18371 @kindex bfd caching
18372 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18373 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18374 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18375 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18376 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18377 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18378 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18379 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18380 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18381
18382 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18383 @kindex bfd caching
18384 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18385 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18386
18387 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18388 @kindex bfd caching
18389 @item show debug bfd-cache
18390 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18391 @end table
18392
18393 @node Separate Debug Files
18394 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18395 @cindex separate debugging information files
18396 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18397 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18398 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18399 @cindex global debugging information directories
18400 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18401 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18402
18403 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18404 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18405 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18406 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18407 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18408 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18409 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18410
18411 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18412 file:
18413
18414 @itemize @bullet
18415 @item
18416 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18417 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18418 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18419 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18420 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18421 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18422 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18423 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18424
18425 @item
18426 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18427 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18428 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18429 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18430 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18431 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18432 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18433 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18434 below.
18435 @end itemize
18436
18437 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18438 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18439
18440 @itemize @bullet
18441 @item
18442 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18443 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18444 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18445 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18446 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18447
18448 @item
18449 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18450 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18451 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18452 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18453 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18454 hex characters, not 10.)
18455 @end itemize
18456
18457 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18458 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18459 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18460 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18461 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18462 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18463
18464 @itemize @minus
18465 @item
18466 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18467 @item
18468 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18469 @item
18470 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18471 @item
18472 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18473 @end itemize
18474
18475 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18476 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18477 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18478 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18479 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18480
18481 @table @code
18482
18483 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18484 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18485 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18486 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18487 concatenating them by a path separator.
18488
18489 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18490 @item show debug-file-directory
18491 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18492 information files.
18493
18494 @end table
18495
18496 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18497 @cindex debug link sections
18498 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18499 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18500
18501 @itemize
18502 @item
18503 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18504 a zero byte,
18505 @item
18506 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18507 boundary within the section, and
18508 @item
18509 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18510 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18511 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18512 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18513 @end itemize
18514
18515 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18516 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18517 described above.
18518
18519 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18520 @cindex build ID sections
18521 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18522 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18523 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18524 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18525 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18526 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18527 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18528 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18529 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18530
18531 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18532 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18533 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18534 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18535 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18536 in an ordinary executable.
18537
18538 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18539 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18540 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18541 following commands:
18542
18543 @smallexample
18544 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18545 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18546 @end smallexample
18547
18548 @noindent
18549 These commands remove the debugging
18550 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18551 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18552 two files:
18553
18554 @itemize @bullet
18555 @item
18556 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18557 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18558
18559 @smallexample
18560 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18561 @end smallexample
18562
18563 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18564 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18565 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18566 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18567
18568 @item
18569 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18570 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18571 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18572 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18573 @end itemize
18574
18575 @noindent
18576
18577 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18578 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18579 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18580
18581 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18582 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18583 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18584 @c different ways!
18585 @ifhtml
18586 @display
18587 @html
18588 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18589 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18590 @end html
18591 @end display
18592 @end ifhtml
18593 @ifnothtml
18594 @display
18595 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18596 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18597 @end display
18598 @end ifnothtml
18599
18600 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18601 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18602 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18603 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18604 CRC.
18605
18606 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18607 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18608 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18609 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18610 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18611
18612 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18613 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18614 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18615 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18616 @code{0xffffffff}.
18617
18618 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18619 @smallexample
18620 unsigned long
18621 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18622 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18623 @{
18624 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18625 @{
18626 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18627 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18628 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18629 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18630 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18631 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18632 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18633 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18634 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18635 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18636 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18637 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18638 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18639 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18640 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18641 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18642 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18643 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18644 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18645 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18646 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18647 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18648 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18649 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18650 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18651 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18652 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18653 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18654 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18655 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18656 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18657 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18658 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18659 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18660 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18661 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18662 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18663 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18664 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18665 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18666 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18667 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18668 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18669 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18670 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18671 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18672 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18673 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18674 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18675 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18676 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18677 0x2d02ef8d
18678 @};
18679 unsigned char *end;
18680
18681 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18682 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18683 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18684 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18685 @}
18686 @end smallexample
18687
18688 @noindent
18689 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18690
18691 @node MiniDebugInfo
18692 @section Debugging information in a special section
18693 @cindex separate debug sections
18694 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18695
18696 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18697 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18698 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18699 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18700
18701 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18702 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18703 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18704 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18705 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18706 debugging information might be included in the section.
18707
18708 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18709 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18710 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18711
18712 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18713 standard utilities:
18714
18715 @smallexample
18716 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18717 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18718 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18719 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18720
18721 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18722 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18723 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18724 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18725 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18726 | sort > funcsyms
18727
18728 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18729 # table.
18730 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18731
18732 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18733 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18734
18735 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18736 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18737 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18738 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18739
18740 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18741 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18742
18743 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18744 # original binary.
18745 xz mini_debuginfo
18746 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18747 @end smallexample
18748
18749 @node Index Files
18750 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18751 @cindex index files
18752 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18753
18754 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18755 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18756 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18757 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18758 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18759 startup.
18760
18761 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18762 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18763 using @command{objcopy}.
18764
18765 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18766
18767 @table @code
18768 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18769 @kindex save gdb-index
18770 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18771 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18772 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18773 @var{directory}.
18774 @end table
18775
18776 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18777 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18778
18779 @smallexample
18780 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18781 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18782 @end smallexample
18783
18784 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18785 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18786 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18787 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18788 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18789 The default is @code{off}.
18790 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18791 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18792
18793 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18794 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18795
18796 @smallexample
18797 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18798 @end smallexample
18799
18800 Instead you must do, for example,
18801
18802 @smallexample
18803 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18804 @end smallexample
18805
18806 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18807 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18808 currently work for programs using Ada.
18809
18810 @node Symbol Errors
18811 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18812
18813 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18814 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18815 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18816 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18817 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18818 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18819 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18820 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18821 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18822 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18823 Messages}).
18824
18825 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18826
18827 @table @code
18828 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18829
18830 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18831 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18832 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18833 in its outer scope blocks.
18834
18835 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18836 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18837 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18838 function.
18839
18840 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18841
18842 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18843 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18844 do so.
18845
18846 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18847 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18848 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18849 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18850 Messages}.)
18851
18852 @item bad block start address patched
18853
18854 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18855 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18856 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18857
18858 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18859 starting on the previous source line.
18860
18861 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18862
18863 @cindex foo
18864 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18865 larger than the size of the string table.
18866
18867 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18868 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18869 with this name.
18870
18871 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18872
18873 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18874 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18875 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18876
18877 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18878 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18879 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18880 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18881 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18882 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18883
18884 @item stub type has NULL name
18885
18886 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18887
18888 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18889 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18890 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18891 it.
18892
18893 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18894
18895 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18896
18897 @end table
18898
18899 @node Data Files
18900 @section GDB Data Files
18901
18902 @cindex prefix for data files
18903 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18904 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18905
18906 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18907 is currently using.
18908
18909 @table @code
18910 @kindex set data-directory
18911 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18912 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18913 to @var{directory}.
18914
18915 @kindex show data-directory
18916 @item show data-directory
18917 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18918 @end table
18919
18920 @cindex default data directory
18921 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18922 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18923 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18924 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18925 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18926 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18927 location.
18928
18929 The data directory may also be specified with the
18930 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18931 @xref{Mode Options}.
18932
18933 @node Targets
18934 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18935
18936 @cindex debugging target
18937 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18938
18939 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18940 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18941 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18942 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18943 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18944 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18945 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18946 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18947
18948 @cindex target architecture
18949 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18950 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18951 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18952 command.
18953
18954 @table @code
18955 @kindex set architecture
18956 @kindex show architecture
18957 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18958 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18959 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18960 supported architectures.
18961
18962 @item show architecture
18963 Show the current target architecture.
18964
18965 @item set processor
18966 @itemx processor
18967 @kindex set processor
18968 @kindex show processor
18969 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18970 and @code{show architecture}.
18971 @end table
18972
18973 @menu
18974 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18975 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18976 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18977 @end menu
18978
18979 @node Active Targets
18980 @section Active Targets
18981
18982 @cindex stacking targets
18983 @cindex active targets
18984 @cindex multiple targets
18985
18986 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18987 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18988 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18989 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18990 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18991 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18992 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18993 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18994 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18995
18996 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18997 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18998 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18999 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19000
19001 @node Target Commands
19002 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19003
19004 @table @code
19005 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19006 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19007 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19008 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19009 protocol of the target machine.
19010
19011 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19012 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19013 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19014
19015 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19016 after executing the command.
19017
19018 @kindex help target
19019 @item help target
19020 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19021 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19022 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19023
19024 @item help target @var{name}
19025 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19026 select it.
19027
19028 @kindex set gnutarget
19029 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19030 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19031 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19032 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19033 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19034 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19035
19036 @quotation
19037 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19038 you must know the actual BFD name.
19039 @end quotation
19040
19041 @noindent
19042 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19043
19044 @kindex show gnutarget
19045 @item show gnutarget
19046 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19047 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19048 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19049 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19050 @end table
19051
19052 @cindex common targets
19053 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19054 configuration):
19055
19056 @table @code
19057 @kindex target
19058 @item target exec @var{program}
19059 @cindex executable file target
19060 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19061 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19062
19063 @item target core @var{filename}
19064 @cindex core dump file target
19065 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19066 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19067
19068 @item target remote @var{medium}
19069 @cindex remote target
19070 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19071 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19072 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19073
19074 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19075 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19076
19077 @smallexample
19078 target remote /dev/ttya
19079 @end smallexample
19080
19081 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19082 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19083 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19084 clobbered by the download.
19085
19086 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19087 @cindex built-in simulator target
19088 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19089 In general,
19090 @smallexample
19091 target sim
19092 load
19093 run
19094 @end smallexample
19095 @noindent
19096 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19097 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19098 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19099 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19100 Processors}.
19101
19102 @item target native
19103 @cindex native target
19104 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19105 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19106 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19107 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19108
19109 @end table
19110
19111 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19112 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19113
19114 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19115 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19116 various aspects of this process.
19117
19118 @table @code
19119
19120 @item set hash
19121 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19122 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19123 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19124 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19125 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19126 monitor.
19127
19128 @item show hash
19129 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19130 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19131
19132 @item set debug monitor
19133 @kindex set debug monitor
19134 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19135 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19136 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19137
19138 @item show debug monitor
19139 @kindex show debug monitor
19140 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19141 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19142 @end table
19143
19144 @table @code
19145
19146 @kindex load @var{filename}
19147 @item load @var{filename}
19148 @anchor{load}
19149 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19150 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19151 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19152 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19153 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19154 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19155
19156 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19157 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19158 target is @dots{}}''
19159
19160 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19161 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19162 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19163 specifies a fixed address.
19164 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19165
19166 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19167 load programs into flash memory.
19168
19169 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19170 @end table
19171
19172 @node Byte Order
19173 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19174
19175 @cindex choosing target byte order
19176 @cindex target byte order
19177
19178 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19179 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19180 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19181 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19182 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19183 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19184
19185 @table @code
19186 @kindex set endian
19187 @item set endian big
19188 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19189
19190 @item set endian little
19191 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19192
19193 @item set endian auto
19194 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19195 executable.
19196
19197 @item show endian
19198 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19199
19200 @end table
19201
19202 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19203 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19204 target system.
19205
19206
19207 @node Remote Debugging
19208 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19209 @cindex remote debugging
19210
19211 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19212 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19213 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19214 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19215 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19216
19217 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19218 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19219 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19220 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19221 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19222 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19223
19224 Other remote targets may be available in your
19225 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19226
19227 @menu
19228 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19229 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19230 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19231 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19232 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19233 @end menu
19234
19235 @node Connecting
19236 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19237
19238 @value{GDBN} needs an unstripped copy of your program to access symbol
19239 and debugging information. Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer
19240 executable filename read}, and @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow
19241 @value{GDBN} to access program files over the same connection used to
19242 communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a target, if the remote
19243 program is unstripped, the only command you need is @code{target
19244 remote}. Otherwise, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19245 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19246 @code{file} command.
19247
19248 @cindex @code{target remote}
19249 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19250 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19251 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19252 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19253 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
19254 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
19255
19256 @table @code
19257
19258 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19259 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19260 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19261 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19262
19263 @smallexample
19264 target remote /dev/ttyb
19265 @end smallexample
19266
19267 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19268 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19269 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19270 @code{target} command.
19271
19272 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19273 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19274 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19275 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19276 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19277 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19278 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19279 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19280 target.
19281
19282 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19283 @code{manyfarms}:
19284
19285 @smallexample
19286 target remote manyfarms:2828
19287 @end smallexample
19288
19289 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19290 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19291 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19292 port 1234 on your local machine:
19293
19294 @smallexample
19295 target remote :1234
19296 @end smallexample
19297 @noindent
19298
19299 Note that the colon is still required here.
19300
19301 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19302 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19303 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19304 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19305
19306 @smallexample
19307 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19308 @end smallexample
19309
19310 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19311 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19312 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19313 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19314
19315 @item target remote | @var{command}
19316 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19317 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19318 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19319 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19320 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19321 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19322 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19323 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19324
19325 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19326 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19327 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19328
19329 @end table
19330
19331 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
19332 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
19333 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
19334 need to use @kbd{run}.
19335
19336 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19337 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19338 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19339 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19340 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19341 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19342 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19343
19344 @smallexample
19345 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19346 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19347 @end smallexample
19348
19349 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
19350 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
19351 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
19352 goes back to waiting.
19353
19354 @table @code
19355 @kindex detach (remote)
19356 @item detach
19357 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19358 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19359 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19360 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19361 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
19362
19363 @kindex disconnect
19364 @item disconnect
19365 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
19366 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19367 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19368 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19369 another target.
19370
19371 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19372 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19373 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19374 @kindex monitor
19375 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19376 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19377 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19378 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19379 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19380 and implement.
19381 @end table
19382
19383 @node File Transfer
19384 @section Sending files to a remote system
19385 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19386 @cindex file transfer
19387 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19388
19389 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19390 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19391 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19392 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19393 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19394 the only way to upload or download files.
19395
19396 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19397
19398 @table @code
19399 @kindex remote put
19400 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19401 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19402 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19403
19404 @kindex remote get
19405 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19406 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19407 on the host system.
19408
19409 @kindex remote delete
19410 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19411 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19412
19413 @end table
19414
19415 @node Server
19416 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19417
19418 @kindex gdbserver
19419 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19420 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19421 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19422 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
19423
19424 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19425 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19426 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19427 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19428 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19429 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19430 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19431 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19432 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19433 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19434 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19435 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19436 choice for debugging.
19437
19438 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19439 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19440 protocol.
19441
19442 @quotation
19443 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19444 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19445 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19446 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19447 @code{gdbserver}.
19448 @end quotation
19449
19450 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19451 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19452 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19453
19454 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19455 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19456 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19457 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19458 system does all the symbol handling.
19459
19460 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19461 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19462 syntax is:
19463
19464 @smallexample
19465 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19466 @end smallexample
19467
19468 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19469 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19470 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19471 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19472 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19473 @file{/dev/com1}:
19474
19475 @smallexample
19476 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19477 @end smallexample
19478
19479 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19480 with it.
19481
19482 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19483
19484 @smallexample
19485 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19486 @end smallexample
19487
19488 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19489 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19490 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19491 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19492 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19493 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19494 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19495 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19496 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19497 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19498 @code{target remote} command.
19499
19500 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19501 with ssh:
19502
19503 @smallexample
19504 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19505 @end smallexample
19506
19507 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19508 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19509 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19510 You could elide it if you want to.
19511
19512 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19513 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19514 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19515 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19516
19517 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19518 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19519 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19520
19521 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19522 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19523
19524 @smallexample
19525 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19526 @end smallexample
19527
19528 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
19529 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19530
19531 @pindex pidof
19532 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19533 @code{pidof} utility:
19534
19535 @smallexample
19536 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19537 @end smallexample
19538
19539 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19540 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19541 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19542
19543 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
19544 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
19545 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
19546
19547 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
19548 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
19549 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
19550 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
19551
19552 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
19553 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
19554 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
19555 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
19556 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
19557 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
19558 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
19559 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
19560 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19561
19562 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19563 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19564 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
19565 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
19566 the program you want to debug.
19567
19568 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
19569 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
19570 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
19571 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
19572 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
19573 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19574
19575 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19576
19577 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
19578
19579 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19580 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19581 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19582 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19583 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19584 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19585 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19586 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19587
19588 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19589 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19590 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19591
19592 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19593 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19594 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19595 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19596 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19597 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19598 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19599 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19600 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19601 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19602 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19603 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19604
19605 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19606 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19607
19608 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19609 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19610 status information about the debugging process.
19611 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19612 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19613 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19614 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19615
19616 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19617 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19618 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19619 Possible options are:
19620
19621 @table @code
19622 @item none
19623 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19624 @item all
19625 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19626 @item timestamps
19627 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19628 @end table
19629
19630 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19631 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19632
19633 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19634 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19635 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19636 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19637 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19638
19639 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19640 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19641 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19642 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19643
19644 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19645 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19646 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19647 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19648
19649 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19650 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19651 environment:
19652
19653 @smallexample
19654 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19655 @end smallexample
19656
19657 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19658
19659 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19660
19661 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
19662 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
19663 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
19664 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
19665
19666 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19667 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19668 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19669 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19670 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19671 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19672 programs.
19673
19674 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19675 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19676 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19677 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19678 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19679 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
19680 already on the target.
19681
19682 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19683 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19684 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19685
19686 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19687 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19688 Here are the available commands.
19689
19690 @table @code
19691 @item monitor help
19692 List the available monitor commands.
19693
19694 @item monitor set debug 0
19695 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19696 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19697
19698 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19699 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19700 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19701 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19702
19703 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19704 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19705 Possible options are:
19706
19707 @table @code
19708 @item none
19709 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19710 @item all
19711 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19712 @item timestamps
19713 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19714 @end table
19715
19716 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19717 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19718
19719 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19720 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19721 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19722 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19723 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19724 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19725
19726 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19727 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19728
19729 @item monitor exit
19730 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19731 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19732 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19733 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19734 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19735
19736 @end table
19737
19738 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19739 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19740
19741 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19742 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19743
19744 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19745 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19746 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19747 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19748 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19749 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19750 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19751 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19752 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19753 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19754 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19755 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19756
19757 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19758
19759 @table @code
19760 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19761
19762 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19763 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19764 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19765
19766 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19767
19768 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19769 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19770 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19771 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19772 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19773 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19774
19775 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19776
19777 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19778 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19779 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19780 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19781 command for that. For example:
19782
19783 @smallexample
19784 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19785 @end smallexample
19786
19787 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19788 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19789 @end table
19790
19791 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19792 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19793 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19794 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19795 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19796 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19797 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19798 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19799 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19800 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19801
19802 @smallexample
19803 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19804 @end smallexample
19805
19806 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19807
19808 @smallexample
19809 $ gdb myprogram
19810 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19811 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19812 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19813 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19814 @end smallexample
19815
19816 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19817 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19818 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19819 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19820 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19821 tracing.
19822
19823 @node Remote Configuration
19824 @section Remote Configuration
19825
19826 @kindex set remote
19827 @kindex show remote
19828 This section documents the configuration options available when
19829 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19830 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19831 system-call-allowed}.
19832
19833 @table @code
19834 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19835 @cindex address size for remote targets
19836 @cindex bits in remote address
19837 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19838 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19839 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19840 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19841
19842 @item show remoteaddresssize
19843 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19844
19845 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19846 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19847 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19848 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19849 remote targets.
19850
19851 @item show serial baud
19852 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19853
19854 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
19855 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
19856 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
19857
19858 @item show serial parity
19859 Show the current parity of the serial port.
19860
19861 @item set remotebreak
19862 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19863 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19864 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19865 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19866 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19867 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19868 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19869 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19870
19871 @item show remotebreak
19872 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19873 interrupt the remote program.
19874
19875 @item set remoteflow on
19876 @itemx set remoteflow off
19877 @kindex set remoteflow
19878 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19879 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19880
19881 @item show remoteflow
19882 @kindex show remoteflow
19883 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19884
19885 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19886 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19887 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19888 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19889 @code{ascii}.
19890
19891 @item show remotelogbase
19892 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19893 protocol.
19894
19895 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19896 @cindex record serial communications on file
19897 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19898 default is not to record at all.
19899
19900 @item show remotelogfile.
19901 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19902 serial communications.
19903
19904 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19905 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19906 @cindex remote timeout
19907 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19908 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19909
19910 @item show remotetimeout
19911 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19912 responses.
19913
19914 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19915 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19916 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19917 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19918 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19919 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19920 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19921 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19922
19923 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19924 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19925 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19926 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19927 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19928 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19929 as unlimited.
19930
19931 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19932 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19933 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19934
19935 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19936 @itemx show remote exec-file
19937 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19938 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19939 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19940 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19941 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19942 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19943
19944 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19945 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19946 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19947 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19948 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19949 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19950 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19951 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19952 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19953 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19954
19955 @item show interrupt-sequence
19956 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19957 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19958 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19959 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19960
19961 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19962 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19963 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19964 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19965 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19966 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19967
19968 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19969 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19970 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19971
19972 @kindex set tcp
19973 @kindex show tcp
19974 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19975 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19976 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19977 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19978 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19979 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19980 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19981 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19982 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19983
19984 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19985 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19986
19987 @item show tcp auto-retry
19988 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19989
19990 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19991 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19992 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19993 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19994 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19995 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19996 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19997 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19998 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19999 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20000 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20001
20002 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20003 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20004 @end table
20005
20006 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20007 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20008 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20009 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20010 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20011 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20012 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20013 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20014 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20015
20016 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20017 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20018 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20019 @value{GDBN} developers.
20020
20021 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20022 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20023 are:
20024
20025 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20026 @item Command Name
20027 @tab Remote Packet
20028 @tab Related Features
20029
20030 @item @code{fetch-register}
20031 @tab @code{p}
20032 @tab @code{info registers}
20033
20034 @item @code{set-register}
20035 @tab @code{P}
20036 @tab @code{set}
20037
20038 @item @code{binary-download}
20039 @tab @code{X}
20040 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20041
20042 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20043 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20044 @tab @code{info auxv}
20045
20046 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20047 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20048 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20049
20050 @item @code{attach}
20051 @tab @code{vAttach}
20052 @tab @code{attach}
20053
20054 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20055 @tab @code{vCont}
20056 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20057
20058 @item @code{run}
20059 @tab @code{vRun}
20060 @tab @code{run}
20061
20062 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20063 @tab @code{Z0}
20064 @tab @code{break}
20065
20066 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20067 @tab @code{Z1}
20068 @tab @code{hbreak}
20069
20070 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20071 @tab @code{Z2}
20072 @tab @code{watch}
20073
20074 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20075 @tab @code{Z3}
20076 @tab @code{rwatch}
20077
20078 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20079 @tab @code{Z4}
20080 @tab @code{awatch}
20081
20082 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20083 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20084 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20085
20086 @item @code{target-features}
20087 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20088 @tab @code{set architecture}
20089
20090 @item @code{library-info}
20091 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20092 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20093
20094 @item @code{memory-map}
20095 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20096 @tab @code{info mem}
20097
20098 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20099 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20100 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20101
20102 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20103 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20104 @tab @code{info spu}
20105
20106 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20107 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20108 @tab @code{info spu}
20109
20110 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20111 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20112 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20113
20114 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20115 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20116 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20117
20118 @item @code{threads}
20119 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20120 @tab @code{info threads}
20121
20122 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20123 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20124 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20125
20126 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20127 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20128 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20129
20130 @item @code{search-memory}
20131 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20132 @tab @code{find}
20133
20134 @item @code{supported-packets}
20135 @tab @code{qSupported}
20136 @tab Remote communications parameters
20137
20138 @item @code{pass-signals}
20139 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20140 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20141
20142 @item @code{program-signals}
20143 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20144 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20145
20146 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20147 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20148 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20149
20150 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20151 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20152 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20153
20154 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20155 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20156 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20157
20158 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20159 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20160 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20161
20162 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20163 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20164 @tab @code{remote delete}
20165
20166 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20167 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20168 @tab Host I/O
20169
20170 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20171 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20172 @tab Host I/O
20173
20174 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20175 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20176 @tab Host I/O
20177
20178 @item @code{noack-packet}
20179 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20180 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20181
20182 @item @code{osdata}
20183 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20184 @tab @code{info os}
20185
20186 @item @code{query-attached}
20187 @tab @code{qAttached}
20188 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20189
20190 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20191 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20192 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20193
20194 @item @code{trace-status}
20195 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20196 @tab @code{tstatus}
20197
20198 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20199 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20200 @tab Traceframe info
20201
20202 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20203 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20204 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20205
20206 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20207 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20208 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20209
20210 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20211 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20212 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20213
20214 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20215 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20216 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20217
20218 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20219 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20220 @tab @code{break}
20221
20222 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20223 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20224 @tab @code{hbreak}
20225
20226 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20227 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20228 @tab @code{fork}
20229
20230 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20231 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20232 @tab @code{vfork}
20233
20234 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20235 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20236 @tab @code{exec}
20237
20238 @item @code{thread-events}
20239 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20240 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20241
20242 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20243 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20244 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20245
20246 @end multitable
20247
20248 @node Remote Stub
20249 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20250
20251 @cindex debugging stub, example
20252 @cindex remote stub, example
20253 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20254 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20255 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20256 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20257 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20258 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20259 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20260 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20261
20262 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20263 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20264 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20265 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20266 program, you need:
20267
20268 @enumerate
20269 @item
20270 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20271 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20272 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20273
20274 @item
20275 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20276 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20277
20278 @item
20279 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20280 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20281 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20282 documentation.
20283 @end enumerate
20284
20285 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20286 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20287 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20288
20289 @table @emph
20290 @item On the host,
20291 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20292 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20293 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20294
20295 @item On the target,
20296 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20297 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20298 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20299
20300 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20301 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20302 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20303 @end table
20304
20305 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20306 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20307 @sc{sparc} boards.
20308
20309 @cindex remote serial stub list
20310 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20311
20312 @table @code
20313
20314 @item i386-stub.c
20315 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20316 @cindex Intel
20317 @cindex i386
20318 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20319
20320 @item m68k-stub.c
20321 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20322 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20323 @cindex m680x0
20324 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20325
20326 @item sh-stub.c
20327 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20328 @cindex Renesas
20329 @cindex SH
20330 For Renesas SH architectures.
20331
20332 @item sparc-stub.c
20333 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20334 @cindex Sparc
20335 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20336
20337 @item sparcl-stub.c
20338 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20339 @cindex Fujitsu
20340 @cindex SparcLite
20341 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20342
20343 @end table
20344
20345 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20346 recently added stubs.
20347
20348 @menu
20349 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20350 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20351 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20352 @end menu
20353
20354 @node Stub Contents
20355 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20356
20357 @cindex remote serial stub
20358 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20359 subroutines:
20360
20361 @table @code
20362 @item set_debug_traps
20363 @findex set_debug_traps
20364 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20365 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20366 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20367 program's startup code.
20368
20369 @item handle_exception
20370 @findex handle_exception
20371 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20372 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20373 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20374 run when a trap is triggered.
20375
20376 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20377 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20378 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20379 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20380 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20381 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20382 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20383 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20384 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20385 machine.
20386
20387 @item breakpoint
20388 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20389 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20390 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20391 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20392 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20393 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20394 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20395 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20396 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20397 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20398 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20399
20400 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20401 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20402 start of your debugging session.
20403 @end table
20404
20405 @node Bootstrapping
20406 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20407
20408 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20409 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20410 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20411 debugging target machine.
20412
20413 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20414 serial port.
20415
20416 @table @code
20417 @item int getDebugChar()
20418 @findex getDebugChar
20419 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20420 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20421 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20422
20423 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20424 @findex putDebugChar
20425 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20426 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20427 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20428 @end table
20429
20430 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20431 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20432 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20433 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20434 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20435 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20436 remote system to stop.
20437
20438 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20439 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20440 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20441 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20442
20443 Other routines you need to supply are:
20444
20445 @table @code
20446 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20447 @findex exceptionHandler
20448 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20449 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20450 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20451 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20452 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20453 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20454 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20455 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20456 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20457 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20458 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20459 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20460 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20461
20462 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20463 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20464 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20465 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20466 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20467
20468 @item void flush_i_cache()
20469 @findex flush_i_cache
20470 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20471 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20472 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20473
20474 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20475 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20476 @end table
20477
20478 @noindent
20479 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20480
20481 @table @code
20482 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20483 @findex memset
20484 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20485 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20486 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20487 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20488 @end table
20489
20490 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20491 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20492 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20493 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20494
20495
20496 @node Debug Session
20497 @subsection Putting it All Together
20498
20499 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20500 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20501 steps.
20502
20503 @enumerate
20504 @item
20505 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20506 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20507 @display
20508 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20509 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20510 @end display
20511
20512 @item
20513 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20514 procedure is called:
20515
20516 @smallexample
20517 set_debug_traps();
20518 breakpoint();
20519 @end smallexample
20520
20521 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20522 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20523 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20524 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20525 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20526 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20527 progress.
20528
20529 @item
20530 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20531 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20532
20533 @smallexample
20534 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20535 @end smallexample
20536
20537 @noindent
20538 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20539 function in your program, that function is called when
20540 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20541 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20542 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20543
20544 @item
20545 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20546 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20547
20548 @item
20549 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20550 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20551
20552 @item
20553 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20554 @c document that. FIXME.
20555 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20556 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20557
20558 @item
20559 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20560 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20561
20562 @end enumerate
20563
20564 @node Configurations
20565 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20566
20567 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20568 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20569 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20570
20571 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20572 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20573 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20574 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20575 are quite different from each other.
20576
20577 @menu
20578 * Native::
20579 * Embedded OS::
20580 * Embedded Processors::
20581 * Architectures::
20582 @end menu
20583
20584 @node Native
20585 @section Native
20586
20587 This section describes details specific to particular native
20588 configurations.
20589
20590 @menu
20591 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
20592 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20593 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20594 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20595 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20596 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20597 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20598 @end menu
20599
20600 @node HP-UX
20601 @subsection HP-UX
20602
20603 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
20604 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
20605 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
20606
20607
20608 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20609 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20610
20611 @cindex libkvm
20612 @cindex kernel memory image
20613 @cindex kernel crash dump
20614
20615 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20616 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20617 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20618 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20619 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20620 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20621 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20622 @code{kvm} target:
20623
20624 @smallexample
20625 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20626 @end smallexample
20627
20628 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20629 argument:
20630
20631 @smallexample
20632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20633 @end smallexample
20634
20635 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20636 available:
20637
20638 @table @code
20639 @kindex kvm
20640 @item kvm pcb
20641 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20642
20643 @item kvm proc
20644 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20645 modern FreeBSD systems.
20646 @end table
20647
20648 @node SVR4 Process Information
20649 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20650 @cindex /proc
20651 @cindex examine process image
20652 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20653
20654 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20655 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20656 process using file-system subroutines.
20657
20658 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20659 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20660 information about the process running your program, or about any
20661 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20662 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
20663
20664 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20665 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20666
20667 @table @code
20668 @kindex info proc
20669 @cindex process ID
20670 @item info proc
20671 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20672 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20673 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20674 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20675 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20676 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20677 executable file's absolute file name.
20678
20679 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20680 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20681 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20682 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20683 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20684 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20685
20686 @item info proc cmdline
20687 @cindex info proc cmdline
20688 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20689 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20690
20691 @item info proc cwd
20692 @cindex info proc cwd
20693 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20694 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20695
20696 @item info proc exe
20697 @cindex info proc exe
20698 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20699 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20700
20701 @item info proc mappings
20702 @cindex memory address space mappings
20703 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20704 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20705 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20706 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20707 memory access rights to that range.
20708
20709 @item info proc stat
20710 @itemx info proc status
20711 @cindex process detailed status information
20712 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20713 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20714 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20715 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20716 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20717 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20718 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20719
20720 @item info proc all
20721 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20722 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20723
20724 @ignore
20725 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20726 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20727 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20728 @kindex info proc times
20729 @item info proc times
20730 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20731 its children.
20732
20733 @kindex info proc id
20734 @item info proc id
20735 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20736 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20737 @end ignore
20738
20739 @item set procfs-trace
20740 @kindex set procfs-trace
20741 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20742 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20743
20744 @item show procfs-trace
20745 @kindex show procfs-trace
20746 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20747
20748 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20749 @kindex set procfs-file
20750 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20751 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20752 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20753 standard output.
20754
20755 @item show procfs-file
20756 @kindex show procfs-file
20757 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20758
20759 @item proc-trace-entry
20760 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20761 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20762 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20763 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20764 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20765 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20766 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20767 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20768 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20769
20770 @item info pidlist
20771 @kindex info pidlist
20772 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20773 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20774 processes and all the threads within each process.
20775
20776 @item info meminfo
20777 @kindex info meminfo
20778 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20779 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20780 @end table
20781
20782 @node DJGPP Native
20783 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20784 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20785 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20786 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20787
20788 @cindex DPMI
20789 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20790 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20791 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20792 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20793
20794 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20795 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20796 subsection describes those commands.
20797
20798 @table @code
20799 @kindex info dos
20800 @item info dos
20801 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20802 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20803
20804 @kindex sysinfo
20805 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20806 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20807 @item info dos sysinfo
20808 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20809 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20810 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20811
20812 @cindex GDT
20813 @cindex LDT
20814 @cindex IDT
20815 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20816 @cindex descriptor tables display
20817 @item info dos gdt
20818 @itemx info dos ldt
20819 @itemx info dos idt
20820 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20821 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20822 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20823 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20824 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20825 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20826 rights.
20827
20828 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20829 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20830 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20831 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20832 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20833
20834 @cindex garbled pointers
20835 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20836 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20837 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20838 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20839 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20840 debugged program's data segment:
20841
20842 @smallexample
20843 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20844 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20845 @end smallexample
20846
20847 @noindent
20848 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20849 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20850
20851 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20852 @item info dos pde
20853 @itemx info dos pte
20854 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20855 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20856 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20857 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20858 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20859 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20860 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20861 that is currently in use.
20862
20863 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20864 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20865 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20866 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20867 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20868 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20869 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20870
20871 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20872 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20873 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20874 controller.
20875
20876 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20877
20878 @cindex physical address from linear address
20879 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20880 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20881 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20882 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20883 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20884 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20885 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20886
20887 @smallexample
20888 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20889 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20890 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20891 @end smallexample
20892
20893 @noindent
20894 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20895 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20896 attributes of that page.
20897
20898 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20899 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20900 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20901 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20902 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20903 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20904
20905 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20906 transfer buffer:
20907
20908 @smallexample
20909 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20910 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20911 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20912 @end smallexample
20913
20914 @noindent
20915 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20916 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20917 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20918 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20919 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20920
20921 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20922 @end table
20923
20924 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20925 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20926 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20927 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20928
20929 @table @code
20930 @kindex set com1base
20931 @kindex set com1irq
20932 @kindex set com2base
20933 @kindex set com2irq
20934 @kindex set com3base
20935 @kindex set com3irq
20936 @kindex set com4base
20937 @kindex set com4irq
20938 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20939 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20940 port.
20941
20942 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20943 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20944 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20945
20946 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20947 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20948 other 3 COM ports.
20949
20950 @kindex show com1base
20951 @kindex show com1irq
20952 @kindex show com2base
20953 @kindex show com2irq
20954 @kindex show com3base
20955 @kindex show com3irq
20956 @kindex show com4base
20957 @kindex show com4irq
20958 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20959 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20960 lines used by the COM ports.
20961
20962 @item info serial
20963 @kindex info serial
20964 @cindex DOS serial port status
20965 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20966 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20967 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20968 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20969 @end table
20970
20971
20972 @node Cygwin Native
20973 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20974 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20975 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20976 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20977
20978 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20979 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20980
20981 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20982 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20983 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20984 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20985 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20986 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20987 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20988 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20989
20990 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20991 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20992 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20993
20994 @table @code
20995 @kindex info w32
20996 @item info w32
20997 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20998 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20999
21000 @item info w32 selector
21001 This command displays information returned by
21002 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21003 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21004 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21005 Without argument, this command displays information
21006 about the six segment registers.
21007
21008 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21009 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21010 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21011 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21012
21013 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21014 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21015 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21016 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21017 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21018 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21019 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21020 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21021 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21022 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21023 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21024
21025 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21026 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21027 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21028 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21029
21030 @kindex set new-console
21031 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21032 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21033 be started in a new console on next start.
21034 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21035 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21036
21037 @kindex show new-console
21038 @item show new-console
21039 Displays whether a new console is used
21040 when the debuggee is started.
21041
21042 @kindex set new-group
21043 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21044 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21045 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21046 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21047 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21048
21049 @kindex show new-group
21050 @item show new-group
21051 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21052
21053 @kindex set debugevents
21054 @item set debugevents
21055 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21056 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21057 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21058 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21059 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21060
21061 @kindex set debugexec
21062 @item set debugexec
21063 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21064 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21065
21066 @kindex set debugexceptions
21067 @item set debugexceptions
21068 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21069 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21070
21071 @kindex set debugmemory
21072 @item set debugmemory
21073 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21074 and writes by the debugger.
21075
21076 @kindex set shell
21077 @item set shell
21078 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21079 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21080
21081 @kindex show shell
21082 @item show shell
21083 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21084
21085 @end table
21086
21087 @menu
21088 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21089 @end menu
21090
21091 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21092 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21093 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21094 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21095
21096 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21097 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21098 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21099 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21100 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21101 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21102 ``minimal symbols''.
21103
21104 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21105 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21106 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21107 program run once to completion.
21108
21109 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21110
21111 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21112 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21113 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21114 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21115 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21116 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21117 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21118 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21119 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21120
21121 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21122 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21123 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21124 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21125 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21126 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21127
21128 @smallexample
21129 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21130 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21131
21132 Non-debugging symbols:
21133 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21134 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21135 @end smallexample
21136
21137 @smallexample
21138 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21139 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21140
21141 Non-debugging symbols:
21142 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21143 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21144 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21145 [etc...]
21146 @end smallexample
21147
21148 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21149
21150 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21151 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21152 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21153 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21154 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21155 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21156 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21157
21158 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21159 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21160 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21161 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21162 problem:
21163
21164 @smallexample
21165 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21166 $1 = 268572168
21167 @end smallexample
21168
21169 @smallexample
21170 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21171 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21172 @end smallexample
21173
21174 And two possible solutions:
21175
21176 @smallexample
21177 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21178 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21179 @end smallexample
21180
21181 @smallexample
21182 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21183 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21184 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21185 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21186 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21187 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21188 @end smallexample
21189
21190 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21191 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21192 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21193 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21194 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21195
21196 @smallexample
21197 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21198 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21199 @end smallexample
21200
21201 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21202 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21203 safe.
21204
21205 @node Hurd Native
21206 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21207 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21208
21209 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21210 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21211
21212 @table @code
21213 @item set signals
21214 @itemx set sigs
21215 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21216 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21217 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21218 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21219 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21220 @code{signals}.
21221
21222 @item show signals
21223 @itemx show sigs
21224 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21225 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21226 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21227
21228 @item set signal-thread
21229 @itemx set sigthread
21230 @kindex set signal-thread
21231 @kindex set sigthread
21232 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21233 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21234 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21235 signal-thread}.
21236
21237 @item show signal-thread
21238 @itemx show sigthread
21239 @kindex show signal-thread
21240 @kindex show sigthread
21241 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21242 delivered a signal.
21243
21244 @item set stopped
21245 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21246 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21247 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21248 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21249
21250 @item show stopped
21251 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21252 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21253 stopped.
21254
21255 @item set exceptions
21256 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21257 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21258 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21259 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21260 trapping on.
21261
21262 @item show exceptions
21263 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21264 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21265
21266 @item set task pause
21267 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21268 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21269 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21270 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21271 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21272 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21273 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21274 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21275 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21276
21277 @item show task pause
21278 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21279 Show the current state of task suspension.
21280
21281 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21282 @cindex task suspend count
21283 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21284 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21285 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21286
21287 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21288 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21289
21290 @item set task exception-port
21291 @itemx set task excp
21292 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21293 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21294 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21295 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21296
21297 @item set noninvasive
21298 @cindex noninvasive task options
21299 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21300 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21301 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21302 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21303
21304 @item info send-rights
21305 @itemx info receive-rights
21306 @itemx info port-rights
21307 @itemx info port-sets
21308 @itemx info dead-names
21309 @itemx info ports
21310 @itemx info psets
21311 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21312 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21313 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21314 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21315 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21316 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21317 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21318 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21319 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21320
21321 @item set thread pause
21322 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21323 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21324 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21325 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21326 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21327 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21328 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21329 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21330 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21331 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21332 only the current thread.
21333
21334 @item show thread pause
21335 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21336 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21337
21338 @item set thread run
21339 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21340
21341 @item show thread run
21342 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21343
21344 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21345 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21346 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21347 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21348 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21349 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21350 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21351
21352 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21353 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21354 detaching.
21355
21356 @item set thread exception-port
21357 @itemx set thread excp
21358 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21359 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21360 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21361
21362 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21363 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21364 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21365 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21366
21367 @item set thread default
21368 @itemx show thread default
21369 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21370 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21371 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21372 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21373 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21374 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21375 the non-default commands.
21376 @end table
21377
21378 @node Darwin
21379 @subsection Darwin
21380 @cindex Darwin
21381
21382 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21383
21384 @table @code
21385 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21386 @kindex set debug darwin
21387 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21388 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21389
21390 @item show debug darwin
21391 @kindex show debug darwin
21392 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21393
21394 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21395 @kindex set debug mach-o
21396 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21397 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21398 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21399 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21400 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21401 usage.
21402
21403 @item show debug mach-o
21404 @kindex show debug mach-o
21405 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21406
21407 @item set mach-exceptions on
21408 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21409 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21410 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21411 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21412 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21413 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21414
21415 @item show mach-exceptions
21416 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21417 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21418 @end table
21419
21420
21421 @node Embedded OS
21422 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21423
21424 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21425 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21426 architectures.
21427
21428 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21429 various real-time operating systems.
21430
21431 @node Embedded Processors
21432 @section Embedded Processors
21433
21434 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21435 configurations.
21436
21437 @cindex send command to simulator
21438 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21439 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21440
21441 @table @code
21442 @item sim @var{command}
21443 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21444 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21445 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21446 acceptable commands.
21447 @end table
21448
21449
21450 @menu
21451 * ARM:: ARM
21452 * M32R/SDI:: Renesas M32R/SDI
21453 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21454 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21455 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21456 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21457 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21458 * CRIS:: CRIS
21459 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21460 @end menu
21461
21462 @node ARM
21463 @subsection ARM
21464
21465 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21466
21467 @table @code
21468 @item set arm disassembler
21469 @kindex set arm
21470 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21471 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21472
21473 @item show arm disassembler
21474 @kindex show arm
21475 Show the current disassembly style.
21476
21477 @item set arm apcs32
21478 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21479 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21480
21481 @item show arm apcs32
21482 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21483
21484 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21485 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21486 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21487
21488 @table @code
21489 @item auto
21490 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21491 @item softfpa
21492 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21493 processors.
21494 @item fpa
21495 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21496 @item softvfp
21497 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21498 @item vfp
21499 VFP co-processor.
21500 @end table
21501
21502 @item show arm fpu
21503 Show the current type of the FPU.
21504
21505 @item set arm abi
21506 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21507
21508 @item show arm abi
21509 Show the currently used ABI.
21510
21511 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21512 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21513 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21514 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21515 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21516 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21517 register).
21518
21519 @item show arm fallback-mode
21520 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21521
21522 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21523 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21524 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21525 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21526 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21527
21528 @item show arm force-mode
21529 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21530
21531 @item set debug arm
21532 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21533 target support subsystem.
21534
21535 @item show debug arm
21536 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21537 @end table
21538
21539 @table @code
21540 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21541 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21542
21543 @table @code
21544 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21545 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21546 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21547 The default value is @code{all}.
21548
21549 @table @code
21550 @item none
21551 @item demon
21552 @item angel
21553 @item redboot
21554 @item all
21555 @end table
21556 @end table
21557 @end table
21558
21559 @node M32R/SDI
21560 @subsection Renesas M32R/SDI
21561
21562 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21563
21564 @table @code
21565 @item sdireset
21566 @kindex sdireset
21567 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21568 This command resets the SDI connection.
21569
21570 @item sdistatus
21571 @kindex sdistatus
21572 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21573
21574 @item debug_chaos
21575 @kindex debug_chaos
21576 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21577 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21578
21579 @item use_debug_dma
21580 @kindex use_debug_dma
21581 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21582
21583 @item use_mon_code
21584 @kindex use_mon_code
21585 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21586
21587 @item use_ib_break
21588 @kindex use_ib_break
21589 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21590
21591 @item use_dbt_break
21592 @kindex use_dbt_break
21593 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21594 @end table
21595
21596 @node M68K
21597 @subsection M68k
21598
21599 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
21600
21601 @node MicroBlaze
21602 @subsection MicroBlaze
21603 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21604 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21605
21606 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21607 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21608 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21609 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21610 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21611 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21612 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21613 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21614 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21615 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21616 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21617
21618 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21619
21620 @table @code
21621 @item target remote :1234
21622 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21623 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21624
21625 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21626 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21627 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21628
21629 @item load
21630 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21631
21632 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21633 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21634
21635 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21636 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21637 @end table
21638
21639 @node MIPS Embedded
21640 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21641
21642 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21643 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21644 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21645 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21646
21647 @need 1000
21648 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21649
21650 @table @code
21651 @item target mips @var{port}
21652 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21653 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21654 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21655 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21656 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21657 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21658 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21659
21660 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21661 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21662 debugger:
21663
21664 @smallexample
21665 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21666 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21667 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21668 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21669 (@value{GDBP}) run
21670 @end smallexample
21671
21672 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21673 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21674 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21675 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21676 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21677
21678 @item target pmon @var{port}
21679 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21680 PMON ROM monitor.
21681
21682 @item target ddb @var{port}
21683 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21684 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21685
21686 @item target lsi @var{port}
21687 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21688 LSI variant of PMON.
21689
21690 @end table
21691
21692
21693 @noindent
21694 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21695
21696 @table @code
21697 @item set mipsfpu double
21698 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21699 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21700 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21701 @itemx show mipsfpu
21702 @kindex set mipsfpu
21703 @kindex show mipsfpu
21704 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21705 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21706 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21707 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21708 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21709 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21710 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21711 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21712 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21713 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21714 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21715 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21716 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21717
21718 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21719 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21720 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21721
21722 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21723 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21724
21725 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21726 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21727 @itemx show timeout
21728 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21729 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21730 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21731 @kindex set timeout
21732 @kindex show timeout
21733 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21734 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21735 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21736 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21737 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21738 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21739 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21740 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21741 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21742 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21743
21744 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21745 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21746 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21747 to run before stopping.
21748
21749 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21750 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21751 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21752 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21753 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21754 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21755
21756 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21757 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21758 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21759 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21760
21761 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21762 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21763 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21764 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21765 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21766 @table @asis
21767 @item pmon target
21768 @samp{PMON}
21769 @item ddb target
21770 @samp{NEC010}
21771 @item lsi target
21772 @samp{PMON>}
21773 @end table
21774
21775 @item show monitor-prompt
21776 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21777 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21778 remote monitor.
21779
21780 @item set monitor-warnings
21781 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21782 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21783 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21784 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21785 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21786
21787 @item show monitor-warnings
21788 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21789 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21790
21791 @item pmon @var{command}
21792 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21793 @cindex send PMON command
21794 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21795 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21796 @end table
21797
21798 @node PowerPC Embedded
21799 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21800
21801 @cindex DVC register
21802 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21803 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21804
21805 @smallexample
21806 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21807 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21808 @end smallexample
21809
21810 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21811 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21812 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21813 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21814 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21815 or newer.
21816
21817 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21818 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21819 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21820 watching variables of scalar types.
21821
21822 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21823 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21824
21825 @smallexample
21826 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21827 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21828 @end smallexample
21829
21830 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21831 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21832
21833 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21834 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21835 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21836 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21837 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21838 use the @code{break-range} command.
21839
21840 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21841
21842 @table @code
21843 @kindex break-range
21844 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21845 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21846 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21847 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21848 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21849 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21850 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21851 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21852 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21853
21854 @kindex set powerpc
21855 @item set powerpc soft-float
21856 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21857 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21858 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21859 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21860
21861 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21862 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21863 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21864 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21865 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21866 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21867 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21868 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21869
21870 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21871 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21872 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21873 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21874 address of its first byte.
21875
21876 @end table
21877
21878 @node AVR
21879 @subsection Atmel AVR
21880 @cindex AVR
21881
21882 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21883 following AVR-specific commands:
21884
21885 @table @code
21886 @item info io_registers
21887 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21888 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21889 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21890 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21891 @end table
21892
21893 @node CRIS
21894 @subsection CRIS
21895 @cindex CRIS
21896
21897 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21898 following CRIS-specific commands:
21899
21900 @table @code
21901 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21902 @cindex CRIS version
21903 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21904 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21905 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21906
21907 @item show cris-version
21908 Show the current CRIS version.
21909
21910 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21911 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21912 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21913 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21914 @code{R59}.
21915
21916 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21917 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21918
21919 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21920 @cindex CRIS mode
21921 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21922 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21923 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21924
21925 @item show cris-mode
21926 Show the current CRIS mode.
21927 @end table
21928
21929 @node Super-H
21930 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21931 @cindex Super-H
21932
21933 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21934 commands:
21935
21936 @table @code
21937 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21938 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21939 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21940 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21941 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21942 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21943 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21944 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21945 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21946 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21947 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21948 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21949
21950 @item show sh calling-convention
21951 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21952 Show the current calling convention setting.
21953
21954 @end table
21955
21956
21957 @node Architectures
21958 @section Architectures
21959
21960 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21961 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21962
21963 @menu
21964 * AArch64::
21965 * i386::
21966 * Alpha::
21967 * MIPS::
21968 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21969 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21970 * PowerPC::
21971 * Nios II::
21972 @end menu
21973
21974 @node AArch64
21975 @subsection AArch64
21976 @cindex AArch64 support
21977
21978 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21979 following special commands:
21980
21981 @table @code
21982 @item set debug aarch64
21983 @kindex set debug aarch64
21984 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21985 messages are to be displayed.
21986
21987 @item show debug aarch64
21988 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21989
21990 @end table
21991
21992 @node i386
21993 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21994
21995 @table @code
21996 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21997 @kindex set struct-convention
21998 @cindex struct return convention
21999 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22000 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22001 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22002 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22003 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22004 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22005 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22006 be returned in a register.
22007
22008 @item show struct-convention
22009 @kindex show struct-convention
22010 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22011 from functions.
22012 @end table
22013
22014
22015 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22016 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22017
22018 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22019 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22020 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22021 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22022 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22023 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22024 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22025
22026 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22027 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22028 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22029 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22030 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22031 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22032
22033 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22034 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22035 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22036
22037 @smallexample
22038 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22039 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22040 @end smallexample
22041
22042 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22043 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22044 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22045 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22046 the pointer.
22047
22048 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22049 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22050 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22051 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22052 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22053
22054 @table @code
22055 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22056 @kindex show mpx bound
22057 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22058
22059 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22060 @kindex set mpx bound
22061 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22062 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22063 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22064 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22065 @end table
22066
22067 @node Alpha
22068 @subsection Alpha
22069
22070 See the following section.
22071
22072 @node MIPS
22073 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22074
22075 @cindex stack on Alpha
22076 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22077 @cindex Alpha stack
22078 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22079 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22080 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22081 find the beginning of a function.
22082
22083 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22084 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22085 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22086 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22087 commands:
22088
22089 @table @code
22090 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22091 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22092 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22093 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22094 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22095 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22096 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22097 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22098
22099 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22100 Display the current limit.
22101 @end table
22102
22103 @noindent
22104 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22105 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22106
22107 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22108 programs:
22109
22110 @table @code
22111 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22112 @kindex set mips abi
22113 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22114 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22115 values of @var{arg} are:
22116
22117 @table @samp
22118 @item auto
22119 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22120 default).
22121 @item o32
22122 @item o64
22123 @item n32
22124 @item n64
22125 @item eabi32
22126 @item eabi64
22127 @end table
22128
22129 @item show mips abi
22130 @kindex show mips abi
22131 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22132
22133 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22134 @kindex set mips compression
22135 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22136 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22137 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22138 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22139 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22140 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22141 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22142 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22143 provided by the executable.
22144
22145 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22146 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22147 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22148 identified as such.
22149
22150 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22151 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22152 implicitly from an executable.
22153
22154 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22155 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22156 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22157 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22158 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22159
22160 @item show mips compression
22161 @kindex show mips compression
22162 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22163 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22164
22165 @item set mipsfpu
22166 @itemx show mipsfpu
22167 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22168
22169 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22170 @kindex set mips mask-address
22171 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22172 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22173 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22174 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22175 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22176
22177 @item show mips mask-address
22178 @kindex show mips mask-address
22179 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22180 not.
22181
22182 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22183 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22184 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22185 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22186 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22187 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22188
22189 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22190 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22191 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22192
22193 @item set debug mips
22194 @kindex set debug mips
22195 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22196 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22197
22198 @item show debug mips
22199 @kindex show debug mips
22200 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22201 @end table
22202
22203
22204 @node HPPA
22205 @subsection HPPA
22206 @cindex HPPA support
22207
22208 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22209 following special commands:
22210
22211 @table @code
22212 @item set debug hppa
22213 @kindex set debug hppa
22214 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22215 messages are to be displayed.
22216
22217 @item show debug hppa
22218 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22219
22220 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22221 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22222 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22223 given @var{address}.
22224
22225 @end table
22226
22227
22228 @node SPU
22229 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22230 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22231 @cindex SPU
22232
22233 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22234 it provides the following special commands:
22235
22236 @table @code
22237 @item info spu event
22238 @kindex info spu
22239 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22240 and pending event status.
22241
22242 @item info spu signal
22243 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22244 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22245 notification channels.
22246
22247 @item info spu mailbox
22248 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22249 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22250 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22251
22252 @item info spu dma
22253 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22254 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22255 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22256
22257 @item info spu proxydma
22258 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22259 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22260 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22261
22262 @end table
22263
22264 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22265 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22266 special commands:
22267
22268 @table @code
22269 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22270 @kindex set spu
22271 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22272 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22273 function. The default is @code{off}.
22274
22275 @item show spu stop-on-load
22276 @kindex show spu
22277 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22278
22279 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22280 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22281 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22282 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22283 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22284 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22285
22286 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22287 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22288
22289 @end table
22290
22291 @node PowerPC
22292 @subsection PowerPC
22293 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22294
22295 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22296 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22297 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22298 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22299 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22300
22301 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22302 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22303 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22304
22305 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22306 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22307
22308 @node Nios II
22309 @subsection Nios II
22310 @cindex Nios II architecture
22311
22312 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22313 it provides the following special commands:
22314
22315 @table @code
22316
22317 @item set debug nios2
22318 @kindex set debug nios2
22319 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22320 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22321
22322 @item show debug nios2
22323 @kindex show debug nios2
22324 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22325 @end table
22326
22327 @node Controlling GDB
22328 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22329
22330 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22331 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22332 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22333 described here.
22334
22335 @menu
22336 * Prompt:: Prompt
22337 * Editing:: Command editing
22338 * Command History:: Command history
22339 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22340 * Numbers:: Numbers
22341 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22342 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22343 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22344 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22345 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22346 @end menu
22347
22348 @node Prompt
22349 @section Prompt
22350
22351 @cindex prompt
22352
22353 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22354 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22355 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22356 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22357 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22358 which one you are talking to.
22359
22360 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22361 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22362 or a prompt that does not.
22363
22364 @table @code
22365 @kindex set prompt
22366 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22367 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22368
22369 @kindex show prompt
22370 @item show prompt
22371 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22372 @end table
22373
22374 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22375 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22376 are:
22377
22378 @table @code
22379 @kindex set extended-prompt
22380 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22381 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22382 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22383 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22384 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22385 is displayed.
22386
22387 For example:
22388
22389 @smallexample
22390 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22391 @end smallexample
22392
22393 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22394 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22395
22396 @kindex show extended-prompt
22397 @item show extended-prompt
22398 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22399 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22400 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22401 @end table
22402
22403 @node Editing
22404 @section Command Editing
22405 @cindex readline
22406 @cindex command line editing
22407
22408 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22409 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22410 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22411 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22412 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22413 debugging sessions.
22414
22415 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22416 command @code{set}.
22417
22418 @table @code
22419 @kindex set editing
22420 @cindex editing
22421 @item set editing
22422 @itemx set editing on
22423 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22424
22425 @item set editing off
22426 Disable command line editing.
22427
22428 @kindex show editing
22429 @item show editing
22430 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22431 @end table
22432
22433 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22434 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22435 @end ifset
22436 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22437 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22438 @end ifclear
22439 for more details about the Readline
22440 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22441 encouraged to read that chapter.
22442
22443 @node Command History
22444 @section Command History
22445 @cindex command history
22446
22447 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22448 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22449 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22450 history facility.
22451
22452 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22453 package, to provide the history facility.
22454 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22455 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22456 @end ifset
22457 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22458 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22459 @end ifclear
22460 for the detailed description of the History library.
22461
22462 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22463 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22464 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22465 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22466 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22467 pressed on a line by itself.
22468
22469 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22470 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22471 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22472 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22473
22474 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22475 history.
22476
22477 @table @code
22478 @cindex history substitution
22479 @cindex history file
22480 @kindex set history filename
22481 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22482 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22483 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22484 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22485 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22486 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22487 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22488 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22489 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22490 is not set.
22491
22492 @cindex save command history
22493 @kindex set history save
22494 @item set history save
22495 @itemx set history save on
22496 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22497 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22498
22499 @item set history save off
22500 Stop recording command history in a file.
22501
22502 @cindex history size
22503 @kindex set history size
22504 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22505 @item set history size @var{size}
22506 @itemx set history size unlimited
22507 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22508 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22509 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22510 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22511 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22512 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22513
22514 @cindex remove duplicate history
22515 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22516 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22517 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22518 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22519 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22520 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22521 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22522 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22523 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22524
22525 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22526 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22527
22528 @end table
22529
22530 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22531 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22532 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22533 @end ifset
22534 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22535 @xref{Event Designators},
22536 @end ifclear
22537 for more details.
22538
22539 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22540 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22541 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22542 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22543 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22544 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22545 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22546 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22547
22548 The commands to control history expansion are:
22549
22550 @table @code
22551 @item set history expansion on
22552 @itemx set history expansion
22553 @kindex set history expansion
22554 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22555
22556 @item set history expansion off
22557 Disable history expansion.
22558
22559 @c @group
22560 @kindex show history
22561 @item show history
22562 @itemx show history filename
22563 @itemx show history save
22564 @itemx show history size
22565 @itemx show history expansion
22566 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22567 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22568 @c @end group
22569 @end table
22570
22571 @table @code
22572 @kindex show commands
22573 @cindex show last commands
22574 @cindex display command history
22575 @item show commands
22576 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22577
22578 @item show commands @var{n}
22579 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22580
22581 @item show commands +
22582 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22583 @end table
22584
22585 @node Screen Size
22586 @section Screen Size
22587 @cindex size of screen
22588 @cindex screen size
22589 @cindex pagination
22590 @cindex page size
22591 @cindex pauses in output
22592
22593 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22594 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22595 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22596 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22597 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22598 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22599 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22600 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22601
22602 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22603 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22604 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22605 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22606 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22607 width} commands:
22608
22609 @table @code
22610 @kindex set height
22611 @kindex set width
22612 @kindex show width
22613 @kindex show height
22614 @item set height @var{lpp}
22615 @itemx set height unlimited
22616 @itemx show height
22617 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22618 @itemx set width unlimited
22619 @itemx show width
22620 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22621 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22622 commands display the current settings.
22623
22624 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22625 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22626 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22627 buffer.
22628
22629 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22630 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22631
22632 @item set pagination on
22633 @itemx set pagination off
22634 @kindex set pagination
22635 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22636 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22637 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22638 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22639
22640 @item show pagination
22641 @kindex show pagination
22642 Show the current pagination mode.
22643 @end table
22644
22645 @node Numbers
22646 @section Numbers
22647 @cindex number representation
22648 @cindex entering numbers
22649
22650 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22651 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22652 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22653 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22654 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22655 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22656 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22657 both input and output with the commands described below.
22658
22659 @table @code
22660 @kindex set input-radix
22661 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22662 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22663 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22664 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22665 example, any of
22666
22667 @smallexample
22668 set input-radix 012
22669 set input-radix 10.
22670 set input-radix 0xa
22671 @end smallexample
22672
22673 @noindent
22674 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22675 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22676 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22677 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22678 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22679 change the radix.
22680
22681 @kindex set output-radix
22682 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22683 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22684 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22685 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22686
22687 @kindex show input-radix
22688 @item show input-radix
22689 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22690
22691 @kindex show output-radix
22692 @item show output-radix
22693 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22694
22695 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22696 @itemx show radix
22697 @kindex set radix
22698 @kindex show radix
22699 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22700 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22701 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22702 default value of 10.
22703
22704 @end table
22705
22706 @node ABI
22707 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22708
22709 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22710 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22711 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22712 current ABI.
22713
22714 @cindex OS ABI
22715 @kindex set osabi
22716 @kindex show osabi
22717 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22718
22719 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22720 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22721 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22722 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22723 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22724 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22725 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22726 platform provides.
22727
22728 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22729 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22730 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22731 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22732
22733 @table @code
22734 @item show osabi
22735 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22736
22737 @item set osabi
22738 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22739
22740 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22741 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22742 @end table
22743
22744 @cindex float promotion
22745
22746 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22747 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22748 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22749 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22750 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22751 @code{double} and then passed.
22752
22753 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22754 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22755 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22756
22757 @table @code
22758 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22759 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22760 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22761 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22762 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22763
22764 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22765 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22766 functions.
22767
22768 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22769 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22770 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22771 @end table
22772
22773 @kindex set cp-abi
22774 @kindex show cp-abi
22775 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22776 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22777 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22778 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22779 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22780 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22781 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22782 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22783 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22784 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22785 ``auto''.
22786
22787 @table @code
22788 @item show cp-abi
22789 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22790
22791 @item set cp-abi
22792 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22793
22794 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22795 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22796 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22797 @end table
22798
22799 @node Auto-loading
22800 @section Automatically loading associated files
22801 @cindex auto-loading
22802
22803 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22804 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22805 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22806 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22807 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22808 sources).
22809
22810 @menu
22811 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22812 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22813
22814 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22815 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22816 @end menu
22817
22818 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22819 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22820 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22821
22822 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22823 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22824 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22825
22826 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22827 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22828
22829 @table @code
22830 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22831 @kindex set auto-load off
22832 @item set auto-load off
22833 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22834 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22835 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22836 @smallexample
22837 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22838 @end smallexample
22839
22840 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22841 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22842 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22843 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22844 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22845 @code{set auto-load no}.
22846
22847 @anchor{show auto-load}
22848 @kindex show auto-load
22849 @item show auto-load
22850 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22851 or disabled.
22852
22853 @smallexample
22854 (gdb) show auto-load
22855 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22856 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22857 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22858 is on.
22859 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22860 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22861 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22862 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22863 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22864 @end smallexample
22865
22866 @anchor{info auto-load}
22867 @kindex info auto-load
22868 @item info auto-load
22869 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22870 not.
22871
22872 @smallexample
22873 (gdb) info auto-load
22874 gdb-scripts:
22875 Loaded Script
22876 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22877 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22878 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22879 loaded.
22880 python-scripts:
22881 Loaded Script
22882 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22883 @end smallexample
22884 @end table
22885
22886 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22887
22888 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22889 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22890 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22891 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22892 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22893 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22894 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22895 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22896 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22897 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22898 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22899 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22900 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22901 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22902 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22903 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22904 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22905 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22906 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22907 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22908 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22909 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22910 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22911 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22912 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22913 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22914 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22915 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22916 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22917 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
22918 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
22919 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22920 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22921 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22922 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22923 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22924 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22925 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22926 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22927 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22928 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22929 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22930 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22931 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22932 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22933 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22934 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22935 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22936 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22937 @end multitable
22938
22939 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22940 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22941 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22942
22943 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22944 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22945 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22946
22947 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22948 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22949
22950 @table @code
22951 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22952 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22953 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22954 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22955 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22956
22957 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22958 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22959 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22960 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22961 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22962
22963 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22964 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22965 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22966 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22967 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22968 @end table
22969
22970 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22971 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22972 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22973
22974 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22975
22976 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22977 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22978
22979 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22980 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22981 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22982 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22983 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22984 library.
22985
22986 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22987 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22988
22989 @table @code
22990 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22991 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22992 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22993 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22994
22995 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22996 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22997 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22998 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22999 enabled or disabled.
23000
23001 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23002 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23003 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23004 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23005 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23006 @end table
23007
23008 @node Auto-loading safe path
23009 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23010 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23011
23012 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23013 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23014 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23015 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23016 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23017
23018 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23019 get loaded:
23020
23021 @smallexample
23022 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23023 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23024 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23025 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23026 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23027 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23028 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23029 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23030 @end smallexample
23031
23032 @noindent
23033 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23034 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23035
23036 @smallexample
23037 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23038 @end smallexample
23039
23040 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23041
23042 @table @code
23043 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23044 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23045 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23046 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23047 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23048 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23049 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23050 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23051 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23052 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23053
23054 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23055 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23056 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23057
23058 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23059 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23060 @item show auto-load safe-path
23061 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23062 scripts.
23063
23064 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23065 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23066 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23067 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23068 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23069 by the host platform path separator in use.
23070 @end table
23071
23072 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23073 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23074 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23075 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23076 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23077
23078 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23079 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23080 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23081 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23082 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23083 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23084 init file in the current directory
23085 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23086
23087 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23088 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23089
23090 @table @asis
23091 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23092 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23093 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23094 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23095
23096 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23097 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23098 @value{GDBN} session.
23099
23100 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23101 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23102 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23103 from trusted sources.
23104
23105 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23106 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23107 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23108 trusted sources.
23109 @end table
23110
23111 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23112 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23113
23114 @table @asis
23115 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23116 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23117
23118 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23119 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23120 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23121 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23122 @end table
23123
23124 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23125 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23126 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23127 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23128 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23129 recommended to be entered.
23130
23131 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23132 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23133 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23134
23135 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23136 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23137 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23138 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23139 be printed.
23140
23141 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23142 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23143 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23144
23145 @smallexample
23146 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23147 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23148 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23149 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23150 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23151 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23152 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23153 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23154 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23155 @end smallexample
23156
23157 @table @code
23158 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23159 @kindex set debug auto-load
23160 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23161 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23162
23163 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23164 @kindex show debug auto-load
23165 @item show debug auto-load
23166 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23167 on or off.
23168 @end table
23169
23170 @node Messages/Warnings
23171 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23172
23173 @cindex verbose operation
23174 @cindex optional warnings
23175 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23176 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23177 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23178 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23179
23180 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23181 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23182 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23183
23184 @table @code
23185 @kindex set verbose
23186 @item set verbose on
23187 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23188
23189 @item set verbose off
23190 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23191
23192 @kindex show verbose
23193 @item show verbose
23194 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23195 @end table
23196
23197 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23198 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23199 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23200 Symbol Files}).
23201
23202 @table @code
23203
23204 @kindex set complaints
23205 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23206 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23207 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23208 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23209 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23210
23211 @kindex show complaints
23212 @item show complaints
23213 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23214
23215 @end table
23216
23217 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23218 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23219 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23220 you try to run a program which is already running:
23221
23222 @smallexample
23223 (@value{GDBP}) run
23224 The program being debugged has been started already.
23225 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23226 @end smallexample
23227
23228 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23229 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23230
23231 @table @code
23232
23233 @kindex set confirm
23234 @cindex flinching
23235 @cindex confirmation
23236 @cindex stupid questions
23237 @item set confirm off
23238 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23239 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23240 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23241
23242 @item set confirm on
23243 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23244
23245 @kindex show confirm
23246 @item show confirm
23247 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23248
23249 @end table
23250
23251 @cindex command tracing
23252 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23253 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23254 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23255 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23256
23257 @table @code
23258 @kindex set trace-commands
23259 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23260 @item set trace-commands on
23261 Enable command tracing.
23262 @item set trace-commands off
23263 Disable command tracing.
23264 @item show trace-commands
23265 Display the current state of command tracing.
23266 @end table
23267
23268 @node Debugging Output
23269 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23270 @cindex optional debugging messages
23271
23272 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23273 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23274 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23275 section documents those commands.
23276
23277 @table @code
23278 @kindex set exec-done-display
23279 @item set exec-done-display
23280 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23281 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23282 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23283 @kindex show exec-done-display
23284 @item show exec-done-display
23285 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23286 notification.
23287 @kindex set debug
23288 @cindex ARM AArch64
23289 @item set debug aarch64
23290 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23291 The default is off.
23292 @kindex show debug
23293 @item show debug aarch64
23294 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23295 ARM AArch64.
23296 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23297 @cindex architecture debugging info
23298 @item set debug arch
23299 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23300 @item show debug arch
23301 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23302 @item set debug aix-solib
23303 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23304 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23305 support module. The default is off.
23306 @item show debug aix-thread
23307 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23308 @item set debug aix-thread
23309 @cindex AIX threads
23310 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23311 module.
23312 @item show debug aix-thread
23313 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23314 @item set debug check-physname
23315 @cindex physname
23316 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23317 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23318 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23319 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23320 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23321 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23322 @item show debug check-physname
23323 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23324 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23325 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23326 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23327 exported symbols. The default is off.
23328 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23329 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23330 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23331 @item set debug dwarf-die
23332 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23333 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23334 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23335 A value of zero turns off the display.
23336 @item show debug dwarf-die
23337 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23338 @item set debug dwarf-line
23339 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23340 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23341 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23342 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23343 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23344 @item show debug dwarf-line
23345 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23346 @item set debug dwarf-read
23347 @cindex DWARF Reading
23348 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23349 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23350 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23351 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23352 @item show debug dwarf-read
23353 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23354 @item set debug displaced
23355 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23356 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23357 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23358 @item show debug displaced
23359 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23360 related to displaced stepping.
23361 @item set debug event
23362 @cindex event debugging info
23363 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23364 default is off.
23365 @item show debug event
23366 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23367 info.
23368 @item set debug expression
23369 @cindex expression debugging info
23370 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23371 expression parsing. The default is off.
23372 @item show debug expression
23373 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23374 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23375 @item set debug frame
23376 @cindex frame debugging info
23377 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23378 default is off.
23379 @item show debug frame
23380 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23381 info.
23382 @item set debug gnu-nat
23383 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23384 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23385 @item show debug gnu-nat
23386 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23387 @item set debug infrun
23388 @cindex inferior debugging info
23389 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23390 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23391 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23392 @item show debug infrun
23393 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23394 @item set debug jit
23395 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23396 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23397 @item show debug jit
23398 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23399 @item set debug lin-lwp
23400 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23401 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23402 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23403 @item show debug lin-lwp
23404 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23405 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23406 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23407 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23408 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23409 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23410 @item set debug mach-o
23411 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23412 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23413 processing. The default is off.
23414 @item show debug mach-o
23415 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23416 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23417 @item set debug notification
23418 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23419 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23420 The default is off.
23421 @item show debug notification
23422 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23423 @item set debug observer
23424 @cindex observer debugging info
23425 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23426 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23427 @item show debug observer
23428 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23429 @item set debug overload
23430 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23431 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23432 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23433 is off.
23434 @item show debug overload
23435 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23436 debugging info.
23437 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23438 @cindex debug expression parser
23439 @item set debug parser
23440 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23441 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23442 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23443 details. The default is off.
23444 @item show debug parser
23445 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23446 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23447 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23448 @cindex debug remote protocol
23449 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23450 @cindex display remote packets
23451 @item set debug remote
23452 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23453 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23454 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23455 @item show debug remote
23456 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23457 @item set debug serial
23458 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23459 default is off.
23460 @item show debug serial
23461 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23462 info.
23463 @item set debug solib-frv
23464 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23465 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23466 @item show debug solib-frv
23467 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23468 messages.
23469 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23470 @cindex symbol lookup
23471 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23472 The default is 0 (off).
23473 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23474 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23475 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23476 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23477 @item set debug symfile
23478 @cindex symbol file functions
23479 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23480 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23481 @item show debug symfile
23482 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23483 @item set debug symtab-create
23484 @cindex symbol table creation
23485 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23486 The default is 0 (off).
23487 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23488 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23489 @item show debug symtab-create
23490 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23491 @item set debug target
23492 @cindex target debugging info
23493 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23494 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23495 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23496 value of large memory transfers.
23497 @item show debug target
23498 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23499 info.
23500 @item set debug timestamp
23501 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23502 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23503 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23504 message.
23505 @item show debug timestamp
23506 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23507 debugging info.
23508 @item set debug varobj
23509 @cindex variable object debugging info
23510 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23511 info. The default is off.
23512 @item show debug varobj
23513 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23514 debugging info.
23515 @item set debug xml
23516 @cindex XML parser debugging
23517 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23518 @item show debug xml
23519 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23520 @end table
23521
23522 @node Other Misc Settings
23523 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23524 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23525
23526 @table @code
23527 @kindex set interactive-mode
23528 @item set interactive-mode
23529 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23530 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23531 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23532 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23533 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23534 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23535 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23536 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23537
23538 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23539 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23540 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23541 inside a cygwin window.
23542
23543 @kindex show interactive-mode
23544 @item show interactive-mode
23545 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23546 @end table
23547
23548 @node Extending GDB
23549 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23550 @cindex extending GDB
23551
23552 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23553 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23554 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23555 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23556 being debugged.
23557
23558 @menu
23559 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23560 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23561 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23562 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23563 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23564 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23565 @end menu
23566
23567 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23568 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23569 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23570 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23571 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23572 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23573
23574 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23575 setting:
23576
23577 @table @code
23578 @kindex set script-extension
23579 @kindex show script-extension
23580 @item set script-extension off
23581 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23582
23583 @item set script-extension soft
23584 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23585 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23586 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23587 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23588
23589 @item set script-extension strict
23590 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23591 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23592 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23593
23594 @item show script-extension
23595 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23596
23597 @end table
23598
23599 @node Sequences
23600 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23601
23602 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23603 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23604 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23605 files.
23606
23607 @menu
23608 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23609 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23610 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23611 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23612 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23613 @end menu
23614
23615 @node Define
23616 @subsection User-defined Commands
23617
23618 @cindex user-defined command
23619 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23620 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23621 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23622 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23623 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23624 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23625
23626 @smallexample
23627 define adder
23628 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23629 end
23630 @end smallexample
23631
23632 @noindent
23633 To execute the command use:
23634
23635 @smallexample
23636 adder 1 2 3
23637 @end smallexample
23638
23639 @noindent
23640 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23641 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23642 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23643 functions calls.
23644
23645 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23646 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23647 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23648 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23649
23650 @smallexample
23651 define adder
23652 if $argc == 2
23653 print $arg0 + $arg1
23654 end
23655 if $argc == 3
23656 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23657 end
23658 end
23659 @end smallexample
23660
23661 @table @code
23662
23663 @kindex define
23664 @item define @var{commandname}
23665 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23666 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23667 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23668 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23669 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23670 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23671
23672 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23673 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23674 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23675
23676 @kindex document
23677 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23678 @item document @var{commandname}
23679 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23680 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23681 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23682 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23683 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23684 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23685
23686 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23687 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23688 does not change the documentation.
23689
23690 @kindex dont-repeat
23691 @cindex don't repeat command
23692 @item dont-repeat
23693 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23694 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23695 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23696
23697 @kindex help user-defined
23698 @item help user-defined
23699 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23700 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23701 included (if any).
23702
23703 @kindex show user
23704 @item show user
23705 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23706 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23707 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23708 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23709 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23710
23711 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23712 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23713 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23714 @item show max-user-call-depth
23715 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23716 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23717 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23718 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23719 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23720 @end table
23721
23722 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23723 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23724
23725 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23726 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23727 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23728
23729 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23730 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23731 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23732 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23733
23734 @node Hooks
23735 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23736 @cindex command hooks
23737 @cindex hooks, for commands
23738 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23739
23740 @kindex hook
23741 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23742 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23743 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23744 before that command.
23745
23746 @cindex hooks, post-command
23747 @kindex hookpost
23748 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23749 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23750 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23751 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23752 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23753
23754 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23755 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23756
23757 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23758 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23759
23760 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23761 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23762 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23763 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23764 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23765
23766 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23767 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23768 you could define:
23769
23770 @smallexample
23771 define hook-stop
23772 handle SIGALRM nopass
23773 end
23774
23775 define hook-run
23776 handle SIGALRM pass
23777 end
23778
23779 define hook-continue
23780 handle SIGALRM pass
23781 end
23782 @end smallexample
23783
23784 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23785 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23786 you could define:
23787
23788 @smallexample
23789 define hook-echo
23790 echo <<<---
23791 end
23792
23793 define hookpost-echo
23794 echo --->>>\n
23795 end
23796
23797 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23798 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23799 (@value{GDBP})
23800
23801 @end smallexample
23802
23803 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23804 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23805 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23806 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23807 @c or not?
23808 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23809 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23810 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23811
23812 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23813 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23814 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23815
23816 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23817 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23818
23819 @node Command Files
23820 @subsection Command Files
23821
23822 @cindex command files
23823 @cindex scripting commands
23824 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23825 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23826 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23827 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23828 terminal.
23829
23830 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23831 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23832 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23833 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23834 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23835
23836 @table @code
23837 @kindex source
23838 @cindex execute commands from a file
23839 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23840 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23841 @end table
23842
23843 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23844 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23845 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23846 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23847 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23848
23849 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23850 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23851 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23852 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23853 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23854 is not relevant to scripts.
23855
23856 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23857 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23858 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23859 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23860 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23861 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23862 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23863 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23864 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23865 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23866 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23867 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23868 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23869 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23870
23871 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23872 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23873 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23874
23875 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23876 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23877 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23878 when called from command files.
23879
23880 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23881 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23882 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23883 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23884 the next command.
23885
23886 @smallexample
23887 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23888 @end smallexample
23889
23890 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23891 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23892 would be directed to @file{log}.
23893
23894 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23895 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23896 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23897 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23898 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23899 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23900 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23901 conditionally, etc.
23902
23903 @table @code
23904 @kindex if
23905 @kindex else
23906 @item if
23907 @itemx else
23908 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23909 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23910 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23911 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23912 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23913 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23914 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23915
23916 @kindex while
23917 @item while
23918 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23919 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23920 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23921 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23922 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23923 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23924
23925 @kindex loop_break
23926 @item loop_break
23927 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23928 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23929 line.
23930
23931 @kindex loop_continue
23932 @item loop_continue
23933 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23934 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23935 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23936 the controlling expression.
23937
23938 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23939 @item end
23940 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23941 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23942 @end table
23943
23944
23945 @node Output
23946 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23947
23948 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23949 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23950 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23951 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23952 want.
23953
23954 @table @code
23955 @kindex echo
23956 @item echo @var{text}
23957 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23958 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23959 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23960 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23961 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23962 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23963 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23964 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23965 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23966 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23967 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23968
23969 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23970 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23971
23972 @smallexample
23973 echo This is some text\n\
23974 which is continued\n\
23975 onto several lines.\n
23976 @end smallexample
23977
23978 produces the same output as
23979
23980 @smallexample
23981 echo This is some text\n
23982 echo which is continued\n
23983 echo onto several lines.\n
23984 @end smallexample
23985
23986 @kindex output
23987 @item output @var{expression}
23988 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23989 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23990 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23991 on expressions.
23992
23993 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23994 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23995 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23996 Formats}, for more information.
23997
23998 @kindex printf
23999 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24000 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24001 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24002 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24003 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24004 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24005 executing the code below:
24006
24007 @smallexample
24008 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24009 @end smallexample
24010
24011 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24012 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24013 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24014 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24015 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24016 printed.
24017
24018 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24019
24020 @smallexample
24021 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24022 @end smallexample
24023
24024 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24025 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24026 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24027
24028 @itemize @bullet
24029 @item
24030 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24031
24032 @item
24033 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24034 width.
24035
24036 @item
24037 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24038 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24039
24040 @item
24041 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24042 supported.
24043
24044 @item
24045 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24046
24047 @item
24048 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24049 @end itemize
24050
24051 @noindent
24052 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24053 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24054 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24055 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24056
24057 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24058 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24059 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24060 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24061 supported.
24062
24063 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24064 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24065 together with a floating point specifier.
24066 letters:
24067
24068 @itemize @bullet
24069 @item
24070 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24071
24072 @item
24073 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24074
24075 @item
24076 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24077 @end itemize
24078
24079 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24080 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24081 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24082
24083 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24084 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24085
24086 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24087 @smallexample
24088 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24089 @end smallexample
24090
24091 @kindex eval
24092 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24093 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24094 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24095
24096 @end table
24097
24098 @node Auto-loading sequences
24099 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24100 @cindex native script auto-loading
24101
24102 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24103 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24104 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24105 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24106
24107 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24108 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24109
24110 @table @code
24111 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24112 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24113 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24114 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24115
24116 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24117 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24118 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24119 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24120 disabled.
24121
24122 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24123 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24124 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24125 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24126 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24127 auto-loaded.
24128 @end table
24129
24130 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24131 matching names are printed.
24132
24133 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24134 @include python.texi
24135
24136 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24137 @include guile.texi
24138
24139 @node Auto-loading extensions
24140 @section Auto-loading extensions
24141 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24142
24143 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24144 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24145 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24146 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24147 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24148
24149 @menu
24150 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24151 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24152 * Which flavor to choose?::
24153 @end menu
24154
24155 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24156 debugging commands and features.
24157
24158 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24159 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24160 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24161 for more information.
24162 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24163 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24164
24165 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24166 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24167
24168 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24169 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24170 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24171 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24172 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24173
24174 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24175 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24176 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24177 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24178
24179 @table @code
24180 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24181 GDB's own command language
24182 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24183 Python
24184 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24185 Guile
24186 @end table
24187
24188 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24189 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24190 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24191 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24192 script in the specified extension language.
24193
24194 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24195 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24196
24197 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24198 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24199
24200 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24201 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24202 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24203 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24204 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24205 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24206
24207 @table @code
24208 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24209 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24210 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24211 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24212 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24213 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24214
24215 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24216 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24217
24218 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24219 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24220 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24221 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24222
24223 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24224 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24225 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24226 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24227 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24228 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24229 platform.
24230
24231 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24232 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24233 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24234
24235 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24236 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24237 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24238 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24239
24240 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24241 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24242 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24243 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24244 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24245 @end table
24246
24247 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24248 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24249 @var{objfile} is opened.
24250 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24251 is evaluated more than once.
24252
24253 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24254 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24255 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24256
24257 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24258 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24259 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24260 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24261 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24262 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24263 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24264
24265 The following entries are supported:
24266
24267 @table @code
24268 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24269 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24270 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24271 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24272 @end table
24273
24274 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24275
24276 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24277 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24278 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24279 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24280 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24281
24282 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24283 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24284
24285 @example
24286 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24287 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24288 asm("\
24289 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24290 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24291 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24292 .popsection \n\
24293 ");
24294 @end example
24295
24296 @noindent
24297 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24298 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24299
24300 @example
24301 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24302 @end example
24303
24304 The script name may include directories if desired.
24305
24306 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24307 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24308
24309 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24310 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24311 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24312 will remove duplicates.
24313
24314 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24315
24316 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24317 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24318 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24319 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24320 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24321 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24322 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24323 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24324 on its name.
24325
24326 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24327 testsuite.
24328
24329 @example
24330 #include "symcat.h"
24331 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24332 asm(
24333 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24334 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24335 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24336 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24337 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24338 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24339 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24340 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24341 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24342 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24343 ".byte 0\n"
24344 ".popsection\n"
24345 );
24346 @end example
24347
24348 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24349 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24350 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24351 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24352
24353 @node Which flavor to choose?
24354 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24355
24356 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24357 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24358
24359 @noindent
24360 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24361
24362 @itemize @bullet
24363 @item
24364 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24365
24366 @item
24367 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24368
24369 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24370 in the source search path.
24371 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24372 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24373
24374 @item
24375 Doesn't require source code additions.
24376 @end itemize
24377
24378 @noindent
24379 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24380
24381 @itemize @bullet
24382 @item
24383 Works with static linking.
24384
24385 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24386 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24387 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24388 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24389 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24390
24391 @item
24392 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24393
24394 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24395 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24396
24397 @item
24398 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24399
24400 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24401 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24402 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24403 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24404 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24405 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24406 @end itemize
24407
24408 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24409 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24410
24411 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24412 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24413 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24414
24415 @subsection Python comes first
24416
24417 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24418 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24419 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24420 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24421 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24422 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24423 pretty-printed form of a value).
24424 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24425 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24426 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24427
24428 @node Aliases
24429 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24430 @cindex aliases for commands
24431
24432 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24433 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24434 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24435 that involves less typing.
24436
24437 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24438 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24439 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24440
24441 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24442 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24443 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24444
24445 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24446
24447 @table @code
24448
24449 @kindex alias
24450 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24451
24452 @end table
24453
24454 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24455 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24456 underscores.
24457
24458 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24459 that is being aliased.
24460
24461 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24462 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24463 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24464
24465 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24466 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24467
24468 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24469 of a command so that there is less to type.
24470 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24471 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24472 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24473 The following will accomplish this.
24474
24475 @smallexample
24476 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24477 @end smallexample
24478
24479 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24480 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24481 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24482 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24483
24484 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24485 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24486 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24487 of a command.
24488
24489 @smallexample
24490 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24491 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24492 (gdb) set p elms 20
24493 (gdb) show p elms
24494 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24495 @end smallexample
24496
24497 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24498 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24499 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24500
24501 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24502 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24503
24504 @smallexample
24505 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24506 @end smallexample
24507
24508 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24509 alias for a more complex command.
24510 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24511
24512 @smallexample
24513 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24514 (gdb) spe 20
24515 @end smallexample
24516
24517 @node Interpreters
24518 @chapter Command Interpreters
24519 @cindex command interpreters
24520
24521 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24522 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24523 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24524
24525 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24526 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24527 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24528 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24529
24530 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24531 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24532 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24533 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24534
24535 @table @code
24536 @item console
24537 @cindex console interpreter
24538 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24539 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24540 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24541
24542 @item mi
24543 @cindex mi interpreter
24544 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24545 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24546 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24547 Interface}.
24548
24549 @item mi2
24550 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24551 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24552
24553 @item mi1
24554 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24555 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24556
24557 @end table
24558
24559 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24560 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24561 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24562 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24563 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24564 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24565 the IDE inoperable!
24566
24567 @kindex interpreter-exec
24568 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24569 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24570 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24571 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24572
24573 @smallexample
24574 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24575 @end smallexample
24576
24577 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24578 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24579
24580 @node TUI
24581 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24582 @cindex TUI
24583 @cindex Text User Interface
24584
24585 @menu
24586 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24587 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24588 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24589 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24590 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24591 @end menu
24592
24593 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24594 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24595 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24596 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24597 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24598 is available.
24599
24600 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24601 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24602 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24603 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
24604 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
24605 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24606
24607 @node TUI Overview
24608 @section TUI Overview
24609
24610 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24611
24612 @table @emph
24613 @item command
24614 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24615 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24616 managed using readline.
24617
24618 @item source
24619 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24620 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24621
24622 @item assembly
24623 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24624
24625 @item register
24626 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24627 when their values change.
24628 @end table
24629
24630 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24631 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24632 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24633 indicates the breakpoint type:
24634
24635 @table @code
24636 @item B
24637 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24638
24639 @item b
24640 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24641
24642 @item H
24643 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24644
24645 @item h
24646 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24647 @end table
24648
24649 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24650
24651 @table @code
24652 @item +
24653 Breakpoint is enabled.
24654
24655 @item -
24656 Breakpoint is disabled.
24657 @end table
24658
24659 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24660 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24661 changes.
24662
24663 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24664 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24665 layouts:
24666
24667 @itemize @bullet
24668 @item
24669 source only,
24670
24671 @item
24672 assembly only,
24673
24674 @item
24675 source and assembly,
24676
24677 @item
24678 source and registers, or
24679
24680 @item
24681 assembly and registers.
24682 @end itemize
24683
24684 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24685
24686 @table @emph
24687 @item target
24688 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24689 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24690
24691 @item process
24692 Gives the current process or thread number.
24693 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24694
24695 @item function
24696 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24697 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24698 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24699 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24700
24701 @item line
24702 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24703 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24704
24705 @item pc
24706 Indicates the current program counter address.
24707 @end table
24708
24709 @node TUI Keys
24710 @section TUI Key Bindings
24711 @cindex TUI key bindings
24712
24713 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24714 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24715 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24716 @end ifset
24717 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24718 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24719 @end ifclear
24720 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24721 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24722
24723 @table @kbd
24724 @kindex C-x C-a
24725 @item C-x C-a
24726 @kindex C-x a
24727 @itemx C-x a
24728 @kindex C-x A
24729 @itemx C-x A
24730 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24731 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24732 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24733 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24734 The screen is then refreshed.
24735
24736 @kindex C-x 1
24737 @item C-x 1
24738 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24739 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24740 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24741
24742 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24743
24744 @kindex C-x 2
24745 @item C-x 2
24746 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24747 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24748 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24749 previous layout and the new one.
24750
24751 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24752
24753 @kindex C-x o
24754 @item C-x o
24755 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24756 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24757 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24758
24759 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24760
24761 @kindex C-x s
24762 @item C-x s
24763 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24764 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24765 @end table
24766
24767 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24768
24769 @table @asis
24770 @kindex PgUp
24771 @item @key{PgUp}
24772 Scroll the active window one page up.
24773
24774 @kindex PgDn
24775 @item @key{PgDn}
24776 Scroll the active window one page down.
24777
24778 @kindex Up
24779 @item @key{Up}
24780 Scroll the active window one line up.
24781
24782 @kindex Down
24783 @item @key{Down}
24784 Scroll the active window one line down.
24785
24786 @kindex Left
24787 @item @key{Left}
24788 Scroll the active window one column left.
24789
24790 @kindex Right
24791 @item @key{Right}
24792 Scroll the active window one column right.
24793
24794 @kindex C-L
24795 @item @kbd{C-L}
24796 Refresh the screen.
24797 @end table
24798
24799 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24800 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24801 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24802 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24803 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24804
24805 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24806 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24807 @cindex TUI single key mode
24808
24809 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24810 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24811 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24812
24813 @table @kbd
24814 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24815 @item c
24816 continue
24817
24818 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24819 @item d
24820 down
24821
24822 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24823 @item f
24824 finish
24825
24826 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24827 @item n
24828 next
24829
24830 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24831 @item q
24832 exit the SingleKey mode.
24833
24834 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24835 @item r
24836 run
24837
24838 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24839 @item s
24840 step
24841
24842 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24843 @item u
24844 up
24845
24846 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24847 @item v
24848 info locals
24849
24850 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24851 @item w
24852 where
24853 @end table
24854
24855 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24856 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24857 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24858 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24859 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24860 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24861
24862
24863 @node TUI Commands
24864 @section TUI-specific Commands
24865 @cindex TUI commands
24866
24867 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24868 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24869 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24870 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24871
24872 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24873 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24874 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24875 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24876 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24877
24878 @table @code
24879 @item tui enable
24880 @kindex tui enable
24881 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
24882 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
24883 otherwise a default layout is used.
24884
24885 @item tui disable
24886 @kindex tui disable
24887 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
24888
24889 @item info win
24890 @kindex info win
24891 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24892
24893 @item layout @var{name}
24894 @kindex layout
24895 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
24896 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
24897 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
24898
24899 @table @code
24900 @item next
24901 Display the next layout.
24902
24903 @item prev
24904 Display the previous layout.
24905
24906 @item src
24907 Display the source and command windows.
24908
24909 @item asm
24910 Display the assembly and command windows.
24911
24912 @item split
24913 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
24914
24915 @item regs
24916 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
24917 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
24918 register, assembler, and command windows.
24919 @end table
24920
24921 @item focus @var{name}
24922 @kindex focus
24923 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
24924 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
24925
24926 @table @code
24927 @item next
24928 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24929
24930 @item prev
24931 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24932
24933 @item src
24934 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24935
24936 @item asm
24937 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24938
24939 @item regs
24940 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24941
24942 @item cmd
24943 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24944 @end table
24945
24946 @item refresh
24947 @kindex refresh
24948 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24949
24950 @item tui reg @var{group}
24951 @kindex tui reg
24952 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
24953 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
24954 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
24955 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
24956 following groups are available on most targets:
24957 @table @code
24958 @item next
24959 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
24960 through all of the available register groups.
24961
24962 @item prev
24963 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
24964 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
24965 @var{next}.
24966
24967 @item general
24968 Display the general registers.
24969 @item float
24970 Display the floating point registers.
24971 @item system
24972 Display the system registers.
24973 @item vector
24974 Display the vector registers.
24975 @item all
24976 Display all registers.
24977 @end table
24978
24979 @item update
24980 @kindex update
24981 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24982
24983 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24984 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24985 @kindex winheight
24986 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24987 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24988 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
24989 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
24990 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
24991
24992 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24993 @kindex tabset
24994 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
24995 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
24996 assembly windows.
24997 @end table
24998
24999 @node TUI Configuration
25000 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25001 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25002
25003 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25004
25005 @table @code
25006 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25007 @kindex set tui border-kind
25008 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25009 The possible values are the following:
25010 @table @code
25011 @item space
25012 Use a space character to draw the border.
25013
25014 @item ascii
25015 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25016
25017 @item acs
25018 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25019 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25020 @end table
25021
25022 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25023 @kindex set tui border-mode
25024 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25025 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25026 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25027 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25028 @table @code
25029 @item normal
25030 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25031
25032 @item standout
25033 Use standout mode.
25034
25035 @item reverse
25036 Use reverse video mode.
25037
25038 @item half
25039 Use half bright mode.
25040
25041 @item half-standout
25042 Use half bright and standout mode.
25043
25044 @item bold
25045 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25046
25047 @item bold-standout
25048 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25049 @end table
25050 @end table
25051
25052 @node Emacs
25053 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25054
25055 @cindex Emacs
25056 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25057 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25058 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25059 @value{GDBN}.
25060
25061 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25062 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25063 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25064 created Emacs buffer.
25065 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25066
25067 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25068 things:
25069
25070 @itemize @bullet
25071 @item
25072 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25073 the GUD buffer.
25074
25075 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25076 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25077
25078 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25079 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25080 in this way.
25081
25082 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25083 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25084 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25085 stop.
25086
25087 @item
25088 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25089
25090 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25091 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25092 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25093 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25094 and the source.
25095
25096 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25097 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25098 @end itemize
25099
25100 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25101 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25102 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25103 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25104
25105 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25106 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25107 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25108 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25109 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25110 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25111 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25112 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25113 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25114
25115 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25116 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25117 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25118 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25119
25120 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25121 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25122 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25123 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25124 one you want.
25125
25126 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25127 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25128
25129 @table @kbd
25130 @item C-h m
25131 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25132
25133 @item C-c C-s
25134 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25135 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25136
25137 @item C-c C-n
25138 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25139 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25140 to show the current file and location.
25141
25142 @item C-c C-i
25143 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25144 display window accordingly.
25145
25146 @item C-c C-f
25147 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25148 @code{finish} command.
25149
25150 @item C-c C-r
25151 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25152 command.
25153
25154 @item C-c <
25155 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25156 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25157 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25158
25159 @item C-c >
25160 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25161 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25162 @end table
25163
25164 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25165 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25166
25167 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25168 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25169 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25170 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25171 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25172 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25173 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25174
25175 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25176 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25177 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25178 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25179 frame.
25180
25181 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25182 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25183 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25184 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25185 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25186 to correspond properly with the code.
25187
25188 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25189 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25190 Emacs Manual}).
25191
25192 @node GDB/MI
25193 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25194
25195 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25196
25197 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25198 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25199 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25200 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25201 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25202 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25203
25204 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25205 in the form of a reference manual.
25206
25207 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25208 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25209 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25210
25211 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25212
25213 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25214 This chapter uses the following notation:
25215
25216 @itemize @bullet
25217 @item
25218 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25219
25220 @item
25221 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25222 it may or may not be given.
25223
25224 @item
25225 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25226 may repeat zero or more times.
25227
25228 @item
25229 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25230 may repeat one or more times.
25231
25232 @item
25233 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25234 @end itemize
25235
25236 @ignore
25237 @heading Dependencies
25238 @end ignore
25239
25240 @menu
25241 * GDB/MI General Design::
25242 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25243 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25244 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25245 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25246 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25247 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25248 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25249 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25250 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25251 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25252 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25253 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25254 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25255 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25256 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25257 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25258 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25259 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25260 @ignore
25261 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25262 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25263 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25264 @end ignore
25265 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25266 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25267 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25268 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25269 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25270 @end menu
25271
25272 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25273 @node GDB/MI General Design
25274 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25275 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25276
25277 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25278 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25279 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25280 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25281 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25282 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25283 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25284 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25285 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25286 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25287
25288 The important examples of notifications are:
25289 @itemize @bullet
25290
25291 @item
25292 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25293 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25294 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25295 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25296 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25297 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25298 command itself was successfully executed.
25299
25300 @item
25301 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25302 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25303 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25304 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25305 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25306 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25307
25308 @item
25309 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25310 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25311 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25312 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25313 orthogonal frontend design.
25314
25315 @end itemize
25316
25317 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25318 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25319 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25320 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25321 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25322 the user interface.
25323
25324
25325 @menu
25326 * Context management::
25327 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25328 * Thread groups::
25329 @end menu
25330
25331 @node Context management
25332 @subsection Context management
25333
25334 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25335
25336 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25337 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25338 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25339 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25340 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25341 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25342 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25343 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25344 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25345
25346 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25347 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25348 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25349 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25350 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25351 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25352 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25353 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25354 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25355 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25356 for thread and frame to operate on.
25357
25358 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25359 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25360 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25361 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25362 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25363 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25364 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25365 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25366 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25367 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25368
25369 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25370 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25371 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25372 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25373 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25374 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25375 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25376 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25377 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25378 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25379 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25380 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25381 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25382 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25383 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25384 @samp{--frame} options.
25385
25386 @subsubsection Language
25387
25388 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25389 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25390 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25391 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25392 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25393 For instance:
25394
25395 @smallexample
25396 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25397 ^done,value="4"
25398 (gdb)
25399 @end smallexample
25400
25401 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25402 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25403 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25404
25405 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25406 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25407
25408 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25409 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25410 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25411 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25412 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25413 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25414 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25415 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25416 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25417
25418 @table @code
25419 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25420 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25421 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25422
25423 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25424 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25425 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25426
25427 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25428 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25429 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25430 MI commands even while the target is running.
25431
25432 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25433 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25434 @end table
25435
25436 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25437 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25438 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25439 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25440 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25441 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25442
25443 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25444 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25445 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25446 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25447 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25448 are running.
25449
25450 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25451 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25452 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25453 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25454 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25455 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25456 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25457 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25458 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25459 @samp{--thread} option).
25460
25461 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25462 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25463 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25464 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25465
25466 @node Thread groups
25467 @subsection Thread groups
25468 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25469 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25470 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25471 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25472 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25473
25474 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25475 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25476 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25477 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25478 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25479 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25480 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25481 into processes.
25482
25483 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25484 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25485 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25486 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25487 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25488 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25489 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25490 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25491 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25492 the members of specific thread group.
25493
25494 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25495 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25496 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25497 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25498 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25499 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25500 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25501 after attaching to that thread group.
25502
25503 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25504 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25505 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25506 such thread groups.
25507
25508 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25509 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25510 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25511
25512 @menu
25513 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25514 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25515 @end menu
25516
25517 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25518 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25519
25520 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25521 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25522 @table @code
25523 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25524 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25525
25526 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25527 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25528 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25529
25530 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25531 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25532 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25533
25534 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25535 "any sequence of digits"
25536
25537 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25538 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25539
25540 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25541 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25542
25543 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25544 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25545
25546 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25547 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25548 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25549
25550 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25551 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25552
25553 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25554 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25555 @end table
25556
25557 @noindent
25558 Notes:
25559
25560 @itemize @bullet
25561 @item
25562 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25563 output is described below.
25564
25565 @item
25566 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25567 finishes.
25568
25569 @item
25570 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25571 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25572 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25573 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25574 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25575 @end itemize
25576
25577 Pragmatics:
25578
25579 @itemize @bullet
25580 @item
25581 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25582
25583 @item
25584 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25585 @end itemize
25586
25587 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25588 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25589
25590 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25591 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25592 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25593 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25594 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25595 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25596
25597 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25598 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25599 @var{token}.
25600
25601 @table @code
25602 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25603 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25604
25605 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25606 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25607
25608 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25609 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25610
25611 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25612 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25613
25614 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25615 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25616
25617 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25618 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25619
25620 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25621 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25622
25623 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25624 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25625
25626 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25627 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25628
25629 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25630 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25631 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25632
25633 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25634 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25635
25636 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25637 @code{ @var{string} }
25638
25639 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25640 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25641
25642 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25643 @code{@var{c-string}}
25644
25645 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25646 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25647
25648 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25649 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25650 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25651
25652 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25653 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25654
25655 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25656 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25657
25658 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25659 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25660
25661 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25662 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25663
25664 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25665 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25666
25667 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25668 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25669 @end table
25670
25671 @noindent
25672 Notes:
25673
25674 @itemize @bullet
25675 @item
25676 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25677
25678 @item
25679 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25680 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25681 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25682 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25683 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25684 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25685 prior command.
25686
25687 @item
25688 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25689 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25690 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25691 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25692
25693 @item
25694 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25695 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25696 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25697 @samp{*}.
25698
25699 @item
25700 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25701 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25702 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25703 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25704
25705 @item
25706 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25707 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25708 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25709 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25710
25711 @item
25712 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25713 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25714 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25715
25716 @item
25717 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25718 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25719 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25720 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25721
25722 @item
25723 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25724 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25725 @var{values}.
25726
25727
25728 @end itemize
25729
25730 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25731 details about the various output records.
25732
25733 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25734 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25735 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25736
25737 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25738 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25739
25740 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25741 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25742 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25743 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25744 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25745 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25746
25747 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25748 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25749 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25750
25751 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25752 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25753 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25754 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25755
25756 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25757 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25758
25759 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25760 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25761 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25762 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25763 might change.
25764
25765 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25766 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25767 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25768 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25769
25770 @itemize @bullet
25771 @item
25772 New MI commands may be added.
25773
25774 @item
25775 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25776
25777 @item
25778 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25779 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25780
25781 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25782 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25783
25784 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25785 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25786 @end itemize
25787
25788 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25789 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25790 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25791 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25792 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25793
25794 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25795 @c version?
25796
25797 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25798 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25799 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25800 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25801 @cindex mailing lists
25802
25803 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25804 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25805 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25806
25807 @menu
25808 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25809 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25810 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25811 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25812 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25813 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25814 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25815 @end menu
25816
25817 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25818 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25819
25820 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25821 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25822 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25823 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25824
25825 @table @code
25826 @findex ^done
25827 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25828 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25829 values.
25830
25831 @item "^running"
25832 @findex ^running
25833 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25834 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25835 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25836 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25837 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25838 which threads are resumed.
25839
25840 @item "^connected"
25841 @findex ^connected
25842 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25843
25844 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25845 @findex ^error
25846 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25847 the corresponding error message.
25848
25849 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25850 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25851 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25852
25853 @table @samp
25854 @item "undefined-command"
25855 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25856 @end table
25857
25858 @item "^exit"
25859 @findex ^exit
25860 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25861
25862 @end table
25863
25864 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25865 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25866
25867 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25868 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25869 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25870 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25871 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25872
25873 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25874 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25875 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25876 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25877 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25878
25879 @table @code
25880 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25881 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25882 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25883
25884 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25885 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25886 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25887 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25888
25889 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25890 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25891 internals.
25892 @end table
25893
25894 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25895 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25896
25897 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25898 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25899 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25900 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25901 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25902 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25903
25904 The following is the list of possible async records:
25905
25906 @table @code
25907
25908 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25909 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25910 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25911 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25912 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25913 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25914 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25915 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25916 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25917 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25918
25919 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25920 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25921 following values:
25922
25923 @table @code
25924 @item breakpoint-hit
25925 A breakpoint was reached.
25926 @item watchpoint-trigger
25927 A watchpoint was triggered.
25928 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25929 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25930 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25931 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25932 @item function-finished
25933 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25934 @item location-reached
25935 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25936 @item watchpoint-scope
25937 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25938 @item end-stepping-range
25939 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25940 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25941 @item exited-signalled
25942 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25943 @item exited
25944 The inferior exited.
25945 @item exited-normally
25946 The inferior exited normally.
25947 @item signal-received
25948 A signal was received by the inferior.
25949 @item solib-event
25950 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25951 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25952 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25953 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25954 @item fork
25955 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25956 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25957 @item vfork
25958 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25959 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25960 @item syscall-entry
25961 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25962 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25963 @item syscall-return
25964 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25965 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25966 @item exec
25967 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25968 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25969 @end table
25970
25971 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25972 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25973 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25974 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25975 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25976 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25977 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25978 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25979 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25980 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25981 if such information is not available.
25982
25983 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25984 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25985 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25986 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25987 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25988 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25989 cannot be used in any way.
25990
25991 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25992 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25993 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25994 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25995 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25996 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25997
25998 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25999 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26000 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26001 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26002 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26003 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26004
26005 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26006 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26007 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26008 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26009 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26010
26011 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26012 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26013 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26014 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26015 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26016 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26017 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26018
26019 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26020 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26021 that thread.
26022
26023 @item =library-loaded,...
26024 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26025 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26026 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26027 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26028 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26029 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26030 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26031 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26032 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26033 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26034 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26035 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26036 thread groups.
26037
26038 @item =library-unloaded,...
26039 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26040 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26041 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26042 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26043 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26044 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26045 thread groups.
26046
26047 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26048 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26049 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26050 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26051 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26052
26053 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26054 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26055 initial value @var{initial}.
26056
26057 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26058 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26059 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26060 trace state variables are deleted.
26061
26062 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26063 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26064 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26065 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26066 value of trace state variable is known.
26067
26068 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26069 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26070 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26071 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26072 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26073 user.
26074
26075 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26076 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26077 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26078
26079 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26080 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26081
26082 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26083 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26084 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26085 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26086 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26087
26088 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26089 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26090 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26091 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26092 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26093 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26094
26095 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26096 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26097 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26098 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26099 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26100 executable code.
26101 @end table
26102
26103 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26104 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26105
26106 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26107 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26108 following fields:
26109
26110 @table @code
26111 @item number
26112 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26113 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26114 @samp{1.2}.
26115
26116 @item type
26117 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26118 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26119
26120 @item catch-type
26121 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26122 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26123
26124 @item disp
26125 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26126 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26127 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26128
26129 @item enabled
26130 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26131 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26132 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26133
26134 @item addr
26135 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26136 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26137 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26138 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26139 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26140
26141 @item func
26142 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26143 If not known, this field is not present.
26144
26145 @item filename
26146 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26147 If not known, this field is not present.
26148
26149 @item fullname
26150 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26151 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26152
26153 @item line
26154 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26155 If not known, this field is not present.
26156
26157 @item at
26158 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26159 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26160 by a symbol name.
26161
26162 @item pending
26163 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26164 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26165
26166 @item evaluated-by
26167 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26168 @samp{target}.
26169
26170 @item thread
26171 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26172 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26173
26174 @item task
26175 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26176 field will hold the task identifier.
26177
26178 @item cond
26179 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26180
26181 @item ignore
26182 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26183
26184 @item enable
26185 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26186
26187 @item traceframe-usage
26188 FIXME.
26189
26190 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26191 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26192
26193 @item mask
26194 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26195
26196 @item pass
26197 A tracepoint's pass count.
26198
26199 @item original-location
26200 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26201 This field is optional.
26202
26203 @item times
26204 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26205
26206 @item installed
26207 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26208 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26209 is not.
26210
26211 @item what
26212 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26213
26214 @end table
26215
26216 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26217 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26218
26219 @smallexample
26220 -> -break-insert main
26221 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26222 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26223 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26224 times="0"@}
26225 <- (gdb)
26226 @end smallexample
26227
26228 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26229 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26230
26231 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26232 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26233 fields:
26234
26235 @table @code
26236 @item level
26237 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26238 zero. This field is always present.
26239
26240 @item func
26241 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26242 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26243
26244 @item addr
26245 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26246
26247 @item file
26248 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26249 address. This field may be absent.
26250
26251 @item line
26252 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26253 may be absent.
26254
26255 @item from
26256 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26257 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26258
26259 @end table
26260
26261 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26262 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26263
26264 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26265 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26266
26267 @table @code
26268 @item id
26269 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26270 always present.
26271
26272 @item target-id
26273 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26274
26275 @item details
26276 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26277 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26278 frontend. This field is optional.
26279
26280 @item state
26281 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26282 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26283
26284 @item core
26285 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26286 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26287 @end table
26288
26289 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26290 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26291
26292 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26293 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26294 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26295 the @code{exception-name} field.
26296
26297 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26298 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26299 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26300 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26301
26302 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26303 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26304 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26305 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26306
26307 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26308 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26309
26310 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26311
26312 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26313 information of the breakpoint.
26314
26315 @smallexample
26316 -> -break-insert main
26317 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26318 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26319 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26320 times="0"@}
26321 <- (gdb)
26322 @end smallexample
26323
26324 @subheading Program Execution
26325
26326 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26327 reason that execution stopped.
26328
26329 @smallexample
26330 -> -exec-run
26331 <- ^running
26332 <- (gdb)
26333 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26334 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26335 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26336 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26337 <- (gdb)
26338 -> -exec-continue
26339 <- ^running
26340 <- (gdb)
26341 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26342 <- (gdb)
26343 @end smallexample
26344
26345 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26346
26347 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26348
26349 @smallexample
26350 -> (gdb)
26351 <- -gdb-exit
26352 <- ^exit
26353 @end smallexample
26354
26355 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26356 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26357 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26358 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26359 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26360 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26361
26362 @subheading A Bad Command
26363
26364 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26365
26366 @smallexample
26367 -> -rubbish
26368 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26369 <- (gdb)
26370 @end smallexample
26371
26372
26373 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26374 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26375 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26376
26377 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26378 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26379
26380 @subheading Motivation
26381
26382 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26383
26384 @subheading Introduction
26385
26386 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26387
26388 @subheading Commands
26389
26390 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26391
26392 @subsubheading Synopsis
26393
26394 @smallexample
26395 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26396 @end smallexample
26397
26398 @subsubheading Result
26399
26400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26401
26402 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26403
26404 @subsubheading Example
26405
26406 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26407 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26408
26409
26410 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26411 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26412 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26413
26414 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26415 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26416 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26417 breakpoints.
26418
26419 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26420 @findex -break-after
26421
26422 @subsubheading Synopsis
26423
26424 @smallexample
26425 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26426 @end smallexample
26427
26428 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26429 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26430 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26431 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26432
26433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26434
26435 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26436
26437 @subsubheading Example
26438
26439 @smallexample
26440 (gdb)
26441 -break-insert main
26442 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26443 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26444 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26445 times="0"@}
26446 (gdb)
26447 -break-after 1 3
26448 ~
26449 ^done
26450 (gdb)
26451 -break-list
26452 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26453 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26454 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26455 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26456 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26457 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26458 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26459 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26460 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26461 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26462 (gdb)
26463 @end smallexample
26464
26465 @ignore
26466 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26467 @findex -break-catch
26468 @end ignore
26469
26470 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26471 @findex -break-commands
26472
26473 @subsubheading Synopsis
26474
26475 @smallexample
26476 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26477 @end smallexample
26478
26479 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26480 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26481 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26482 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26483 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26484 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26485
26486 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26487
26488 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26489
26490 @subsubheading Example
26491
26492 @smallexample
26493 (gdb)
26494 -break-insert main
26495 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26496 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26497 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26498 times="0"@}
26499 (gdb)
26500 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26501 ^done
26502 (gdb)
26503 @end smallexample
26504
26505 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26506 @findex -break-condition
26507
26508 @subsubheading Synopsis
26509
26510 @smallexample
26511 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26512 @end smallexample
26513
26514 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26515 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26516 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26517 command below).
26518
26519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26520
26521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26522
26523 @subsubheading Example
26524
26525 @smallexample
26526 (gdb)
26527 -break-condition 1 1
26528 ^done
26529 (gdb)
26530 -break-list
26531 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26532 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26533 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26534 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26535 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26536 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26537 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26538 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26539 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26540 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26541 (gdb)
26542 @end smallexample
26543
26544 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26545 @findex -break-delete
26546
26547 @subsubheading Synopsis
26548
26549 @smallexample
26550 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26551 @end smallexample
26552
26553 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26554 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26555
26556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26557
26558 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26559
26560 @subsubheading Example
26561
26562 @smallexample
26563 (gdb)
26564 -break-delete 1
26565 ^done
26566 (gdb)
26567 -break-list
26568 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26569 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26570 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26571 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26572 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26573 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26574 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26575 body=[]@}
26576 (gdb)
26577 @end smallexample
26578
26579 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26580 @findex -break-disable
26581
26582 @subsubheading Synopsis
26583
26584 @smallexample
26585 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26586 @end smallexample
26587
26588 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26589 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26590
26591 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26592
26593 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26594
26595 @subsubheading Example
26596
26597 @smallexample
26598 (gdb)
26599 -break-disable 2
26600 ^done
26601 (gdb)
26602 -break-list
26603 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26604 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26605 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26606 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26607 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26608 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26609 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26610 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26611 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26612 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26613 (gdb)
26614 @end smallexample
26615
26616 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26617 @findex -break-enable
26618
26619 @subsubheading Synopsis
26620
26621 @smallexample
26622 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26623 @end smallexample
26624
26625 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26626
26627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26628
26629 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26630
26631 @subsubheading Example
26632
26633 @smallexample
26634 (gdb)
26635 -break-enable 2
26636 ^done
26637 (gdb)
26638 -break-list
26639 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26640 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26641 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26642 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26643 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26644 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26645 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26646 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26647 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26648 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26649 (gdb)
26650 @end smallexample
26651
26652 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26653 @findex -break-info
26654
26655 @subsubheading Synopsis
26656
26657 @smallexample
26658 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26659 @end smallexample
26660
26661 @c REDUNDANT???
26662 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26663
26664 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26665 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26666 table.
26667
26668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26669
26670 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26671
26672 @subsubheading Example
26673 N.A.
26674
26675 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26676 @findex -break-insert
26677 @anchor{-break-insert}
26678
26679 @subsubheading Synopsis
26680
26681 @smallexample
26682 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26683 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26684 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26685 @end smallexample
26686
26687 @noindent
26688 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26689
26690 @table @var
26691 @item linespec location
26692 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
26693
26694 @item explicit location
26695 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
26696 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
26697 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
26698
26699 @table @samp
26700 @item --source @var{filename}
26701 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
26702 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
26703
26704 @item --function @var{function}
26705 The name of a function or method.
26706
26707 @item --label @var{label}
26708 The name of a label.
26709
26710 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
26711 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
26712 @end table
26713
26714 @item address location
26715 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
26716 @end table
26717
26718 @noindent
26719 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26720
26721 @table @samp
26722 @item -t
26723 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26724 @item -h
26725 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26726 @item -f
26727 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26728 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26729 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26730 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26731 cannot be parsed.
26732 @item -d
26733 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26734 @item -a
26735 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26736 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26737 @item -c @var{condition}
26738 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26739 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26740 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26741 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26742 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26743 @end table
26744
26745 @subsubheading Result
26746
26747 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26748 resulting breakpoint.
26749
26750 Note: this format is open to change.
26751 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26752
26753 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26754
26755 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26756 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26757
26758 @subsubheading Example
26759
26760 @smallexample
26761 (gdb)
26762 -break-insert main
26763 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26764 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26765 times="0"@}
26766 (gdb)
26767 -break-insert -t foo
26768 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26769 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26770 times="0"@}
26771 (gdb)
26772 -break-list
26773 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26774 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26775 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26776 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26777 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26778 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26779 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26780 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26781 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26782 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26783 times="0"@},
26784 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26785 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26786 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26787 times="0"@}]@}
26788 (gdb)
26789 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26790 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26791 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26792 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26793 @c times="0"@}
26794 @c (gdb)
26795 @end smallexample
26796
26797 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26798 @findex -dprintf-insert
26799
26800 @subsubheading Synopsis
26801
26802 @smallexample
26803 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26804 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26805 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26806 [ @var{argument} ]
26807 @end smallexample
26808
26809 @noindent
26810 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
26811 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
26812
26813 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26814
26815 @table @samp
26816 @item -t
26817 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26818 @item -f
26819 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26820 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26821 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26822 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26823 cannot be parsed.
26824 @item -d
26825 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26826 @item -c @var{condition}
26827 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26828 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26829 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26830 to @var{ignore-count}.
26831 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26832 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26833 @end table
26834
26835 @subsubheading Result
26836
26837 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26838 resulting breakpoint.
26839
26840 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26841
26842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26843
26844 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26845
26846 @subsubheading Example
26847
26848 @smallexample
26849 (gdb)
26850 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26851 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26852 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26853 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26854 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26855 original-location="foo"@}
26856 (gdb)
26857 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26858 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26859 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26860 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26861 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26862 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26863 (gdb)
26864 @end smallexample
26865
26866 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26867 @findex -break-list
26868
26869 @subsubheading Synopsis
26870
26871 @smallexample
26872 -break-list
26873 @end smallexample
26874
26875 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26876
26877 @table @samp
26878 @item Number
26879 number of the breakpoint
26880 @item Type
26881 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26882 @item Disposition
26883 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26884 or @samp{nokeep}
26885 @item Enabled
26886 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26887 @item Address
26888 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26889 @item What
26890 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26891 name, line number
26892 @item Thread-groups
26893 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26894 @item Times
26895 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26896 @end table
26897
26898 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26899 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26900
26901 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26902
26903 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26904
26905 @subsubheading Example
26906
26907 @smallexample
26908 (gdb)
26909 -break-list
26910 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26911 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26912 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26913 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26914 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26915 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26916 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26917 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26918 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26919 times="0"@},
26920 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26921 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26922 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26923 (gdb)
26924 @end smallexample
26925
26926 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26927
26928 @smallexample
26929 (gdb)
26930 -break-list
26931 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26932 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26933 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26934 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26935 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26936 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26937 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26938 body=[]@}
26939 (gdb)
26940 @end smallexample
26941
26942 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26943 @findex -break-passcount
26944
26945 @subsubheading Synopsis
26946
26947 @smallexample
26948 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26949 @end smallexample
26950
26951 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26952 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26953 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26954 command @samp{passcount}.
26955
26956 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26957 @findex -break-watch
26958
26959 @subsubheading Synopsis
26960
26961 @smallexample
26962 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26963 @end smallexample
26964
26965 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26966 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26967 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26968 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26969 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26970 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26971 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26972 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26973
26974 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26975 breakpoints inserted.
26976
26977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26978
26979 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26980 @samp{rwatch}.
26981
26982 @subsubheading Example
26983
26984 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26985
26986 @smallexample
26987 (gdb)
26988 -break-watch x
26989 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26990 (gdb)
26991 -exec-continue
26992 ^running
26993 (gdb)
26994 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26995 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26996 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26997 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26998 (gdb)
26999 @end smallexample
27000
27001 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27002 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27003 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27004
27005 @smallexample
27006 (gdb)
27007 -break-watch C
27008 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27009 (gdb)
27010 -exec-continue
27011 ^running
27012 (gdb)
27013 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27014 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27015 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27016 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27017 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27018 (gdb)
27019 -exec-continue
27020 ^running
27021 (gdb)
27022 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27023 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27024 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27025 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27026 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27027 (gdb)
27028 @end smallexample
27029
27030 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27031 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27032 deleted.
27033
27034 @smallexample
27035 (gdb)
27036 -break-watch C
27037 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27038 (gdb)
27039 -break-list
27040 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27041 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27042 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27043 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27044 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27045 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27046 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27047 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27048 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27049 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27050 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27051 times="1"@},
27052 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27053 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27054 (gdb)
27055 -exec-continue
27056 ^running
27057 (gdb)
27058 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27059 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27060 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27061 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27062 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27063 (gdb)
27064 -break-list
27065 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27066 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27067 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27068 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27069 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27070 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27071 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27072 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27073 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27074 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27075 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27076 times="1"@},
27077 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27078 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27079 (gdb)
27080 -exec-continue
27081 ^running
27082 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27083 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27084 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27085 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27086 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27087 (gdb)
27088 -break-list
27089 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27090 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27091 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27092 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27093 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27094 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27095 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27096 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27097 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27098 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27099 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27100 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27101 (gdb)
27102 @end smallexample
27103
27104
27105 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27106 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27107 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27108
27109 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27110 catchpoints.
27111
27112 @menu
27113 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27114 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27115 @end menu
27116
27117 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27118 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27119
27120 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27121 @findex -catch-load
27122
27123 @subsubheading Synopsis
27124
27125 @smallexample
27126 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27127 @end smallexample
27128
27129 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27130 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27131 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27132 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27133 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27134
27135
27136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27137
27138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27139
27140 @subsubheading Example
27141
27142 @smallexample
27143 -catch-load -t foo.so
27144 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27145 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27146 (gdb)
27147 @end smallexample
27148
27149
27150 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27151 @findex -catch-unload
27152
27153 @subsubheading Synopsis
27154
27155 @smallexample
27156 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27157 @end smallexample
27158
27159 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27160 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27161 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27162 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27163 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27164
27165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27166
27167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27168
27169 @subsubheading Example
27170
27171 @smallexample
27172 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27173 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27174 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27175 (gdb)
27176 @end smallexample
27177
27178 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27179 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27180
27181 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27182 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27183
27184 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27185 @findex -catch-assert
27186
27187 @subsubheading Synopsis
27188
27189 @smallexample
27190 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27191 @end smallexample
27192
27193 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27194
27195 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27196
27197 @table @samp
27198 @item -c @var{condition}
27199 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27200 @item -d
27201 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27202 @item -t
27203 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27204 @end table
27205
27206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27207
27208 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27209
27210 @subsubheading Example
27211
27212 @smallexample
27213 -catch-assert
27214 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27215 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27216 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27217 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27218 (gdb)
27219 @end smallexample
27220
27221 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27222 @findex -catch-exception
27223
27224 @subsubheading Synopsis
27225
27226 @smallexample
27227 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27228 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27229 @end smallexample
27230
27231 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27232 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27233 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27234 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27235 catchpoints.
27236
27237 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27238
27239 @table @samp
27240 @item -c @var{condition}
27241 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27242 @item -d
27243 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27244 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27245 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27246 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27247 @item -t
27248 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27249 @item -u
27250 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27251 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27252 @end table
27253
27254 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27255
27256 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27257 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27258
27259 @subsubheading Example
27260
27261 @smallexample
27262 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27263 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27264 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27265 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27266 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27267 (gdb)
27268 @end smallexample
27269
27270 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27271 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27272 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27273
27274 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27275 @findex -exec-arguments
27276
27277
27278 @subsubheading Synopsis
27279
27280 @smallexample
27281 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27282 @end smallexample
27283
27284 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27285 @samp{-exec-run}.
27286
27287 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27288
27289 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27290
27291 @subsubheading Example
27292
27293 @smallexample
27294 (gdb)
27295 -exec-arguments -v word
27296 ^done
27297 (gdb)
27298 @end smallexample
27299
27300
27301 @ignore
27302 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27303 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27304
27305 @subsubheading Synopsis
27306
27307 @smallexample
27308 -exec-show-arguments
27309 @end smallexample
27310
27311 Print the arguments of the program.
27312
27313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27314
27315 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27316
27317 @subsubheading Example
27318 N.A.
27319 @end ignore
27320
27321
27322 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27323 @findex -environment-cd
27324
27325 @subsubheading Synopsis
27326
27327 @smallexample
27328 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27329 @end smallexample
27330
27331 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27332
27333 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27334
27335 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27336
27337 @subsubheading Example
27338
27339 @smallexample
27340 (gdb)
27341 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27342 ^done
27343 (gdb)
27344 @end smallexample
27345
27346
27347 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27348 @findex -environment-directory
27349
27350 @subsubheading Synopsis
27351
27352 @smallexample
27353 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27354 @end smallexample
27355
27356 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27357 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27358 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27359 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27360 occurs as normal.
27361 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27362 multiple directories in a single command
27363 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27364 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27365 If blanks are needed as
27366 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27367 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27368 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27369 character must not be used
27370 in any directory name.
27371 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27372
27373 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27374
27375 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27376
27377 @subsubheading Example
27378
27379 @smallexample
27380 (gdb)
27381 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27382 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27383 (gdb)
27384 -environment-directory ""
27385 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27386 (gdb)
27387 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27388 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27389 (gdb)
27390 -environment-directory -r
27391 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27392 (gdb)
27393 @end smallexample
27394
27395
27396 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27397 @findex -environment-path
27398
27399 @subsubheading Synopsis
27400
27401 @smallexample
27402 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27403 @end smallexample
27404
27405 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27406 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27407 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27408 supplied in addition to the
27409 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27410 occurs as normal.
27411 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27412 multiple directories in a single command
27413 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27414 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27415 If blanks are needed as
27416 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27417 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27418 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27419 character must not be used
27420 in any directory name.
27421 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27422
27423
27424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27425
27426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27427
27428 @subsubheading Example
27429
27430 @smallexample
27431 (gdb)
27432 -environment-path
27433 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27434 (gdb)
27435 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27436 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27437 (gdb)
27438 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27439 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27440 (gdb)
27441 @end smallexample
27442
27443
27444 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27445 @findex -environment-pwd
27446
27447 @subsubheading Synopsis
27448
27449 @smallexample
27450 -environment-pwd
27451 @end smallexample
27452
27453 Show the current working directory.
27454
27455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27456
27457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27458
27459 @subsubheading Example
27460
27461 @smallexample
27462 (gdb)
27463 -environment-pwd
27464 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27465 (gdb)
27466 @end smallexample
27467
27468 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27469 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27470 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27471
27472
27473 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27474 @findex -thread-info
27475
27476 @subsubheading Synopsis
27477
27478 @smallexample
27479 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27480 @end smallexample
27481
27482 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27483 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27484 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27485 also reports the current thread.
27486
27487 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27488
27489 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27490 about all threads.
27491
27492 @subsubheading Result
27493
27494 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27495 defined for a given thread:
27496
27497 @table @samp
27498 @item current
27499 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27500
27501 @item id
27502 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27503
27504 @item target-id
27505 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27506
27507 @item details
27508 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27509 field is optional.
27510
27511 @item name
27512 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27513 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27514 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27515 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27516 field is omitted.
27517
27518 @item frame
27519 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27520
27521 @item state
27522 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27523 values:
27524
27525 @table @code
27526 @item stopped
27527 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27528 threads.
27529
27530 @item running
27531 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27532 threads.
27533
27534 @end table
27535
27536 @item core
27537 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27538 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27539
27540 @end table
27541
27542 @subsubheading Example
27543
27544 @smallexample
27545 -thread-info
27546 ^done,threads=[
27547 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27548 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27549 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27550 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27551 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27552 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27553 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27554 state="running"@}],
27555 current-thread-id="1"
27556 (gdb)
27557 @end smallexample
27558
27559 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27560 @findex -thread-list-ids
27561
27562 @subsubheading Synopsis
27563
27564 @smallexample
27565 -thread-list-ids
27566 @end smallexample
27567
27568 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27569 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27570
27571 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27572 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27573
27574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27575
27576 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27577
27578 @subsubheading Example
27579
27580 @smallexample
27581 (gdb)
27582 -thread-list-ids
27583 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27584 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27585 (gdb)
27586 @end smallexample
27587
27588
27589 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27590 @findex -thread-select
27591
27592 @subsubheading Synopsis
27593
27594 @smallexample
27595 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27596 @end smallexample
27597
27598 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27599 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27600
27601 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27602 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27603
27604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27605
27606 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27607
27608 @subsubheading Example
27609
27610 @smallexample
27611 (gdb)
27612 -exec-next
27613 ^running
27614 (gdb)
27615 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27616 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27617 (gdb)
27618 -thread-list-ids
27619 ^done,
27620 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27621 number-of-threads="3"
27622 (gdb)
27623 -thread-select 3
27624 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27625 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27626 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27627 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27628 (gdb)
27629 @end smallexample
27630
27631 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27632 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27633 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27634
27635 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27636 @findex -ada-task-info
27637
27638 @subsubheading Synopsis
27639
27640 @smallexample
27641 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27642 @end smallexample
27643
27644 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27645 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27646
27647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27648
27649 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27650 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27651
27652 @subsubheading Result
27653
27654 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27655 defined for each Ada task:
27656
27657 @table @samp
27658 @item current
27659 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27660
27661 @item id
27662 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27663
27664 @item task-id
27665 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27666
27667 @item thread-id
27668 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27669
27670 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27671 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27672 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27673
27674 @item parent-id
27675 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27676 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27677
27678 @item priority
27679 The base priority of the task.
27680
27681 @item state
27682 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27683 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27684
27685 @item name
27686 The name of the task.
27687
27688 @end table
27689
27690 @subsubheading Example
27691
27692 @smallexample
27693 -ada-task-info
27694 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27695 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27696 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27697 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27698 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27699 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27700 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27701 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27702 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27703 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27704 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27705 (gdb)
27706 @end smallexample
27707
27708 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27709 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27710 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27711
27712 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27713 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27714 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27715 other cases.
27716
27717 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27718 @findex -exec-continue
27719
27720 @subsubheading Synopsis
27721
27722 @smallexample
27723 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27724 @end smallexample
27725
27726 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27727 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27728 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27729 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27730 @itemize @bullet
27731 @item
27732 breakpoints or watchpoints
27733 @item
27734 signals or exceptions
27735 @item
27736 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27737 @item
27738 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27739 @end itemize
27740 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27741 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27742 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27743 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27744 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27745 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27746
27747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27748
27749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27750
27751 @subsubheading Example
27752
27753 @smallexample
27754 -exec-continue
27755 ^running
27756 (gdb)
27757 @@Hello world
27758 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27759 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27760 line="13"@}
27761 (gdb)
27762 @end smallexample
27763
27764
27765 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27766 @findex -exec-finish
27767
27768 @subsubheading Synopsis
27769
27770 @smallexample
27771 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27772 @end smallexample
27773
27774 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27775 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27776 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27777 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27778 function was called.
27779
27780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27781
27782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27783
27784 @subsubheading Example
27785
27786 Function returning @code{void}.
27787
27788 @smallexample
27789 -exec-finish
27790 ^running
27791 (gdb)
27792 @@hello from foo
27793 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27794 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27795 (gdb)
27796 @end smallexample
27797
27798 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27799 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27800 value itself.
27801
27802 @smallexample
27803 -exec-finish
27804 ^running
27805 (gdb)
27806 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27807 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27808 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27809 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27810 (gdb)
27811 @end smallexample
27812
27813
27814 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27815 @findex -exec-interrupt
27816
27817 @subsubheading Synopsis
27818
27819 @smallexample
27820 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27821 @end smallexample
27822
27823 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27824 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27825 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27826 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27827 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27828
27829 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27830 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27831 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27832 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27833
27834 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27835 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27836 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27837 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27838
27839 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27840
27841 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27842
27843 @subsubheading Example
27844
27845 @smallexample
27846 (gdb)
27847 111-exec-continue
27848 111^running
27849
27850 (gdb)
27851 222-exec-interrupt
27852 222^done
27853 (gdb)
27854 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27855 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27856 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27857 (gdb)
27858
27859 (gdb)
27860 -exec-interrupt
27861 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27862 (gdb)
27863 @end smallexample
27864
27865 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27866 @findex -exec-jump
27867
27868 @subsubheading Synopsis
27869
27870 @smallexample
27871 -exec-jump @var{location}
27872 @end smallexample
27873
27874 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27875 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27876 different forms of @var{location}.
27877
27878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27879
27880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27881
27882 @subsubheading Example
27883
27884 @smallexample
27885 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27886 *running,thread-id="all"
27887 ^running
27888 @end smallexample
27889
27890
27891 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27892 @findex -exec-next
27893
27894 @subsubheading Synopsis
27895
27896 @smallexample
27897 -exec-next [--reverse]
27898 @end smallexample
27899
27900 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27901 of the next source line is reached.
27902
27903 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27904 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27905 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27906 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27907 source line where the function was called.
27908
27909
27910 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27911
27912 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27913
27914 @subsubheading Example
27915
27916 @smallexample
27917 -exec-next
27918 ^running
27919 (gdb)
27920 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27921 (gdb)
27922 @end smallexample
27923
27924
27925 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27926 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27927
27928 @subsubheading Synopsis
27929
27930 @smallexample
27931 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27932 @end smallexample
27933
27934 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27935 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27936 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27937 printed as well.
27938
27939 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27940 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27941 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27942 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27943 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27944
27945 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27946
27947 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27948
27949 @subsubheading Example
27950
27951 @smallexample
27952 (gdb)
27953 -exec-next-instruction
27954 ^running
27955
27956 (gdb)
27957 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27958 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27959 (gdb)
27960 @end smallexample
27961
27962
27963 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27964 @findex -exec-return
27965
27966 @subsubheading Synopsis
27967
27968 @smallexample
27969 -exec-return
27970 @end smallexample
27971
27972 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27973 Displays the new current frame.
27974
27975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27976
27977 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27978
27979 @subsubheading Example
27980
27981 @smallexample
27982 (gdb)
27983 200-break-insert callee4
27984 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27985 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27986 (gdb)
27987 000-exec-run
27988 000^running
27989 (gdb)
27990 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27991 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27992 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27993 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27994 (gdb)
27995 205-break-delete
27996 205^done
27997 (gdb)
27998 111-exec-return
27999 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28000 args=[@{name="strarg",
28001 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28002 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28003 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28004 (gdb)
28005 @end smallexample
28006
28007
28008 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28009 @findex -exec-run
28010
28011 @subsubheading Synopsis
28012
28013 @smallexample
28014 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28015 @end smallexample
28016
28017 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28018 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28019 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28020 the program has exited exceptionally.
28021
28022 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28023 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28024 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28025 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28026 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28027
28028 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28029 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28030 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28031 (@pxref{Starting}).
28032
28033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28034
28035 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28036
28037 @subsubheading Examples
28038
28039 @smallexample
28040 (gdb)
28041 -break-insert main
28042 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28043 (gdb)
28044 -exec-run
28045 ^running
28046 (gdb)
28047 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28048 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28049 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28050 (gdb)
28051 @end smallexample
28052
28053 @noindent
28054 Program exited normally:
28055
28056 @smallexample
28057 (gdb)
28058 -exec-run
28059 ^running
28060 (gdb)
28061 x = 55
28062 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28063 (gdb)
28064 @end smallexample
28065
28066 @noindent
28067 Program exited exceptionally:
28068
28069 @smallexample
28070 (gdb)
28071 -exec-run
28072 ^running
28073 (gdb)
28074 x = 55
28075 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28076 (gdb)
28077 @end smallexample
28078
28079 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28080 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28081
28082 @smallexample
28083 (gdb)
28084 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28085 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28086 @end smallexample
28087
28088
28089 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28090
28091
28092 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28093 @findex -exec-step
28094
28095 @subsubheading Synopsis
28096
28097 @smallexample
28098 -exec-step [--reverse]
28099 @end smallexample
28100
28101 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28102 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28103 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28104 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28105 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28106 previously executed source line.
28107
28108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28109
28110 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28111
28112 @subsubheading Example
28113
28114 Stepping into a function:
28115
28116 @smallexample
28117 -exec-step
28118 ^running
28119 (gdb)
28120 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28121 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28122 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28123 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28124 (gdb)
28125 @end smallexample
28126
28127 Regular stepping:
28128
28129 @smallexample
28130 -exec-step
28131 ^running
28132 (gdb)
28133 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28134 (gdb)
28135 @end smallexample
28136
28137
28138 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28139 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28140
28141 @subsubheading Synopsis
28142
28143 @smallexample
28144 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28145 @end smallexample
28146
28147 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28148 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28149 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28150 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28151 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28152 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28153 as well.
28154
28155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28156
28157 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28158
28159 @subsubheading Example
28160
28161 @smallexample
28162 (gdb)
28163 -exec-step-instruction
28164 ^running
28165
28166 (gdb)
28167 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28168 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28169 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28170 (gdb)
28171 -exec-step-instruction
28172 ^running
28173
28174 (gdb)
28175 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28176 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28177 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28178 (gdb)
28179 @end smallexample
28180
28181
28182 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28183 @findex -exec-until
28184
28185 @subsubheading Synopsis
28186
28187 @smallexample
28188 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28189 @end smallexample
28190
28191 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28192 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28193 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28194 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28195
28196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28197
28198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28199
28200 @subsubheading Example
28201
28202 @smallexample
28203 (gdb)
28204 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28205 ^running
28206 (gdb)
28207 x = 55
28208 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28209 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28210 (gdb)
28211 @end smallexample
28212
28213 @ignore
28214 @subheading -file-clear
28215 Is this going away????
28216 @end ignore
28217
28218 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28219 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28220 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28221
28222 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28223 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28224
28225 @smallexample
28226 -enable-frame-filters
28227 @end smallexample
28228
28229 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28230 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28231 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28232 request that this functionality be enabled.
28233
28234 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28235
28236 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28237 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28238
28239 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28240 @findex -stack-info-frame
28241
28242 @subsubheading Synopsis
28243
28244 @smallexample
28245 -stack-info-frame
28246 @end smallexample
28247
28248 Get info on the selected frame.
28249
28250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28251
28252 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28253 (without arguments).
28254
28255 @subsubheading Example
28256
28257 @smallexample
28258 (gdb)
28259 -stack-info-frame
28260 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28261 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28262 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28263 (gdb)
28264 @end smallexample
28265
28266 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28267 @findex -stack-info-depth
28268
28269 @subsubheading Synopsis
28270
28271 @smallexample
28272 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28273 @end smallexample
28274
28275 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28276 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28277
28278 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28279
28280 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28281
28282 @subsubheading Example
28283
28284 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28285
28286 @smallexample
28287 (gdb)
28288 -stack-info-depth
28289 ^done,depth="12"
28290 (gdb)
28291 -stack-info-depth 4
28292 ^done,depth="4"
28293 (gdb)
28294 -stack-info-depth 12
28295 ^done,depth="12"
28296 (gdb)
28297 -stack-info-depth 11
28298 ^done,depth="11"
28299 (gdb)
28300 -stack-info-depth 13
28301 ^done,depth="12"
28302 (gdb)
28303 @end smallexample
28304
28305 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28306 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28307 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28308
28309 @subsubheading Synopsis
28310
28311 @smallexample
28312 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28313 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28314 @end smallexample
28315
28316 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28317 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28318 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28319 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28320 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28321 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28322 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28323 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28324
28325 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28326 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28327 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28328 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28329 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28330 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28331
28332 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28333 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28334 are still displayed, however.
28335
28336 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28337 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28338
28339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28340
28341 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28342 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28343 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28344
28345 @subsubheading Example
28346
28347 @smallexample
28348 (gdb)
28349 -stack-list-frames
28350 ^done,
28351 stack=[
28352 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28353 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28354 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28355 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28356 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28357 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28358 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28359 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28360 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28361 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28362 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28363 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28364 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28365 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28366 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28367 (gdb)
28368 -stack-list-arguments 0
28369 ^done,
28370 stack-args=[
28371 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28372 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28373 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28374 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28375 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28376 (gdb)
28377 -stack-list-arguments 1
28378 ^done,
28379 stack-args=[
28380 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28381 frame=@{level="1",
28382 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28383 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28384 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28385 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28386 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28387 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28388 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28389 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28390 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28391 (gdb)
28392 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28393 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28394 (gdb)
28395 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28396 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28397 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28398 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28399 (gdb)
28400 @end smallexample
28401
28402 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28403
28404
28405 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28406 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28407 @findex -stack-list-frames
28408
28409 @subsubheading Synopsis
28410
28411 @smallexample
28412 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28413 @end smallexample
28414
28415 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28416 following info:
28417
28418 @table @samp
28419 @item @var{level}
28420 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28421 @item @var{addr}
28422 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28423 @item @var{func}
28424 Function name.
28425 @item @var{file}
28426 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28427 @item @var{fullname}
28428 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28429 @item @var{line}
28430 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28431 @item @var{from}
28432 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28433 if the frame's function is not known.
28434 @end table
28435
28436 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28437 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28438 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28439 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28440 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28441 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28442 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28443 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28444 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28445
28446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28447
28448 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28449
28450 @subsubheading Example
28451
28452 Full stack backtrace:
28453
28454 @smallexample
28455 (gdb)
28456 -stack-list-frames
28457 ^done,stack=
28458 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28459 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28460 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28461 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28462 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28463 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28464 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28465 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28466 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28467 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28468 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28469 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28470 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28471 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28472 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28473 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28474 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28475 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28476 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28477 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28478 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28479 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28480 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28481 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28482 (gdb)
28483 @end smallexample
28484
28485 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28486
28487 @smallexample
28488 (gdb)
28489 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28490 ^done,stack=
28491 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28492 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28493 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28494 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28495 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28496 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28497 (gdb)
28498 @end smallexample
28499
28500 Show a single frame:
28501
28502 @smallexample
28503 (gdb)
28504 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28505 ^done,stack=
28506 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28507 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28508 (gdb)
28509 @end smallexample
28510
28511
28512 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28513 @findex -stack-list-locals
28514 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28515
28516 @subsubheading Synopsis
28517
28518 @smallexample
28519 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28520 @end smallexample
28521
28522 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28523 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28524 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28525 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28526 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28527 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28528 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28529 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28530 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28531 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28532
28533 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28534 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28535 variables are still displayed, however.
28536
28537 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28538 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28539
28540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28541
28542 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28543
28544 @subsubheading Example
28545
28546 @smallexample
28547 (gdb)
28548 -stack-list-locals 0
28549 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28550 (gdb)
28551 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28552 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28553 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28554 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28555 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28556 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28557 (gdb)
28558 @end smallexample
28559
28560 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28561 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28562 @findex -stack-list-variables
28563
28564 @subsubheading Synopsis
28565
28566 @smallexample
28567 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28568 @end smallexample
28569
28570 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28571 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28572 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28573 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28574 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28575 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28576 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28577
28578 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28579 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28580 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28581
28582 @subsubheading Example
28583
28584 @smallexample
28585 (gdb)
28586 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28587 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28588 (gdb)
28589 @end smallexample
28590
28591
28592 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28593 @findex -stack-select-frame
28594
28595 @subsubheading Synopsis
28596
28597 @smallexample
28598 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28599 @end smallexample
28600
28601 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28602 the stack.
28603
28604 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28605 option to every command.
28606
28607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28608
28609 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28610 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28611
28612 @subsubheading Example
28613
28614 @smallexample
28615 (gdb)
28616 -stack-select-frame 2
28617 ^done
28618 (gdb)
28619 @end smallexample
28620
28621 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28622 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28623 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28624
28625 @ignore
28626
28627 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28628
28629 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28630 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28631 used by @code{Insight}.
28632
28633 The two main reasons for that are:
28634
28635 @enumerate 1
28636 @item
28637 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28638
28639 @item
28640 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28641 now).
28642 @end enumerate
28643
28644 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28645 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28646 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28647 hints about their use.
28648
28649 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28650 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28651 least, the following operations:
28652
28653 @itemize @bullet
28654 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28655 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28656 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28657 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28658 @end itemize
28659
28660 @end ignore
28661
28662 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28663
28664 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28665
28666 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28667 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28668 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28669 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28670 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28671 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28672 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28673 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28674 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28675 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28676 object, or to change display format.
28677
28678 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28679 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28680 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28681 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28682 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28683 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28684 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28685 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28686 child will be created.
28687
28688 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28689 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28690 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28691 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28692 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28693
28694 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28695 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28696 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28697 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28698 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28699 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28700 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28701 variables that frontend has created.
28702
28703 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28704 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28705 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28706 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28707 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28708 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28709 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28710 implicitly updated.
28711
28712 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28713 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28714 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28715 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28716 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28717 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28718 frame. Consider this example:
28719
28720 @smallexample
28721 void do_work(...)
28722 @{
28723 struct work_state state;
28724
28725 if (...)
28726 do_work(...);
28727 @}
28728 @end smallexample
28729
28730 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28731 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28732 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28733 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28734 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28735
28736 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28737 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28738 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28739 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28740 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28741 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28742
28743 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28744 access this functionality:
28745
28746 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28747 @item @strong{Operation}
28748 @tab @strong{Description}
28749
28750 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28751 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28752 @item @code{-var-create}
28753 @tab create a variable object
28754 @item @code{-var-delete}
28755 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28756 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28757 @tab set the display format of this variable
28758 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28759 @tab show the display format of this variable
28760 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28761 @tab tells how many children this object has
28762 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28763 @tab return a list of the object's children
28764 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28765 @tab show the type of this variable object
28766 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28767 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28768 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28769 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28770 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28771 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28772 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28773 @tab get the value of this variable
28774 @item @code{-var-assign}
28775 @tab set the value of this variable
28776 @item @code{-var-update}
28777 @tab update the variable and its children
28778 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28779 @tab set frozeness attribute
28780 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28781 @tab set range of children to display on update
28782 @end multitable
28783
28784 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28785 how it can be used.
28786
28787 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28788
28789 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28790 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28791
28792 @smallexample
28793 -enable-pretty-printing
28794 @end smallexample
28795
28796 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28797 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28798 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28799 request that this functionality be enabled.
28800
28801 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28802
28803 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28804 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28805
28806 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28807 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28808
28809 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28810 @findex -var-create
28811
28812 @subsubheading Synopsis
28813
28814 @smallexample
28815 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28816 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28817 @end smallexample
28818
28819 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28820 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28821 register.
28822
28823 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28824 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28825 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28826 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28827 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28828
28829 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28830 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28831 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28832 object must be created.
28833
28834 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28835 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28836
28837 @itemize @bullet
28838 @item
28839 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28840
28841 @item
28842 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28843
28844 @item
28845 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28846 @end itemize
28847
28848 @cindex dynamic varobj
28849 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28850 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28851 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28852 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28853 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28854 compatibility for existing clients.
28855
28856 @subsubheading Result
28857
28858 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28859 are:
28860
28861 @table @samp
28862 @item name
28863 The name of the varobj.
28864
28865 @item numchild
28866 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28867 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28868 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28869
28870 @item value
28871 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28872 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28873 will not be interesting.
28874
28875 @item type
28876 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28877 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28878 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28879 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28880 @emph{declared} one.
28881
28882 @item thread-id
28883 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28884 thread's identifier.
28885
28886 @item has_more
28887 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28888 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28889
28890 @item dynamic
28891 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28892 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28893 then this attribute will not be present.
28894
28895 @item displayhint
28896 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28897 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28898 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28899 @end table
28900
28901 Typical output will look like this:
28902
28903 @smallexample
28904 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28905 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28906 @end smallexample
28907
28908
28909 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28910 @findex -var-delete
28911
28912 @subsubheading Synopsis
28913
28914 @smallexample
28915 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28916 @end smallexample
28917
28918 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28919 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28920
28921 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28922
28923
28924 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28925 @findex -var-set-format
28926
28927 @subsubheading Synopsis
28928
28929 @smallexample
28930 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28931 @end smallexample
28932
28933 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28934 @var{format-spec}.
28935
28936 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28937 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28938
28939 @smallexample
28940 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28941 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28942 @end smallexample
28943
28944 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28945 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28946 for pointers, etc.).
28947
28948 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28949 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28950
28951 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28952 @findex -var-show-format
28953
28954 @subsubheading Synopsis
28955
28956 @smallexample
28957 -var-show-format @var{name}
28958 @end smallexample
28959
28960 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28961
28962 @smallexample
28963 @var{format} @expansion{}
28964 @var{format-spec}
28965 @end smallexample
28966
28967
28968 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28969 @findex -var-info-num-children
28970
28971 @subsubheading Synopsis
28972
28973 @smallexample
28974 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28975 @end smallexample
28976
28977 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28978
28979 @smallexample
28980 numchild=@var{n}
28981 @end smallexample
28982
28983 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28984 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28985 be available.
28986
28987
28988 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28989 @findex -var-list-children
28990
28991 @subsubheading Synopsis
28992
28993 @smallexample
28994 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28995 @end smallexample
28996 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28997
28998 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28999 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29000 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29001 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29002 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29003 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29004 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29005 and unions.
29006
29007 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29008 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29009 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29010 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29011 reported.
29012
29013 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29014 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29015 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29016 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29017 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29018 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29019 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29020 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29021 the visible items.
29022
29023 For each child the following results are returned:
29024
29025 @table @var
29026
29027 @item name
29028 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29029
29030 @item exp
29031 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29032 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29033
29034 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29035 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29036
29037 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29038 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29039 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29040 type and value are not present.
29041
29042 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29043 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29044 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29045
29046 @item numchild
29047 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29048 0.
29049
29050 @item type
29051 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29052 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29053 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29054 @emph{declared} one.
29055
29056 @item value
29057 If values were requested, this is the value.
29058
29059 @item thread-id
29060 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
29061 Otherwise this result is not present.
29062
29063 @item frozen
29064 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29065
29066 @item displayhint
29067 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29068 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29069 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29070
29071 @item dynamic
29072 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29073 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29074 then this attribute will not be present.
29075
29076 @end table
29077
29078 The result may have its own attributes:
29079
29080 @table @samp
29081 @item displayhint
29082 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29083 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29084 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29085
29086 @item has_more
29087 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29088 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29089 @end table
29090
29091 @subsubheading Example
29092
29093 @smallexample
29094 (gdb)
29095 -var-list-children n
29096 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29097 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29098 (gdb)
29099 -var-list-children --all-values n
29100 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29101 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29102 @end smallexample
29103
29104
29105 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29106 @findex -var-info-type
29107
29108 @subsubheading Synopsis
29109
29110 @smallexample
29111 -var-info-type @var{name}
29112 @end smallexample
29113
29114 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29115 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29116 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29117
29118 @smallexample
29119 type=@var{typename}
29120 @end smallexample
29121
29122
29123 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29124 @findex -var-info-expression
29125
29126 @subsubheading Synopsis
29127
29128 @smallexample
29129 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29130 @end smallexample
29131
29132 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29133 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29134 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29135
29136 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29137 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29138
29139 @smallexample
29140 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29141 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29142 @end smallexample
29143
29144 @noindent
29145 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29146 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29147
29148 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29149 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29150 is of limited use.
29151
29152 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29153 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29154
29155 @subsubheading Synopsis
29156
29157 @smallexample
29158 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29159 @end smallexample
29160
29161 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29162 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29163 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29164 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29165 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29166 watchpoint from a variable object.
29167
29168 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29169 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29170
29171 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29172 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29173 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29174 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29175 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29176 @smallexample
29177 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29178 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29179 @end smallexample
29180
29181 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29182 @findex -var-show-attributes
29183
29184 @subsubheading Synopsis
29185
29186 @smallexample
29187 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29188 @end smallexample
29189
29190 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29191
29192 @smallexample
29193 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29194 @end smallexample
29195
29196 @noindent
29197 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29198
29199 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29200 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29201
29202 @subsubheading Synopsis
29203
29204 @smallexample
29205 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29206 @end smallexample
29207
29208 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29209 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29210 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29211 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29212 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29213 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29214 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29215
29216 @smallexample
29217 value=@var{value}
29218 @end smallexample
29219
29220 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29221 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29222
29223 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29224 @findex -var-assign
29225
29226 @subsubheading Synopsis
29227
29228 @smallexample
29229 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29230 @end smallexample
29231
29232 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29233 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29234 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29235 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29236
29237 @subsubheading Example
29238
29239 @smallexample
29240 (gdb)
29241 -var-assign var1 3
29242 ^done,value="3"
29243 (gdb)
29244 -var-update *
29245 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29246 (gdb)
29247 @end smallexample
29248
29249 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29250 @findex -var-update
29251
29252 @subsubheading Synopsis
29253
29254 @smallexample
29255 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29256 @end smallexample
29257
29258 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29259 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29260 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29261 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29262 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29263 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29264 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29265 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29266 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29267 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29268 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29269 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29270 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29271
29272 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29273 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29274 diagnostic.
29275
29276 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29277 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29278
29279 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29280 @samp{changelist}.
29281
29282 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29283
29284 @table @samp
29285 @item name
29286 The name of the varobj.
29287
29288 @item value
29289 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29290 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29291
29292 @item in_scope
29293 @anchor{-var-update}
29294 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29295
29296 @table @code
29297 @item "true"
29298 The variable object's current value is valid.
29299
29300 @item "false"
29301 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29302 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29303 scope.
29304
29305 @item "invalid"
29306 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29307 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29308 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29309 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29310 objects.
29311 @end table
29312
29313 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29314 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29315
29316 @item type_changed
29317 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29318 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29319 be @samp{false}.
29320
29321 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29322 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29323 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29324 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29325 unset.
29326
29327 @item new_type
29328 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29329 hold the new type.
29330
29331 @item new_num_children
29332 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29333 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29334
29335 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29336 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29337 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29338 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29339 children which may be available.
29340
29341 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29342 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29343 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29344 only happen at the end of the update range).
29345
29346 @item displayhint
29347 The display hint, if any.
29348
29349 @item has_more
29350 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29351 available outside the varobj's update range.
29352
29353 @item dynamic
29354 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29355 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29356 then this attribute will not be present.
29357
29358 @item new_children
29359 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29360 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29361 be listed in this attribute.
29362 @end table
29363
29364 @subsubheading Example
29365
29366 @smallexample
29367 (gdb)
29368 -var-assign var1 3
29369 ^done,value="3"
29370 (gdb)
29371 -var-update --all-values var1
29372 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29373 type_changed="false"@}]
29374 (gdb)
29375 @end smallexample
29376
29377 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29378 @findex -var-set-frozen
29379 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29380
29381 @subsubheading Synopsis
29382
29383 @smallexample
29384 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29385 @end smallexample
29386
29387 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29388 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29389 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29390 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29391 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29392 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29393 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29394 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29395 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29396 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29397 @code{-var-update} does.
29398
29399 @subsubheading Example
29400
29401 @smallexample
29402 (gdb)
29403 -var-set-frozen V 1
29404 ^done
29405 (gdb)
29406 @end smallexample
29407
29408 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29409 @findex -var-set-update-range
29410 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29411
29412 @subsubheading Synopsis
29413
29414 @smallexample
29415 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29416 @end smallexample
29417
29418 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29419 @code{-var-update}.
29420
29421 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29422 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29423 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29424 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29425
29426 @subsubheading Example
29427
29428 @smallexample
29429 (gdb)
29430 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29431 ^done
29432 @end smallexample
29433
29434 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29435 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29436 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29437
29438 @subsubheading Synopsis
29439
29440 @smallexample
29441 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29442 @end smallexample
29443
29444 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29445
29446 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29447 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29448
29449 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29450 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29451 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29452 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29453 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29454 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29455 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29456
29457 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29458 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29459 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29460 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29461
29462 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29463 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29464 can be used to check this.
29465
29466 @subsubheading Example
29467
29468 Resetting the visualizer:
29469
29470 @smallexample
29471 (gdb)
29472 -var-set-visualizer V None
29473 ^done
29474 @end smallexample
29475
29476 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29477
29478 @smallexample
29479 (gdb)
29480 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29481 ^done
29482 @end smallexample
29483
29484 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29485 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29486
29487 @smallexample
29488 (gdb)
29489 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29490 ^done
29491 @end smallexample
29492
29493 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29494 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29495 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29496
29497 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29498 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29499 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29500 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29501
29502 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29503 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29504
29505 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29506 @c @subheading -data-assign
29507 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29508 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29509 @c set variable
29510 @c @subsubheading Example
29511 @c N.A.
29512
29513 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29514 @findex -data-disassemble
29515
29516 @subsubheading Synopsis
29517
29518 @smallexample
29519 -data-disassemble
29520 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29521 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29522 -- @var{mode}
29523 @end smallexample
29524
29525 @noindent
29526 Where:
29527
29528 @table @samp
29529 @item @var{start-addr}
29530 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29531 @item @var{end-addr}
29532 is the end address
29533 @item @var{filename}
29534 is the name of the file to disassemble
29535 @item @var{linenum}
29536 is the line number to disassemble around
29537 @item @var{lines}
29538 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29539 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29540 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29541 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29542 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29543 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29544 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29545 are displayed.
29546 @item @var{mode}
29547 is one of:
29548 @itemize @bullet
29549 @item 0 disassembly only
29550 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
29551 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
29552 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
29553 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
29554 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
29555 @end itemize
29556
29557 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
29558 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
29559 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
29560 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
29561 @end table
29562
29563 @subsubheading Result
29564
29565 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29566 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29567 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29568
29569 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29570 following fields:
29571
29572 @table @code
29573 @item address
29574 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29575
29576 @item func-name
29577 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29578
29579 @item offset
29580 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29581
29582 @item inst
29583 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29584
29585 @item opcodes
29586 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
29587 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29588
29589 @end table
29590
29591 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29592 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29593
29594 @table @code
29595 @item line
29596 The line number within @samp{file}.
29597
29598 @item file
29599 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29600 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29601 used.
29602
29603 @item fullname
29604 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29605 using the source file search path
29606 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29607 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29608
29609 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29610 present in the debug information.
29611
29612 @item line_asm_insn
29613 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29614 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29615 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29616 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29617 @samp{opcodes}.
29618
29619 @end table
29620
29621 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29622 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29623 adjust its format.
29624
29625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29626
29627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29628
29629 @subsubheading Example
29630
29631 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29632
29633 @smallexample
29634 (gdb)
29635 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29636 ^done,
29637 asm_insns=[
29638 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29639 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29640 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29641 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29642 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29643 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29644 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29645 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29646 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29647 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29648 (gdb)
29649 @end smallexample
29650
29651 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29652 @code{main}.
29653
29654 @smallexample
29655 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29656 ^done,asm_insns=[
29657 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29658 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29659 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29660 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29661 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29662 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29663 [@dots{}]
29664 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29665 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29666 (gdb)
29667 @end smallexample
29668
29669 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29670
29671 @smallexample
29672 (gdb)
29673 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29674 ^done,asm_insns=[
29675 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29676 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29677 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29678 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29679 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29680 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29681 (gdb)
29682 @end smallexample
29683
29684 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29685
29686 @smallexample
29687 (gdb)
29688 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29689 ^done,asm_insns=[
29690 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29691 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29692 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29693 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29694 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29695 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29696 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29697 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29698 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29699 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29700 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29701 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29702 (gdb)
29703 @end smallexample
29704
29705
29706 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29707 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29708
29709 @subsubheading Synopsis
29710
29711 @smallexample
29712 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29713 @end smallexample
29714
29715 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29716 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29717 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29718
29719 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29720
29721 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29722 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29723 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29724
29725 @subsubheading Example
29726
29727 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29728 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29729 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29730 output.
29731
29732 @smallexample
29733 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29734 211^done,value="1"
29735 (gdb)
29736 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29737 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29738 (gdb)
29739 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29740 411^done,value="4"
29741 (gdb)
29742 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29743 511^done,value="4"
29744 (gdb)
29745 @end smallexample
29746
29747
29748 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29749 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29750
29751 @subsubheading Synopsis
29752
29753 @smallexample
29754 -data-list-changed-registers
29755 @end smallexample
29756
29757 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29758
29759 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29760
29761 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29762 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29763
29764 @subsubheading Example
29765
29766 On a PPC MBX board:
29767
29768 @smallexample
29769 (gdb)
29770 -exec-continue
29771 ^running
29772
29773 (gdb)
29774 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29775 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29776 line="5"@}
29777 (gdb)
29778 -data-list-changed-registers
29779 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29780 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29781 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29782 (gdb)
29783 @end smallexample
29784
29785
29786 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29787 @findex -data-list-register-names
29788
29789 @subsubheading Synopsis
29790
29791 @smallexample
29792 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29793 @end smallexample
29794
29795 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29796 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29797 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29798 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29799 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29800 include empty register names.
29801
29802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29803
29804 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29805 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29806 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29807
29808 @subsubheading Example
29809
29810 For the PPC MBX board:
29811 @smallexample
29812 (gdb)
29813 -data-list-register-names
29814 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29815 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29816 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29817 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29818 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29819 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29820 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29821 (gdb)
29822 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29823 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29824 (gdb)
29825 @end smallexample
29826
29827 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29828 @findex -data-list-register-values
29829
29830 @subsubheading Synopsis
29831
29832 @smallexample
29833 -data-list-register-values
29834 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29835 @end smallexample
29836
29837 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29838 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29839 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29840 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29841 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29842 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29843
29844 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29845
29846 @table @code
29847 @item x
29848 Hexadecimal
29849 @item o
29850 Octal
29851 @item t
29852 Binary
29853 @item d
29854 Decimal
29855 @item r
29856 Raw
29857 @item N
29858 Natural
29859 @end table
29860
29861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29862
29863 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29864 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29865
29866 @subsubheading Example
29867
29868 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29869 don't appear in the actual output):
29870
29871 @smallexample
29872 (gdb)
29873 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29874 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29875 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29876 (gdb)
29877 -data-list-register-values x
29878 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29879 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29880 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29881 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29882 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29883 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29884 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29885 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29886 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29887 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29888 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29889 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29890 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29891 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29892 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29893 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29894 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29895 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29896 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29897 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29898 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29899 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29900 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29901 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29902 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29903 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29904 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29905 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29906 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29907 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29908 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29909 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29910 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29911 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29912 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29913 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29914 (gdb)
29915 @end smallexample
29916
29917
29918 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29919 @findex -data-read-memory
29920
29921 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29922
29923 @subsubheading Synopsis
29924
29925 @smallexample
29926 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29927 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29928 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29929 @end smallexample
29930
29931 @noindent
29932 where:
29933
29934 @table @samp
29935 @item @var{address}
29936 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29937 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29938 quoted using the C convention.
29939
29940 @item @var{word-format}
29941 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29942 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29943 ,Output Formats}).
29944
29945 @item @var{word-size}
29946 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29947
29948 @item @var{nr-rows}
29949 The number of rows in the output table.
29950
29951 @item @var{nr-cols}
29952 The number of columns in the output table.
29953
29954 @item @var{aschar}
29955 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29956 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29957 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29958 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29959
29960 @item @var{byte-offset}
29961 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29962 @end table
29963
29964 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29965 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29966 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29967 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29968 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29969 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29970 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29971 @samp{addr}.
29972
29973 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29974 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29975 @samp{prev-page}.
29976
29977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29978
29979 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29980 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29981
29982 @subsubheading Example
29983
29984 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29985 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29986 word. Display each word in hex.
29987
29988 @smallexample
29989 (gdb)
29990 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29991 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29992 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29993 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29994 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29995 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29996 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29997 (gdb)
29998 @end smallexample
29999
30000 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30001 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30002
30003 @smallexample
30004 (gdb)
30005 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30006 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30007 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30008 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30009 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30010 (gdb)
30011 @end smallexample
30012
30013 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30014 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30015 used as the non-printable character.
30016
30017 @smallexample
30018 (gdb)
30019 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30020 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30021 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30022 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30023 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30024 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30025 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30026 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30027 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30028 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30029 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30030 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30031 (gdb)
30032 @end smallexample
30033
30034 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30035 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30036
30037 @subsubheading Synopsis
30038
30039 @smallexample
30040 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30041 @var{address} @var{count}
30042 @end smallexample
30043
30044 @noindent
30045 where:
30046
30047 @table @samp
30048 @item @var{address}
30049 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30050 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30051 quoted using the C convention.
30052
30053 @item @var{count}
30054 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30055 literal.
30056
30057 @item @var{offset}
30058 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30059 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30060 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30061 arithmetics itself.
30062
30063 @end table
30064
30065 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30066 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30067 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30068 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30069 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30070 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30071
30072 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30073 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30074 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30075 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30076 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30077 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30078 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30079 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30080
30081 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30082 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30083 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30084 and has the following fields:
30085
30086 @table @code
30087 @item begin
30088 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30089
30090 @item end
30091 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30092
30093 @item offset
30094 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30095 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30096
30097 @item contents
30098 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30099
30100 @end table
30101
30102
30103
30104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30105
30106 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30107
30108 @subsubheading Example
30109
30110 @smallexample
30111 (gdb)
30112 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30113 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30114 end="0xbffff15e",
30115 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30116 (gdb)
30117 @end smallexample
30118
30119
30120 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30121 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30122
30123 @subsubheading Synopsis
30124
30125 @smallexample
30126 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30127 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30128 @end smallexample
30129
30130 @noindent
30131 where:
30132
30133 @table @samp
30134 @item @var{address}
30135 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30136 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30137 be quoted using the C convention.
30138
30139 @item @var{contents}
30140 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30141 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30142
30143 @item @var{count}
30144 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30145 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30146 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30147 @var{count} memory units.
30148
30149 @end table
30150
30151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30152
30153 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30154
30155 @subsubheading Example
30156
30157 @smallexample
30158 (gdb)
30159 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30160 ^done
30161 (gdb)
30162 @end smallexample
30163
30164 @smallexample
30165 (gdb)
30166 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30167 ^done
30168 (gdb)
30169 @end smallexample
30170
30171 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30172 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30173 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30174
30175 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30176 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30177
30178 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30179 @findex -trace-find
30180
30181 @subsubheading Synopsis
30182
30183 @smallexample
30184 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30185 @end smallexample
30186
30187 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30188 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30189 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30190
30191 @table @samp
30192
30193 @item none
30194 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30195
30196 @item frame-number
30197 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30198 that index.
30199
30200 @item tracepoint-number
30201 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30202 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30203
30204 @item pc
30205 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30206 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30207 address.
30208
30209 @item pc-inside-range
30210 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30211 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30212 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30213
30214 @item pc-outside-range
30215 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30216 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30217 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30218
30219 @item line
30220 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30221 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30222 the specified location.
30223
30224 @end table
30225
30226 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30227 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30228
30229 @table @samp
30230 @item found
30231 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30232 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30233
30234 @item traceframe
30235 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30236 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30237
30238 @item tracepoint
30239 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30240 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30241
30242 @item frame
30243 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30244 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30245 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30246
30247 @end table
30248
30249 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30250
30251 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30252
30253 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30254 @findex -trace-define-variable
30255
30256 @subsubheading Synopsis
30257
30258 @smallexample
30259 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30260 @end smallexample
30261
30262 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30263 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30264 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30265 with the @samp{$} character.
30266
30267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30268
30269 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30270
30271 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30272 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30273
30274 @subsubheading Synopsis
30275
30276 @smallexample
30277 -trace-frame-collected
30278 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30279 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30280 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30281 [--memory-contents]
30282 @end smallexample
30283
30284 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30285 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30286 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30287 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30288 See the output description table below for more details.
30289
30290 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30291 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30292 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30293 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30294 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30295
30296 For instance, if the actions were
30297 @smallexample
30298 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30299 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30300 @end smallexample
30301
30302 @noindent
30303 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30304 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30305 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30306 objects would be computed expressions.
30307
30308 An example output would be:
30309
30310 @smallexample
30311 (gdb)
30312 -trace-frame-collected
30313 ^done,
30314 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30315 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30316 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30317 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30318 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30319 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30320 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30321 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30322 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30323 ...
30324 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30325 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30326 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30327 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30328 (gdb)
30329 @end smallexample
30330
30331 Where:
30332
30333 @table @code
30334 @item explicit-variables
30335 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30336 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30337 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30338 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30339 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30340 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30341 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30342 arrays, structures and unions.
30343
30344 @item computed-expressions
30345 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30346 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30347 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30348 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30349
30350 @item registers
30351 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30352 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30353 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30354 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30355 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30356
30357 @item tvars
30358 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30359 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30360 current value are returned.
30361
30362 @item memory
30363 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30364 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30365 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30366
30367 @table @code
30368 @item address
30369 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30370
30371 @item length
30372 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30373
30374 @item contents
30375 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30376 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30377
30378 @end table
30379
30380 @end table
30381
30382 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30383
30384 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30385
30386 @subsubheading Example
30387
30388 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30389 @findex -trace-list-variables
30390
30391 @subsubheading Synopsis
30392
30393 @smallexample
30394 -trace-list-variables
30395 @end smallexample
30396
30397 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30398 table has the following fields:
30399
30400 @table @samp
30401 @item name
30402 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30403
30404 @item initial
30405 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30406 field is always present.
30407
30408 @item current
30409 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30410 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30411 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30412 presently running.
30413
30414 @end table
30415
30416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30417
30418 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30419
30420 @subsubheading Example
30421
30422 @smallexample
30423 (gdb)
30424 -trace-list-variables
30425 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30426 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30427 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30428 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30429 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30430 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30431 (gdb)
30432 @end smallexample
30433
30434 @subheading -trace-save
30435 @findex -trace-save
30436
30437 @subsubheading Synopsis
30438
30439 @smallexample
30440 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30441 @end smallexample
30442
30443 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30444 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30445 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30446 to perform the save.
30447
30448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30449
30450 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30451
30452
30453 @subheading -trace-start
30454 @findex -trace-start
30455
30456 @subsubheading Synopsis
30457
30458 @smallexample
30459 -trace-start
30460 @end smallexample
30461
30462 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30463 have any fields.
30464
30465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30466
30467 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30468
30469 @subheading -trace-status
30470 @findex -trace-status
30471
30472 @subsubheading Synopsis
30473
30474 @smallexample
30475 -trace-status
30476 @end smallexample
30477
30478 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30479 the following fields:
30480
30481 @table @samp
30482
30483 @item supported
30484 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30485 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30486 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30487 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30488 started. This field is always present.
30489
30490 @item running
30491 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30492 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30493 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30494
30495 @item stop-reason
30496 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30497 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30498 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30499 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30500 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30501 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30502 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30503 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30504 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30505
30506 @item stopping-tracepoint
30507 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30508 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30509 @samp{passcount}.
30510
30511 @item frames
30512 @itemx frames-created
30513 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30514 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30515 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30516 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30517
30518 @item buffer-size
30519 @itemx buffer-free
30520 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30521 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30522
30523 @item circular
30524 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30525 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30526 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30527 and may fill up.
30528
30529 @item disconnected
30530 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30531 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30532 that the trace run will stop.
30533
30534 @item trace-file
30535 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30536 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30537
30538 @end table
30539
30540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30541
30542 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30543
30544 @subheading -trace-stop
30545 @findex -trace-stop
30546
30547 @subsubheading Synopsis
30548
30549 @smallexample
30550 -trace-stop
30551 @end smallexample
30552
30553 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30554 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30555 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30556
30557 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30558
30559 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30560
30561
30562 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30563 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30564 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30565
30566
30567 @ignore
30568 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30569 @findex -symbol-info-address
30570
30571 @subsubheading Synopsis
30572
30573 @smallexample
30574 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30575 @end smallexample
30576
30577 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30578
30579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30580
30581 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30582
30583 @subsubheading Example
30584 N.A.
30585
30586
30587 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30588 @findex -symbol-info-file
30589
30590 @subsubheading Synopsis
30591
30592 @smallexample
30593 -symbol-info-file
30594 @end smallexample
30595
30596 Show the file for the symbol.
30597
30598 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30599
30600 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30601 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30602
30603 @subsubheading Example
30604 N.A.
30605
30606
30607 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30608 @findex -symbol-info-function
30609
30610 @subsubheading Synopsis
30611
30612 @smallexample
30613 -symbol-info-function
30614 @end smallexample
30615
30616 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30617
30618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30619
30620 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30621
30622 @subsubheading Example
30623 N.A.
30624
30625
30626 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30627 @findex -symbol-info-line
30628
30629 @subsubheading Synopsis
30630
30631 @smallexample
30632 -symbol-info-line
30633 @end smallexample
30634
30635 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30636
30637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30638
30639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30640 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30641
30642 @subsubheading Example
30643 N.A.
30644
30645
30646 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30647 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30648
30649 @subsubheading Synopsis
30650
30651 @smallexample
30652 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30653 @end smallexample
30654
30655 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30656
30657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30658
30659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30660
30661 @subsubheading Example
30662 N.A.
30663
30664
30665 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30666 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30667
30668 @subsubheading Synopsis
30669
30670 @smallexample
30671 -symbol-list-functions
30672 @end smallexample
30673
30674 List the functions in the executable.
30675
30676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30677
30678 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30679 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30680
30681 @subsubheading Example
30682 N.A.
30683 @end ignore
30684
30685
30686 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30687 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30688
30689 @subsubheading Synopsis
30690
30691 @smallexample
30692 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30693 @end smallexample
30694
30695 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30696 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30697 ascending PC order.
30698
30699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30700
30701 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30702
30703 @subsubheading Example
30704 @smallexample
30705 (gdb)
30706 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30707 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30708 (gdb)
30709 @end smallexample
30710
30711
30712 @ignore
30713 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30714 @findex -symbol-list-types
30715
30716 @subsubheading Synopsis
30717
30718 @smallexample
30719 -symbol-list-types
30720 @end smallexample
30721
30722 List all the type names.
30723
30724 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30725
30726 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30727 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30728
30729 @subsubheading Example
30730 N.A.
30731
30732
30733 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30734 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30735
30736 @subsubheading Synopsis
30737
30738 @smallexample
30739 -symbol-list-variables
30740 @end smallexample
30741
30742 List all the global and static variable names.
30743
30744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30745
30746 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30747
30748 @subsubheading Example
30749 N.A.
30750
30751
30752 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30753 @findex -symbol-locate
30754
30755 @subsubheading Synopsis
30756
30757 @smallexample
30758 -symbol-locate
30759 @end smallexample
30760
30761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30762
30763 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30764
30765 @subsubheading Example
30766 N.A.
30767
30768
30769 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30770 @findex -symbol-type
30771
30772 @subsubheading Synopsis
30773
30774 @smallexample
30775 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30776 @end smallexample
30777
30778 Show type of @var{variable}.
30779
30780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30781
30782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30783 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30784
30785 @subsubheading Example
30786 N.A.
30787 @end ignore
30788
30789
30790 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30791 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30792 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30793
30794 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30795 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30796
30797 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30798 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30799
30800 @subsubheading Synopsis
30801
30802 @smallexample
30803 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30804 @end smallexample
30805
30806 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30807 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30808 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30809 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30810 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30811 notification.
30812
30813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30814
30815 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30816
30817 @subsubheading Example
30818
30819 @smallexample
30820 (gdb)
30821 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30822 ^done
30823 (gdb)
30824 @end smallexample
30825
30826
30827 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30828 @findex -file-exec-file
30829
30830 @subsubheading Synopsis
30831
30832 @smallexample
30833 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30834 @end smallexample
30835
30836 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30837 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30838 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30839 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30840 notification.
30841
30842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30843
30844 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30845
30846 @subsubheading Example
30847
30848 @smallexample
30849 (gdb)
30850 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30851 ^done
30852 (gdb)
30853 @end smallexample
30854
30855
30856 @ignore
30857 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30858 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30859
30860 @subsubheading Synopsis
30861
30862 @smallexample
30863 -file-list-exec-sections
30864 @end smallexample
30865
30866 List the sections of the current executable file.
30867
30868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30869
30870 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30871 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30872 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30873
30874 @subsubheading Example
30875 N.A.
30876 @end ignore
30877
30878
30879 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30880 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30881
30882 @subsubheading Synopsis
30883
30884 @smallexample
30885 -file-list-exec-source-file
30886 @end smallexample
30887
30888 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30889 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30890 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30891 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30892
30893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30894
30895 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30896
30897 @subsubheading Example
30898
30899 @smallexample
30900 (gdb)
30901 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30902 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30903 (gdb)
30904 @end smallexample
30905
30906
30907 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30908 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30909
30910 @subsubheading Synopsis
30911
30912 @smallexample
30913 -file-list-exec-source-files
30914 @end smallexample
30915
30916 List the source files for the current executable.
30917
30918 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30919 name) of a source file.
30920
30921 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30922
30923 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30924 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30925
30926 @subsubheading Example
30927 @smallexample
30928 (gdb)
30929 -file-list-exec-source-files
30930 ^done,files=[
30931 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30932 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30933 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30934 (gdb)
30935 @end smallexample
30936
30937 @ignore
30938 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30939 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30940
30941 @subsubheading Synopsis
30942
30943 @smallexample
30944 -file-list-shared-libraries
30945 @end smallexample
30946
30947 List the shared libraries in the program.
30948
30949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30950
30951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30952
30953 @subsubheading Example
30954 N.A.
30955
30956
30957 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30958 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30959
30960 @subsubheading Synopsis
30961
30962 @smallexample
30963 -file-list-symbol-files
30964 @end smallexample
30965
30966 List symbol files.
30967
30968 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30969
30970 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30971
30972 @subsubheading Example
30973 N.A.
30974 @end ignore
30975
30976
30977 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30978 @findex -file-symbol-file
30979
30980 @subsubheading Synopsis
30981
30982 @smallexample
30983 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30984 @end smallexample
30985
30986 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30987 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30988 produced, except for a completion notification.
30989
30990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30991
30992 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30993
30994 @subsubheading Example
30995
30996 @smallexample
30997 (gdb)
30998 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30999 ^done
31000 (gdb)
31001 @end smallexample
31002
31003 @ignore
31004 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31005 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31006 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31007
31008 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31009
31010 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31011
31012 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31013
31014 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31015
31016 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31017
31018 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31019
31020 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31021
31022 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31023
31024 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31025 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31026 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31027
31028 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31029
31030 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31031
31032 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31033
31034 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31035 @end ignore
31036
31037
31038 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31039 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31040 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31041
31042
31043 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31044 @findex -target-attach
31045
31046 @subsubheading Synopsis
31047
31048 @smallexample
31049 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31050 @end smallexample
31051
31052 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31053 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31054 group, the id previously returned by
31055 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31056
31057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31058
31059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31060
31061 @subsubheading Example
31062 @smallexample
31063 (gdb)
31064 -target-attach 34
31065 =thread-created,id="1"
31066 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31067 ^done
31068 (gdb)
31069 @end smallexample
31070
31071 @ignore
31072 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31073 @findex -target-compare-sections
31074
31075 @subsubheading Synopsis
31076
31077 @smallexample
31078 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31079 @end smallexample
31080
31081 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31082 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31083
31084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31085
31086 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31087
31088 @subsubheading Example
31089 N.A.
31090 @end ignore
31091
31092
31093 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31094 @findex -target-detach
31095
31096 @subsubheading Synopsis
31097
31098 @smallexample
31099 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31100 @end smallexample
31101
31102 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31103 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31104 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31105
31106 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31107
31108 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31109
31110 @subsubheading Example
31111
31112 @smallexample
31113 (gdb)
31114 -target-detach
31115 ^done
31116 (gdb)
31117 @end smallexample
31118
31119
31120 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31121 @findex -target-disconnect
31122
31123 @subsubheading Synopsis
31124
31125 @smallexample
31126 -target-disconnect
31127 @end smallexample
31128
31129 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31130 generally not resumed.
31131
31132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31133
31134 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31135
31136 @subsubheading Example
31137
31138 @smallexample
31139 (gdb)
31140 -target-disconnect
31141 ^done
31142 (gdb)
31143 @end smallexample
31144
31145
31146 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31147 @findex -target-download
31148
31149 @subsubheading Synopsis
31150
31151 @smallexample
31152 -target-download
31153 @end smallexample
31154
31155 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31156 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31157
31158 @table @samp
31159 @item section
31160 The name of the section.
31161 @item section-sent
31162 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31163 @item section-size
31164 The size of the section.
31165 @item total-sent
31166 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31167 @item total-size
31168 The size of the overall executable to download.
31169 @end table
31170
31171 @noindent
31172 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31173 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31174
31175 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31176 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31177
31178 @table @samp
31179 @item section
31180 The name of the section.
31181 @item section-size
31182 The size of the section.
31183 @item total-size
31184 The size of the overall executable to download.
31185 @end table
31186
31187 @noindent
31188 At the end, a summary is printed.
31189
31190 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31191
31192 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31193
31194 @subsubheading Example
31195
31196 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31197 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31198
31199 @smallexample
31200 (gdb)
31201 -target-download
31202 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31203 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31204 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31205 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31206 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31207 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31208 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31209 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31210 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31211 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31212 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31213 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31214 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31215 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31216 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31217 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31218 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31219 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31220 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31221 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31222 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31223 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31224 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31225 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31226 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31227 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31228 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31229 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31230 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31231 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31232 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31233 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31234 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31235 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31236 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31237 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31238 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31239 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31240 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31241 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31242 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31243 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31244 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31245 write-rate="429"
31246 (gdb)
31247 @end smallexample
31248
31249
31250 @ignore
31251 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31252 @findex -target-exec-status
31253
31254 @subsubheading Synopsis
31255
31256 @smallexample
31257 -target-exec-status
31258 @end smallexample
31259
31260 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31261 not, for instance).
31262
31263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31264
31265 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31266
31267 @subsubheading Example
31268 N.A.
31269
31270
31271 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31272 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31273
31274 @subsubheading Synopsis
31275
31276 @smallexample
31277 -target-list-available-targets
31278 @end smallexample
31279
31280 List the possible targets to connect to.
31281
31282 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31283
31284 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31285
31286 @subsubheading Example
31287 N.A.
31288
31289
31290 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31291 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31292
31293 @subsubheading Synopsis
31294
31295 @smallexample
31296 -target-list-current-targets
31297 @end smallexample
31298
31299 Describe the current target.
31300
31301 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31302
31303 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31304 other things).
31305
31306 @subsubheading Example
31307 N.A.
31308
31309
31310 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31311 @findex -target-list-parameters
31312
31313 @subsubheading Synopsis
31314
31315 @smallexample
31316 -target-list-parameters
31317 @end smallexample
31318
31319 @c ????
31320 @end ignore
31321
31322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31323
31324 No equivalent.
31325
31326 @subsubheading Example
31327 N.A.
31328
31329
31330 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31331 @findex -target-select
31332
31333 @subsubheading Synopsis
31334
31335 @smallexample
31336 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31337 @end smallexample
31338
31339 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31340
31341 @table @samp
31342 @item @var{type}
31343 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31344 @item @var{parameters}
31345 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31346 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31347 @end table
31348
31349 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31350 which the target program is, in the following form:
31351
31352 @smallexample
31353 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31354 args=[@var{arg list}]
31355 @end smallexample
31356
31357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31358
31359 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31360
31361 @subsubheading Example
31362
31363 @smallexample
31364 (gdb)
31365 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31366 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31367 (gdb)
31368 @end smallexample
31369
31370 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31371 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31372 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31373
31374
31375 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31376 @findex -target-file-put
31377
31378 @subsubheading Synopsis
31379
31380 @smallexample
31381 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31382 @end smallexample
31383
31384 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31385 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31386
31387 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31388
31389 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31390
31391 @subsubheading Example
31392
31393 @smallexample
31394 (gdb)
31395 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31396 ^done
31397 (gdb)
31398 @end smallexample
31399
31400
31401 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31402 @findex -target-file-get
31403
31404 @subsubheading Synopsis
31405
31406 @smallexample
31407 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31408 @end smallexample
31409
31410 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31411 on the host system.
31412
31413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31414
31415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31416
31417 @subsubheading Example
31418
31419 @smallexample
31420 (gdb)
31421 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31422 ^done
31423 (gdb)
31424 @end smallexample
31425
31426
31427 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31428 @findex -target-file-delete
31429
31430 @subsubheading Synopsis
31431
31432 @smallexample
31433 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31434 @end smallexample
31435
31436 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31437
31438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31439
31440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31441
31442 @subsubheading Example
31443
31444 @smallexample
31445 (gdb)
31446 -target-file-delete remotefile
31447 ^done
31448 (gdb)
31449 @end smallexample
31450
31451
31452 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31453 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31454 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31455
31456 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31457 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31458
31459 @subsubheading Synopsis
31460
31461 @smallexample
31462 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31463 @end smallexample
31464
31465 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31466 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31467 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31468
31469 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31470
31471 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31472
31473 @subsubheading Result
31474
31475 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31476 defined for each exception:
31477
31478 @table @samp
31479 @item name
31480 The name of the exception.
31481
31482 @item address
31483 The address of the exception.
31484
31485 @end table
31486
31487 @subsubheading Example
31488
31489 @smallexample
31490 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31491 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31492 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31493 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31494 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31495 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31496 @end smallexample
31497
31498 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31499
31500 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31501 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31502 Catchpoint Commands}.
31503
31504
31505 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31506 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31507 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31508
31509 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31510 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31511 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31512 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31513
31514 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31515 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31516 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31517
31518 @subsubheading Synopsis
31519
31520 @smallexample
31521 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31522 @end smallexample
31523
31524 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31525
31526 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31527 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31528 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31529 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31530 dash.
31531
31532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31533
31534 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31535
31536 @subsubheading Result
31537
31538 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31539
31540 @table @samp
31541 @item exists
31542 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31543 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31544
31545 @end table
31546
31547 @subsubheading Example
31548
31549 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31550
31551 @smallexample
31552 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31553 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31554 @end smallexample
31555
31556 @noindent
31557 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31558 to the debugger:
31559
31560 @smallexample
31561 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31562 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31563 @end smallexample
31564
31565 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31566 @findex -list-features
31567 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31568
31569 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31570 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31571 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31572 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31573 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31574 startup.
31575
31576 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31577 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31578 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31579 is given below.
31580
31581 Example output:
31582
31583 @smallexample
31584 (gdb) -list-features
31585 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31586 @end smallexample
31587
31588 The current list of features is:
31589
31590 @ftable @samp
31591 @item frozen-varobjs
31592 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31593 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31594 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31595 @item pending-breakpoints
31596 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31597 command.
31598 @item python
31599 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31600 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31601 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31602 @item thread-info
31603 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31604 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31605 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31606 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31607 @item breakpoint-notifications
31608 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31609 CLI will be announced via async records.
31610 @item ada-task-info
31611 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31612 @item language-option
31613 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31614 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31615 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31616 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31617 @item undefined-command-error-code
31618 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31619 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31620 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31621 @item exec-run-start-option
31622 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31623 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31624 @end ftable
31625
31626 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31627 @findex -list-target-features
31628
31629 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31630 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31631 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31632 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31633 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31634 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31635 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31636 Example output:
31637
31638 @smallexample
31639 (gdb) -list-target-features
31640 ^done,result=["async"]
31641 @end smallexample
31642
31643 The current list of features is:
31644
31645 @table @samp
31646 @item async
31647 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31648 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31649 while the target is running.
31650
31651 @item reverse
31652 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31653 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31654
31655 @end table
31656
31657 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31658 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31659 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31660
31661 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31662
31663 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31664 @findex -gdb-exit
31665
31666 @subsubheading Synopsis
31667
31668 @smallexample
31669 -gdb-exit
31670 @end smallexample
31671
31672 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31673
31674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31675
31676 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31677
31678 @subsubheading Example
31679
31680 @smallexample
31681 (gdb)
31682 -gdb-exit
31683 ^exit
31684 @end smallexample
31685
31686
31687 @ignore
31688 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31689 @findex -exec-abort
31690
31691 @subsubheading Synopsis
31692
31693 @smallexample
31694 -exec-abort
31695 @end smallexample
31696
31697 Kill the inferior running program.
31698
31699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31700
31701 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31702
31703 @subsubheading Example
31704 N.A.
31705 @end ignore
31706
31707
31708 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31709 @findex -gdb-set
31710
31711 @subsubheading Synopsis
31712
31713 @smallexample
31714 -gdb-set
31715 @end smallexample
31716
31717 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31718 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31719
31720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31721
31722 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31723
31724 @subsubheading Example
31725
31726 @smallexample
31727 (gdb)
31728 -gdb-set $foo=3
31729 ^done
31730 (gdb)
31731 @end smallexample
31732
31733
31734 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31735 @findex -gdb-show
31736
31737 @subsubheading Synopsis
31738
31739 @smallexample
31740 -gdb-show
31741 @end smallexample
31742
31743 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31744
31745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31746
31747 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31748
31749 @subsubheading Example
31750
31751 @smallexample
31752 (gdb)
31753 -gdb-show annotate
31754 ^done,value="0"
31755 (gdb)
31756 @end smallexample
31757
31758 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31759
31760
31761 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31762 @findex -gdb-version
31763
31764 @subsubheading Synopsis
31765
31766 @smallexample
31767 -gdb-version
31768 @end smallexample
31769
31770 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31771
31772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31773
31774 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31775 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31776
31777 @subsubheading Example
31778
31779 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31780 @c box in TeX.
31781 @smallexample
31782 (gdb)
31783 -gdb-version
31784 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31785 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31786 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31787 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31788 ~ certain conditions.
31789 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31790 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31791 ~ details.
31792 ~This GDB was configured as
31793 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31794 ^done
31795 (gdb)
31796 @end smallexample
31797
31798 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31799 @findex -list-thread-groups
31800
31801 @subheading Synopsis
31802
31803 @smallexample
31804 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31805 @end smallexample
31806
31807 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31808 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31809 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31810 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31811 top-level thread groups.
31812
31813 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31814 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31815 available on the target.
31816
31817 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31818 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31819 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31820 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31821 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31822 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31823 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31824 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31825
31826 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31827 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31828 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31829 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31830 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31831 @samp{threads} field.
31832
31833 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31834 the following caveats:
31835
31836 @itemize @bullet
31837 @item
31838 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31839 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31840 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31841
31842 @item
31843 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31844 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31845 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31846 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31847 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31848 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31849
31850 @end itemize
31851
31852 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31853 have the following fields:
31854
31855 @table @code
31856 @item id
31857 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31858 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31859 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31860
31861 @item type
31862 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31863 valid type.
31864
31865 @item pid
31866 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31867 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31868
31869 @item exit-code
31870 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31871 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31872 only if the process is not running.
31873
31874 @item num_children
31875 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31876 absent for an available thread group.
31877
31878 @item threads
31879 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31880 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31881 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31882
31883 @item cores
31884 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31885 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31886 such information is not available.
31887
31888 @item executable
31889 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31890 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31891 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31892
31893 @end table
31894
31895 @subheading Example
31896
31897 @smallexample
31898 @value{GDBP}
31899 -list-thread-groups
31900 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31901 -list-thread-groups 17
31902 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31903 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31904 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31905 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31906 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31907 -list-thread-groups --available
31908 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31909 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31910 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31911 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31912 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31913 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31914 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31915 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31916 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31917 @end smallexample
31918
31919 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31920 @findex -info-os
31921
31922 @subsubheading Synopsis
31923
31924 @smallexample
31925 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31926 @end smallexample
31927
31928 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31929 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31930 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31931 of data of that type.
31932
31933 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31934 system.
31935
31936 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31937
31938 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31939
31940 @subsubheading Example
31941
31942 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31943 like this:
31944
31945 @smallexample
31946 @value{GDBP}
31947 -info-os
31948 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
31949 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31950 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31951 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31952 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
31953 col2="CPUs"@},
31954 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31955 col2="File descriptors"@},
31956 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31957 col2="Kernel modules"@},
31958 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31959 col2="Message queues"@},
31960 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31961 col2="Processes"@},
31962 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31963 col2="Process groups"@},
31964 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31965 col2="Semaphores"@},
31966 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31967 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31968 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31969 col2="Sockets"@},
31970 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31971 col2="Threads"@}]
31972 @value{GDBP}
31973 -info-os processes
31974 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31975 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31976 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31977 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31978 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31979 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31980 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31981 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31982 ...
31983 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31984 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31985 (gdb)
31986 @end smallexample
31987
31988 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31989 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31990 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31991 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31992 @code{info os} omits it.)
31993
31994 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31995 @findex -add-inferior
31996
31997 @subheading Synopsis
31998
31999 @smallexample
32000 -add-inferior
32001 @end smallexample
32002
32003 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32004 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32005 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32006 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32007 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32008 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32009
32010 @subheading Example
32011
32012 @smallexample
32013 @value{GDBP}
32014 -add-inferior
32015 ^done,inferior="i3"
32016 @end smallexample
32017
32018 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32019 @findex -interpreter-exec
32020
32021 @subheading Synopsis
32022
32023 @smallexample
32024 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32025 @end smallexample
32026 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32027
32028 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32029
32030 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32031
32032 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32033
32034 @subheading Example
32035
32036 @smallexample
32037 (gdb)
32038 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32039 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32040 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32041 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32042 ^done
32043 (gdb)
32044 @end smallexample
32045
32046 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32047 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32048
32049 @subheading Synopsis
32050
32051 @smallexample
32052 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32053 @end smallexample
32054
32055 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32056
32057 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32058
32059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32060
32061 @subheading Example
32062
32063 @smallexample
32064 (gdb)
32065 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32066 ^done
32067 (gdb)
32068 @end smallexample
32069
32070 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32071 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32072
32073 @subheading Synopsis
32074
32075 @smallexample
32076 -inferior-tty-show
32077 @end smallexample
32078
32079 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32080
32081 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32082
32083 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32084
32085 @subheading Example
32086
32087 @smallexample
32088 (gdb)
32089 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32090 ^done
32091 (gdb)
32092 -inferior-tty-show
32093 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32094 (gdb)
32095 @end smallexample
32096
32097 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32098 @findex -enable-timings
32099
32100 @subheading Synopsis
32101
32102 @smallexample
32103 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32104 @end smallexample
32105
32106 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32107 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32108 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32109 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32110
32111 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32112
32113 No equivalent.
32114
32115 @subheading Example
32116
32117 @smallexample
32118 (gdb)
32119 -enable-timings
32120 ^done
32121 (gdb)
32122 -break-insert main
32123 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32124 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32125 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32126 times="0"@},
32127 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32128 (gdb)
32129 -enable-timings no
32130 ^done
32131 (gdb)
32132 -exec-run
32133 ^running
32134 (gdb)
32135 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32136 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32137 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32138 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32139 (gdb)
32140 @end smallexample
32141
32142 @node Annotations
32143 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32144
32145 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32146 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32147 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32148 relatively high level.
32149
32150 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32151 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32152
32153 @ignore
32154 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32155 @end ignore
32156
32157 @menu
32158 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32159 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32160 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32161 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32162 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32163 * Annotations for Running::
32164 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32165 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32166 @end menu
32167
32168 @node Annotations Overview
32169 @section What is an Annotation?
32170 @cindex annotations
32171
32172 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32173 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32174 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32175 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32176 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32177 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32178 cannot contain newline characters.
32179
32180 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32181 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32182 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32183 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32184 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32185 means those three characters as output.
32186
32187 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32188 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32189 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32190 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32191 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32192 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32193 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32194 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32195 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32196
32197 @table @code
32198 @kindex set annotate
32199 @item set annotate @var{level}
32200 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32201 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32202
32203 @item show annotate
32204 @kindex show annotate
32205 Show the current annotation level.
32206 @end table
32207
32208 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32209
32210 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32211
32212 @smallexample
32213 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32214 GNU gdb 6.0
32215 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32216 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32217 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32218 under certain conditions.
32219 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32220 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32221 for details.
32222 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32223
32224 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32225 (@value{GDBP})
32226 ^Z^Zprompt
32227 @kbd{quit}
32228
32229 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32230 $
32231 @end smallexample
32232
32233 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32234 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32235 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32236 output from @value{GDBN}.
32237
32238 @node Server Prefix
32239 @section The Server Prefix
32240 @cindex server prefix
32241
32242 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32243 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32244 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32245 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32246 a transparent manner.
32247
32248 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32249 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32250 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32251 @code{print} command.
32252
32253 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32254 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32255
32256 @node Prompting
32257 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32258
32259 @cindex annotations for prompts
32260 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32261 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32262 over, etc.
32263
32264 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32265 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32266 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32267 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32268 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32269 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32270 features the following annotations:
32271
32272 @smallexample
32273 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32274 ^Z^Zprompt
32275 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32276 @end smallexample
32277
32278 The input types are
32279
32280 @table @code
32281 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32282 @findex prompt annotation
32283 @findex post-prompt annotation
32284 @item prompt
32285 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32286
32287 @findex pre-commands annotation
32288 @findex commands annotation
32289 @findex post-commands annotation
32290 @item commands
32291 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32292 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32293
32294 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32295 @findex overload-choice annotation
32296 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32297 @item overload-choice
32298 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32299
32300 @findex pre-query annotation
32301 @findex query annotation
32302 @findex post-query annotation
32303 @item query
32304 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32305
32306 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32307 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32308 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32309 @item prompt-for-continue
32310 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32311 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32312 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32313 presence of annotations.
32314 @end table
32315
32316 @node Errors
32317 @section Errors
32318 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32319
32320 @findex quit annotation
32321 @smallexample
32322 ^Z^Zquit
32323 @end smallexample
32324
32325 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32326
32327 @findex error annotation
32328 @smallexample
32329 ^Z^Zerror
32330 @end smallexample
32331
32332 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32333
32334 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32335 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32336 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32337 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32338 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32339 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32340 to the top level.
32341
32342 @findex error-begin annotation
32343 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32344
32345 @smallexample
32346 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32347 @end smallexample
32348
32349 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32350 message.
32351
32352 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32353 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32354 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32355
32356 @node Invalidation
32357 @section Invalidation Notices
32358
32359 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32360 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32361 changed.
32362
32363 @table @code
32364 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32365 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32366
32367 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32368 have changed.
32369
32370 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32371 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32372
32373 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32374 deleted a breakpoint.
32375 @end table
32376
32377 @node Annotations for Running
32378 @section Running the Program
32379 @cindex annotations for running programs
32380
32381 @findex starting annotation
32382 @findex stopping annotation
32383 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32384 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32385
32386 @smallexample
32387 ^Z^Zstarting
32388 @end smallexample
32389
32390 is output. When the program stops,
32391
32392 @smallexample
32393 ^Z^Zstopped
32394 @end smallexample
32395
32396 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32397 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32398
32399 @table @code
32400 @findex exited annotation
32401 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32402 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32403 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32404
32405 @findex signalled annotation
32406 @findex signal-name annotation
32407 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32408 @findex signal-string annotation
32409 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32410 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32411 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32412 annotation continues:
32413
32414 @smallexample
32415 @var{intro-text}
32416 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32417 @var{name}
32418 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32419 @var{middle-text}
32420 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32421 @var{string}
32422 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32423 @var{end-text}
32424 @end smallexample
32425
32426 @noindent
32427 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32428 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32429 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32430 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32431 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32432
32433 @findex signal annotation
32434 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32435 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32436 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32437 terminated with it.
32438
32439 @findex breakpoint annotation
32440 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32441 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32442
32443 @findex watchpoint annotation
32444 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32445 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32446 @end table
32447
32448 @node Source Annotations
32449 @section Displaying Source
32450 @cindex annotations for source display
32451
32452 @findex source annotation
32453 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32454
32455 @smallexample
32456 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32457 @end smallexample
32458
32459 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32460 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32461 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32462 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32463 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32464 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32465 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32466 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32467 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32468 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32469 depend on the language).
32470
32471 @node JIT Interface
32472 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32473 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32474 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32475
32476 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32477 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32478 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32479 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32480
32481 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32482 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32483 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32484 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32485 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32486 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32487
32488 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32489 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32490 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32491 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32492 LLVM JIT.
32493
32494 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32495 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32496 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32497 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32498 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32499 out about additional code.
32500
32501 @menu
32502 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32503 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32504 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32505 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32506 @end menu
32507
32508 @node Declarations
32509 @section JIT Declarations
32510
32511 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32512 implement the interface:
32513
32514 @smallexample
32515 typedef enum
32516 @{
32517 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32518 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32519 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32520 @} jit_actions_t;
32521
32522 struct jit_code_entry
32523 @{
32524 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32525 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32526 const char *symfile_addr;
32527 uint64_t symfile_size;
32528 @};
32529
32530 struct jit_descriptor
32531 @{
32532 uint32_t version;
32533 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32534 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32535 uint32_t action_flag;
32536 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32537 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32538 @};
32539
32540 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32541 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32542
32543 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32544 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32545 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32546 @end smallexample
32547
32548 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32549 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32550 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32551
32552 @node Registering Code
32553 @section Registering Code
32554
32555 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32556
32557 @itemize @bullet
32558 @item
32559 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32560 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32561
32562 @item
32563 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32564 file.
32565
32566 @item
32567 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32568
32569 @item
32570 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32571
32572 @item
32573 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32574 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32575 @end itemize
32576
32577 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32578 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32579 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32580 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32581
32582 @node Unregistering Code
32583 @section Unregistering Code
32584
32585 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32586
32587 @itemize @bullet
32588 @item
32589 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32590
32591 @item
32592 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32593
32594 @item
32595 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32596 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32597 @end itemize
32598
32599 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32600 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32601
32602 @node Custom Debug Info
32603 @section Custom Debug Info
32604 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32605 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32606
32607 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32608 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32609 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32610 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32611 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32612 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32613 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32614 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32615 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32616
32617 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32618 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32619 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32620 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32621 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32622 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32623 compiler.
32624
32625 @menu
32626 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32627 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32628 @end menu
32629
32630 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32631 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32632 @kindex jit-reader-load
32633 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32634
32635 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32636 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32637
32638 @table @code
32639 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32640 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32641 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32642 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32643 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32644 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32645 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32646
32647 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32648 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32649 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32650 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32651 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32652
32653 @item jit-reader-unload
32654 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32655
32656 @end table
32657
32658 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32659 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32660 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32661
32662 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32663 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32664
32665 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32666 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32667 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32668 the system include directory.
32669
32670 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32671 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32672 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32673
32674 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32675 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32676
32677 @findex gdb_init_reader
32678 @smallexample
32679 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32680 @end smallexample
32681
32682 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32683
32684 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32685 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32686 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32687 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32688 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32689 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32690
32691 @smallexample
32692 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32693 @{
32694 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32695 int reader_version;
32696
32697 /* For use by the reader. */
32698 void *priv_data;
32699
32700 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32701 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32702 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32703 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32704 @};
32705 @end smallexample
32706
32707 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32708 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32709
32710 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32711 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32712 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32713 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32714 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32715 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32716 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32717 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32718 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32719 target's address space.
32720
32721 @node In-Process Agent
32722 @chapter In-Process Agent
32723 @cindex debugging agent
32724 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32725 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32726 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32727 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32728 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32729 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32730 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32731 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32732 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32733 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32734 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32735 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32736 behavior without interrupting it.
32737
32738 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32739 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32740 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32741 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32742 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32743 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32744 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32745 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32746 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32747
32748 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32749 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32750 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32751 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32752
32753 @anchor{Control Agent}
32754 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32755 debugging with the following commands:
32756
32757 @table @code
32758 @kindex set agent on
32759 @item set agent on
32760 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32761 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32762 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32763 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32764 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32765 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32766
32767 @kindex set agent off
32768 @item set agent off
32769 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32770 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32771
32772 @kindex show agent
32773 @item show agent
32774 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32775 the in-process agent.
32776 @end table
32777
32778 @menu
32779 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32780 @end menu
32781
32782 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32783 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32784 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32785
32786 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32787 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32788 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32789 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32790 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32791 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32792 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32793 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32794 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32795
32796 @menu
32797 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32798 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32799 @end menu
32800
32801 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32802 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32803 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32804
32805 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32806 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32807
32808 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32809 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32810 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32811 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32812
32813 @enumerate
32814 @item
32815 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32816 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32817 @item
32818 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32819 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32820 the other one.
32821 @end enumerate
32822
32823 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32824
32825 @enumerate
32826 @item
32827 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32828 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32829 @anchor{agent expression object}
32830 @item
32831 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32832 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32833 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32834 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32835 @item
32836 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32837 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32838
32839 @end enumerate
32840
32841 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32842 object:
32843
32844 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32845 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32846 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32847 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32848 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32849 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32850 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32851 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32852 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32853 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32854 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32855 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32856 memory address for collecting.
32857 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32858 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32859 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32860 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32861 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32862 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32863 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32864 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32865 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32866 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32867 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32868 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32869 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32870 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32871 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32872 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32873 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32874 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32875 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32876 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32877 @ref{agent expression object}
32878 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32879 @ref{agent expression object}
32880 @item actions @tab variable
32881 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32882 @end multitable
32883
32884 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32885 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32886 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32887
32888 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32889 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32890
32891 @table @samp
32892
32893 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32894 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32895 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32896 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32897 in IPA finally.
32898
32899 Replies:
32900 @table @samp
32901 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32902 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32903 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32904 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32905 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32906 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32907 @item E @var{NN}
32908 for an error
32909
32910 @end table
32911
32912 @item close
32913 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32914 is about to kill inferiors.
32915
32916 @item qTfSTM
32917 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32918 @item qTsSTM
32919 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32920 @item qTSTMat
32921 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32922 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32923 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32924
32925 Replies:
32926 @table @samp
32927 @item E @var{NN}
32928 for an error
32929 @end table
32930 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32931 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32932 @end table
32933
32934 @node GDB Bugs
32935 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32936 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32937 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32938
32939 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32940
32941 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32942 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32943 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32944 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32945
32946 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32947 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32948
32949 @menu
32950 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32951 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32952 @end menu
32953
32954 @node Bug Criteria
32955 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32956 @cindex bug criteria
32957
32958 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32959
32960 @itemize @bullet
32961 @cindex fatal signal
32962 @cindex debugger crash
32963 @cindex crash of debugger
32964 @item
32965 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32966 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32967
32968 @cindex error on valid input
32969 @item
32970 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32971 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32972 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32973
32974 @cindex invalid input
32975 @item
32976 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32977 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32978 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32979 for traditional practice''.
32980
32981 @item
32982 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32983 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32984 @end itemize
32985
32986 @node Bug Reporting
32987 @section How to Report Bugs
32988 @cindex bug reports
32989 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32990
32991 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32992 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32993 contact that organization first.
32994
32995 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32996 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32997 distribution.
32998 @c should add a web page ref...
32999
33000 @ifset BUGURL
33001 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33002 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33003 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33004 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33005 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33006 be used.
33007
33008 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33009 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33010 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33011 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33012
33013 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33014 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33015 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33016 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33017 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33018 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33019 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33020 bug reports to the mailing list.
33021 @end ifset
33022 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33023 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33024 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33025 @end ifclear
33026 @end ifset
33027
33028 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33029 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33030 fact or leave it out, state it!
33031
33032 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33033 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33034 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33035 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33036 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33037 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33038 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33039 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33040 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33041
33042 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33043 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33044 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33045 self-contained.
33046
33047 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33048 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33049 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33050 bugs properly.
33051
33052 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33053
33054 @itemize @bullet
33055 @item
33056 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33057 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33058 version}.
33059
33060 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33061 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33062
33063 @item
33064 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33065 version number.
33066
33067 @item
33068 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33069 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33070 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33071 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33072
33073 @item
33074 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33075 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33076
33077 @item
33078 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33079 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33080 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33081 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33082 those compilers.
33083
33084 @item
33085 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33086 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33087 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33088 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33089
33090 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33091 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33092
33093 @item
33094 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33095 reproduce the bug.
33096
33097 @item
33098 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33099 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33100
33101 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33102 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33103 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33104 a chance to make a mistake.
33105
33106 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33107 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33108 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33109 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33110 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33111 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33112 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33113 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33114
33115 @pindex script
33116 @cindex recording a session script
33117 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33118 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33119 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33120 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33121
33122 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33123 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33124
33125 @item
33126 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33127 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33128 it by context, not by line number.
33129
33130 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33131 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33132
33133 @end itemize
33134
33135 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33136
33137 @itemize @bullet
33138 @item
33139 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33140
33141 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33142 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33143 changes will not affect it.
33144
33145 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33146 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33147 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33148 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33149
33150 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33151 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33152 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33153 less time, and so on.
33154
33155 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33156 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33157
33158 @item
33159 A patch for the bug.
33160
33161 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33162 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33163 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33164 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33165
33166 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33167 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33168 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33169 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33170
33171 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33172 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33173 help us to understand.
33174
33175 @item
33176 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33177
33178 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33179 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33180 @end itemize
33181
33182 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33183 @c and consists of the two following files:
33184 @c rluser.texi
33185 @c hsuser.texi
33186 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33187 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33188 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33189 @include rluser.texi
33190 @include hsuser.texi
33191 @end ifclear
33192
33193 @node In Memoriam
33194 @appendix In Memoriam
33195
33196 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33197 contributors:
33198
33199 @table @code
33200 @item Fred Fish
33201 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33202 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33203 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33204
33205 @item Michael Snyder
33206 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33207 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33208 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33209 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33210 @end table
33211
33212 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33213 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33214
33215 @node Formatting Documentation
33216 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33217
33218 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33219 @cindex reference card
33220 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33221 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33222 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33223 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33224 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33225 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33226
33227 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33228 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33229
33230 @smallexample
33231 make refcard.dvi
33232 @end smallexample
33233
33234 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33235 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33236 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33237 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33238 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33239
33240 @cindex documentation
33241
33242 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33243 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33244 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33245 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33246 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33247 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33248
33249 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33250 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33251 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33252 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33253 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33254 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33255 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33256 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33257
33258 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33259 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33260 @code{makeinfo}.
33261
33262 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33263 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33264 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33265
33266 @smallexample
33267 cd gdb
33268 make gdb.info
33269 @end smallexample
33270
33271 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33272 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33273 Texinfo definitions file.
33274
33275 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33276 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33277 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33278 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33279 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33280 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33281 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33282
33283 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33284 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33285 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33286 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33287 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33288 directory.
33289
33290 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33291 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33292 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33293 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33294
33295 @smallexample
33296 make gdb.dvi
33297 @end smallexample
33298
33299 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33300
33301 @node Installing GDB
33302 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33303 @cindex installation
33304
33305 @menu
33306 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33307 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33308 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33309 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33310 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33311 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33312 @end menu
33313
33314 @node Requirements
33315 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33316 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33317
33318 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33319 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33320
33321 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33322 @table @asis
33323 @item ISO C90 compiler
33324 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33325 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33326
33327 @end table
33328
33329 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33330 @table @asis
33331 @item Expat
33332 @anchor{Expat}
33333 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33334 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33335 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33336 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33337 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33338 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33339
33340 Expat is used for:
33341
33342 @itemize @bullet
33343 @item
33344 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33345 @item
33346 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33347 @item
33348 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33349 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33350 @item
33351 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33352 @item
33353 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33354 @item
33355 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33356 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33357 @end itemize
33358
33359 @item zlib
33360 @cindex compressed debug sections
33361 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33362 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33363 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33364 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33365 information in such binaries.
33366
33367 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33368 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33369 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33370
33371 @item iconv
33372 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33373 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33374 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33375 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33376
33377 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33378 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33379 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33380 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33381
33382 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33383 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33384 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33385
33386 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33387 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33388 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33389 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33390 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33391 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33392 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33393 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33394 @end table
33395
33396 @node Running Configure
33397 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33398 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33399 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33400 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33401 build the @code{gdb} program.
33402 @iftex
33403 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33404 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33405 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33406 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33407 @end iftex
33408
33409 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33410 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33411 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33412
33413 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33414 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33415
33416 @table @code
33417 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33418 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33419
33420 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33421 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33422
33423 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33424 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33425
33426 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33427 @sc{gnu} include files
33428
33429 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33430 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33431
33432 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33433 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33434
33435 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33436 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33437
33438 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33439 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33440
33441 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33442 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33443 @end table
33444
33445 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33446 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33447 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33448
33449 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33450 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33451 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33452 argument.
33453
33454 For example:
33455
33456 @smallexample
33457 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33458 ./configure @var{host}
33459 make
33460 @end smallexample
33461
33462 @noindent
33463 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33464 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33465 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33466 correct value by examining your system.)
33467
33468 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33469 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33470 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33471 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33472
33473 @need 750
33474 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33475 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33476 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33477
33478 @smallexample
33479 sh configure @var{host}
33480 @end smallexample
33481
33482 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33483 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33484 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33485 @file{configure}
33486 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33487 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33488
33489 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33490 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33491 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33492 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33493 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33494 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33495 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33496 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33497 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33498
33499 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33500 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33501 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33502 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33503 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33504
33505 @node Separate Objdir
33506 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33507
33508 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33509 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33510 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33511 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33512 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33513 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33514 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33515 program specified there.
33516
33517 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33518 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33519 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33520 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33521 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33522 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33523
33524 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33525 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33526
33527 @smallexample
33528 @group
33529 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33530 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33531 cd ../gdb-sun4
33532 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33533 make
33534 @end group
33535 @end smallexample
33536
33537 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33538 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33539 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33540 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33541 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33542 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33543
33544 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33545 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33546 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33547 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33548 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33549
33550 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33551 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33552 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33553 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33554 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33555 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33556
33557 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33558 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33559 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33560
33561 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33562 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33563 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33564 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33565 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33566
33567 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33568 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33569 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33570 with each other.
33571
33572 @node Config Names
33573 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33574
33575 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33576 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33577 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33578 of information in the following pattern:
33579
33580 @smallexample
33581 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33582 @end smallexample
33583
33584 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33585 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33586 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33587
33588 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33589 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33590 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33591 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33592 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33593 abbreviations---for example:
33594
33595 @smallexample
33596 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33597 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33598 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33599 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33600 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33601 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33602 % sh config.sub sun4
33603 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33604 % sh config.sub sun3
33605 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33606 % sh config.sub i986v
33607 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33608 @end smallexample
33609
33610 @noindent
33611 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33612 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33613
33614 @node Configure Options
33615 @section @file{configure} Options
33616
33617 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33618 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33619 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33620 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33621
33622 @smallexample
33623 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33624 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33625 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33626 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33627 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33628 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33629 @var{host}
33630 @end smallexample
33631
33632 @noindent
33633 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33634 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33635 @samp{--}.
33636
33637 @table @code
33638 @item --help
33639 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33640
33641 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33642 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33643 @file{@var{dir}}.
33644
33645 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33646 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33647 @file{@var{dir}}.
33648
33649 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33650 @need 2000
33651 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33652 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33653 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33654 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33655 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33656 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33657 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33658 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33659 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33660 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33661 @var{dirname}.
33662
33663 @item --norecursion
33664 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33665 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33666
33667 @item --target=@var{target}
33668 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33669 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33670 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33671
33672 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33673
33674 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33675 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33676
33677 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33678 @end table
33679
33680 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33681 needed for special purposes only.
33682
33683 @node System-wide configuration
33684 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33685 @cindex system-wide init file
33686
33687 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33688 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33689 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33690
33691 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33692
33693 @table @code
33694 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33695 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33696 @var{file}.
33697 @end table
33698
33699 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33700 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33701
33702 @itemize @bullet
33703 @item
33704 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33705 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33706 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33707 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33708 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33709 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33710
33711 @item
33712 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33713 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33714 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33715 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33716 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33717 @end itemize
33718
33719 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33720 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33721 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33722 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33723 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33724 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33725 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33726 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33727 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33728 reread.
33729
33730 @menu
33731 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33732 @end menu
33733
33734 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33735 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33736 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33737
33738 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33739 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33740 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33741 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33742 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33743 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33744
33745 The following scripts are currently available:
33746 @itemize @bullet
33747
33748 @item @file{elinos.py}
33749 @pindex elinos.py
33750 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33751 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33752 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33753 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33754 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33755 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33756
33757 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33758 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33759 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33760 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33761 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33762 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33763
33764 @end itemize
33765
33766 @node Maintenance Commands
33767 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33768 @cindex maintenance commands
33769 @cindex internal commands
33770
33771 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33772 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33773 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33774 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33775 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33776
33777 @table @code
33778 @kindex maint agent
33779 @kindex maint agent-eval
33780 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33781 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33782 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33783 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33784 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33785 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33786 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33787 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33788 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33789 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33790 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33791 addition and return the sum.
33792 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33793 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33794
33795 @kindex maint agent-printf
33796 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33797 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33798 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33799 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33800 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33801
33802 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33803 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33804 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33805 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33806 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33807 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33808 is shown:
33809
33810 @table @code
33811 @item breakpoint
33812 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33813
33814 @item watchpoint
33815 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33816
33817 @item longjmp
33818 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33819 @code{longjmp} calls.
33820
33821 @item longjmp resume
33822 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33823
33824 @item until
33825 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33826
33827 @item finish
33828 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33829
33830 @item shlib events
33831 Shared library events.
33832
33833 @end table
33834
33835 @kindex maint info btrace
33836 @item maint info btrace
33837 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
33838
33839 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
33840 @item maint btrace packet-history
33841 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
33842 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
33843 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
33844 recording format.
33845
33846 @table @code
33847 @item bts
33848 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
33849 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
33850
33851 @table @asis
33852 @item Block number
33853 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
33854 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
33855 @item Highest @samp{PC}
33856 @end table
33857
33858 @item pt
33859 For the Intel(R) Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
33860 Intel(R) Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
33861 information is printed:
33862
33863 @table @asis
33864 @item Packet number
33865 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
33866 @item Trace offset
33867 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
33868 @item Packet opcode and payload
33869 @end table
33870 @end table
33871
33872 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
33873 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
33874 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
33875 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
33876 needed.
33877
33878 @kindex maint btrace clear
33879 @item maint btrace clear
33880 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
33881 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
33882
33883 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
33884 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
33885 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
33886 buffer.
33887
33888 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
33889 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
33890 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
33891 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
33892 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
33893 packet history.
33894
33895 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33896 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33897 @cindex displaced stepping support
33898 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33899 @item set displaced-stepping
33900 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33901 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33902 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33903 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33904 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33905 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33906
33907 @table @code
33908 @item set displaced-stepping on
33909 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33910 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33911
33912 @item set displaced-stepping off
33913 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33914 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33915
33916 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33917 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33918 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33919 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33920 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33921 @end table
33922
33923 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33924 @item maint check-psymtabs
33925 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33926 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33927
33928 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33929 @item maint check-symtabs
33930 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33931
33932 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33933 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33934 Expand symbol tables.
33935 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33936 names matching @var{regexp}.
33937
33938 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33939 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33940 @cindex demangler crashes
33941 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33942 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33943 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33944 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33945 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33946 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33947 option to terminate the current session.
33948
33949 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33950 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33951 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33952
33953 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33954 @item maint cplus namespace
33955 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33956
33957 @kindex maint deprecate
33958 @kindex maint undeprecate
33959 @cindex deprecated commands
33960 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33961 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33962 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33963 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33964 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33965 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33966 the replacement as part of the warning.
33967
33968 @kindex maint dump-me
33969 @item maint dump-me
33970 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33971 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33972 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33973 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33974
33975 @kindex maint internal-error
33976 @kindex maint internal-warning
33977 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33978 @cindex demangler crashes
33979 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33980 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33981 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33982
33983 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33984 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33985 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
33986 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33987 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33988 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33989 @value{GDBN} session.
33990
33991 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33992 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33993
33994 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33995
33996 @smallexample
33997 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33998 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33999 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34000 debugging may prove unreliable.
34001 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34002 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34003 (@value{GDBP})
34004 @end smallexample
34005
34006 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34007 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34008 @cindex demangler crashes
34009
34010 @kindex maint set internal-error
34011 @kindex maint show internal-error
34012 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34013 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34014 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34015 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34016 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34017 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34018 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34019 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34020 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34021 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34022 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34023 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34024 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34025 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34026 described in the table below.
34027
34028 @table @samp
34029 @item quit
34030 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34031 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34032
34033 @item corefile
34034 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34035 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34036 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34037 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34038 disabled.
34039 @end table
34040
34041 @kindex maint packet
34042 @item maint packet @var{text}
34043 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34044 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34045 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34046 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34047 checksum.
34048
34049 @kindex maint print architecture
34050 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34051 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34052 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34053
34054 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34055 @item maint print c-tdesc
34056 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34057 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34058 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34059
34060 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34061 @item maint print dummy-frames
34062 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34063
34064 @smallexample
34065 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34066 @dots{}
34067 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34068 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34069 58 return (a + b);
34070 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34071 @dots{}
34072 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34073 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34074 (@value{GDBP})
34075 @end smallexample
34076
34077 Takes an optional file parameter.
34078
34079 @kindex maint print registers
34080 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34081 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34082 @kindex maint print register-groups
34083 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34084 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34085 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34086 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34087 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34088 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34089 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34090
34091 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34092 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34093 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34094 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34095 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34096 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34097 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34098 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34099
34100 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34101 write the information.
34102
34103 @kindex maint print reggroups
34104 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34105 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34106 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34107 information.
34108
34109 The register groups info looks like this:
34110
34111 @smallexample
34112 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34113 Group Type
34114 general user
34115 float user
34116 all user
34117 vector user
34118 system user
34119 save internal
34120 restore internal
34121 @end smallexample
34122
34123 @kindex flushregs
34124 @item flushregs
34125 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34126
34127 @kindex maint print objfiles
34128 @cindex info for known object files
34129 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34130 Print a dump of all known object files.
34131 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34132 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34133 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34134
34135 @kindex maint print user-registers
34136 @cindex user registers
34137 @item maint print user-registers
34138 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34139 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34140 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34141 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34142 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34143 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34144 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34145
34146 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34147 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34148 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34149 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34150 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34151 matching @var{regexp}.
34152 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34153 and the full path if known.
34154 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34155
34156 @kindex maint print statistics
34157 @cindex bcache statistics
34158 @item maint print statistics
34159 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34160 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34161 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34162 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34163 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34164 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34165 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34166 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34167 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34168 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34169 lengths.
34170
34171 @kindex maint print target-stack
34172 @cindex target stack description
34173 @item maint print target-stack
34174 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34175 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34176 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34177 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34178 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34179 address.
34180
34181 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34182 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34183
34184 @kindex maint print type
34185 @cindex type chain of a data type
34186 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34187 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34188 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34189 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34190 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34191 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34192
34193 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34194 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34195 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34196 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34197 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34198 information.
34199
34200 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34201 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34202 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34203 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34204 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34205 always see the disassembly form.
34206
34207 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34208
34209 @smallexample
34210 (gdb) info addr argc
34211 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34212 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34213 @end smallexample
34214
34215 For more information on these expressions, see
34216 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34217
34218 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34219 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34220 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34221 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34222 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34223
34224 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34225 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34226 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34227 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34228 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34229 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34230 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34231 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34232 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34233
34234 @kindex maint set profile
34235 @kindex maint show profile
34236 @cindex profiling GDB
34237 @item maint set profile
34238 @itemx maint show profile
34239 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34240
34241 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34242 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34243 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34244 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34245 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34246 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34247 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34248
34249 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34250 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34251
34252 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34253 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34254 @cindex hardware debug registers
34255 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34256 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34257 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34258 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34259 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34260 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34261 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34262
34263 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34264 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34265 @item maint set show-all-tib
34266 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34267 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34268 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34269 command.
34270
34271 @kindex maint set target-async
34272 @kindex maint show target-async
34273 @item maint set target-async
34274 @itemx maint show target-async
34275 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34276 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34277 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34278 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34279
34280 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34281 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34282 @item maint set target-non-stop
34283 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34284
34285 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34286 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34287 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34288 if supported by the target.
34289
34290 @table @code
34291 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34292 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34293 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34294
34295 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34296 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34297 does not indicate support.
34298
34299 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34300 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34301 target supports it.
34302 @end table
34303
34304 @kindex maint set per-command
34305 @kindex maint show per-command
34306 @item maint set per-command
34307 @itemx maint show per-command
34308 @cindex resources used by commands
34309
34310 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34311 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34312
34313 @table @code
34314 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34315 @itemx maint show per-command space
34316 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34317 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34318 took, following the command's own output.
34319 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34320 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34321
34322 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34323 @itemx maint show per-command time
34324 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34325 for each command.
34326 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34327 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34328 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34329 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34330 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34331 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34332 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34333 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34334 spent by the program been debugged.
34335 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34336 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34337
34338 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34339 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34340 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34341 for each command.
34342 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34343
34344 @enumerate a
34345 @item
34346 number of symbol tables
34347 @item
34348 number of primary symbol tables
34349 @item
34350 number of blocks in the blockvector
34351 @end enumerate
34352 @end table
34353
34354 @kindex maint space
34355 @cindex memory used by commands
34356 @item maint space @var{value}
34357 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34358 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34359
34360 @kindex maint time
34361 @cindex time of command execution
34362 @item maint time @var{value}
34363 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34364 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34365
34366 @kindex maint translate-address
34367 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34368 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34369 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34370 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34371 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34372 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34373 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34374
34375 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34376 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34377 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34378
34379 @end table
34380
34381 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34382 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34383
34384 @table @code
34385 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34386 @kindex set watchdog
34387 @cindex watchdog timer
34388 @cindex timeout for commands
34389 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34390 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34391 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34392
34393 @item show watchdog
34394 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34395 @end table
34396
34397 @node Remote Protocol
34398 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34399
34400 @menu
34401 * Overview::
34402 * Packets::
34403 * Stop Reply Packets::
34404 * General Query Packets::
34405 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34406 * Tracepoint Packets::
34407 * Host I/O Packets::
34408 * Interrupts::
34409 * Notification Packets::
34410 * Remote Non-Stop::
34411 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34412 * Examples::
34413 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34414 * Library List Format::
34415 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34416 * Memory Map Format::
34417 * Thread List Format::
34418 * Traceframe Info Format::
34419 * Branch Trace Format::
34420 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34421 @end menu
34422
34423 @node Overview
34424 @section Overview
34425
34426 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34427 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34428 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34429 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34430
34431 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34432 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34433
34434 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34435 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34436 @cindex remote serial protocol
34437 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34438 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34439 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34440 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34441 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34442
34443 @smallexample
34444 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34445 @end smallexample
34446 @noindent
34447
34448 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34449 @noindent
34450 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34451 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34452 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34453
34454 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34455 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34456
34457 @smallexample
34458 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34459 @end smallexample
34460
34461 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34462 @noindent
34463 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34464 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34465 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34466
34467 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34468 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34469 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34470 retransmission):
34471
34472 @smallexample
34473 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34474 <- @code{+}
34475 @end smallexample
34476 @noindent
34477
34478 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34479 once a connection is established.
34480 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34481
34482 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34483 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34484 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34485 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34486 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34487 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34488 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34489
34490 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34491 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34492 exceptions).
34493
34494 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34495 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34496 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34497 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34498
34499 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34500 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34501 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34502
34503 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34504 @anchor{Binary Data}
34505 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34506 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34507 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34508 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34509 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34510 binary data.
34511
34512 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34513 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34514 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34515 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34516 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34517 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34518 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34519 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34520 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34521 (described next).
34522
34523 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34524 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34525 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34526 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34527 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34528 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34529 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34530 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34531 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34532 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34533 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34534 3}} more times.
34535
34536 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34537 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34538 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34539 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34540 @samp{0*"00}.
34541
34542 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34543 error number. That number is not well defined.
34544
34545 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34546 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34547 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34548 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34549 on that response.
34550
34551 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34552 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34553 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34554 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34555 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34556 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34557
34558 @node Packets
34559 @section Packets
34560
34561 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34562 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34563 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34564 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34565
34566 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34567 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34568 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34569 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34570 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34571 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34572 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34573 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34574 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34575 @var{baz}.
34576
34577 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34578 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34579 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34580 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34581 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34582 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34583 pick any thread.
34584
34585 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34586 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34587 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34588 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34589 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34590 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34591 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34592 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34593 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34594 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34595 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34596 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34597 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34598
34599 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34600 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34601 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34602 more information.
34603
34604 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34605 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34606
34607 Here are the packet descriptions.
34608
34609 @table @samp
34610
34611 @item !
34612 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34613 @anchor{extended mode}
34614 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34615 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34616 debugged.
34617
34618 Reply:
34619 @table @samp
34620 @item OK
34621 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34622 @end table
34623
34624 @item ?
34625 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34626 @anchor{? packet}
34627 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34628 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34629 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34630
34631 Reply:
34632 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34633
34634 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34635 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34636 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34637 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34638 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34639
34640 Reply:
34641 @table @samp
34642 @item OK
34643 The arguments were set.
34644 @item E @var{NN}
34645 An error occurred.
34646 @end table
34647
34648 @item b @var{baud}
34649 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34650 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34651 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34652
34653 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34654 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34655 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34656
34657 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34658 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34659 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34660 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34661 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34662
34663 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34664 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34665 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34666 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34667
34668 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34669 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34670
34671 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34672 @anchor{bc}
34673 @item bc
34674 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34675 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34676
34677 Reply:
34678 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34679
34680 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34681 @anchor{bs}
34682 @item bs
34683 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34684 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34685
34686 Reply:
34687 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34688
34689 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34690 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34691 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34692 is omitted, resume at current address.
34693
34694 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34695 packet}.
34696
34697 Reply:
34698 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34699
34700 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34701 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34702 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34703 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34704
34705 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34706 packet}.
34707
34708 Reply:
34709 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34710
34711 @item d
34712 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34713 Toggle debug flag.
34714
34715 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34716 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34717
34718 @item D
34719 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34720 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34721 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34722 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34723 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34724
34725 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34726 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34727 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34728 big-endian hex string.
34729
34730 Reply:
34731 @table @samp
34732 @item OK
34733 for success
34734 @item E @var{NN}
34735 for an error
34736 @end table
34737
34738 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34739 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34740 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34741 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34742 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34743
34744 @item g
34745 @anchor{read registers packet}
34746 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34747 Read general registers.
34748
34749 Reply:
34750 @table @samp
34751 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34752 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34753 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34754 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34755 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34756 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34757 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34758
34759 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34760 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34761 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34762 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34763 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34764 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34765 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34766 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34767
34768 @smallexample
34769 -> @code{g}
34770 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34771 @end smallexample
34772
34773 @item E @var{NN}
34774 for an error.
34775 @end table
34776
34777 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34778 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34779 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34780 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34781
34782 Reply:
34783 @table @samp
34784 @item OK
34785 for success
34786 @item E @var{NN}
34787 for an error
34788 @end table
34789
34790 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34791 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34792 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34793 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34794 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34795 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34796 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34797 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34798 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34799
34800 Reply:
34801 @table @samp
34802 @item OK
34803 for success
34804 @item E @var{NN}
34805 for an error
34806 @end table
34807
34808 @c FIXME: JTC:
34809 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34810 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34811 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34812 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34813 @c described. For example:
34814 @c
34815 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34816 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34817 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34818 @c
34819 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34820 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34821 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34822
34823 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34824 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34825 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34826 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34827 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34828 step starting at that address.
34829
34830 @item I
34831 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34832 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34833 step packet}.
34834
34835 @item k
34836 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34837 Kill request.
34838
34839 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34840
34841 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34842 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34843
34844 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34845
34846 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34847 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34848 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34849
34850 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34851 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34852 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34853
34854 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34855 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34856 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34857 (@pxref{? packet}).
34858
34859 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34860 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34861 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
34862 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
34863 any particular boundary.
34864
34865 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34866 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34867 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34868 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34869 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34870 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34871 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34872 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34873
34874 Reply:
34875 @table @samp
34876 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34877 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
34878 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
34879 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34880 @item E @var{NN}
34881 @var{NN} is errno
34882 @end table
34883
34884 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34885 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34886 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
34887 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
34888 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
34889
34890 Reply:
34891 @table @samp
34892 @item OK
34893 for success
34894 @item E @var{NN}
34895 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34896 written).
34897 @end table
34898
34899 @item p @var{n}
34900 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34901 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34902 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34903 register value is encoded.
34904
34905 Reply:
34906 @table @samp
34907 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34908 the register's value
34909 @item E @var{NN}
34910 for an error
34911 @item @w{}
34912 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34913 @end table
34914
34915 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34916 @anchor{write register packet}
34917 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34918 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34919 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34920 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34921
34922 Reply:
34923 @table @samp
34924 @item OK
34925 for success
34926 @item E @var{NN}
34927 for an error
34928 @end table
34929
34930 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34931 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34932 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34933 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34934 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34935 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34936
34937 @item r
34938 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34939 Reset the entire system.
34940
34941 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34942
34943 @item R @var{XX}
34944 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34945 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34946 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34947
34948 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34949
34950 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34951 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34952 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34953 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34954
34955 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34956 packet}.
34957
34958 Reply:
34959 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34960
34961 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34962 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34963 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34964 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34965 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34966
34967 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34968 packet}.
34969
34970 Reply:
34971 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34972
34973 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34974 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34975 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34976 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34977 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34978
34979 @item T @var{thread-id}
34980 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34981 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34982
34983 Reply:
34984 @table @samp
34985 @item OK
34986 thread is still alive
34987 @item E @var{NN}
34988 thread is dead
34989 @end table
34990
34991 @item v
34992 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34993 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34994
34995 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34996 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34997 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34998 The process ID is a
34999 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35000 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35001 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35002
35003 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35004 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35005 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35006 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35007 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35008 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35009 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35010 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35011
35012 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35013
35014 Reply:
35015 @table @samp
35016 @item E @var{nn}
35017 for an error
35018 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35019 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35020 @item OK
35021 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35022 @end table
35023
35024 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35025 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35026 @anchor{vCont packet}
35027 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35028 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35029 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35030 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35031 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35032 Specifying multiple
35033 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35034 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35035
35036 Currently supported actions are:
35037
35038 @table @samp
35039 @item c
35040 Continue.
35041 @item C @var{sig}
35042 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35043 @item s
35044 Step.
35045 @item S @var{sig}
35046 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35047 @item t
35048 Stop.
35049 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35050 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35051 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35052 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35053 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35054 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35055
35056 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35057 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35058 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35059 jumps to @var{start}).
35060
35061 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35062 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35063 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35064
35065 @end table
35066
35067 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35068 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35069 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35070
35071 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35072 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35073 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35074 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35075 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35076 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35077 as an implementation detail.
35078
35079 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35080 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35081 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35082 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35083 @var{thread-id}.
35084
35085 Reply:
35086 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35087
35088 @item vCont?
35089 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35090 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35091
35092 Reply:
35093 @table @samp
35094 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35095 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35096 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35097 @item @w{}
35098 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35099 @end table
35100
35101 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35102 @item vCtrlC
35103 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35104 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35105 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35106 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35107 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35108 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35109 variant.
35110
35111 Reply:
35112 @table @samp
35113 @item E @var{nn}
35114 for an error
35115 @item OK
35116 for success
35117 @end table
35118
35119 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35120 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35121 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35122 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35123
35124 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35125 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35126 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35127 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35128 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35129 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35130 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35131 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35132 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35133 packet is received.
35134
35135 Reply:
35136 @table @samp
35137 @item OK
35138 for success
35139 @item E @var{NN}
35140 for an error
35141 @end table
35142
35143 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35144 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35145 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35146 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35147 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35148 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35149 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35150 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35151 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35152 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35153 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35154 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35155
35156
35157 Reply:
35158 @table @samp
35159 @item OK
35160 for success
35161 @item E.memtype
35162 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35163 @item E @var{NN}
35164 for an error
35165 @end table
35166
35167 @item vFlashDone
35168 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35169 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35170 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35171 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35172 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35173 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35174 request is completed.
35175
35176 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35177 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35178 @anchor{vKill packet}
35179 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35180 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35181 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35182 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35183
35184 Reply:
35185 @table @samp
35186 @item E @var{nn}
35187 for an error
35188 @item OK
35189 for success
35190 @end table
35191
35192 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35193 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35194 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35195 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35196 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35197 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35198 state.
35199
35200 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35201
35202 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35203
35204 Reply:
35205 @table @samp
35206 @item E @var{nn}
35207 for an error
35208 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35209 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35210 @end table
35211
35212 @item vStopped
35213 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35214 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35215
35216 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35217 @anchor{X packet}
35218 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35219 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35220 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35221 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35222 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35223
35224 Reply:
35225 @table @samp
35226 @item OK
35227 for success
35228 @item E @var{NN}
35229 for an error
35230 @end table
35231
35232 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35233 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35234 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35235 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35236 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35237 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35238 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35239
35240 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35241 separately.
35242
35243 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35244 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35245 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35246 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35247 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35248 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35249
35250 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35251 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35252 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35253 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35254 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35255 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35256
35257 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35258 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35259 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35260 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35261 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35262 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35263 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35264 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35265 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35266 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35267
35268 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35269 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35270
35271 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35272 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35273
35274 @table @samp
35275
35276 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35277 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35278 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35279
35280 @end table
35281
35282 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35283 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35284 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35285 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35286 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35287 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35288 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35289
35290 @table @samp
35291
35292 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35293 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35294 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35295
35296 @end table
35297
35298 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35299
35300 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35301 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35302 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35303 target, is not defined.}
35304
35305 Reply:
35306 @table @samp
35307 @item OK
35308 success
35309 @item @w{}
35310 not supported
35311 @item E @var{NN}
35312 for an error
35313 @end table
35314
35315 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35316 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35317 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35318 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35319 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35320 address @var{addr}.
35321
35322 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35323 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35324 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35325
35326 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35327 movement.}
35328
35329 Reply:
35330 @table @samp
35331 @item OK
35332 success
35333 @item @w{}
35334 not supported
35335 @item E @var{NN}
35336 for an error
35337 @end table
35338
35339 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35340 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35341 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35342 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35343 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35344 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35345
35346 Reply:
35347 @table @samp
35348 @item OK
35349 success
35350 @item @w{}
35351 not supported
35352 @item E @var{NN}
35353 for an error
35354 @end table
35355
35356 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35357 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35358 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35359 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35360 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35361 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35362
35363 Reply:
35364 @table @samp
35365 @item OK
35366 success
35367 @item @w{}
35368 not supported
35369 @item E @var{NN}
35370 for an error
35371 @end table
35372
35373 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35374 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35375 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35376 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35377 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35378 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35379
35380 Reply:
35381 @table @samp
35382 @item OK
35383 success
35384 @item @w{}
35385 not supported
35386 @item E @var{NN}
35387 for an error
35388 @end table
35389
35390 @end table
35391
35392 @node Stop Reply Packets
35393 @section Stop Reply Packets
35394 @cindex stop reply packets
35395
35396 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35397 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35398 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35399 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35400 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35401 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35402 @value{GDBN} source code.
35403
35404 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35405 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35406 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35407 components.
35408
35409 @table @samp
35410
35411 @item S @var{AA}
35412 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35413 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35414 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35415
35416 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35417 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35418 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35419 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35420 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35421 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35422 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35423 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35424
35425 @itemize @bullet
35426 @item
35427 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35428 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35429 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35430 two-digit hex number.
35431
35432 @item
35433 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35434 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35435
35436 @item
35437 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35438 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35439
35440 @item
35441 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35442 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35443 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35444 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35445
35446 @item
35447 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35448 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35449 future.
35450 @end itemize
35451
35452 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35453
35454 @table @samp
35455 @item watch
35456 @itemx rwatch
35457 @itemx awatch
35458 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35459 hex.
35460
35461 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35462 @item library
35463 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35464 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35465 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35466
35467 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35468 @item replaylog
35469 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35470 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35471 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35472 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35473 for more information.
35474
35475 @item swbreak
35476 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35477 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35478 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35479 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35480 part must be left empty.
35481
35482 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35483 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35484 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35485 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35486 address.
35487
35488 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35489 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35490 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35491 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35492 indicating support.
35493
35494 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35495
35496 @item hwbreak
35497 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35498 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35499
35500 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35501 apply.
35502
35503 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35504 @item fork
35505 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35506 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35507 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35508 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35509 fork events.
35510
35511 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35512 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35513 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35514 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35515 indicating support.
35516
35517 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35518 @item vfork
35519 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35520 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35521 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35522 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35523 vfork events.
35524
35525 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35526 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35527 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35528 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35529 indicating support.
35530
35531 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35532 @item vforkdone
35533 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35534 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35535 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35536 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35537 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35538
35539 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35540 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35541 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35542 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35543 indicating support.
35544
35545 @cindex exec events, remote reply
35546 @item exec
35547 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
35548 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
35549 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
35550
35551 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35552 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35553 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35554 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35555 indicating support.
35556
35557 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
35558 @anchor{thread create event}
35559 @item create
35560 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
35561 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
35562 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
35563 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
35564 also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.
35565
35566 @end table
35567
35568 @item W @var{AA}
35569 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35570 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35571 applicable to certain targets.
35572
35573 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35574 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35575 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35576 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35577
35578 @item X @var{AA}
35579 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35580 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35581
35582 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35583 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35584 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35585 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35586
35587 @anchor{thread exit event}
35588 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
35589 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
35590
35591 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
35592 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
35593 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
35594
35595 @item N
35596 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
35597 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
35598 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
35599 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
35600 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
35601 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
35602 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
35603 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
35604 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
35605 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
35606 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
35607 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
35608 support.
35609
35610 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35611 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35612 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35613 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35614 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35615
35616 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35617 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35618 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35619 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35620 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35621 system calls.
35622
35623 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35624 this very system call.
35625
35626 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35627 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35628 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35629 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35630 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35631 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35632
35633 @end table
35634
35635 @node General Query Packets
35636 @section General Query Packets
35637 @cindex remote query requests
35638
35639 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35640 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35641 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35642 sending information to and from the stub.
35643
35644 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35645 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35646 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35647 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35648 conventions:
35649
35650 @itemize @bullet
35651 @item
35652 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35653 @item
35654 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35655 letter.
35656 @item
35657 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35658 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35659 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35660 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35661 @end itemize
35662
35663 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35664 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35665 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35666 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35667 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35668 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35669 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35670 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35671 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35672 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35673 packet.}.
35674
35675 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35676 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35677 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35678 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35679 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35680
35681 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35682
35683 @table @samp
35684
35685 @item QAgent:1
35686 @itemx QAgent:0
35687 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35688 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35689
35690 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35691 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35692 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35693 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35694 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35695 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35696 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35697 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35698 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35699 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35700 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35701
35702 @item qC
35703 @cindex current thread, remote request
35704 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35705 Return the current thread ID.
35706
35707 Reply:
35708 @table @samp
35709 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35710 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35711 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35712 @item @r{(anything else)}
35713 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35714 @end table
35715
35716 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35717 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35718 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35719 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35720 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35721 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35722 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35723 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35724
35725 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35726 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35727 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35728 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35729 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35730 detect trailing zeros.
35731
35732 Reply:
35733 @table @samp
35734 @item E @var{NN}
35735 An error (such as memory fault)
35736 @item C @var{crc32}
35737 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35738 @end table
35739
35740 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35741 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35742 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35743 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35744 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35745 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35746 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35747 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35748 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35749 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35750 randomization.
35751
35752 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35753
35754 Reply:
35755 @table @samp
35756 @item OK
35757 The request succeeded.
35758
35759 @item E @var{nn}
35760 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35761
35762 @item @w{}
35763 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
35764 by the stub.
35765 @end table
35766
35767 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35768 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35769 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
35770 address space randomization.
35771
35772 @item qfThreadInfo
35773 @itemx qsThreadInfo
35774 @cindex list active threads, remote request
35775 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
35776 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
35777 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
35778 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
35779 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
35780 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
35781 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
35782 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
35783
35784 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
35785
35786 Reply:
35787 @table @samp
35788 @item m @var{thread-id}
35789 A single thread ID
35790 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
35791 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
35792 @item l
35793 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35794 @end table
35795
35796 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35797 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35798 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35799 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35800 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35801 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35802 fields.
35803
35804 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35805 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35806 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35807 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35808 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35809
35810 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35811 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35812 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35813 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35814 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35815
35816 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35817 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35818
35819 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35820 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35821 information associated with the variable.)
35822
35823 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35824 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35825 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35826 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35827 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35828 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35829
35830 Reply:
35831 @table @samp
35832 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35833 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35834 local storage requested.
35835
35836 @item E @var{nn}
35837 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35838
35839 @item @w{}
35840 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35841 @end table
35842
35843 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35844 @cindex get thread information block address
35845 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35846 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35847
35848 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35849
35850 Reply:
35851 @table @samp
35852 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35853 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35854 thread information block.
35855
35856 @item E @var{nn}
35857 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35858 address could not be retrieved.
35859
35860 @item @w{}
35861 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35862 @end table
35863
35864 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35865 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35866 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35867 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35868 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35869 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35870 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35871
35872 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35873
35874 Reply:
35875 @table @samp
35876 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35877 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35878 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35879 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35880 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35881 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35882 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35883 @end table
35884
35885 @item qOffsets
35886 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35887 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35888 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35889 image.
35890
35891 Reply:
35892 @table @samp
35893 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35894 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35895 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35896 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35897 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35898 segments by the supplied offsets.
35899
35900 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35901 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35902 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35903
35904 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35905 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35906 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35907 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35908 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35909 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35910 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35911 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35912 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35913 @end table
35914
35915 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35916 @cindex thread information, remote request
35917 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35918 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35919 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35920 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35921
35922 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35923 (see below).
35924
35925 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35926
35927 @item QNonStop:1
35928 @itemx QNonStop:0
35929 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35930 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35931 @anchor{QNonStop}
35932 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35933 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35934
35935 Reply:
35936 @table @samp
35937 @item OK
35938 The request succeeded.
35939
35940 @item E @var{nn}
35941 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35942
35943 @item @w{}
35944 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35945 the stub.
35946 @end table
35947
35948 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35949 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35950 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35951 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35952
35953 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35954 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35955 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35956 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35957 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35958 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35959 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35960 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35961 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35962 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35963 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35964 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35965 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35966
35967 Reply:
35968 @table @samp
35969 @item OK
35970 The request succeeded.
35971
35972 @item E @var{nn}
35973 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35974
35975 @item @w{}
35976 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35977 the stub.
35978 @end table
35979
35980 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35981 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35982 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35983 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35984
35985 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35986 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35987 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35988 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35989 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35990 Others should be silently discarded.
35991
35992 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35993 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35994 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35995 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35996 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35997 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35998 signals.
35999
36000 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36001 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36002
36003 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36004 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36005 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36006 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36007 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36008
36009 Reply:
36010 @table @samp
36011 @item OK
36012 The request succeeded.
36013
36014 @item E @var{nn}
36015 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36016
36017 @item @w{}
36018 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36019 by the stub.
36020 @end table
36021
36022 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36023 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36024 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36025 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36026
36027 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36028 @item QThreadEvents:1
36029 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36030 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36031 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36032
36033 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36034 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36035 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36036 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36037 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36038 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36039 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36040 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36041 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36042 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36043
36044 Reply:
36045 @table @samp
36046 @item OK
36047 The request succeeded.
36048
36049 @item E @var{nn}
36050 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36051
36052 @item @w{}
36053 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36054 the stub.
36055 @end table
36056
36057 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36058 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36059
36060 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36061 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36062 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36063 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36064 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36065 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36066 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36067 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36068 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36069
36070 Reply:
36071 @table @samp
36072 @item OK
36073 A command response with no output.
36074 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36075 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36076 @item E @var{NN}
36077 Indicate a badly formed request.
36078 @item @w{}
36079 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36080 @end table
36081
36082 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36083 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36084 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36085 packets.)
36086
36087 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36088 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36089 @ifnotinfo
36090 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36091 @end ifnotinfo
36092 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36093 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36094 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36095 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36096 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36097
36098 Reply:
36099 @table @samp
36100 @item 0
36101 The pattern was not found.
36102 @item 1,address
36103 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36104 @item E @var{NN}
36105 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36106 @item @w{}
36107 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36108 @end table
36109
36110 @item QStartNoAckMode
36111 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36112 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36113 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36114 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36115
36116 Reply:
36117 @table @samp
36118 @item OK
36119 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36120 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36121 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36122 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36123 @item @w{}
36124 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36125 @end table
36126
36127 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36128 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36129 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36130 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36131 @anchor{qSupported}
36132 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36133 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36134 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36135 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36136 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36137 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36138 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36139 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36140 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36141 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36142 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36143 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36144 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36145 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36146
36147 Reply:
36148 @table @samp
36149 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36150 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36151 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36152 possible forms).
36153 @item @w{}
36154 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36155 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36156 @end table
36157
36158 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36159 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36160 are:
36161
36162 @table @samp
36163 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36164 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36165 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36166 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36167 @item @var{name}+
36168 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36169 need an associated value.
36170 @item @var{name}-
36171 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36172 @item @var{name}?
36173 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36174 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36175 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36176 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36177 @end table
36178
36179 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36180 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36181 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36182 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36183 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36184
36185 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36186 are defined:
36187
36188 @table @samp
36189 @item multiprocess
36190 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36191 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36192 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36193 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36194 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36195
36196 @item xmlRegisters
36197 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36198 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36199 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36200 description.
36201
36202 @item qRelocInsn
36203 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36204 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36205 instruction reply packet}).
36206
36207 @item swbreak
36208 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36209 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36210
36211 @item hwbreak
36212 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36213 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36214
36215 @item fork-events
36216 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36217 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36218 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36219 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36220
36221 @item vfork-events
36222 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36223 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36224 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36225 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36226
36227 @item exec-events
36228 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36229 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36230 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36231 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36232
36233 @item vContSupported
36234 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36235 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36236 @end table
36237
36238 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36239 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36240 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36241 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36242 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36243 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36244 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36245 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36246 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36247 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36248 all the features it supports.
36249
36250 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36251 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36252
36253 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36254 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36255 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36256 form response.
36257
36258 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36259 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36260 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36261 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36262
36263 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36264 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36265 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36266 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36267 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36268
36269 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36270
36271 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36272 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36273 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36274 @item Feature Name
36275 @tab Value Required
36276 @tab Default
36277 @tab Probe Allowed
36278
36279 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36280 @tab Yes
36281 @tab @samp{-}
36282 @tab No
36283
36284 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36285 @tab No
36286 @tab @samp{-}
36287 @tab Yes
36288
36289 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36290 @tab No
36291 @tab @samp{-}
36292 @tab Yes
36293
36294 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36295 @tab No
36296 @tab @samp{-}
36297 @tab Yes
36298
36299 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36300 @tab No
36301 @tab @samp{-}
36302 @tab Yes
36303
36304 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36305 @tab No
36306 @tab @samp{-}
36307 @tab Yes
36308
36309 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36310 @tab No
36311 @tab @samp{-}
36312 @tab Yes
36313
36314 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36315 @tab No
36316 @tab @samp{-}
36317 @tab Yes
36318
36319 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36320 @tab No
36321 @tab @samp{-}
36322 @tab No
36323
36324 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36325 @tab No
36326 @tab @samp{-}
36327 @tab Yes
36328
36329 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36330 @tab No
36331 @tab @samp{-}
36332 @tab Yes
36333
36334 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36335 @tab No
36336 @tab @samp{-}
36337 @tab Yes
36338
36339 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36340 @tab No
36341 @tab @samp{-}
36342 @tab Yes
36343
36344 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36345 @tab No
36346 @tab @samp{-}
36347 @tab Yes
36348
36349 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36350 @tab No
36351 @tab @samp{-}
36352 @tab Yes
36353
36354 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36355 @tab No
36356 @tab @samp{-}
36357 @tab Yes
36358
36359 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36360 @tab No
36361 @tab @samp{-}
36362 @tab Yes
36363
36364 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36365 @tab No
36366 @tab @samp{-}
36367 @tab Yes
36368
36369 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36370 @tab No
36371 @tab @samp{-}
36372 @tab Yes
36373
36374 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36375 @tab Yes
36376 @tab @samp{-}
36377 @tab Yes
36378
36379 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36380 @tab Yes
36381 @tab @samp{-}
36382 @tab Yes
36383
36384 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36385 @tab Yes
36386 @tab @samp{-}
36387 @tab Yes
36388
36389 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36390 @tab Yes
36391 @tab @samp{-}
36392 @tab Yes
36393
36394 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36395 @tab Yes
36396 @tab @samp{-}
36397 @tab Yes
36398
36399 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36400 @tab No
36401 @tab @samp{-}
36402 @tab Yes
36403
36404 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36405 @tab No
36406 @tab @samp{-}
36407 @tab Yes
36408
36409 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36410 @tab No
36411 @tab @samp{-}
36412 @tab Yes
36413
36414 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36415 @tab No
36416 @tab @samp{-}
36417 @tab No
36418
36419 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36420 @tab No
36421 @tab @samp{-}
36422 @tab No
36423
36424 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36425 @tab No
36426 @tab @samp{-}
36427 @tab No
36428
36429 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36430 @tab No
36431 @tab @samp{-}
36432 @tab No
36433
36434 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36435 @tab No
36436 @tab @samp{-}
36437 @tab No
36438
36439 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36440 @tab No
36441 @tab @samp{-}
36442 @tab No
36443
36444 @item @samp{QAgent}
36445 @tab No
36446 @tab @samp{-}
36447 @tab No
36448
36449 @item @samp{QAllow}
36450 @tab No
36451 @tab @samp{-}
36452 @tab No
36453
36454 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36455 @tab No
36456 @tab @samp{-}
36457 @tab No
36458
36459 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36460 @tab No
36461 @tab @samp{-}
36462 @tab No
36463
36464 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36465 @tab No
36466 @tab @samp{-}
36467 @tab No
36468
36469 @item @samp{tracenz}
36470 @tab No
36471 @tab @samp{-}
36472 @tab No
36473
36474 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36475 @tab No
36476 @tab @samp{-}
36477 @tab No
36478
36479 @item @samp{swbreak}
36480 @tab No
36481 @tab @samp{-}
36482 @tab No
36483
36484 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36485 @tab No
36486 @tab @samp{-}
36487 @tab No
36488
36489 @item @samp{fork-events}
36490 @tab No
36491 @tab @samp{-}
36492 @tab No
36493
36494 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36495 @tab No
36496 @tab @samp{-}
36497 @tab No
36498
36499 @item @samp{exec-events}
36500 @tab No
36501 @tab @samp{-}
36502 @tab No
36503
36504 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
36505 @tab No
36506 @tab @samp{-}
36507 @tab No
36508
36509 @item @samp{no-resumed}
36510 @tab No
36511 @tab @samp{-}
36512 @tab No
36513
36514 @end multitable
36515
36516 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36517
36518 @table @samp
36519 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36520 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36521 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36522 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36523 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36524 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36525 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36526 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36527 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36528 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36529
36530 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36531 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36532 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36533
36534 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36535 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36536 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36537
36538 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36539 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36540 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36541
36542 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36543 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36544 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36545
36546 @item qXfer:features:read
36547 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36548 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36549
36550 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36551 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36552 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36553
36554 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36555 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36556 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36557
36558 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36559 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36560 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36561 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36562
36563 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36564 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36565 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36566
36567 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36568 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36569 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36570
36571 @item qXfer:spu:read
36572 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36573 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36574
36575 @item qXfer:spu:write
36576 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36577 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36578
36579 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36580 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36581 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36582
36583 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36584 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36585 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36586
36587 @item qXfer:threads:read
36588 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36589 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36590
36591 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36592 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36593 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36594
36595 @item qXfer:uib:read
36596 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36597 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36598
36599 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36600 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36601 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36602
36603 @item QNonStop
36604 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36605 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36606
36607 @item QPassSignals
36608 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36609 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36610
36611 @item QStartNoAckMode
36612 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36613 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36614
36615 @item multiprocess
36616 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36617 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36618 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36619 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36620 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36621 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36622 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36623 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36624 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36625 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36626 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36627
36628 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36629 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36630 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36631
36632 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36633 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36634 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36635 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36636
36637 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36638 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36639 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36640
36641 @item ReverseContinue
36642 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36643 (@pxref{bc}).
36644
36645 @item ReverseStep
36646 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36647 (@pxref{bs}).
36648
36649 @item TracepointSource
36650 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36651 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36652
36653 @item QAgent
36654 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36655
36656 @item QAllow
36657 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36658
36659 @item QDisableRandomization
36660 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36661
36662 @item StaticTracepoint
36663 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36664 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36665
36666 @item InstallInTrace
36667 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36668 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36669
36670 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36671 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36672 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36673 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36674
36675 @item QTBuffer:size
36676 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36677 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36678
36679 @item tracenz
36680 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36681 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36682 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36683
36684 @item BreakpointCommands
36685 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36686 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36687 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36688
36689 @item Qbtrace:off
36690 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36691
36692 @item Qbtrace:bts
36693 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36694
36695 @item Qbtrace:pt
36696 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
36697
36698 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36699 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36700
36701 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
36702 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
36703
36704 @item swbreak
36705 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
36706 breakpoints.
36707
36708 @item hwbreak
36709 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
36710 breakpoints.
36711
36712 @item fork-events
36713 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
36714
36715 @item vfork-events
36716 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
36717 and vforkdone events.
36718
36719 @item exec-events
36720 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
36721
36722 @item vContSupported
36723 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
36724 @samp{vCont?} packet.
36725
36726 @item QThreadEvents
36727 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
36728
36729 @item no-resumed
36730 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
36731
36732 @end table
36733
36734 @item qSymbol::
36735 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36736 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36737 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36738 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36739
36740 Reply:
36741 @table @samp
36742 @item OK
36743 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36744 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36745 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36746 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36747 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36748 below.
36749 @end table
36750
36751 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36752 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36753
36754 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36755 target has previously requested.
36756
36757 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36758 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36759 will be empty.
36760
36761 Reply:
36762 @table @samp
36763 @item OK
36764 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36765 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36766 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36767 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36768 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36769 @end table
36770
36771 @item qTBuffer
36772 @itemx QTBuffer
36773 @itemx QTDisconnected
36774 @itemx QTDP
36775 @itemx QTDPsrc
36776 @itemx QTDV
36777 @itemx qTfP
36778 @itemx qTfV
36779 @itemx QTFrame
36780 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
36781
36782 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36783
36784 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
36785 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
36786 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
36787 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
36788 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
36789 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
36790 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
36791 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
36792 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
36793 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
36794 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
36795
36796 Reply:
36797 @table @samp
36798 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36799 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
36800 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
36801 the thread's attributes.
36802 @end table
36803
36804 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
36805 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36806 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36807 packets.)
36808
36809 @item QTNotes
36810 @itemx qTP
36811 @itemx QTSave
36812 @itemx qTsP
36813 @itemx qTsV
36814 @itemx QTStart
36815 @itemx QTStop
36816 @itemx QTEnable
36817 @itemx QTDisable
36818 @itemx QTinit
36819 @itemx QTro
36820 @itemx qTStatus
36821 @itemx qTV
36822 @itemx qTfSTM
36823 @itemx qTsSTM
36824 @itemx qTSTMat
36825 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36826
36827 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36828 @cindex read special object, remote request
36829 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
36830 @anchor{qXfer read}
36831 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
36832 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
36833 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
36834 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
36835 additional details about what data to access.
36836
36837 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36838 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36839 formats, listed below.
36840
36841 @table @samp
36842 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36843 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
36844 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
36845 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
36846
36847 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36848 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36849
36850 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36851 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
36852
36853 Return a description of the current branch trace.
36854 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
36855 packet may have one of the following values:
36856
36857 @table @code
36858 @item all
36859 Returns all available branch trace.
36860
36861 @item new
36862 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
36863 the last read request.
36864
36865 @item delta
36866 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
36867 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
36868 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
36869 used to stitch traces together.
36870
36871 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
36872 @end table
36873
36874 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36875 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36876
36877 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36878 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
36879
36880 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
36881 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
36882
36883 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36884 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36885
36886 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36887 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
36888 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
36889 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
36890 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
36891 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
36892 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
36893
36894 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36895 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36896
36897 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36898 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
36899 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
36900 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
36901 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
36902
36903 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36904 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36905
36906 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36907 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
36908 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
36909 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36910 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36911
36912 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
36913 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
36914 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
36915
36916 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36917 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36918
36919 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36920 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
36921 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
36922 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
36923 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
36924 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
36925 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36926 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
36927
36928 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
36929 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
36930
36931 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36932 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36933
36934 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
36935 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
36936 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
36937 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
36938
36939 @table @code
36940 @item start=@var{address}
36941 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36942 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
36943 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
36944 chosen as the starting point.
36945
36946 @item prev=@var{address}
36947 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36948 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
36949 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
36950 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
36951 exists prior to the starting point.
36952
36953 @end table
36954
36955 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
36956 ignored.
36957
36958 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36959 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
36960 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
36961 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36962 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36963
36964 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36965 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36966
36967 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36968 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
36969
36970 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
36971 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
36972 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
36973 Action Lists}.
36974
36975 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36976 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36977 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36978
36979 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36980 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
36981 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
36982 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36983 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36984
36985 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36986 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36987 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36988
36989 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36990 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
36991 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36992 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
36993 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36994 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36995 in that context to be accessed.
36996
36997 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36998 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36999 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37000
37001 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37002 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37003 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37004 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37005 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37006
37007 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37008 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37009
37010 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37011 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37012
37013 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37014 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37015 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37016
37017 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37018 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37019
37020 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37021 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37022
37023 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37024 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37025
37026 This packet is not probed by default.
37027
37028 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37029 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37030 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37031 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37032 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37033
37034 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37035 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37036
37037 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37038 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37039 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37040 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37041
37042 @end table
37043
37044 Reply:
37045 @table @samp
37046 @item m @var{data}
37047 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37048 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37049 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37050 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37051 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37052 request.
37053
37054 @item l @var{data}
37055 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37056 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37057 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37058
37059 @item l
37060 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37061 There is no more data to be read.
37062
37063 @item E00
37064 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37065
37066 @item E @var{nn}
37067 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37068 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37069
37070 @item @w{}
37071 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37072 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37073 @end table
37074
37075 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37076 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37077 @anchor{qXfer write}
37078 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37079 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37080 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37081 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37082 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37083 to access.
37084
37085 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37086 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37087 formats, listed below.
37088
37089 @table @samp
37090 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37091 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37092 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37093 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37094 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37095
37096 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37097 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37098 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37099
37100 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37101 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37102 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37103 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37104 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37105 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37106 in that context to be accessed.
37107
37108 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37109 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37110 @end table
37111
37112 Reply:
37113 @table @samp
37114 @item @var{nn}
37115 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37116 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37117
37118 @item E00
37119 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37120
37121 @item E @var{nn}
37122 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37123 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37124
37125 @item @w{}
37126 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37127 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37128 @end table
37129
37130 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37131 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37132 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37133 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37134 must respond with an empty packet.
37135
37136 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37137 @cindex query attached, remote request
37138 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37139 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37140 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37141 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37142 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37143 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37144 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37145
37146 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37147 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37148 the @code{quit} command.
37149
37150 Reply:
37151 @table @samp
37152 @item 1
37153 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37154 @item 0
37155 The remote server created a new process.
37156 @item E @var{NN}
37157 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37158 @end table
37159
37160 @item Qbtrace:bts
37161 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37162
37163 Reply:
37164 @table @samp
37165 @item OK
37166 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37167 @item E.errtext
37168 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37169 @end table
37170
37171 @item Qbtrace:pt
37172 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel(R) Processor Trace.
37173
37174 Reply:
37175 @table @samp
37176 @item OK
37177 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37178 @item E.errtext
37179 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37180 @end table
37181
37182 @item Qbtrace:off
37183 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37184
37185 Reply:
37186 @table @samp
37187 @item OK
37188 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37189 @item E.errtext
37190 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37191 @end table
37192
37193 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37194 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37195 btrace recording method in bts format.
37196
37197 Reply:
37198 @table @samp
37199 @item OK
37200 The ring buffer size has been set.
37201 @item E.errtext
37202 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37203 @end table
37204
37205 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37206 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37207 btrace recording method in pt format.
37208
37209 Reply:
37210 @table @samp
37211 @item OK
37212 The ring buffer size has been set.
37213 @item E.errtext
37214 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37215 @end table
37216
37217 @end table
37218
37219 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37220 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37221
37222 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37223 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37224 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37225
37226 @menu
37227 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37228 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37229 @end menu
37230
37231 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37232 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37233
37234 @menu
37235 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37236 @end menu
37237
37238 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37239 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37240 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37241
37242 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37243
37244 @table @r
37245
37246 @item 2
37247 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37248
37249 @item 3
37250 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37251
37252 @item 4
37253 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37254
37255 @end table
37256
37257 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37258 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37259
37260 @menu
37261 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37262 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37263 @end menu
37264
37265 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37266 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37267 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37268
37269 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37270 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37271 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37272 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37273 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37274 most-significant -- least-significant.
37275
37276 @table @r
37277
37278 @item MIPS32
37279 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37280 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37281 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37282
37283 @item MIPS64
37284 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37285 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37286 as @code{MIPS32}.
37287
37288 @end table
37289
37290 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37291 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37292 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37293
37294 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37295
37296 @table @r
37297
37298 @item 2
37299 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37300
37301 @item 3
37302 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37303
37304 @item 4
37305 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37306
37307 @item 5
37308 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37309
37310 @end table
37311
37312 @node Tracepoint Packets
37313 @section Tracepoint Packets
37314 @cindex tracepoint packets
37315 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37316
37317 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37318 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37319
37320 @table @samp
37321
37322 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37323 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37324 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37325 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37326 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37327 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37328 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37329 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37330 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37331 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37332 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37333 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37334 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37335 actions.
37336
37337 Replies:
37338 @table @samp
37339 @item OK
37340 The packet was understood and carried out.
37341 @item qRelocInsn
37342 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37343 @item @w{}
37344 The packet was not recognized.
37345 @end table
37346
37347 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37348 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37349 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37350 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37351 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37352 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37353 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37354
37355 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37356 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37357 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37358 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37359 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37360 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37361 tracepoint actions.
37362
37363 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37364 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37365 following forms:
37366
37367 @table @samp
37368
37369 @item R @var{mask}
37370 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37371 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37372 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37373 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37374 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37375
37376 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37377 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37378 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37379 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37380 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37381 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37382 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37383
37384 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37385 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37386 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37387 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37388 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37389 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37390 packet).
37391
37392 @end table
37393
37394 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37395 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37396 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37397 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37398 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37399 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37400 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37401 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37402
37403 Replies:
37404 @table @samp
37405 @item OK
37406 The packet was understood and carried out.
37407 @item qRelocInsn
37408 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37409 @item @w{}
37410 The packet was not recognized.
37411 @end table
37412
37413 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37414 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37415 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37416 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37417 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37418 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37419 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37420 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37421
37422 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37423 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37424 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37425 fit in a single packet.
37426 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37427 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37428
37429 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37430 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37431 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37432 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37433
37434 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37435 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37436 query packets.
37437
37438 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37439 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37440 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37441 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37442 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37443 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37444 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37445 be found.
37446
37447 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37448 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37449 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37450 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37451 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37452 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37453 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37454 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37455 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37456 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37457 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37458 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37459 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37460 variable.
37461
37462 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37463 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37464 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37465 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37466 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37467
37468 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37469 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37470 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37471 one of the following forms:
37472
37473 @table @samp
37474 @item F @var{f}
37475 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37476 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37477 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37478
37479 @item T @var{t}
37480 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37481 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37482
37483 @end table
37484
37485 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37486 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37487 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37488 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37489
37490 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37491 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37492 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37493 is a hexadecimal number.
37494
37495 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37496 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37497 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37498 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37499 numbers.
37500
37501 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37502 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37503 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37504
37505 @item qTMinFTPILen
37506 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37507 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37508 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37509 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37510 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37511 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37512 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37513 arrange for that.
37514
37515 Replies:
37516
37517 @table @samp
37518 @item 0
37519 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37520 @item @var{length}
37521 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37522 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37523 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37524 regardless of size.
37525 @item E
37526 An error has occurred.
37527 @item @w{}
37528 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37529 @end table
37530
37531 @item QTStart
37532 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37533 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37534 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37535 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37536 instruction reply packet}).
37537
37538 @item QTStop
37539 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37540 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37541
37542 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37543 @anchor{QTEnable}
37544 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37545 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37546 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37547 of data from it will resume.
37548
37549 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37550 @anchor{QTDisable}
37551 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37552 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37553 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37554 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37555
37556 @item QTinit
37557 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37558 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37559
37560 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37561 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37562 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37563 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37564 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37565
37566 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37567 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37568 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37569 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37570
37571 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37572 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37573 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37574 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37575 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37576 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37577
37578 @item qTStatus
37579 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37580 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37581
37582 The reply has the form:
37583
37584 @table @samp
37585
37586 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37587 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37588 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37589 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37590
37591 @end table
37592
37593 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37594 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37595
37596 @table @samp
37597
37598 @item tnotrun:0
37599 No trace has been run yet.
37600
37601 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37602 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37603 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37604 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37605 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37606
37607 @item tfull:0
37608 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37609
37610 @item tdisconnected:0
37611 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37612
37613 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37614 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37615
37616 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37617 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37618 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37619 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37620 is hex encoded.
37621
37622 @item tunknown:0
37623 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37624
37625 @end table
37626
37627 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37628 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37629 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37630 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37631 trace.
37632
37633 @table @samp
37634
37635 @item tframes:@var{n}
37636 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37637
37638 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37639 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37640 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37641
37642 @item tsize:@var{n}
37643 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37644
37645 @item tfree:@var{n}
37646 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37647
37648 @item circular:@var{n}
37649 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37650 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37651 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37652 and may fill up.
37653
37654 @item disconn:@var{n}
37655 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37656 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37657 that the trace run will stop.
37658
37659 @end table
37660
37661 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37662 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37663 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37664 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37665 address @var{addr}.
37666
37667 Replies:
37668 @table @samp
37669 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37670 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37671 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37672 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37673 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37674
37675 @end table
37676
37677 @item qTV:@var{var}
37678 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37679 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37680 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37681
37682 Replies:
37683 @table @samp
37684 @item V@var{value}
37685 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37686 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37687 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37688 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37689 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37690 program is running.
37691
37692 @item U
37693 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37694 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37695 was not collected.
37696 @end table
37697
37698 @item qTfP
37699 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37700 @itemx qTsP
37701 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37702 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37703 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37704 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37705 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37706 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37707
37708 @item qTfV
37709 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37710 @itemx qTsV
37711 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37712 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37713 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37714 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37715 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37716 trace state variables.
37717
37718 @item qTfSTM
37719 @itemx qTsSTM
37720 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37721 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37722 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37723 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37724 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37725 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37726 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37727 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37728
37729 Reply:
37730 @table @samp
37731 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37732 A single marker
37733 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37734 a comma-separated list of markers
37735 @item l
37736 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37737 @item E @var{nn}
37738 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37739 @item @w{}
37740 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37741 stub.
37742 @end table
37743
37744 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37745 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37746
37747 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37748 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37749 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37750 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37751 @dfn{last}).
37752
37753 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37754 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37755 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37756 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37757 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37758 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37759 tracepoint markers.
37760
37761 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37762 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37763 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37764 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37765 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37766 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37767
37768 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37769 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37770 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37771 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37772 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37773 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37774 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37775 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37776 available.
37777
37778 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37779 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37780 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37781
37782 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
37783 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
37784 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
37785 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
37786 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
37787 use whatever size it prefers.
37788
37789 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37790 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37791 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37792 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37793 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37794
37795 @end table
37796
37797 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37798 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37799 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37800 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37801 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37802 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37803 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37804 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37805 it had executed in the original location.
37806
37807 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37808 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37809 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37810 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37811 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37812 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37813 format of the request is:
37814
37815 @table @samp
37816 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
37817
37818 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
37819 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
37820 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
37821 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
37822 memory starting at @var{to}.
37823 @end table
37824
37825 Replies:
37826 @table @samp
37827 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
37828 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
37829 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
37830 @item E @var{NN}
37831 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
37832 relocating the instruction.
37833 @end table
37834
37835 @node Host I/O Packets
37836 @section Host I/O Packets
37837 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
37838 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
37839
37840 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
37841 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
37842 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
37843 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
37844 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
37845 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
37846 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
37847 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
37848 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
37849 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
37850
37851 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
37852 its arguments. They have this format:
37853
37854 @table @samp
37855
37856 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
37857 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
37858 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
37859 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
37860 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
37861 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
37862 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
37863 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
37864 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37865
37866 @end table
37867
37868 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
37869
37870 @table @samp
37871
37872 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
37873 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
37874 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
37875 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
37876 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
37877 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
37878 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
37879 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
37880 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
37881 @var{attachment}.
37882
37883 @item @w{}
37884 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
37885
37886 @end table
37887
37888 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
37889
37890 @table @samp
37891 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
37892 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
37893 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
37894 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
37895 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
37896 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
37897 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
37898
37899 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
37900 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
37901 -1 if an error occurs.
37902
37903 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
37904 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
37905 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
37906 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
37907 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
37908 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
37909 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
37910 @var{count} was zero.
37911
37912 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37913 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37914 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37915 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37916 some characters were escaped.
37917
37918 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
37919 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
37920 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
37921 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
37922 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
37923 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
37924 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
37925 error occurred.
37926
37927 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
37928 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
37929 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
37930 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
37931 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
37932 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
37933
37934 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
37935 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
37936 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
37937
37938 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
37939 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
37940 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
37941
37942 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37943 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37944 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37945 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37946 some characters were escaped.
37947
37948 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
37949 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
37950 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
37951 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
37952 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
37953 inferior(s).
37954
37955 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
37956 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
37957 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
37958 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
37959 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
37960 operation.
37961
37962 @end table
37963
37964 @node Interrupts
37965 @section Interrupts
37966 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
37967 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
37968
37969 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
37970 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
37971 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
37972 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
37973
37974 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
37975 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
37976 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
37977 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
37978 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
37979
37980 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
37981 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
37982 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
37983 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
37984 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
37985 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
37986 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
37987 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
37988
37989 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
37990 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
37991 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
37992
37993 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
37994 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
37995 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
37996 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
37997 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
37998 @code{0x03}.
37999
38000 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38001 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38002 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38003 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38004 currently-executing threads and processes.
38005 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38006 running program, it should send one of the stop
38007 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38008 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38009 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38010 Interrupts received while the
38011 program is stopped are discarded.
38012
38013 @node Notification Packets
38014 @section Notification Packets
38015 @cindex notification packets
38016 @cindex packets, notification
38017
38018 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38019 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38020 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38021 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38022 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38023 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38024 is not a problem.
38025
38026 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38027 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38028 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38029 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38030 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38031 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38032 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38033
38034 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38035 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38036
38037 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38038 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38039 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38040 not they understand it.
38041
38042 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38043 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38044 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38045 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38046 recipients.
38047
38048 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38049 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38050 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38051 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38052 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38053
38054 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38055 @table @samp
38056 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38057 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38058 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38059 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38060 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38061 @item @var{ack}
38062 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38063 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38064 @end table
38065
38066 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38067 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38068
38069 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38070 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38071 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38072 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38073 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38074 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38075 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38076 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38077 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38078 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38079
38080 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38081 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38082 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38083 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38084 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38085 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38086
38087 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38088 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38089 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38090 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38091 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38092
38093 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38094 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38095 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38096 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38097 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38098 normally.
38099
38100 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38101 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38102 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38103 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38104 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38105 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38106 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38107 the process shall be repeated.
38108
38109 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38110 following example:
38111 @smallexample
38112 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38113 @code{...}
38114 -> @code{vStopped}
38115 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38116 -> @code{vStopped}
38117 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38118 -> @code{vStopped}
38119 <- @code{OK}
38120 @end smallexample
38121
38122 The following notifications are defined:
38123 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38124
38125 @item Notification
38126 @tab Ack
38127 @tab Event
38128 @tab Description
38129
38130 @item Stop
38131 @tab vStopped
38132 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38133 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38134 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38135 @value{GDBN}.
38136 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38137
38138 @end multitable
38139
38140 @node Remote Non-Stop
38141 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38142
38143 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38144 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38145 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38146 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38147
38148 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38149 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38150 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38151 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38152 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38153 probe the target state after a mode change.
38154
38155 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38156 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38157 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38158 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38159 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38160 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38161 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38162 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38163 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38164 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38165 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38166
38167 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38168 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38169 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38170 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38171 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38172 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38173 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38174 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38175 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38176 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38177 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38178 @samp{OK}.
38179
38180 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38181 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38182 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38183 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38184 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38185 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38186 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38187 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38188 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38189 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38190 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38191 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38192 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38193
38194 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38195 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38196
38197 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38198 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38199 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38200 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38201 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38202 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38203 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38204
38205 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38206 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38207 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38208 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38209 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38210
38211 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38212 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38213 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38214 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38215
38216 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38217 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38218 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38219 @pxref{qSupported}.
38220 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38221 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38222 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38223 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38224 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38225 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38226 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38227
38228 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38229 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38230 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38231 connection.
38232 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38233 new connection is established,
38234 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38235 for the current connection, once disabled.
38236
38237 @node Examples
38238 @section Examples
38239
38240 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38241 does not get any direct output:
38242
38243 @smallexample
38244 -> @code{R00}
38245 <- @code{+}
38246 @emph{target restarts}
38247 -> @code{?}
38248 <- @code{+}
38249 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38250 -> @code{+}
38251 @end smallexample
38252
38253 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38254
38255 @smallexample
38256 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38257 <- @code{+}
38258 -> @code{s}
38259 <- @code{+}
38260 @emph{time passes}
38261 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38262 -> @code{+}
38263 -> @code{g}
38264 <- @code{+}
38265 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38266 -> @code{+}
38267 @end smallexample
38268
38269 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38270 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38271 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38272
38273 @menu
38274 * File-I/O Overview::
38275 * Protocol Basics::
38276 * The F Request Packet::
38277 * The F Reply Packet::
38278 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38279 * Console I/O::
38280 * List of Supported Calls::
38281 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38282 * Constants::
38283 * File-I/O Examples::
38284 @end menu
38285
38286 @node File-I/O Overview
38287 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38288 @cindex file-i/o overview
38289
38290 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38291 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38292 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38293 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38294 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38295 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38296
38297 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38298 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38299 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38300 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38301 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38302
38303 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38304 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38305 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38306 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38307 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38308 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38309 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38310
38311 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38312 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38313 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38314 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38315 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38316
38317 @smallexample
38318 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38319 <- target requests 'system call X'
38320 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38321 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38322 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38323 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38324 @end smallexample
38325
38326 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38327 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38328 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38329 system are not supported by this protocol.
38330
38331 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38332
38333 @node Protocol Basics
38334 @subsection Protocol Basics
38335 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38336
38337 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38338 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38339 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38340 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38341 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38342 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38343 to call the appropriate host system call:
38344
38345 @itemize @bullet
38346 @item
38347 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38348
38349 @item
38350 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38351 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38352 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38353 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38354
38355 @end itemize
38356
38357 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38358
38359 @itemize @bullet
38360 @item
38361 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38362 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38363 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38364 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38365 packet.
38366
38367 @item
38368 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38369 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38370
38371 @item
38372 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38373
38374 @item
38375 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38376
38377 @item
38378 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38379 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38380 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38381 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38382 packet.
38383
38384 @end itemize
38385
38386 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38387 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38388
38389 @itemize @bullet
38390 @item
38391 Return value.
38392
38393 @item
38394 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38395
38396 @item
38397 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38398
38399 @end itemize
38400
38401 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38402 the latest continue or step action.
38403
38404 @node The F Request Packet
38405 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38406 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38407 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38408
38409 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38410
38411 @table @samp
38412 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38413
38414 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38415 This is just the name of the function.
38416
38417 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38418 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38419 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38420 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38421 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38422 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38423 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38424
38425 @end table
38426
38427
38428
38429 @node The F Reply Packet
38430 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38431 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38432 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38433
38434 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38435
38436 @table @samp
38437
38438 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38439
38440 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38441
38442 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38443 representation.
38444 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38445
38446 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38447 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38448 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38449
38450 @smallexample
38451 F0,0,C
38452 @end smallexample
38453
38454 @noindent
38455 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38456
38457 @smallexample
38458 F-1,4,C
38459 @end smallexample
38460
38461 @noindent
38462 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38463
38464 @end table
38465
38466
38467 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38468 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38469 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38470
38471 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38472 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38473 the target should behave as if it had
38474 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38475 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38476 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38477 packet.
38478
38479 It's important for the target to know in which
38480 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38481
38482 @itemize @bullet
38483 @item
38484 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38485
38486 @item
38487 The system call on the host has been finished.
38488
38489 @end itemize
38490
38491 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38492 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38493 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38494 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38495 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38496 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38497
38498 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38499 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38500 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38501 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38502 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38503 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38504 or the full action has been completed.
38505
38506 @node Console I/O
38507 @subsection Console I/O
38508 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38509
38510 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38511 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38512 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38513 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38514 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38515 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38516 conditions is met:
38517
38518 @itemize @bullet
38519 @item
38520 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38521 @code{read}
38522 system call is treated as finished.
38523
38524 @item
38525 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38526 newline.
38527
38528 @item
38529 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38530 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38531
38532 @end itemize
38533
38534 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38535 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38536 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38537 is stopped at the user's request.
38538
38539
38540 @node List of Supported Calls
38541 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38542 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38543
38544 @menu
38545 * open::
38546 * close::
38547 * read::
38548 * write::
38549 * lseek::
38550 * rename::
38551 * unlink::
38552 * stat/fstat::
38553 * gettimeofday::
38554 * isatty::
38555 * system::
38556 @end menu
38557
38558 @node open
38559 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38560 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38561
38562 @table @asis
38563 @item Synopsis:
38564 @smallexample
38565 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38566 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38567 @end smallexample
38568
38569 @item Request:
38570 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38571
38572 @noindent
38573 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38574
38575 @table @code
38576 @item O_CREAT
38577 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38578 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38579 are concerned.
38580
38581 @item O_EXCL
38582 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38583 an error and open() fails.
38584
38585 @item O_TRUNC
38586 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38587 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38588 truncated to zero length.
38589
38590 @item O_APPEND
38591 The file is opened in append mode.
38592
38593 @item O_RDONLY
38594 The file is opened for reading only.
38595
38596 @item O_WRONLY
38597 The file is opened for writing only.
38598
38599 @item O_RDWR
38600 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38601 @end table
38602
38603 @noindent
38604 Other bits are silently ignored.
38605
38606
38607 @noindent
38608 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38609
38610 @table @code
38611 @item S_IRUSR
38612 User has read permission.
38613
38614 @item S_IWUSR
38615 User has write permission.
38616
38617 @item S_IRGRP
38618 Group has read permission.
38619
38620 @item S_IWGRP
38621 Group has write permission.
38622
38623 @item S_IROTH
38624 Others have read permission.
38625
38626 @item S_IWOTH
38627 Others have write permission.
38628 @end table
38629
38630 @noindent
38631 Other bits are silently ignored.
38632
38633
38634 @item Return value:
38635 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38636 occurred.
38637
38638 @item Errors:
38639
38640 @table @code
38641 @item EEXIST
38642 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38643
38644 @item EISDIR
38645 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38646
38647 @item EACCES
38648 The requested access is not allowed.
38649
38650 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38651 @var{pathname} was too long.
38652
38653 @item ENOENT
38654 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38655
38656 @item ENODEV
38657 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38658
38659 @item EROFS
38660 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38661 write access was requested.
38662
38663 @item EFAULT
38664 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38665
38666 @item ENOSPC
38667 No space on device to create the file.
38668
38669 @item EMFILE
38670 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38671
38672 @item ENFILE
38673 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38674 has been reached.
38675
38676 @item EINTR
38677 The call was interrupted by the user.
38678 @end table
38679
38680 @end table
38681
38682 @node close
38683 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38684 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38685
38686 @table @asis
38687 @item Synopsis:
38688 @smallexample
38689 int close(int fd);
38690 @end smallexample
38691
38692 @item Request:
38693 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38694
38695 @item Return value:
38696 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38697
38698 @item Errors:
38699
38700 @table @code
38701 @item EBADF
38702 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38703
38704 @item EINTR
38705 The call was interrupted by the user.
38706 @end table
38707
38708 @end table
38709
38710 @node read
38711 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38712 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38713
38714 @table @asis
38715 @item Synopsis:
38716 @smallexample
38717 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38718 @end smallexample
38719
38720 @item Request:
38721 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38722
38723 @item Return value:
38724 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38725 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38726 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38727
38728 @item Errors:
38729
38730 @table @code
38731 @item EBADF
38732 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38733 reading.
38734
38735 @item EFAULT
38736 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38737
38738 @item EINTR
38739 The call was interrupted by the user.
38740 @end table
38741
38742 @end table
38743
38744 @node write
38745 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38746 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38747
38748 @table @asis
38749 @item Synopsis:
38750 @smallexample
38751 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38752 @end smallexample
38753
38754 @item Request:
38755 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38756
38757 @item Return value:
38758 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38759 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38760 is returned.
38761
38762 @item Errors:
38763
38764 @table @code
38765 @item EBADF
38766 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38767 writing.
38768
38769 @item EFAULT
38770 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38771
38772 @item EFBIG
38773 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38774 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38775
38776 @item ENOSPC
38777 No space on device to write the data.
38778
38779 @item EINTR
38780 The call was interrupted by the user.
38781 @end table
38782
38783 @end table
38784
38785 @node lseek
38786 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38787 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38788
38789 @table @asis
38790 @item Synopsis:
38791 @smallexample
38792 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38793 @end smallexample
38794
38795 @item Request:
38796 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38797
38798 @var{flag} is one of:
38799
38800 @table @code
38801 @item SEEK_SET
38802 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38803
38804 @item SEEK_CUR
38805 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38806 bytes.
38807
38808 @item SEEK_END
38809 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38810 bytes.
38811 @end table
38812
38813 @item Return value:
38814 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38815 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
38816 value of -1 is returned.
38817
38818 @item Errors:
38819
38820 @table @code
38821 @item EBADF
38822 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
38823
38824 @item ESPIPE
38825 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
38826
38827 @item EINVAL
38828 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
38829
38830 @item EINTR
38831 The call was interrupted by the user.
38832 @end table
38833
38834 @end table
38835
38836 @node rename
38837 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
38838 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
38839
38840 @table @asis
38841 @item Synopsis:
38842 @smallexample
38843 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
38844 @end smallexample
38845
38846 @item Request:
38847 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
38848
38849 @item Return value:
38850 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38851
38852 @item Errors:
38853
38854 @table @code
38855 @item EISDIR
38856 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
38857 directory.
38858
38859 @item EEXIST
38860 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
38861
38862 @item EBUSY
38863 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
38864 process.
38865
38866 @item EINVAL
38867 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
38868 of itself.
38869
38870 @item ENOTDIR
38871 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
38872 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
38873 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
38874
38875 @item EFAULT
38876 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
38877
38878 @item EACCES
38879 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38880
38881 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38882
38883 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
38884
38885 @item ENOENT
38886 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
38887
38888 @item EROFS
38889 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38890
38891 @item ENOSPC
38892 The device containing the file has no room for the new
38893 directory entry.
38894
38895 @item EINTR
38896 The call was interrupted by the user.
38897 @end table
38898
38899 @end table
38900
38901 @node unlink
38902 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
38903 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
38904
38905 @table @asis
38906 @item Synopsis:
38907 @smallexample
38908 int unlink(const char *pathname);
38909 @end smallexample
38910
38911 @item Request:
38912 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
38913
38914 @item Return value:
38915 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38916
38917 @item Errors:
38918
38919 @table @code
38920 @item EACCES
38921 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38922
38923 @item EPERM
38924 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
38925
38926 @item EBUSY
38927 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
38928 being used by another process.
38929
38930 @item EFAULT
38931 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38932
38933 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38934 @var{pathname} was too long.
38935
38936 @item ENOENT
38937 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38938
38939 @item ENOTDIR
38940 A component of the path is not a directory.
38941
38942 @item EROFS
38943 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38944
38945 @item EINTR
38946 The call was interrupted by the user.
38947 @end table
38948
38949 @end table
38950
38951 @node stat/fstat
38952 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
38953 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
38954 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
38955
38956 @table @asis
38957 @item Synopsis:
38958 @smallexample
38959 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
38960 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
38961 @end smallexample
38962
38963 @item Request:
38964 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
38965 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
38966
38967 @item Return value:
38968 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38969
38970 @item Errors:
38971
38972 @table @code
38973 @item EBADF
38974 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
38975
38976 @item ENOENT
38977 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
38978 path is an empty string.
38979
38980 @item ENOTDIR
38981 A component of the path is not a directory.
38982
38983 @item EFAULT
38984 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38985
38986 @item EACCES
38987 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38988
38989 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38990 @var{pathname} was too long.
38991
38992 @item EINTR
38993 The call was interrupted by the user.
38994 @end table
38995
38996 @end table
38997
38998 @node gettimeofday
38999 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39000 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39001
39002 @table @asis
39003 @item Synopsis:
39004 @smallexample
39005 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39006 @end smallexample
39007
39008 @item Request:
39009 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39010
39011 @item Return value:
39012 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39013
39014 @item Errors:
39015
39016 @table @code
39017 @item EINVAL
39018 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39019
39020 @item EFAULT
39021 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39022 @end table
39023
39024 @end table
39025
39026 @node isatty
39027 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39028 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39029
39030 @table @asis
39031 @item Synopsis:
39032 @smallexample
39033 int isatty(int fd);
39034 @end smallexample
39035
39036 @item Request:
39037 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39038
39039 @item Return value:
39040 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39041
39042 @item Errors:
39043
39044 @table @code
39045 @item EINTR
39046 The call was interrupted by the user.
39047 @end table
39048
39049 @end table
39050
39051 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39052 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39053 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39054 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39055 needed.
39056
39057
39058 @node system
39059 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39060 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39061
39062 @table @asis
39063 @item Synopsis:
39064 @smallexample
39065 int system(const char *command);
39066 @end smallexample
39067
39068 @item Request:
39069 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39070
39071 @item Return value:
39072 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39073 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39074 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39075 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39076 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39077 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39078 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39079
39080 @item Errors:
39081
39082 @table @code
39083 @item EINTR
39084 The call was interrupted by the user.
39085 @end table
39086
39087 @end table
39088
39089 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39090 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39091 the host is simplified before it's returned
39092 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39093 is discarded, and the return value consists
39094 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39095
39096 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39097 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39098 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39099
39100 @table @code
39101 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39102 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39103 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39104 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39105
39106 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39107 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39108 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39109 protocol.
39110 @end table
39111
39112 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39113 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39114 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39115
39116 @menu
39117 * Integral Datatypes::
39118 * Pointer Values::
39119 * Memory Transfer::
39120 * struct stat::
39121 * struct timeval::
39122 @end menu
39123
39124 @node Integral Datatypes
39125 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39126 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39127
39128 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39129 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39130 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39131
39132 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39133 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39134
39135 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39136
39137 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39138 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39139
39140 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39141
39142 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39143 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39144 byte order.
39145
39146 @node Pointer Values
39147 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39148 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39149
39150 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39151 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39152 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39153 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39154
39155 @smallexample
39156 @code{1aaf/12}
39157 @end smallexample
39158
39159 @noindent
39160 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39161 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39162 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39163 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39164
39165 @smallexample
39166 @code{123456/d}
39167 @end smallexample
39168
39169 @node Memory Transfer
39170 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39171 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39172
39173 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39174 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39175 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39176 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39177 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39178 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39179 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39180
39181
39182 @node struct stat
39183 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39184 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39185
39186 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39187 is defined as follows:
39188
39189 @smallexample
39190 struct stat @{
39191 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39192 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39193 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39194 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39195 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39196 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39197 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39198 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39199 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39200 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39201 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39202 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39203 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39204 @};
39205 @end smallexample
39206
39207 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39208 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39209 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39210
39211 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39212 range of values.
39213
39214 @table @code
39215
39216 @item st_dev
39217 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39218
39219 @item st_ino
39220 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39221
39222 @item st_mode
39223 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39224 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39225
39226 @item st_uid
39227 @itemx st_gid
39228 @itemx st_rdev
39229 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39230
39231 @item st_atime
39232 @itemx st_mtime
39233 @itemx st_ctime
39234 These values have a host and file system dependent
39235 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39236 support exact timing values.
39237 @end table
39238
39239 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39240 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39241 continuing.
39242
39243 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39244 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39245 get truncated on the target.
39246
39247 @node struct timeval
39248 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39249 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39250
39251 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39252 is defined as follows:
39253
39254 @smallexample
39255 struct timeval @{
39256 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39257 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39258 @};
39259 @end smallexample
39260
39261 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39262 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39263 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39264
39265 @node Constants
39266 @subsection Constants
39267 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39268
39269 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39270 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39271 values before and after the call as needed.
39272
39273 @menu
39274 * Open Flags::
39275 * mode_t Values::
39276 * Errno Values::
39277 * Lseek Flags::
39278 * Limits::
39279 @end menu
39280
39281 @node Open Flags
39282 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39283 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39284
39285 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39286
39287 @smallexample
39288 O_RDONLY 0x0
39289 O_WRONLY 0x1
39290 O_RDWR 0x2
39291 O_APPEND 0x8
39292 O_CREAT 0x200
39293 O_TRUNC 0x400
39294 O_EXCL 0x800
39295 @end smallexample
39296
39297 @node mode_t Values
39298 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39299 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39300
39301 All values are given in octal representation.
39302
39303 @smallexample
39304 S_IFREG 0100000
39305 S_IFDIR 040000
39306 S_IRUSR 0400
39307 S_IWUSR 0200
39308 S_IXUSR 0100
39309 S_IRGRP 040
39310 S_IWGRP 020
39311 S_IXGRP 010
39312 S_IROTH 04
39313 S_IWOTH 02
39314 S_IXOTH 01
39315 @end smallexample
39316
39317 @node Errno Values
39318 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39319 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39320
39321 All values are given in decimal representation.
39322
39323 @smallexample
39324 EPERM 1
39325 ENOENT 2
39326 EINTR 4
39327 EBADF 9
39328 EACCES 13
39329 EFAULT 14
39330 EBUSY 16
39331 EEXIST 17
39332 ENODEV 19
39333 ENOTDIR 20
39334 EISDIR 21
39335 EINVAL 22
39336 ENFILE 23
39337 EMFILE 24
39338 EFBIG 27
39339 ENOSPC 28
39340 ESPIPE 29
39341 EROFS 30
39342 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39343 EUNKNOWN 9999
39344 @end smallexample
39345
39346 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39347 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39348
39349 @node Lseek Flags
39350 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39351 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39352
39353 @smallexample
39354 SEEK_SET 0
39355 SEEK_CUR 1
39356 SEEK_END 2
39357 @end smallexample
39358
39359 @node Limits
39360 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39361 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39362
39363 All values are given in decimal representation.
39364
39365 @smallexample
39366 INT_MIN -2147483648
39367 INT_MAX 2147483647
39368 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39369 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39370 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39371 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39372 @end smallexample
39373
39374 @node File-I/O Examples
39375 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39376 @cindex file-i/o examples
39377
39378 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39379 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39380
39381 @smallexample
39382 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39383 @emph{request memory read from target}
39384 -> @code{m1234,6}
39385 <- XXXXXX
39386 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39387 -> @code{F6}
39388 @end smallexample
39389
39390 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39391 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39392
39393 @smallexample
39394 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39395 @emph{request memory write to target}
39396 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39397 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39398 -> @code{F6}
39399 @end smallexample
39400
39401 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39402 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39403
39404 @smallexample
39405 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39406 -> @code{F-1,9}
39407 @end smallexample
39408
39409 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39410 host is called:
39411
39412 @smallexample
39413 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39414 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39415 <- @code{T02}
39416 @end smallexample
39417
39418 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39419 host is called:
39420
39421 @smallexample
39422 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39423 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39424 <- @code{T02}
39425 @end smallexample
39426
39427 @node Library List Format
39428 @section Library List Format
39429 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39430
39431 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39432 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39433 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39434 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39435 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39436 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39437 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39438 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39439 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39440 are loaded.
39441
39442 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39443 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39444 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39445 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39446
39447 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39448 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39449 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39450 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39451 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39452 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39453
39454 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39455 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39456
39457 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39458 offset, looks like this:
39459
39460 @smallexample
39461 <library-list>
39462 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39463 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39464 </library>
39465 </library-list>
39466 @end smallexample
39467
39468 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39469 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39470
39471 @smallexample
39472 <library-list>
39473 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39474 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39475 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39476 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39477 </library>
39478 </library-list>
39479 @end smallexample
39480
39481 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39482
39483 @smallexample
39484 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39485 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39486 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39487 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39488 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39489 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39490 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39491 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39492 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39493 @end smallexample
39494
39495 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39496 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39497 section for each library.
39498
39499 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39500 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39501 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39502
39503 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39504 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39505 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39506 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39507
39508 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39509 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39510 target, the following parameters are reported:
39511
39512 @itemize @minus
39513 @item
39514 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39515 @code{struct link_map}.
39516 @item
39517 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39518 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39519 @item
39520 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39521 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39522 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39523 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39524 @item
39525 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39526 @end itemize
39527
39528 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39529 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39530 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39531
39532 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39533 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39534
39535 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39536 looks like this:
39537
39538 @smallexample
39539 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39540 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39541 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39542 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39543 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39544 </library-list-svr>
39545 @end smallexample
39546
39547 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39548
39549 @smallexample
39550 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39551 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39552 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39553 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39554 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39555 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39556 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39557 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39558 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39559 @end smallexample
39560
39561 @node Memory Map Format
39562 @section Memory Map Format
39563 @cindex memory map format
39564
39565 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39566 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39567 memory map.
39568
39569 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39570 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39571 lists memory regions.
39572
39573 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39574 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39575
39576 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39577
39578 @smallexample
39579 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39580 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39581 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39582 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39583 <memory-map>
39584 region...
39585 </memory-map>
39586 @end smallexample
39587
39588 Each region can be either:
39589
39590 @itemize
39591
39592 @item
39593 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39594 bytes from there:
39595
39596 @smallexample
39597 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39598 @end smallexample
39599
39600
39601 @item
39602 A region of read-only memory:
39603
39604 @smallexample
39605 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39606 @end smallexample
39607
39608
39609 @item
39610 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39611 bytes in length:
39612
39613 @smallexample
39614 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39615 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39616 </memory>
39617 @end smallexample
39618
39619 @end itemize
39620
39621 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39622 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39623 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39624
39625 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39626
39627 @smallexample
39628 <!-- ................................................... -->
39629 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39630 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39631 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39632 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39633 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39634 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39635 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39636 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39637 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39638 and its type, or device. -->
39639 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39640 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39641 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39642 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39643 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39644 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39645 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39646 @end smallexample
39647
39648 @node Thread List Format
39649 @section Thread List Format
39650 @cindex thread list format
39651
39652 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39653 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39654 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39655 the following structure:
39656
39657 @smallexample
39658 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39659 <threads>
39660 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
39661 ... description ...
39662 </thread>
39663 </threads>
39664 @end smallexample
39665
39666 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39667 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39668 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39669 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
39670 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
39671 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
39672 auxiliary information.
39673
39674 @node Traceframe Info Format
39675 @section Traceframe Info Format
39676 @cindex traceframe info format
39677
39678 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39679 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39680 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39681 collected in a traceframe.
39682
39683 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39684 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39685
39686 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39687 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39688
39689 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39690
39691 @smallexample
39692 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39693 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39694 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39695 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39696 <traceframe-info>
39697 block...
39698 </traceframe-info>
39699 @end smallexample
39700
39701 Each traceframe block can be either:
39702
39703 @itemize
39704
39705 @item
39706 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39707 @var{length} bytes from there:
39708
39709 @smallexample
39710 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39711 @end smallexample
39712
39713 @item
39714 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39715 collected:
39716
39717 @smallexample
39718 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39719 @end smallexample
39720
39721 @end itemize
39722
39723 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39724
39725 @smallexample
39726 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39727 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39728
39729 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39730 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39731 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39732 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39733 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39734 @end smallexample
39735
39736 @node Branch Trace Format
39737 @section Branch Trace Format
39738 @cindex branch trace format
39739
39740 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39741 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39742 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39743 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39744
39745 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39746 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39747
39748 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39749 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39750
39751 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39752
39753 @smallexample
39754 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39755 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39756 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39757 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39758 <btrace>
39759 block...
39760 </btrace>
39761 @end smallexample
39762
39763 @itemize
39764
39765 @item
39766 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39767 and ending at @var{end}:
39768
39769 @smallexample
39770 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39771 @end smallexample
39772
39773 @end itemize
39774
39775 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39776
39777 @smallexample
39778 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
39779 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39780
39781 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39782 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
39783 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
39784
39785 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
39786
39787 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
39788
39789 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
39790 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
39791 family CDATA #REQUIRED
39792 model CDATA #REQUIRED
39793 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
39794
39795 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
39796 @end smallexample
39797
39798 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
39799 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
39800 @cindex branch trace configuration format
39801
39802 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
39803 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39804 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
39805
39806 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
39807 settings for that format. The following information is described:
39808
39809 @table @code
39810 @item bts
39811 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
39812 @table @code
39813 @item size
39814 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
39815 @end table
39816 @item pt
39817 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel(R) Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel(R)
39818 PT}) format.
39819 @table @code
39820 @item size
39821 The size of the @acronym{Intel(R) PT} ring buffer in bytes.
39822 @end table
39823 @end table
39824
39825 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39826 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39827
39828 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
39829
39830 @smallexample
39831 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
39832 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39833
39834 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
39835 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39836
39837 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
39838 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39839 @end smallexample
39840
39841 @include agentexpr.texi
39842
39843 @node Target Descriptions
39844 @appendix Target Descriptions
39845 @cindex target descriptions
39846
39847 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
39848 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
39849 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
39850 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
39851 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
39852 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
39853 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
39854
39855 @itemize @bullet
39856 @item
39857 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
39858 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
39859 @item
39860 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
39861 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
39862 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
39863 @item
39864 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
39865 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
39866 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
39867 @end itemize
39868
39869 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
39870 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
39871 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
39872 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
39873 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
39874
39875 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39876 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
39877
39878 @menu
39879 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
39880 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
39881 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
39882 descriptions.
39883 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
39884 @end menu
39885
39886 @node Retrieving Descriptions
39887 @section Retrieving Descriptions
39888
39889 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
39890 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
39891 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
39892 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
39893 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
39894 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
39895 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
39896 Format}.
39897
39898 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
39899 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
39900 specify a file are:
39901
39902 @table @code
39903 @cindex set tdesc filename
39904 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
39905 Read the target description from @var{path}.
39906
39907 @cindex unset tdesc filename
39908 @item unset tdesc filename
39909 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
39910 will use the description supplied by the current target.
39911
39912 @cindex show tdesc filename
39913 @item show tdesc filename
39914 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
39915 @end table
39916
39917
39918 @node Target Description Format
39919 @section Target Description Format
39920 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
39921
39922 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
39923 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
39924 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
39925 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
39926 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
39927 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
39928 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
39929
39930 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
39931 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
39932 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
39933 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
39934 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
39935
39936 Here is a simple target description:
39937
39938 @smallexample
39939 <target version="1.0">
39940 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
39941 </target>
39942 @end smallexample
39943
39944 @noindent
39945 This minimal description only says that the target uses
39946 the x86-64 architecture.
39947
39948 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
39949 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
39950 are explained further below.
39951
39952 @smallexample
39953 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39954 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
39955 <target version="1.0">
39956 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
39957 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
39958 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
39959 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
39960 </target>
39961 @end smallexample
39962
39963 @noindent
39964 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
39965 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
39966 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
39967 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
39968 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
39969 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
39970 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
39971 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
39972 the version mismatch.
39973
39974 @subsection Inclusion
39975 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
39976 @cindex XInclude
39977 @ifnotinfo
39978 @cindex <xi:include>
39979 @end ifnotinfo
39980
39981 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
39982 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
39983 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
39984 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
39985 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
39986
39987 @smallexample
39988 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
39989 @end smallexample
39990
39991 @noindent
39992 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
39993 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
39994 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
39995 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
39996 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
39997 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
39998 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
39999 original description.
40000
40001 @subsection Architecture
40002 @cindex <architecture>
40003
40004 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40005
40006 @smallexample
40007 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40008 @end smallexample
40009
40010 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40011 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40012
40013 @subsection OS ABI
40014 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40015
40016 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40017 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40018
40019 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40020
40021 @smallexample
40022 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40023 @end smallexample
40024
40025 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40026 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40027
40028 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40029 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40030
40031 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40032 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40033
40034 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40035
40036 @smallexample
40037 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40038 @end smallexample
40039
40040 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40041 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40042
40043 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40044 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40045 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40046 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40047 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40048 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40049 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40050
40051 @smallexample
40052 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40053 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40054 @end smallexample
40055
40056 @subsection Features
40057 @cindex <feature>
40058
40059 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40060 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40061 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40062 has this form:
40063
40064 @smallexample
40065 <feature name="@var{name}">
40066 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40067 @var{reg}@dots{}
40068 </feature>
40069 @end smallexample
40070
40071 @noindent
40072 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40073 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40074 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40075 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40076
40077 @subsection Types
40078
40079 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40080 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40081 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40082 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40083 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
40084
40085 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40086 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40087 Types must be defined before they are used.
40088
40089 @cindex <vector>
40090 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40091 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40092 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40093 @var{count}:
40094
40095 @smallexample
40096 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40097 @end smallexample
40098
40099 @cindex <union>
40100 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40101 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40102 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40103 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40104
40105 @smallexample
40106 <union id="@var{id}">
40107 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40108 @dots{}
40109 </union>
40110 @end smallexample
40111
40112 @cindex <struct>
40113 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40114 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
40115 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
40116 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
40117 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
40118 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
40119 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
40120 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
40121
40122 @smallexample
40123 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40124 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40125 @dots{}
40126 </struct>
40127 @end smallexample
40128
40129 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
40130 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
40131
40132 @smallexample
40133 <struct id="@var{id}">
40134 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40135 @dots{}
40136 </struct>
40137 @end smallexample
40138
40139 @cindex <flags>
40140 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
40141 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
40142 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
40143 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
40144 are supported.
40145
40146 @smallexample
40147 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40148 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40149 @dots{}
40150 </flags>
40151 @end smallexample
40152
40153 @subsection Registers
40154 @cindex <reg>
40155
40156 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40157
40158 @smallexample
40159 <reg name="@var{name}"
40160 bitsize="@var{size}"
40161 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40162 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40163 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40164 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40165 @end smallexample
40166
40167 @noindent
40168 The components are as follows:
40169
40170 @table @var
40171
40172 @item name
40173 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40174
40175 @item bitsize
40176 The register's size, in bits.
40177
40178 @item regnum
40179 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40180 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40181 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40182 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40183 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40184 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40185 in order of increasing register number.
40186
40187 @item save-restore
40188 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40189 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40190 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40191 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40192 ABI.
40193
40194 @item type
40195 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40196 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40197 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40198 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40199 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40200 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40201
40202 @item group
40203 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40204 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40205 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40206 in @code{info registers}.
40207
40208 @end table
40209
40210 @node Predefined Target Types
40211 @section Predefined Target Types
40212 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40213
40214 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40215 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40216 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40217 types. The currently supported types are:
40218
40219 @table @code
40220
40221 @item int8
40222 @itemx int16
40223 @itemx int32
40224 @itemx int64
40225 @itemx int128
40226 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40227
40228 @item uint8
40229 @itemx uint16
40230 @itemx uint32
40231 @itemx uint64
40232 @itemx uint128
40233 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40234
40235 @item code_ptr
40236 @itemx data_ptr
40237 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40238 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40239 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40240 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40241 may be marked as data pointers.
40242
40243 @item ieee_single
40244 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40245
40246 @item ieee_double
40247 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40248
40249 @item arm_fpa_ext
40250 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40251
40252 @item i387_ext
40253 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40254
40255 @item i386_eflags
40256 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40257
40258 @item i386_mxcsr
40259 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40260
40261 @end table
40262
40263 @node Standard Target Features
40264 @section Standard Target Features
40265 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40266
40267 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40268 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40269 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40270 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40271 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40272 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40273 can recognize them.
40274
40275 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40276 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40277 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40278 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40279 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40280 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40281 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40282 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40283
40284 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40285 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40286 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40287
40288 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40289 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40290 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40291 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40292
40293 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40294 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40295 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40296
40297 @menu
40298 * AArch64 Features::
40299 * ARM Features::
40300 * i386 Features::
40301 * MicroBlaze Features::
40302 * MIPS Features::
40303 * M68K Features::
40304 * Nios II Features::
40305 * PowerPC Features::
40306 * S/390 and System z Features::
40307 * TIC6x Features::
40308 @end menu
40309
40310
40311 @node AArch64 Features
40312 @subsection AArch64 Features
40313 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40314
40315 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40316 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40317 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40318
40319 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40320 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40321 and @samp{fpcr}.
40322
40323 @node ARM Features
40324 @subsection ARM Features
40325 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40326
40327 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40328 ARM targets.
40329 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40330 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40331
40332 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40333 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40334 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40335 and @samp{xpsr}.
40336
40337 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40338 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40339
40340 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40341 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40342 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40343 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40344
40345 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40346 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40347 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40348 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40349 halves of the double-precision registers.
40350
40351 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40352 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40353 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40354 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40355 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40356 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40357
40358 @node i386 Features
40359 @subsection i386 Features
40360 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40361
40362 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40363 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40364
40365 @itemize @minus
40366 @item
40367 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40368 @item
40369 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40370 @item
40371 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40372 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40373 @item
40374 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40375 @item
40376 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40377 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40378 @end itemize
40379
40380 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40381
40382 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40383 describe registers:
40384
40385 @itemize @minus
40386 @item
40387 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40388 @item
40389 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40390 @item
40391 @samp{mxcsr}
40392 @end itemize
40393
40394 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40395 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40396 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40397
40398 @itemize @minus
40399 @item
40400 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40401 @item
40402 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40403 @end itemize
40404
40405 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
40406 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40407
40408 @itemize @minus
40409 @item
40410 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40411 @item
40412 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40413 @end itemize
40414
40415 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40416 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40417
40418 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40419 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40420 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40421
40422 @itemize @minus
40423 @item
40424 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40425 @end itemize
40426
40427 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40428
40429 @itemize @minus
40430 @item
40431 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40432 @end itemize
40433
40434 It should
40435 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40436
40437 @itemize @minus
40438 @item
40439 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40440 @item
40441 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40442 @end itemize
40443
40444 It should
40445 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40446
40447 @itemize @minus
40448 @item
40449 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40450 @end itemize
40451
40452 @node MicroBlaze Features
40453 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40454 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40455
40456 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40457 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40458 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40459 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40460 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40461
40462 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40463 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40464
40465 @node MIPS Features
40466 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40467 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40468
40469 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40470 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40471 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40472 on the target.
40473
40474 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40475 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40476 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40477
40478 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40479 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40480 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40481 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40482
40483 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40484 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40485 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40486 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40487
40488 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40489 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40490 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40491
40492 @node M68K Features
40493 @subsection M68K Features
40494 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40495
40496 @table @code
40497 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40498 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40499 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40500 One of those features must be always present.
40501 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40502 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40503 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40504 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40505
40506 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40507 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40508 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40509 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40510 @end table
40511
40512 @node Nios II Features
40513 @subsection Nios II Features
40514 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40515
40516 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40517 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40518 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40519 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40520 @samp{mpuacc}).
40521
40522 @node PowerPC Features
40523 @subsection PowerPC Features
40524 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40525
40526 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40527 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40528 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40529 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40530
40531 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40532 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40533
40534 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40535 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40536 and @samp{vrsave}.
40537
40538 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40539 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40540 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40541 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40542 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40543 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40544
40545 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40546 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40547 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40548 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40549 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40550 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40551 user.
40552
40553 @node S/390 and System z Features
40554 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40555 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40556 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40557
40558 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40559 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40560 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40561 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40562 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40563 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40564 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40565 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40566 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40567
40568 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40569 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40570 @samp{fpc}.
40571
40572 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40573 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40574
40575 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40576 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40577 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40578 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40579 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40580 32-bit wide.
40581
40582 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40583 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40584 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40585
40586 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40587 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40588 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40589 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40590 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40591 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40592 @samp{v31}.
40593
40594 @node TIC6x Features
40595 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40596 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40597 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40598 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40599 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40600 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40601
40602 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40603 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40604 through @samp{B31}.
40605
40606 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40607 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40608
40609 @node Operating System Information
40610 @appendix Operating System Information
40611 @cindex operating system information
40612
40613 @menu
40614 * Process list::
40615 @end menu
40616
40617 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40618 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40619 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40620 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40621 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40622 on a different aspect of target.
40623
40624 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40625 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40626 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40627 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40628
40629 @node Process list
40630 @appendixsection Process list
40631 @cindex operating system information, process list
40632
40633 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40634 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40635 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40636 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40637
40638 An example document is:
40639
40640 @smallexample
40641 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40642 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40643 <osdata type="processes">
40644 <item>
40645 <column name="pid">1</column>
40646 <column name="user">root</column>
40647 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40648 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40649 </item>
40650 </osdata>
40651 @end smallexample
40652
40653 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40654 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40655 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40656 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40657 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40658 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40659 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40660
40661 @node Trace File Format
40662 @appendix Trace File Format
40663 @cindex trace file format
40664
40665 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40666 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40667
40668 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40669 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40670 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40671 in the future.
40672
40673 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40674 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40675 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40676 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40677 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40678 of this section.
40679
40680 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40681
40682 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40683 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40684 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40685 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40686 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40687 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40688 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40689 endianness.
40690
40691 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40692
40693 @table @code
40694 @item R @var{bytes}
40695 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40696 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40697 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40698 hexadecimal encoding.
40699
40700 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40701 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40702 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40703 @var{length} bytes.
40704
40705 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40706 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40707 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40708
40709 @end table
40710
40711 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40712 of blocks.
40713
40714 @node Index Section Format
40715 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40716 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40717 @cindex index section format
40718
40719 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40720 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40721 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40722 description.
40723
40724 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40725 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40726 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40727 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40728 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40729 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40730
40731 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40732
40733 @enumerate
40734 @item
40735 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40736 unless otherwise noted:
40737
40738 @enumerate
40739 @item
40740 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40741 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40742 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40743 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40744 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40745 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40746 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40747
40748 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40749 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40750 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40751 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40752
40753 @item
40754 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40755
40756 @item
40757 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40758 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40759 to the next offset.
40760
40761 @item
40762 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40763
40764 @item
40765 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40766
40767 @item
40768 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40769 @end enumerate
40770
40771 @item
40772 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40773 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40774 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40775 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40776 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40777 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40778 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40779 CU indices.
40780
40781 @item
40782 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40783 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40784 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40785 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40786
40787 @item
40788 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40789 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40790
40791 @enumerate
40792 @item
40793 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40794
40795 @item
40796 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40797 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40798
40799 @item
40800 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40801 @end enumerate
40802
40803 @item
40804 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40805 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40806
40807 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40808 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40809 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40810 constant pool.
40811
40812 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40813 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40814 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40815
40816 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
40817 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
40818 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
40819 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
40820 index version:
40821
40822 @table @asis
40823 @item Version 4
40824 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
40825
40826 @item Versions 5 to 7
40827 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
40828 @end table
40829
40830 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
40831
40832 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
40833 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
40834 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
40835 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
40836 collision.
40837
40838 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
40839 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
40840 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
40841 the code.
40842
40843 @item
40844 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
40845 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
40846 strings.
40847
40848 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
40849 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
40850 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
40851 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
40852 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
40853 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
40854
40855 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
40856 @end enumerate
40857
40858 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
40859 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
40860 CU index+attributes value for each use.
40861
40862 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
40863 (bit 0 = LSB):
40864
40865 @table @asis
40866
40867 @item Bits 0-23
40868 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
40869 @item Bits 24-27
40870 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
40871 @item Bits 28-30
40872 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
40873
40874 @table @asis
40875 @item 0
40876 This value is reserved and should not be used.
40877 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
40878 with previous versions of the index.
40879 @item 1
40880 The symbol is a type.
40881 @item 2
40882 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
40883 @item 3
40884 The symbol is a function.
40885 @item 4
40886 Any other kind of symbol.
40887 @item 5,6,7
40888 These values are reserved.
40889 @end table
40890
40891 @item Bit 31
40892 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
40893
40894 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
40895 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
40896 @value{GDBN} sources.
40897
40898 @end table
40899
40900 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
40901 global/static attributes in the index.
40902
40903 @smallexample
40904 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
40905 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
40906 switch (die->tag)
40907 @{
40908 case DW_TAG_typedef:
40909 case DW_TAG_base_type:
40910 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
40911 kind = TYPE;
40912 is_static = 1;
40913 break;
40914 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
40915 kind = VARIABLE;
40916 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40917 break;
40918 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
40919 kind = FUNCTION;
40920 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
40921 break;
40922 case DW_TAG_constant:
40923 kind = VARIABLE;
40924 is_static = ! is_external;
40925 break;
40926 case DW_TAG_variable:
40927 kind = VARIABLE;
40928 is_static = ! is_external;
40929 break;
40930 case DW_TAG_namespace:
40931 kind = TYPE;
40932 is_static = 0;
40933 break;
40934 case DW_TAG_class_type:
40935 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
40936 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
40937 case DW_TAG_union_type:
40938 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
40939 kind = TYPE;
40940 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40941 break;
40942 default:
40943 assert (0);
40944 @}
40945 @end smallexample
40946
40947 @node Man Pages
40948 @appendix Manual pages
40949 @cindex Man pages
40950
40951 @menu
40952 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
40953 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
40954 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
40955 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
40956 @end menu
40957
40958 @node gdb man
40959 @heading gdb man
40960
40961 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
40962
40963 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
40964 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
40965 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
40966 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
40967 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
40968 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
40969 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
40970 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
40971 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
40972 @c man end
40973
40974 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
40975 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
40976 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
40977 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
40978
40979 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
40980 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
40981
40982 @itemize @bullet
40983 @item
40984 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
40985
40986 @item
40987 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
40988
40989 @item
40990 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
40991
40992 @item
40993 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
40994 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
40995 @end itemize
40996
40997 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
40998 Modula-2.
40999
41000 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41001 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41002 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41003 by using the command @code{help}.
41004
41005 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41006 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41007 executable program as the argument:
41008
41009 @smallexample
41010 gdb program
41011 @end smallexample
41012
41013 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41014
41015 @smallexample
41016 gdb program core
41017 @end smallexample
41018
41019 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41020 to debug a running process:
41021
41022 @smallexample
41023 gdb program 1234
41024 gdb -p 1234
41025 @end smallexample
41026
41027 @noindent
41028 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41029 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41030 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41031
41032 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41033
41034 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41035 @table @env
41036 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
41037 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41038
41039 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41040 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41041
41042 @item bt
41043 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41044
41045 @item print @var{expr}
41046 Display the value of an expression.
41047
41048 @item c
41049 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41050
41051 @item next
41052 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41053 function calls in the line.
41054
41055 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41056 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41057
41058 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41059 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41060
41061 @item step
41062 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41063 function calls in the line.
41064
41065 @item help [@var{name}]
41066 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41067 about using @value{GDBN}.
41068
41069 @item quit
41070 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41071 @end table
41072
41073 @ifset man
41074 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41075 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41076 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41077 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41078 @end ifset
41079 @c man end
41080
41081 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41082 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41083 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41084 encountered with no
41085 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41086 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41087 Many options have
41088 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41089 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41090 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41091 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41092 more usual convention.)
41093
41094 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41095 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41096 option is used.
41097
41098 @table @env
41099 @item -help
41100 @itemx -h
41101 List all options, with brief explanations.
41102
41103 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41104 @itemx -s @var{file}
41105 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41106
41107 @item -write
41108 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41109
41110 @item -exec=@var{file}
41111 @itemx -e @var{file}
41112 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41113 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41114 dump.
41115
41116 @item -se=@var{file}
41117 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41118 file.
41119
41120 @item -core=@var{file}
41121 @itemx -c @var{file}
41122 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41123
41124 @item -command=@var{file}
41125 @itemx -x @var{file}
41126 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41127
41128 @item -ex @var{command}
41129 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41130
41131 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41132 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41133 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41134
41135 @item -nh
41136 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41137
41138 @item -nx
41139 @itemx -n
41140 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41141
41142 @item -quiet
41143 @itemx -q
41144 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41145 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41146
41147 @item -batch
41148 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41149 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41150 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41151 commands in the command files.
41152
41153 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41154 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41155 more useful, the message
41156
41157 @smallexample
41158 Program exited normally.
41159 @end smallexample
41160
41161 @noindent
41162 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41163 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41164
41165 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41166 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41167 instead of the current directory.
41168
41169 @item -fullname
41170 @itemx -f
41171 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41172 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41173 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41174 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41175 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41176 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41177 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41178 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41179
41180 @item -b @var{bps}
41181 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41182 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41183
41184 @item -tty=@var{device}
41185 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41186 @end table
41187 @c man end
41188
41189 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41190 @ifset man
41191 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41192 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41193 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41194
41195 @smallexample
41196 info gdb
41197 @end smallexample
41198
41199 @noindent
41200 should give you access to the complete manual.
41201
41202 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41203 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41204 @end ifset
41205 @c man end
41206
41207 @node gdbserver man
41208 @heading gdbserver man
41209
41210 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41211 @format
41212 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41213 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41214
41215 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41216
41217 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41218 @c man end
41219 @end format
41220
41221 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41222 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41223 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41224
41225 @ifclear man
41226 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41227 @end ifclear
41228 @ifset man
41229 Usage (server (target) side):
41230 @end ifset
41231
41232 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41233 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41234 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41235 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41236
41237 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41238 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41239 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41240
41241 @smallexample
41242 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41243 @end smallexample
41244
41245 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41246
41247 @smallexample
41248 @ifset man
41249 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41250 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41251 @end ifset
41252 @ifclear man
41253 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41254 @end ifclear
41255 @end smallexample
41256
41257 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41258 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41259 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41260
41261 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41262
41263 @smallexample
41264 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41265 @end smallexample
41266
41267 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41268 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41269 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41270 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41271 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41272 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41273 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41274 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41275 print an error message and exit.
41276
41277 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41278 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41279
41280 @smallexample
41281 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41282 @end smallexample
41283
41284 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41285 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41286
41287 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41288 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41289 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41290 the program you want to debug.
41291
41292 @smallexample
41293 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41294 @end smallexample
41295
41296 @ifclear man
41297 @subheading Usage (host side)
41298 @end ifclear
41299 @ifset man
41300 Usage (host side):
41301 @end ifset
41302
41303 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41304 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41305 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41306 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41307 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41308 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41309 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41310 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41311 descriptor. For example:
41312
41313 @smallexample
41314 @ifset man
41315 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41316 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41317 @end ifset
41318 @ifclear man
41319 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41320 @end ifclear
41321 @end smallexample
41322
41323 @noindent
41324 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41325
41326 @smallexample
41327 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41328 @end smallexample
41329
41330 @noindent
41331 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41332 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41333 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41334 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41335 `Connection refused'.
41336
41337 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41338 described in
41339 @ifset man
41340 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41341 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41342 @end ifset
41343 @ifclear man
41344 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41345 @end ifclear
41346 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41347
41348 @smallexample
41349 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41350 @end smallexample
41351
41352 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41353 case.
41354 @c man end
41355
41356 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41357 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41358
41359 @itemize @bullet
41360
41361 @item
41362 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41363
41364 @smallexample
41365 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41366 @end smallexample
41367
41368 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41369 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41370 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41371 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41372 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41373 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41374 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41375
41376 @item
41377 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41378 program:
41379
41380 @smallexample
41381 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41382 @end smallexample
41383
41384 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41385 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41386 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41387 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41388
41389 @item
41390 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41391
41392 @smallexample
41393 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41394 @end smallexample
41395
41396 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41397 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41398 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41399 debug several processes in the same session.
41400 @end itemize
41401
41402 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41403
41404 @table @env
41405
41406 @item --help
41407 List all options, with brief explanations.
41408
41409 @item --version
41410 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41411
41412 @item --attach
41413 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41414
41415 @smallexample
41416 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41417 @end smallexample
41418
41419 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41420 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41421
41422 @item --multi
41423 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41424 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41425 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41426 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41427
41428 @smallexample
41429 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41430 @end smallexample
41431
41432 @item --debug
41433 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41434 process.
41435 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41436 the developers.
41437
41438 @item --remote-debug
41439 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41440 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41441 the developers.
41442
41443 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41444 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41445 of debugging output.
41446 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41447
41448 @item --wrapper
41449 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41450 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41451 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41452 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41453
41454 @item --once
41455 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41456 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41457 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41458 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41459
41460 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41461
41462 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41463 @c QDisableRandomization.
41464
41465 @end table
41466 @c man end
41467
41468 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41469 @ifset man
41470 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41471 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41472 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41473
41474 @smallexample
41475 info gdb
41476 @end smallexample
41477
41478 should give you access to the complete manual.
41479
41480 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41481 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41482 @end ifset
41483 @c man end
41484
41485 @node gcore man
41486 @heading gcore
41487
41488 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41489
41490 @format
41491 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41492 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41493 @c man end
41494 @end format
41495
41496 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41497 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41498 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41499 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41500 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41501 running without any change.
41502 @c man end
41503
41504 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41505 @table @env
41506 @item -o @var{filename}
41507 The optional argument
41508 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41509 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41510 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41511 @end table
41512 @c man end
41513
41514 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41515 @ifset man
41516 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41517 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41518 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41519
41520 @smallexample
41521 info gdb
41522 @end smallexample
41523
41524 @noindent
41525 should give you access to the complete manual.
41526
41527 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41528 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41529 @end ifset
41530 @c man end
41531
41532 @node gdbinit man
41533 @heading gdbinit
41534
41535 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41536
41537 @format
41538 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41539 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41540 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41541 @end ifset
41542
41543 ~/.gdbinit
41544
41545 ./.gdbinit
41546 @c man end
41547 @end format
41548
41549 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41550 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41551 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41552 described in
41553 @ifset man
41554 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41555 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41556 @end ifset
41557 @ifclear man
41558 @ref{Sequences}.
41559 @end ifclear
41560
41561 Please read more in
41562 @ifset man
41563 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41564 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41565 @end ifset
41566 @ifclear man
41567 @ref{Startup}.
41568 @end ifclear
41569
41570 @table @env
41571 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41572 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41573 @end ifset
41574 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41575 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41576 @end ifclear
41577 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41578 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41579 See more in
41580 @ifset man
41581 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41582 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41583 @end ifset
41584 @ifclear man
41585 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41586 @end ifclear
41587
41588 @item ~/.gdbinit
41589 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41590 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
41591
41592 @item ./.gdbinit
41593 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
41594 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
41595 See more in
41596 @ifset man
41597 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
41598 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
41599 @end ifset
41600 @ifclear man
41601 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
41602 @end ifclear
41603 @end table
41604 @c man end
41605
41606 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
41607 @ifset man
41608 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
41609
41610 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41611 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41612 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41613
41614 @smallexample
41615 info gdb
41616 @end smallexample
41617
41618 should give you access to the complete manual.
41619
41620 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41621 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41622 @end ifset
41623 @c man end
41624
41625 @include gpl.texi
41626
41627 @node GNU Free Documentation License
41628 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
41629 @include fdl.texi
41630
41631 @node Concept Index
41632 @unnumbered Concept Index
41633
41634 @printindex cp
41635
41636 @node Command and Variable Index
41637 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
41638
41639 @printindex fn
41640
41641 @tex
41642 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
41643 % meantime:
41644 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
41645 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
41646 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
41647 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
41648 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
41649 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
41650 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
41651 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
41652 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
41653 \page\colophon
41654 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
41655 @end tex
41656
41657 @bye
This page took 1.042568 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.